Phy 3
Phy 3
Phy 3
·-·- u , ca
-
1-1
+-'
ca · ·- a,
o
a u
' .. ■ ■
Ul
·C:-
'0
ca .S· ::I
C
0
+' a:: ',::( 2
I U- I I ;, I
LO ·a, � N C'l
Cl Cl) Lil .LU JJ,1
PAST PAPER
AL CE DSE
BY-TOPIC
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/01 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/02
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
TI
The following list of formulae may be found useful : 3. < HKCE 1984 Paper II - 24 >
Coulomb's law
+
X
00
A. B.o:J C. D.
Electric field between parallel plates (numerically)
Permittivity of free space Two uncharged metal spheres are suspended by insulating threads as shown in the diagram. A plastic sheet is put between
them. When a positively charged rod Xis brought near them as shown, which of the following diagrams shows the resulting
charge distnbution of the spheres ?
nm
A B
c. Ch
vµ �
Part A : HKCE examination questions .� .rh
Ct---]
1. < HKCE 1981 Paper n- 26 >
ti
s. < HKCE 1986 Paper II - 28 >
Two light conducting spheres are suspended from two silk threads as shown. If they are found to attract one another' which
one of the following conclusions is/are correct?
(I) They carry smri1ar charges. The diagram shows two conducting spheres X and Y mounted on insulating stands. Sphere X carries positive charges and
(2) They carry opposite charges. sphere Y carries negative charges. As Yis moved slowly towards X(but without touclringXJ the total charges onX
(3) Only one of them is charged. A. increase and are positive.
A. (2)only B. remain unchanged.
B. (3) only C. become negative.
C. (1) & (3) only D. disappear.
D. (2) & (3) only
tttttt
6. < BKCE 1987 Paper II- 37 >
2. < BKCE 1982 Paper II - 35 > In the figure shown, an electron travels in a horizontal direction and enters a
uniform electric field. The direction ofthe electric field is as shown. What
is the direction of the force due to the electric field acting on the electron?
A. upwards
B. downwards
C. into the page
D. out ofthepage
Three metal spheres X, Y and Z areplaced in contact as shown. A negatively charged rod is brought near z. The sphere yis
then earthed while the charged rod is still nearby. 'Which of the following statements is/are true?
(1) Xis negativelycharged. 7. < HKCE 1988 Paper II- 28 >
(2) Y is neutral. A positively charged metal sphere Xis brought near an uncharged metal sphere Y as
(3) Z is positively charged. shown. Y is then touched momentarily with a finger. Xis then taken away. Y is now
A. (3) only A. positively charged.
B. (I) & (2) only B. negatively charged.
C. (2) & (3) only C. negatively charged on the left side and positively charged on the right side.
D. (!), (2) & (3) D. positively charged on the left side and negatively charged on the right side.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/03 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/04
EMl: Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
:ti:
8. < HKCE 1990 Paper Il 30 > w
14. < HKCE 1995 Paper Il • 29 >
X y
A positively-charged metal sphere is mounted on an insulating stand. When the sphere is earthed with a finger,
A. protons will move from the sphere to the earth.
B. protons will move from the earth to the sphere.
C electrons will move from the sphere to the earth.
D. electrons will move from the earth to the sphere.
9. < BK.CE 1991 Paper 11 � 29 > Two insulated uncharged metal spheres X and Y are in contact with each other. A positively charged rod is brought nearXas
w
In the figure shown, X and Y are two insulated metal spheres in contact with each shown above. Which of the following diagrams correctly shows the distribution of charges on the spheres?
A.
CD
other. A negatively charged object C is brought near X Xis touched momentarily B.
with a finger, and thenX and Y are separated. The charges onXand Y are
SphereX Sphere Y
A. positive positive D.
CD
B. positive C.
negative
C. negative negative
D. positive "'°
10. < HKCE 1992Paper Il 30 > w 15. < HKCE 1996 Paper II - 29 >
A positively charged rod is brought near an insulated uncharged metal A small conducting sphere is suspended by an insulated thread. When a positively
sphere as shown in the figure. If1he sphere is earthed with a finger, charged rod is brought near the sphere, the sphere is attracted as shown. Which of
A. positive charges flow from the earth to the sphere. the following is/are reasonable dednction(s) ?
B. electrons flow from the earth to the sphere. (1) The sphere may carry a positive charge.
C. electrons flow from the sphere to the earth.
D. the sphere is completely discharged. (2) The sphere may carry a negative charge.
(3) The sphere.maybe neutral.
11. < HK.CE 1993 Paper Il 31 >w
A. (2)only
B. (1) & (3) only
An uncharged light conducting sphere is suspended by an insulating thread. The metal dome of an operating Van de Graaff C. (2) & (3) only
generator is brought near the sphere. Which of the following statements best descnl>es the motion of the sphere ? D. (1), (2) & (3)
A. The sphere remains stationazy.
B. The sphere moves away from the dome.
C. The sphere moves towards the dome, touches it and remains there. 16. <HKCE 1997Paperll- 27 >
D. The sphere moves towards the dome, touches it and then moves away.
The following are the steps to charge an isolated metal sphere by induction, but they are in the wrong order.
(1) Removing the finger away from the metal sphere.
12. < BKCE 1994 Paper n- 25>
(2) Touching the metal sphere with a finger.
Which of the following involve(s) the application of electrostatics ? (3) Bringing a positively charged rod near the metal sphere.
(I) A photocopier
(4) Removing the positively charged rod away from the metal sphere.
(2) A precipitator in the chimney ofa coal-fired power station
(3) A VandeGraaffgenerator Which of the following shows the correct order?
A. (3) only A. (2), (3), (4), (1)
B. (1) & (2) only B. (3), (2), (1), (4)
C. (1) & (3) only C. (3). (2), (4), (1)
D. (1), (2) & (3) D. (3), (4), (2), (1)
.
18. < HKCE 2000Paper 11- 28 > 21. < HK.CE 2003Paper II - 31 >
+ t"'"
' . -----------•' - .
''
•' '
': •
C
'l
''' '''
- L --------- >. -l +
Four point charges of equal magnitude are placed at the four vertices of a square. The signs of the charges are as shown. A
Two insulated uncharged metal spheres X and Y are p laced in contact. A positively-charged rod is brought near X as shown pciint charge C is placed at the centre of the square. What will be the direction of the resultant electrostatic force, if any,
above. Xis then earthed momentarily. The charged rod is removed and the two spheres are then separated. Which of the acting on C?
following dc:scnbes the charges onXand Y?
A. ➔
SphereX SphereY
B. t
A. negative negative
B. negative uncharged C. The resultant force acting on C is zero.
C. positive positive D. It cannot be determined sincethe sign of C is not given.
D. uncharged uncharged
+ + N N
20. <HKCE2002Paperll-31>
A. (1) on ly
B. (2) only
C. (3) on ly
D. (!), (2) & (3)
2S. < HKCE 2007 Paper ll - 19 > 29. < HK.AL 1985 Paper I - 45 >
t
p Q
a.,.,:::;
highvo::l
J
-C
In the above figures, P, Q, Rand Sare identical light conducting spheres and they are hanging freely by insulating threads of
the same length. Which of the following deductions is/are correct? A light conducting ball is placed between two metal plates connected through an �eter to a de. s� e of high volta? e.
(1) P and Q must carry like charges. The ball shuttles back and forth between the plates, making alternate contacts with each plate. Which of the followmg
statements are correct ?
(2) R and S must carry un1ilre charges.
(3) P and Q must carry the same amount of net charges. (I) The ball carries charges, sometimes positive, and sometimes negative.
A. (1) only (2) Ifthe separation ofthe metal plates increases, the :frequency of oscillation of the ball decreases.
B. (2) only (3) The galvanometer shows a current flowing always in the same direction.
C. (I)&(3)only
D. (2) & (3) only A. (1) & (2) only
B. (1) & (3) o,ly
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (!), (2) & (3)
□
I , +lC -lC
26. <BKAL1982Paperl-27>
The diagram shows a negative charged particle inside a uniform electric field E ' '''
pointing in downward direction. At the instant shown, the particle is tzavelling ''' '
in the direction of the arrow v. Which of the anows 1 to 4 gives the direction of '' '
the acceleration of the particle at this instant? '' ''
A. 1
B. 2 '' y
C. 3
D. 4 Et +'s Q -lC
Three charge + I C, - 1 C and - 1 C are fixed at the comers W, Xand Yrespectively of a square as shown. A fourth charge,
Q, is fixed atZ. Ifthe net electrostatic force acting on the charge atXis indicated by the mow, what is the magnitude of Q?
27. < BKAL 1983 Paper I- 20 >
A. -.Jzc
2
Two parallel metal plates are placed horizontally with a separation of 0.05 m. A voltage of2000 Vis connected across the B. + ✓ C
plates. An oil drop carrying a charge of - 1.6 x 10-19 C is found to be at rest between the plates. Find the mass of the drop. C. -2./zC
(Take the acceleration due to gravity to be 10 m s-2.) D. +2$C
A 1.6 X 10 -18 kg.
B. 1.6 X 10-15 kg.
C. 6.4 X 10-14 kg. 1 31. < HKAL 1990 Paper I - 27 >
D. 6.4 x 10-16 kg.
[,:!"-'
=ml +
pl,to
r
A negatively charged oil drop is kept stationary between two horizontal metal plates connected to a d.c. supply as shown.
almninium The oil drop then acquires an additional negative charge. Which of the following changes will be able to hold the oil drop
'°""'t �
�--�EHT---
stationary?
(1) Disconnecting the plates from the supply and moving the plates closer
(2) Keeping the separation between the plates unchanged and increasing the p.d. between the plates
Two parallel metal plates are connected to the terminal of an EHT. When a charged aluminium foil strip is placed between (3) Keeping the p.d. between plates unchanged and moving the plates further apart.
the plates, the deflection of the foil is shown in the above :figure. Which of the following statements is/are correct ? A. (l)only
(1) The charge on the foil is negative. B. (3) only
(2) Ifthe separation between the two plates decreases, the deflection of the :full increases. C. (1)& (2) o oly
(3) When moving the foil towards the positive plate, the deflection ofthe foil increases. D. (2) & (3) ool y
A. (l)only
m
B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only 37. <BKAL2007PaperIIA-14>
D. (2) & (3)ooly
+Q -2Q
A point charge +Q is fixed at pointXwhile another point charge-2Q is fixed at point Yas shown. Ex andEy denote the
magnitude of the electric field due to the point charge atX and Y respectively. For the points on the line passing throughX
and Y, how many ofthem haslhave Ex = Ev and how many has/have zero resultant electric field ?
(No need to consider the points at infinity.) A small neutral conducting sphere is suspended by an insulated thread. When a positively charged metal rod is brought near
A. There are 3 points with Ex = Ev and the resultant field is zero at 2 ofthem. the sphere, which of the following consequences are correct ?
B. There are 2 points with Ex =Ev and the resultant field is zero at both of them. (1) The sphere is attracted by the charged rod due to the induced charge on the sphere.
C. There are 2 points with Ex =Ey and the resultant field is zero at 1 of them. (2) The sphere is repelled from the charged rod after touching the charged rod
D. There is 1 point with Ex= EY and the resultant field is zero at that point.
(3) The sphere finally carries positive charge.
A. (I) & (2) oc ly
40. < BKAL 2009 Paper llA - 33 > B. (1) & (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only
A potential difference of 3 kV is applied across two horizontal D. (!), (2) & (3)
metal plates of separation 1.5 cm. A charged oil drop ofmass +3 kV negatively
9.6 x 10- 15 kg is kept stationary between the plates as shown. charged oil
Find the quantity of charge acquired by the oil drop? d,op 44.
(Tal<:e the acceleration due to gravity as 10 m s-2.)
A. 1.6 X 10-19 C
B. 3.2 X 10-19 C
c. 4.s x w--- 19 c
D. 6.4 X 10-19 C
Part C : Supplemental exercise When a plastic ruler is placed close to pieces of small paper, some of them are found to be attracted towards the ruler.
Which of the following statements is/are correct ?
'.Yrr
41. Two insulated uncharged � spheres X and Y are placed in contact. X y (I) The attraction is due to the electric force between the ruler and the pieces of paper.
A positively-charged rod is brought near X as shown. Xis then earthed
momentarily. The charged rod is then removed. Which of the following (2) Those pieces of paper attracted by the ruler remain neutral.
descnDes the charges onXand Y? (3) The attraction acting on each piece of paper is greater than the attraction acting on the ruler by that piece ofpaper.
SphereX Sphere Y A. (1) only
A. negative negative B. (3) only
B. negative uncharged C. (1) & (2) only
C. positive positive D. (2) & (3) o cly
D. uncharged uncharged
4S.
42.
(±)-----1----L---!-----G) 2 �-
''
---------:f
''
' '
3 ''
: 4 :
'
Two identical spheres carrying equal amount of positive charges are placed as shown in the figure above. Which of the ' ''
following statements are correct? t----------i
(1) At the mid-p:iint Ybetween the two spheres, it is a neutral point +Q -Q
(2) Ifa small negative charge is placed at polntX, it experiences a net electric force towards the left.
Point charges, each of magnitude Q, are placed at three corners ofa square as shown in the diagram. What is the direction of
(3) If a small positive charge is placed at point Z, it experiences a net electric force towards the right the resultant electric field at the fourth comer?
A. (!) & (2) ocly A Directionl
B. (!) & (3) only B. Direction2
C. (2) & (3) only C. Direction 3
D. (I). (2) & (3) D. Direction4
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/13 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/14
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
46.
----+----+----+----+----
D
so.
A B C
A, B, C., D � four points on a strai � line as shown in the di agram. A point charge+ Q is fixed at A. When another point
_
charge -Q 1S mov:ed fromB to C, which of the following statements is/are correct?
•
y
(1) The electrostatic force between the two charges increases.
(2) The magnitude of the electric field strength at the pointD in creases.
(3) PointB becomes the neutral point.
A. (1) only
The above figure shows the electric field pattern around two point charges P and Q. Xis the mid-point between P and Q.
Y
B. (2) only
is a neutral point. Which ofthe following deductions is/are correct 1
C. (1) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) only (1) Both charges P and Qare positive.
(2) The magnitude of chargePis greater than that of Q.
(3) The electrostatic force acting on Q byPis greater than that onPby Q.
47. The charge on theuraniui:nnucleus is 1.5 x 10-17 Cand the charge on the a.-particle is 3.2 x 10-19 C. What is the electrostatic
force between a uranium nucleus and an a-particle separated by 1.0 x 10-13 m? A. (1) only
A 4.32 x l0--33 N B. (1) & (2) only
C. (2) & (3) only
B. 4.32 x 10-2° N D. (1), (2) &(3)
C. 43Zx10-13 N
D. 4.32N supply. Neglect
51. A charged particle is accelerated across the gap between two parallel plates connected to a constant voltage
the effect of gravity, the kinetic energy gained by the particle in crossing the gap depends on
48. What is the magnitude of the electric field strength at a distance r from an isolated stationary nucleus of proton number (1) the mass of the charged particle
(atomic number) Z?
A z, (2) the separation between the two parallel plates
411:&0r (3) the voltage across the two parallel plates
Thediagram. shows a pattern of electric :field lines in whichx; YandZ are points marked on one of the field lines. It would
be correct to say that
z.
(1) the electric field at Xis weaker than that at
+ + N N
z
(2) a negative charge placed at Z would experience an electric force to the left along the tangent of the field line at
(3) the force exerted on a charge at Ywould be greater than ifthe charge were placed atX
A. (1) & (2) owy A. (1) only
B. (1) & (3) only B. (2) only
C. (2) & (3) only C. (3) only
D. (1).(2)&(3) D. (1), (2) & (3 )
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/15 DSE Physics - Section Ji : M.C. PD-EMl-M/16
1 1
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
53. < HKDSE Sample Paper IA - 32 > 58. < HKDSE 2013 Paper IA- 24 >
The figure shows the location of an isolated charge of size +Q. The magnitude Xand Y are two small identical metal spheres carrying charges -2Q and +6Q respectively. WhenXand Y are separated by a
of the electric field strength is marked at certain points. What is the magnitude certain distance, the magnitude ofthe electrostatic force between them is F.
of the electric field strength atXand Y?
electric field strength atX X X y
@--r �
electric field strength at Y
A.
B.
c.
72
72
90
30
36
30
72 y
\
D. 90 36 40 Toe spheres are �ught to touch each other and then placed back to their original positions. The electrostatic force between
+Q 360
them becomes
�---�p:.:.----:----�---�:----�
r--- T- ---, --,----T-- -.,- - --,---r---, ---,----, C. ½ F, attractive D. ½ F, repulsive
7.,"'.
56. < HKDSE 2012 Paper IA- 24 > following descriptions about the electric field E between the plates is correct ?
A. E=0.02NC-1 fromQtoP . p� ,:;:
P, Q,R, Sare charged objects. When two of them are brought close to each other, P and Q repel, Rand S also repel while B. E=0.02NC-1 fromP toQ
QandR attract each other. Which ofthe following descriptions about their charges .is/are correct?
C. E=S0NC- 1 fromQtoP
(1) P and R are negatively charged.
D. E=S0NC-1 fromPtoQ
(2) Q ands are positively charged.
(3) Pis positively chaiged and Sis negatively charged.
A. (l)only
61. <BKDSE2014PaperIA-21>
B. (3) only
c. (1)& (2) only Q, Q, Q,
D. (2) & (3) only
Three point charges Qi, Qi and 0 are :fixed on a straight line with 0 at the mid-point of Qi and 0. The resultant
57. < HKDSE 2013 Paper IA- 25 > electrostatic force on each charge is zero. Which oftbe following can be the sign and the magnitude (in the same arbitrary
Llghtning flash may occur when the strength of the �lectric field (assumed uniform) between a thundercloud and the ground units) of Q1, Qz andQ3?
reaches �C:.1• A lightning flash on average discharges about 20 C of charge. If a thunderdoud is at a height
of Q, Q, Q,
. ..2
.o:!>_:a;i�ovethe ground, estimate the order ofmagnitude of the energy released in a lightning flash.
A. 106 J A. +2 +1 +2
B. 10s J B. +2 -1 +2
C. 1010 J C. -4 +1 +4
D. 1012 J D. -4 +1 -4
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/17 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMl-M/18
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
w X y z 0 X
0 X
-d -d
Two point charges -4Q and +Q are fixed as shown. At which point indicated in the figw-e is the resultant electric field due to : :
these two charges zero ?
A. w
&. X C. D.
C. y
D. Z
__J_J.:::====+
64. < BKDSE 2016 Paper IA - 24 >
-----+-----➔
+4Q +Q------► x X
-d: -d: 0
0 15= 0
Point charges +4Q and +Q are fixed on the x-axis with +4Q at the origin O and +Q at x = 15 cm as shown. The respective
electric fields due to the two charges are equal at 67. <HKDSE 2019 Paper IA-23>
A. x = lOcm.
B. x = 12cm.
C. x=20 cm.
D. x=30cm.
1. D ⇒ electrons flow from the earth to the sp here(as proton does not move)
3. Bringing(+) charged rod ⇒ (-) charge induced at left.side ofthe sphere and(+) charge at ri�t side of the sphere
C
Bringing(+) charged rod towards right ball Earthed with a finger ⇒ electrons flow from the Earth to the sphere to neutralize the(+) charge at the right side
⇒ (+) charge induced on the left side of the right ball (as plastic sheet does not allow flow of charge) ✓ (1) Photocopier makes use of electrostatic charge to give photocopying
⇒ (-) charge induced on right side of the left ball ✓ (2) Precipitator makes use of electrostatic charge to attract the coal dust
⇒ (+) charge induced on left side oftbe left ball ✓ (3) A Van de Graaff generator gives large amount of electrostatic charge for demonstrating
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl-MS/03 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl-MS/04
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
13. B 19. B
✓ (1) Since the two spheres repel, the two spheres may both carry(+) charge or both carry(-) charge
(1) Bringing positively charged rod near the sphere
⇒ (-) charge induced at the left side and(+) charge induced at the right side of the sphere (2) Since the force acting on B by A and the force acting on A by B are action and reaction pruI,
⇒ upon earthing, electrons flow to the sphere to neutralize the(+) charge at the right side they must be equal in magnitude but opposite in direction
.·. the sphere finally carries negative charges. ✓ (3) Assume the electric force F acting on the sphere is approximately horizontal
✓ Touching the sphere with the rod would make the sphere share some positive charges. Resolving the tension into two components
(2)
Positive charges of the rod are discharged upon earthing by the finger Tcos0=mg and Tsin0=F tanB=_!_
(3) mg
but the human body always remains neutral without carrying net charge mg
For sphere A, Bis smaller, tan 0is smaller, thus mis greater.
:. no charge is shared with the sphere by the finger, thus the sphere remains neutral
20. D
14. C
✓ (1) Water is neutral, as the ruler attracts the water, the ruler must carry an electric charge.
Due to attraction between unlike charges, negative charge is induced at the left side ofX
✓ (2) The attractive forces between the running water and the ruler are action and reaction pruI,
Due to repulsion between like charges, positive charge is induced at the right side ofY. so they are of equal magnitude.
✓ (3) The side of the running water near the ruler would induce the opposite type of electric charge
15. C while the side of the rw:ming water further away from the water would induce the same type of charge
(1) If the sphere carries (+ ) charges, repulsion occurs between the sphere and the rod
✓ (2) Attraction exists between unlike charges. 21. C
✓ (3) Attraction exists between a charged body and a neutral body. At the centre, the forces due to the two(+) charges on the point charge C balance each other
while the forces due to the two(-) charges on the point charge C also balance each other, thus resultant force on C is zero.
16. B
(3)' (-) charges are induced on the sphere at the side near the rod while(+) charges appear at the far side 22.
Suppose the three spheres are A, Band C such that A is uncharged, Bis positively charged and C is negatively charged.
(2)' electrons flow from the earth to the sphere to neutralize the(+) charges
(l) : the finger must be removed first before the removing ofthe charged rod
a, A and B attract each other since a positively charged body would attract a neutral body.
A and C attract each other since a negatively charged body would attract a neutral body.
(4) : after the rod is removed, the sphere becomes (-) charged.
® Band C attract each other since a positively charged body attracts a negatively charged body.
Thus, one sphere is uncharged and the other two caey unlike charges.
17. A
When the charged rod is brought near .X, (+) charges are induced onX and (-) charges are induced on z.
23. D
After Yis earthed, only the induced(+} charge remains on the left side ofX due to the attraction by the(-) charged rod.
✓ (1) Two balls carrying unlike charges would attract each other.
Z would become neutral as the negative induced charges would flow to earth during earthing.
✓ (2) A ball carrying positive charge would attract an uncharged ball by induced charge.
✓ (3) A ball carrying negative charge would attract an uncharged ball by induced charge.
18. A
a, presence of positively charged rod ⇒ (-) charge is induced on X while (+) charge is induced on Y
"'
24. B
Xis earthed momentarily ⇒ (-) charge on Xleft but (+) charge on Y is neutralized by electrons from the earth ✓ Attraction force exists between two opposite charges.
(1)
<l) The charged rod is removed ⇒ the (-) charge onX is then shared between Xand Y No electric force exists between two uncharged objects.
(2)
© Two spheres are separated ⇒ bothX and Ybecomes negatively charged ✓ A ruler carrying charge would attract uncharged paper scraps by induced charges on the paper scraps.
(3)
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl -MS/05 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl -MS/06
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
25. A C
✓ ( !) Since repulsion exists between P and Q, they must carry like charges. The sphere carries (-)-charge ⇒ moves towards and touches (+) plate first
X (2) Since attraction exists between R and S, It then shares some (+) charge and moves towards and touches the opposite (-) plate
they may carry unlike charges OR one of them carries charge but the other is neutral. :. The sphere oscillates.
X (3) Even P and Q carry different amount of charges, same force would exist between them.
32. C
26. D
✓ (!) Since the strip is deflected towards the positive plates, the strip should cany negative charges.
As the .&field is in downward direction
The negatively charged particle experiences an upward electric force (F = - q E) ✓ (2) ByE=� :. dt ⇒Et :. deflectioni
d
Thus, the particle accelerates in upward direction.
X
(3) E-field is constant within 2 charged plates, thus there is no change in deflection of the strip.
27. D
33. D
Downward weight =Upward electric force from electric field
mg= qE = q!
E= f. =
d
. 03
(4 5x1 )
(15xl0"3)
= 3xl06 V
m (10) = (1.6 X 10-19) X (2xIO ) l
:. m = 6.4 x 10-16 kg F = q E = (1.60xl0-19)(3x10 ) = 4.8x10-1J N
6
(0.05)
.Sxl0-13 - '1
F 4 S.3 x10 ms-2
a =;; = 9 .llxl0-31 -
28. C
✓ (!) By U=qV :.U=(lC)x(IV)=lJ 34. C
✓ (2) By F= qE :. F= (lC)x(lVm-1) = lN Case I: Two charges areofthe same sign, i.e. (+5Q) and(+lQ).
X (3) Charge on 1 mole of electrons = 6.02 x 1023 x 1.6 x 10-19 C = 96320 C ;,; I C After sharing, they become (+3Q) and (+3Q).
= (SQ)Oq) = (3Q)(3�)
,; F,
4m: 0 r 4,rs 0 r
29. D
:. Fi:A = S:9
✓ (!) After touching (+)-plate, it carries(+) charge. After touching {-)-plate, it carries (-) charge.
Case 2: Two charges are ofthe opposite sign, i.e. (+sQ) and (-lQ).
✓ (2) d1' ⇒ E.J, (by E =!:::,) ⇒ pJ, (by F=q E) ⇒ a J. (by a=!..) ⇒ frequency of oscillation .J,
d m After sharing, they become(+2Q) and (+2Q).
✓ Carrying (+)-charge to (-)-plate ⇒ current flows in clockwise direction Q Q (2Q)(2QJ
(3) F. = (S )O z ) F. =
' 4m:.r 2 4m.r z
Carrying (-)-charge to (+)-plate � current flows in clockwise direction
:. Fi:F.:i.=5:4
30. D
35. B
Let the length of the square be r.
Since the electrostatic force is attractive, X and Y carry unlike charges.
Distance betweenXand Zis ✓2 r.
Let the charge carried byXbe +Q and the charge carried by Ybe -Q.
For sharing of charges, Qi + Q2 = Q + Q where Q is the final charge at each of the two spheres.
Since the net force onXis to the left, thus the upward force by Y is balanced by the downward component of force by z AfterZtouches.X,Xcarries +½ Q andZcarries +½ Q.
2
Fz cos 45 ° = Fy .-. Q(l) ° I
( )
I .-. Q=2✓ C AfterZtouchesY,Ycarries -¼Q andZcarries -¼Q.
4n:sJ/2'rf 7z = 41ts0 ?
41. A
37. B The positively-charged rod is brought near X X: negative Y: positive
Since poinJ:Xhas the same distance as the point of 72, the electric field at Xis 72. Xis earthed momentarily X: negative Y; uncharged
38. B
43. D
(1) They may both carry positive charges OR both carry negative charges. ✓ Some induced negative charges appear at the left side
(1)
(2) The charge on X may be greater OR smaller than that on Y. and induced positive charges appear at the right side of the sphere.
Attraction force then exists between the positive charged rod and the negative induced charges.
Ho wever, the forces between them are equal and opposite since they are action and reaction pair.
✓ ✓ (2) After touching the charged rod, the sphere shares some positive charges from the metal rod
(3) Since the angle Bis smaller, thus the weight ofXis greater.
and is repelled away.
A X B y
44. C
+Q -2Q
✓ (1) Electric force exists between the induced charges in the papers and the electric charges in the ruler.
By E=-Q- , ✓
4:n:a,, r1 (2) Since both positive and negative charges are induced in the paper, the paper remains neutral.
At point A, charge at Xis smaller and distance is closer, charge at Y is greater but distance is longer, thus Ex= F}y.
45. A
At pointB, charge at Xis smaller and distance is closer, charge at Yis greater but distance is longer, thus Ex= By.
The electric field due to the upper charge is towards the left.
There are 2 points with magnitude : Ex= By. The electric field due to the lower left charge is upwards.
At point A, Ex is towards the left butEv is towards the right, thus the resultant field is zero. The resultant of these two fields points towards direction 1.
At pointB, Ex is towards the right and Ex is also towards the right, thus the resultant field is not zero. The electric field due to the lower right charge is along direction 4,
There is 1 point with zero resultant field. however, this field is weaker than the resultant of the other two, thus the overall resultant field is along direction 1.
DSE Physics · Section D : MC. Solution PD-EMl-MS/09 DSE Physics · Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl-MS/10
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
46. B 52. D
(I) rt ⇒ p-!, ✓ (I) Two balls canyingwilike charges would attract each other.
✓ (2) A ball carrying positive chaige would attract an .mcharged ball by induced charge.
✓ (2) AtpointD, E-field due to the positive charge points to the right ✓ (3) A ball carrying negative charge would attract an uncharged ball by induced cbarge.
and that due to negative charge points to the left.
(3) At the mid pointB, the direction ofE-field due to both +Q and-Qare towards the right, Distance ofpoint Yfrom +Q is ✓(Jf +(1)
2
= ✓JO.
thus, it cannot be a neutral point
Since electric field obeys inverse"square law,
[Note that there is no neutral point in this situation.]
47. D
F = Q1 Q2 "" (l.5xl0-l7)(32xl0-l9)
2 4.32N
4,i:e r 41t(8.85xl0-12)(1.0xI0-13 )2
E a __Q_2
=�
2
41te0 r 41t&0 r 54, D
Assume that the three charges are allpositive (it is arbitrary, same result obtained if assumed negative).
. .
49. D The tfuection ofE,.field by a positive charge is away from the charge.
•
q,
✓ (!) The density of electric field lines represents the strength of the electric field. X qz
q1 E2 E
As the field lines atZis closer, E-field strength atZ is greater. �
E,
✓ (2) Negative charged particle experiences an electric force opposite to theE-field
AtpointX, the electric field due to q1 and (ft are in opposite directions and caned each other,
Thus, electric foroe on the negative charge points towards the left along the tangent of field line.
the net £.field is E3 and directed towards the left
✓ (3) Electric field lines at Yis closer than thatat2; thus the electric field strength at Yis greater,
At point Y, the electric field due to the three charges are all towards the right,
therefore, a charge would experience a greater force at Y, by F= q E.
thus the resultant E-field is rightwards, therefore, the direction of£..field atX and Yare in opposite directions.
so. B The magnitude of E3 are the same atXand Y, but there areE1 andEz in addition.,
thus the resultant E-:field at Y is greater than that atX
✓ (I) Since the field lines are directed away from the charges, the two charges are positive.
✓ (2) As the neutral po.int is further away from P, the charge Pis greater than that of Q.
55. D
' (3) The two forces are action and reaction pair, they must be equal in magnitude. W X Y E2 Z E1
----------1-----------©---r----- --1-----0 ·---+-'+-•
M
+2Q -Q
51. B
' (!) Gain of KE does not depend on the mass. The electric :field due to a (+) point charge is away from the charge.
The larger the mass, the smaller the speed, but the same KE. The electric field due to a(-) point charge is towards the charge.
' (2) For cQilStant voltage between the two parallel plates, At Z, the field due to +2Q is E1 while that due to -Q is Ei,
the gain of KE depends on voltage only but not affects by the separation between the two plates.
and they are in opposite direction, thus they may be balanced to give zero resultant field, that is, the neutral point.
✓ (3) Gain of KE = loss of electric PE = q V.
[ Note that W cannot be a neutral point as theE-field due to the greater charge 2Q must be greater since it is closer.]
The greater the voltage V, the greater the gain of KE.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl-MS/ 11 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMl-MS/12
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
B 6i. D
Since P and Q repel, they must catt}' like charges. Electrostatic force: F = Qi Qz
41t&., r2
Since R and S repel, they must cacy like charges.
A. To give zero resultant force on 0, the sign of Q1 and Q,. should be opposite.
Since Q and R attract, they IllUSt caey 'Unlike charges.
(l) Pand R must cany unlike charges, tlms they cannot be both negatively charged. B. Distance of Q1 from Q:; is two times that of Qz from 0,
thus the magnitude of the charge of Qi should be 4 times as that of Qz, not 2 times.
(2) Q and S must cany unlike charges, thus they cannot be both positively charged.
✓ C. To give zero resultant force on Q1, the sign of Qz and (23 should be opposite.
(3) P and S must cany unlike charges, thus P may be positively charged and Smay be negatively cllarged.
✓ D. Forces between Qi and Q:; is tepulsive with magnitude : F1 (4)(4)
41t&. (2r)2
57. C
Potential difference between the thundercloud and the ground (assume that theyform.2parallel plates) Forces between Qz and Q3 is attractive with magnitude: F1 = �
41tf: 0 (7)2
9
V =Ed"" (3 x 106)x(500) = 1.Sx 10 V As Fi = Fi, the resultant force on Q; is zero.
Energy released :
1
U= QV= (20)(15x1G9) = 3xl0QJ 62. B
Order ofmagnitude ofthe energy released = 10 10 J Due to the induced charges, a neutral ball and a positive charged ball would attract each otbct.
Due to induced charges, a neutral ball and a negative charged ball would attract each other.
58. D The deduction should be :
Before touching, electrostatic force between the two spheres : (D one ball carries positive charge
When the charged rod is removed, Xre.ma.ins negatively charged and Y remains uncharged. The neutral point is atZ.
60. D 64. D
Since the electton carries negative charge, the dttection of electric :field should be from Pto Q. There are two points that the magnitude ofthe electric field due to the two charges are equal.
For the same electric field (both magnitude and direction), the point must be at the right side of +Q.
By F = qE
Let the point from O be x.
:. (8.0 x 10-18) = (1.6 x 10-� E
Q ••• X = 30cm
:. E = S0NC-1 41tE:., -x2
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution
EMl : Electrostatics
PD-EMI-MS/13
(2) The arttOUllt of charges on the two spheres may NOT be the same.
Electric field strength due to a point charge
✓ (3) The electrostatic force F acting on the higher sphere is upwards that balance its downwards weight mg.
:, mg=_g&_
2
4ne0 d Electric field between par.ill.el plates (numerically)
Thus, the separation d depends on m.
I\
(b) Two similar charged metal-coated balls, A and B, are suspended from two i.nsulating threads as shown in the figure.
(i) Draw on the diagram all the forces acting on the two balls.
(n) Ifthe ball A is earthed by touching. what would happen to the two balls ? Explain briefly.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMl-Q/02 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMl- Q/03
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
,�
2. <BKCE 1987 Paper I- 9 > 4. < HKAL 2011 Paper I - 7 >
E.H. T. via an ammeter as shown
The below figure shows two aluminium. foils held by plastic clips and a negatively charged plastic block. They are used for A small conducting ball is placed midway between two parallel metal plates connected to an
charging the aluminium foils by induction. in the Figure.
p1'stiobln,kQi
aluminium foil
(,) Descnbe the steps taken in charging the aluminium foils. (3 marks)
E.H.T.
(b) What type of charge is induced on the aluminium foils ? (1 mark)
(a) State how to make the ball acquire positive charges. (1 mark)
(,) Explain briefly why the clips should be an insulator but not a conductor in this experiment. (2 marks)
3. < BKAL 2006 Paper I - 4 > (b) After the ball acquires positive charges, explain why it can shuttle continuously between the two plates.
In a vacuum, a beam of electrons with an initial horizontal velocity enters midway into a region of electric field between
two horizontal square metal plates as shown in the figure below. A p.d. of 320 V is applied across the plates and the
separation between them is 1.6 cm.
,_L 116=
r
320 V clootron •._
T plates
(c) State and explain how the average current registered by the ammeter is affected if the separation of the two metal
is decreased. (3 marks)
{a) Find the electric field strength between the plates. (2marks)
(b) The electron beam reaches one of the plates. Sketch in the above figure the path of the electron beam between the two
plates. (Neglect the weight of the electron..) (2nwks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMl -Q/04 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMl-Q/05
EMl : Electrostatics EMl : Electrostatics
Part C : HKDSE examination questions 6. < UKDSE 2013 Paper IB-11 >
Figure (a) shows two identical small metal spheresX and Y suspended by insulating -9threads of the sam� length. Each sph�
( C). The separation d of the spheres is
s. < BKDSE Practice Paper IB � 8 > has amass of LO x 10-s kg and each carries a positive charge of3.l nC 1 nC = 10
p
As shown in the Figure, two lar ge vertical parallel metal plates, each in a slotted base, are placed on a polystyrene tile. The 10 cm. The size of spheres is negligible compMed with their separation, therefore they can be treated as oint charges.
plat.es are connected to the positive and negative tenninals of an EHT supply respectively. The plates' separation d= IO cm. Truce_!_,,, 9xt0 Nm C .
9 2 -2
41te0
m"'1
plate
X cf Y
EHT supply
<:-------->
d=l0cm
polystyrene
til•
(a) Find the angle between the threads.
A small charged ball is suspended by a n ylon thread and is placed midway between the plates. The thread makes an angle 0
to the vertical when the ball is in equilibrium.
(a) By using a :free--body diagram, draw and name all the forces acting on the charged ball. Also indicate in your diagram
the direction of the electric field between the plates. (3 llllll'ks )
(b) Point P is vertically below the fixed point O and it is 10 cm from each sphere as shown in Figure (b).
(i) Indicate the direction of the resultant electric field at P due to these two charged spheres. (1 mark)
(b) (i) Express tan 0 in terms of the electric force F acting on the hall and the wei ght W of the ball. (1 mark)
Diagram.NOT drawn to scale
Figure(b)
(ri) Given that the mass of the ball is 0.07 g. When the voltage between the plates is 4000 V, 0 = 2°. Estimate
the magnitude ofthe charge carried by the ball. Assume that the electric field between the plates is unifurm.
( 3 """")
(c) Using the setup in the Figure, suggest a simple method to test whether the electric field between the plates is uniform.
(3 marks)
(ii) A neutral metal sphere of finite size is now placed at P. State whether the separation dwould increase, decrease or
remain unchanged due to the presence of this sphere. (1 mark)
1
Students and teachers who me not involved in the marking process are advised to inteipret the Markixlg Scheme with care. 3. (b)
Question Solution
320 V ol,ctrnn
:_:::::::> 11.6=
1. (a) (i) Small pieces of paper are attracted by the comb and are found on the comb
l-
[!] T
Since the plastic comb is an insulator, charges produced by robbing remain on the comb [!]
(ii) Small pieces of paper are not affected and stay at the original places [!] [!]
< The path bends upwards >
Since aluminium is a conductor, charges produced by rubbing will be conducted a:way. [!] [!]
< The path is a curve >
(b) (i)
T T
[!]
4. (a) Let the ball touch the left plate to share some positive charges.
F'+---\ [!]
j--+p (b) The ball is repelled by left plate and attracted to the right plate.
The ball then aequires negative charges when touching the right plate and the process repeats. [!]
Hence, the ball shuttles between the two plates.
w w
(c) As the plate separation d decreases, the electric field between the plate increases ( E = VI d). [!]
< weight of the two balls marked correctly> [!]
Therefore, electric force on the ball increases. [!]
< tension of the strings marked correctly> [!]
The acceleration of the ball increases and thus the average CU1Tent increases. [!]
< electrostatic force between the two balls marked correctly > [!]
�"--�--
Since charges in ball A is conducted away, it is attracted by ball B [!]
When it makes contact with ball B, it shares similar charges and repels away. [!]
direction of
electric field
2. (a) Place the aluminium foils near the plastic block. [!] w(weight)
Touch the foil momentarily with a finger. [!] [!]
< Weight and tension correctly drawn with correct name >
Then remove the block. [!] [!]
< The electrical force correctly drawn with correct name >
< Direction of electric field correct > [!]
(b) positive charge [!]
[!]
(c) Iftbe clip is a conductor, the induced charge would escape (b ) (i) tanB • f_
through the clip and the band.
[!]
w
[!]
(ii) For parallel plates: E = !:. = 4ooo = 40000 V m-1 [!]
d 0.1
3. (a)E=� tan0 = !_ == qE
d W mg
320 q•(40000)
[l] [!]
0.016 tan2" ==
(0.07 xio-')(9.81)
= 2xl04 Vm-1 (OR 20000NC-1 ) [!] [!]
:. q = 6.0ox10-10c
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EMl-QS/03
• Hong Kong Diploma of Secondary Education Examination
EMl: Electrostatics : Physics - Compulsory part (;1,if<Jl,l-)
, Section A-Heat and Gases (�'f"liUll:)
, 1. Temperature,Heat and Internal energy (m.&, ;;,,;i;�R�)
5. (c} Fix the plates separation and the output voltage of the EHT Supply. [!] 2. Transfer Processes (1¥.#:fJ:i&.fl.)
Move the polystyrene tile so that the ball is placed in different positions in the space between the plates. 3. Change of State (%.@:�iltyt)
[!]
4. General Gas Law (-ti&�J'llt;t.#)
The angleBshould remain the same if the electric field between the plates is unifonn. [!] 5. Kinetic Theory ( '.S,-"7'.i{�rt,i)
SectionB -Force and Motion (:h:ft!Jl10)
1. Positionand Movement (1ir.1f.'f":11*-i)
6. (a) 2. Newton's1aws(4,<ll1i::t.#)
T 3. Moment ofForce (iJ#!)
(
4. Work,Energy and Power (,fj:J:/J � j�:1,:;fcr.;&*)
5. Momentum(Z'l:ft)
6. Projectile Motion (&:lti'E:ti'J)
7. CircularMotion(l!)J;ll�!»)
F+- 8. Gravitation ('iii])
Section C- Wave Motion (ii:.111)
w 1. Wave Propagation (/&'.{t,i;J!til!)
2. WavePhenomena(JBtj).lJl.$.)
.--9 2
3. Reflection and Refraction ofLight ( 16ft:l �MA:brM)
F = �2 = (9 x 109) x (3.Ixl0 ) = 8.65 x lO�N [I] 4. Lenses (iS.�)
4ite0 r (O.lo)2 5. Wave Nature ofLlght (:J'e.�ii.:ti'J�·!t.)
"" 5 6. Sound(tt)
W =mg= (LO x 10 ) (9,81) = 9.81 x I<r-5N
Section D - Electricity and Magnetism ( 11!::fl'.fit)
ResolvethetensionT: TsinB=F and TcosB= W 1. Electrostatics (ff-1!!:�J!,)
6 2. Electric Cimlits ( 'l!t.'13-)
:. tanB = !_ "" 8.65xI0-""5 [!] 3. DomesticE!ectricity(Ull!'ilt)
W 9.81xl0
4. MagneticField(:qt.¼,Jt)
°
:. 0 = 5.04 5. Electromagnetic Induction ('it.i;;lt� .(Ji)
Angle between the threads = 2B = 10,l 0 6. Alternating Cmrent ( 5c,,m.'1ft)
[I] Section E- Radioactivity and Nuclear Energy (:tk¼tJJ!.�;f";ft1!5)
(b) (i ) 1. Radiation and Radioactivity ( .tiMt'f�<l'l:.M JJL ,t..)
2. Atomic Model (,IJT.fU:D
3. Nuclear Energy(#.!:�)
The following list of formulae may be found useful : 2. < HKCE 1980 Paper Il- 38 >
Resistors in parallel 1 1 1 Two identical resistors R, an ammeter, a switchK and a cell are connected as shown. When K is open, the ammeter reading
-=-+-
R R, R , is 1 A. When K is closed, the reading will
A not change.
Power in a circuit B. increase to 2 A
C. increase to 4 A.
D. decrease to A ½
USe the following data wherever necessary: 3. <HKCE 1980 Paper ll- 44 >
6V
R,
A
A,
sooon
�---1 B In the circuit shown, the cell has negligiOle intemal resistance. Ifthe lamp LJ bums out, then
A. L 1 becomes brighter.
In the circuit shown, ammeter A1 reads 2 mA and ammeter Ai reads 8 mA What is the voltage across AB? B. k becomes brighter.
A lOV C. L 1 becomes dimmer.
B. 40V D. L1 retains the same brightness.
C, 50V
D. lOOV
11. < HKCE 1982 Paper Il- 30 >
7. <BKCE1981PaperII-27> Suppose you were given four similar lamps and a battety. Which of the follo wing ways of connecting the lamps to the battezy
would give the maximum brightness overall ?
C rn rn D A. a
2Q -
A rn rn B
The diagram shows a network of resistors, where the resistance of each resistor is 2 n. What are the equivalent resistances
across AB and AD respectively ?
AB AD
C. D.
A. I.67 n l.OOQ
B. 1.67Q 1.67 n
C. 1.670 3.670
D. 2.son 1.oon
III
,-------, I I I I-----, 3A lA
2A
A
&·
In the circuit shown, what is the current passing through the ammeter A ?
In the circuit shown. the resistances ofR1,& and & are all equal to 2 n. The power dissipated by& is A. 0A
A 2W B. IA
B. 4W C. 2A
C. 6W D. 4A
D. SW
·l
� HKCE 1983Paper 11- 28 >
The diagrams below show three possible arrangements of four identical resistorsR.
JWhen connected in series man electric CII'CUlt, the power diss1patcd m two resistors R1 and R:.z lS in the ratio of 1 : 4. What
will be the ratio of the power dissipated inR1 and& when they are connected in parallel? (a) R
A. 1 :2
B. 2 :1 X�Y
c. 1 :4
D. 4:1
( b) R R
(o) R
s
X y
In the above circuit, A1, A2 and AJ are ammeters of negligible internal resistance. What will happen to the readings of the
anuneters if the switch Sis closed?
List the arrangements in order of�equivalent resistance, as measured betweenX and Y.
Reading of At Reading ofAi Reading of .43 A. (a), (b), (o)
A decreases increases becomes zero B. (b), (o), (a)
13. increases decreases decreases
C. (o), (a), (b)
C. unchanged increases becomes zero
'"D. unchanged decreases increases D. (o), (b), (a)
l ti
=
_ ==
==D::: EM2S:::E:::Phy=::: sics=-:::S:::ee1l
: Electric :::":::on:::D=: M c
Crrcuits . .
2
= P D - E M =- M / O 7.
::: ::: :::=== = ::: :::::: ::: ::: :::::: ::;J ..
I I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Crrcuits
PD-EM - /08
2 M
11
20/ 7< HK.CE 1984 Paper n - 33 > 24. < HKCE 1985Paper Il - 44 >
I I
V Which of the following will increase the resistance ofa metal wire ?
(1) increasing the length of the wire
(2) increasing the cross-sectional area of the wire
(3) increasing the temperature ofthe wire
p R A. (I) only
B. (1) & (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (1), (2) & (3)
Four identical bulbsP, Q, Rand Sare connected as shown in the two circuit diagrams above. What happens to the brightness
of P andR if the switches of both circuits are closed?
Brightness of P Brightness of R
A. decreases remains constant
B. remains constant decreases
C. increases remains constant
D. decreases decreases
In the circuit, whenK1 is closed the voltmeter reads 12 V. What would the reading be ifbothKi and Ki are closed?
A. 8V
21. < HKCE 1985 Paper ll- 36 > B. 12V
C. 16V
D. 18V
26.
In the circuit shown, all bulbs Bare identical. If ammeter A1 reads 1.8 A, what does ammeter A2 read?
A 1.2A
B. 0.9A
C. 0.6A
D. 0.3A
In the above circuit A 1, /4i ancl'A3 are ammeters connected to a constant voltage source. What will happen to the readings of
the ammeters if the switch Sis closed ?
22. < HK.CE 1985 Paper Il- 34 > Ai A2 Al
An immer.rion heater A. talces 10 minutes to boil a kettle of water while another h�ter B takes 40 minutes to boil the same A. decreases increases becomes zero
kettle of water under the same vOitage Sllppiy. If the resistance ofheatet: A is 100 .n, "what is-the resistance of heater _B � B. increases decreases decreases
C. no change increases becomes zero
A 500.
D. no change decreases increases
B. 100.Q
C. 2000
27. <HKCE1986Paperil-30>
D. 4000
Ammge the following circuits in ascending order of equivalent resistances :
(1) (2)
23. < HK.CE 1985 Paper II- 35 >
A student, who wishes to find the resistance ofa light bulb when �
connected to at:� !J�, incorrectly connects a�cal
v.o!Eueter and a ;practii;_al ammeter as shown. What woii1:o'bethe (3)
most probable outcome -Of his error?
>------< A ,_____,
A. The voltmeter would indicate zero voltages. o---+--{�J--+---.
B, The ammeter would bum out A. (3), (2). (1)
B. (1), (3). (2)
C, The light bulb would bum out.
C. (2), (3), (1)
D. Both the ammeter and the voltmeter would bum oul D. (2). (1). �)
I DSE Physics - Secti.on D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/09 I I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/ 1011
28. < HKCE 1987 Paper II - 28 > 32. < HKCE 1988 Paper n- 27 >
What should be the potential difference between P and Qin the
cixcu.it shown 7
p A. 3V
B. 6V
C. 9V
Q D. 12V
� 6-rr b_ �
A. B. C. D.
35. < HKCE 1989 Paper II- 31 >
In the circuit shown. resistors A, Band Care identical. WhenK is open,
the power dissipated by A is P1. When K is closed, the power dissipated
by A becomes P2. The ratio Pi : P2 is equal to
A. 3:2
P Q R S P Q R S P Q R S
B. 2: l
P Q R S
C. 9:4
30. < HKCE 1987 hper 11- 30 > D. 4: 1
In the circuit shown, all resistors are the same. If the current
passing through point X is 1 A. what will the current delivered
from the battery be ? R 36. < HKCE 1989 Paper II- 38 >
lA
A. lA
X
B. 2A
C. 2.SA A
D. 3A R
V }-+=:::i-....J
31. < HKCE 1988 Paper II- 26 > K
In the circuit shown, the energy required by an electron to travel p 2Q
fromQ to P through Xis Et and that through Yis £2. vVhich of Q In the circ-ujt above, the two resistors are identical When the switch K is closed, what happens to the readings of the
X
the following is true 'I ammeter A and the voltmeter V?
4Q Reading of ammeter A Reading of voltmeter V
A. E1 = 4E2
y
B. Et = 2£2 A. increases decreases to zero
C. E1 = Ez B. decreases decreases to zero
C. decreases decreases
D. 2E1 = Bi D. increases decreases
1
37.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
I I 41.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
'---------<,1�-...,,...,,_--1 In the above circuit, P, Q and R are identical resiston. Which of the following is true when switch Sis closed ?
A. The power output from the battery increases.
B. The voltage across P remains unchanged.
In the circuit shown, a 4 n resistor is tobe connected to two of the terminals A, B, C andD to give the greatestbrightness in C. The cime:nt tbroughQ remains unchanged.
the lampbulb. Which connection should be made? D. The currentthroughP decreases.
A. acrossA.B
B. acrossBC
C. across CD 42. < HKCE 1991 Paper II - 33 >
D. acrossAD In the circuit shown, what are ·the readings of voltmeters Vi and V2
if switch Sis closed ?
An electric heater takes a time Ttoboil a kettle of water when connected to a 200 V source. '\Vb.at willbe the time required A. ov 2V 100
to boil the s.une kettle ofwater when the heater is connected to a 00 V source? B. ov 3V
(You may assume that the resistance of the heater remains unchanged.)
1
C. IV 2V
A. T/4 D. 3V ov
B. T/2
C. 2T
43. < BK.CE 1991 Paper II- 31 >
D. 4T
The following diagrams show three networks consisting of different resistors.
�----"
39. <HKCE1990Paperll-32> (1
) ~--+�---!
II: !--+--�
� �
(2) 10 !Mn
6V
( 3) !Mn
In the circuit shown, the potential differencebetweenXand Yis
A. ""'·
B. LS V.
C. 3.0V
D. 4.SV. Arrange the above networks in descending order of equivalent resistances :
A. (1), (2), (3)
B. (2), (!), (3)
40. <HKCE 1990 Paper Il - 34 > C. (2), (3), (1)
D. (3). (!). (2)
In the circuit shown, Li ,Li andL3 are identical light bulbs.
Which of the following statements is/are correct when the
switch Sis closed ? 44. <HKCE 1991 Paper II-1 >
(1) The brightness ofL1 decreases. Which of the following is/are vectors ?
(2) L,. and Ls are of $ame brightness. (1) momentum
(3) Ldsbrighterthan.Lz. (2) power
(3) voltage
A. (2) only A. !) only
B. (3) only B. (�) only
C. (!) & (2) only C. (1) & (2) on ly
D. (2) & (3) only D. (2) & (3) only
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
m.12 : Electric Circuits
PD-
EM M
2-
/13
11
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
m.12 : Elec1ric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/14
1
Ji------.
45. <HKCE 1992 Paper II - 29 > 49. < HKCE 1993 Paper II- 29 >
The potential difference between t:wo pointsX and Yin a circuit is 10 V. Which of the following must be true ?
A. 1 J of electrical potential energy is transferred in passing 10 C of charges fromXto Y. �---11
B. SJ of electrlcal potential energy is transferred in passing 2 C of charges fromXto Y.
C. 10 J ofelectrical potential energy is transferred in passing l C of charges fromXto Y.
D. The resistance between%and Yis 10 n.
A,
46. < HKCE 1992 Paper II- 31 >
A,)---C=}-� L--j=:::J---{A,}------'
In the circuit shown above, all resistors are identical and the ammeters are of negligible resistance. If the readings of
A, }---..----J==}--r------+ ammeter A1 is 2 A, find the readings of ammeters Ai and AJ .
s A, A,
A. 2A 2A
A, }----- -C==:J---- .J B. 2A 4A
C. 4A 2A
D. 4A 6A
In the circuit above, what happens to the readings of the three ammeters if switch Sis closed?
Ai Ai A:i
""""""
A. increases increases increases 50. < HKCE 1993 Paper II- 30 >
B. remains unchanged becomes zero increases
C. increases becomes zero Which of the following circuits can be used to measure the resiS!mC� of the light bulb?
A B.
�-----1111---�
D. decreases increases becomes zero
47. <HKCE1992Paperll-32>
A
�----< V I---�
L,
L,
51. <HKCE 1994 Paper II- 26 >
A student uses an ammeter and a voltmeter to find the resistance
In the circuit, L1, M. andL3 are identical light bulbs. Which of the following statements is/are true? of a light bulb. He incorrectly connects the circuit as shown.
(1) Li andL3 are ofthe same brightness. Which of the following is the most probable outcome ?
(2) Li is brighter thank. A The ammeter bums out V
(3) The power dissipated in L1 is equal to the sum ofpowers dissipated in Li and £3•
B. The light bulb burns oul
A. {2) only
B. (3) only C. The reading of the voltmeter is zero.
C. (1) & (2) only
D. (1) & (3) only
D. The reading of the ammeter is zero.
52.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
I
56.
DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
A,
A,·'----<
L-----/ V l---_J
In the above circuit, all the light bulbs are identical. What happens to the brightness of the bulbs L1 , k and LJ if switch S is
closed?
In the circuit above, the ammeters have negligi'ble resistance. Which of the following statements are true if switch S is
L, L, L,
closed?
A. decreases increases remains unchanged (I) The reading ofammeter A1 decreases.
B. increases remains unchange d increases (2) Thereading ofammeterkincreases. v'
C. decreases remains unchanged remains unchanged (3) The reading of the voltmeter remains unchanged.
D. remains unchanged decreases increases A. (1) & (2) only
B. (1) & (3) only
�T
C. (2) & (3) only
< HKCE 1994 Paper II- 27 >
D. (1), (2) & (3)
57, <HKCE 1995 Paperll-1 >
4<l
x4" Which ofthe following pairs of physical quantities has the same units ?
A. Charge and current
4!2 B. Workandvoltage
y C. Kinetic energy and heat
D. Force and momentum
Find the p.d. betweenXand Yin the above circuit
A. ov
B. 1 V 58. <HKCE 1996 Paper II- 30 >
C. 2V It is knovm that the resistance ofa resistor R is about 5 kn. Which of the following circuits is most suitable for measuring the
D. 3V resistance ofR? The ammeter and voltmeter used are common moving coil meters.
B.
54. < HK.CE 1994 Paper II- I>
A, ---"II,___
--- I I 1---
Wf!ich of the following is a correct unit for the corresponding physical quantity? R
Physical quantity Unit .--r----,_-1 A
A. Work watt
B. Electromotive force newton '---< V '-----' '----" A l--___,
C, Momentum newton second
D. Heat capacity joule per kilogram
C. D.
I
55. < HKCE 1995 Paper II- 27 >
10n
p I 1----C::::J---, Q
sn
,------[=}--j A,
ron
L--CJ----{ A, 59. <HKCE 1996 Paper II-1 >
In the above circuit, the reading of ammeter A1 is 0.6 A. Find the p.d. between pointsP and Q. Which of the following expressions does not represent energy?
A, 3V A. Force x displacement
B. 6V B. ± x mass x (speed)2
C. 9V C. (Cwrent)2 x resistance
D. 12V D. Cwrent x voltage x time
I
60.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
64.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
y
X
6Q
y\----
In the circuit shown, the reading ofammeter A2 is 0.3 A. Find the reading ofammeter A1. Jn the circuit shown, X and Y are identical beaters. The ammeter has negligible resistance while the voltmeter has veiy high
A. 0.75A resistance. When switch Sis closed, the ammeter records a reading but the voltmeter reading is zero. Which ofthe following
B. 0.6A provides a possible explanation?
C. 0.SA A. The heater Xburns out.
D. 0.45A B. The heater Ybums out.
C. The heater Xis short.circuited..
D. The heater Yis short-circuited.
61. < HK.CE 1996 Paper II -32 >
65. < HKCE 1998 Paper Il - 30 >
�1[� 6V
---'I[>-----
� 6Q
R
A.H=::i-.
Figure(a) Figure(b)
12"
In Figure (a), the ammeter reading and the total power dissipated in the two identical resistors are I and Prespectively. The
resistors are rearranged as shown in Figure (b). Find the ammeter reading and the total power dissipated ii:!. the two resistors.
Ammeter reading Total power dissipated In the above circuit, the reading ofthe ammeter is 0.4 A. Find the resistance of the resistor R.
A. 3Q
A. 2l 2P B. sn
B. 2l 4P C. 6Q
C. 41 2P D. 9Q
D. 41 4P
70.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
I •
I -
�--<ljt---�
60'2 A
-
60Q
- 30Q
A resistor and a bulb are connected in parallel to a 9 V battery as shown above. The reading of the ammeter is 5 A. H the
power dissipated by the resistor is 18 W, find the power dissipated by the bulb.
In the above circuit, the current delivered by the cell is I. What is the current passing through the 30 n resistor?
A. 9W
A. ½I B. 18W
B. t1 C. 22.SW
D. 27W
C. ¼1
D. t1
71. < HK.CE 2000 Paper II- 36 >
I
'
68. <HKCE 2000 Paper Il - 30 >
I +
I
R1=6.Q
4!l p Q
_fu= 12.Q
Three resistors are connected to a battery as shown above. Which of the following statements is/are correct?
(1) The current passing through R1 1s equal to that passing through .R;;.
(2) The voltage across R1 is equal to that across k
(3) The energy dissipated by one coulomb of charge passing through the 4 !2-resistor is equal to that dissipated by one
coulomb of charge passing through PQ. Q R
A. (3)only
1l, (1) & (2) only
C. (2) & (3) only Bwb
.0.. (1), (2) & (3)
Voltmeter
69. < HKCE 2000 Paper II- 31 >
s The above figure shows an experimemal set-up for measuring the resistance of a bulb. To which of the temrinals P, Q andR
ofthe ammeter and voltmeter should each of the wires be connected 1
R
1--_.._-c':::i--{ A A, Wire (1) Wire (2) Wire (3)
II
R, A. p Q R
j-----C_j-----, A A, B. p R Q
C. Q p R
R, D. R p Q
'-----{C::J------{ A A,
If switch Sin the above circuit is closed, which of the following statements is/are correct? 72. < lll(CE 2001 Paper II - 27 >
(1) The readings of ammeters A1 andA2 are both increased.
(2) The ratio of the readings of ammeters Ai and A2 is increased. Which of the following relations is incorrect 1
(3) The reading of ammeter A3 remains unchanged. A. 1 ohm (0) 1 volt per ampere (V K1)
A. (I) only B. 1 watt (W) 1 joule per second (J s-1)
B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only C. 1 coulomb (C) 1 ampere per second (A s-1)
D. (2) & (3) only D. 1 volt (V) 1 joule per coulomb (J C-1)
DSE Physics· Section D : M.C. PD-EM2-M/21 DSE Physics • Section D : M.C. PD-EM2-M/22
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
73- < BKCE 2001 Paper II - 30 > 77. <HKCE 2003 Paper II- 33 >
V
+-----{ V }------.
A A,
s
xL.-{=::J--...,---__jy .�------+I
Figure(a) Figure (b)
In the above circuit, the two resistors are identical. If switch Sis closed, which ofthe folloWlllgpredictions is incorrect?
A. The :reading ofthe ammeterA 1 increases. Figure (a) shows a circuit used to investigate how the voltage Vacross a resistance wire varies with the current I through the
B. The reading ofthe ammeter Az remains unchan ged. wire. The result is shown in Figure (b). If the experiment is repeated usin g a thinner wire of the same material and of equal
C. The voltage betweenpointsXand Yin.creases. length, which of the following graphs (denoted by the dashed line) represents the expected result ?
D. The power delivered by the ba ttery increases. A. B. C �
«:.---------+I
RegionQ
b:'
S R
X
:q
The figure above shows the voltage-current ( V -1) graphs of two resistors X and Y. Which of the following deductions
is/are correct?
(1) The resistance ofXis higher than that ofY.
(2) IfXand Y are connected in series, the V-I graph of the combined resistor will lie inregionP.
(3) IfX and fare connected in parallel, the V-1 graph of the combined resistor will lie in region Q. y
A. (2) only S R
B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only '·
D. {I) & (3) only
DQ
76-. �_HKCE 2002 Paper II -30 >
z
In the circuit shown, both ammeters At and Ai read 1 A
when the switch Sis open. Find the readings of the two R
ammeters when S is closed. ,
A, A,
A. 0.5 A I.SA Which ofthe following relatians is correct?
B. 0.67A lA A. X=Y=Z
C. lA 1.SA B. X=Z>Y
C. X=Z<Y
D. lA 3A
D. X< Y<Z
I DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/23
11
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/24
11
�---; �-1
79. <HKCE2004Paperil-31> 83. <HKCE2005Paperll-19>
12V
o----�
6 Vbattery
s
�--IV
In the above circuit, what is the reading of the voltmeter when switch S is closed?
A. zero
B. 6V
C. 12V
An ammeter and a rheostat of range 0-40 n are connected to a 6 V battery. The sliding contact is located at apositionX D. It cannot be detemined since insufficient information is given.
where AX "" ¼ AB as shown above. Find the ammeter reading.
A. 0.ISA Questions 84 and 85 :
B. 0.2A
C. 0.45A
D. 0.6A then:nistor
----s•-l----�
An ammeter with negligl.Ole resistance and a high-remtance voltmeter 6V
are connected into a circuit as shown. Find the mnneter and voltmeter
readings.
'
B. I 2 84. < HKCE 2005 Paper II - 40 >
C. 3 2 Which of the following shows the variation of the ammeter reading I with the temperature ofthe thermistor{)?
D. 3
w
82. < HKCE 2084 Paper II - 32>
6V 12V
c::J 85.
'.t=..
<BKCE2005Paperil-41>
. .L. Cb. .. -�·
t=. L==.. �- �-
Which of the following shows the variation of the voltmeter reading Vwith the temperature of the thermistor fJ?
A B. Q �
In the above circuits,X, Yand Z are identical resistors. The power dissipated in Xis 20 W. Find the total power dissipated in
YandZ.
A. lOW
B. 20W
C. SOW
D. 160 W
I
86.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
I
89.
DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
-----/-/"\+----/ A A, L......Cx
,__ �-\
Ifthe current in the circuit shown is 0.8 A, what is the number ofelectrons passing through the pointX in l minute?
A. 8.3 X 1016
B. 1.6 x 1017
ill the above circuit, the bulbs are identical. If ht e reading ofammeter A1 is 1A. find the readings ofammeters A:zandAl, C. 5.0 X 1018
Reading of.Al Reading of.43 D. 3.0 X 102°
A. 0.5A lA
B. 0.5A LSA 90. < BKCE 2006 Paper II- 24 >
C. 2A 2A
D. 2A 3A !·-·---·-·---·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-·-· ;
87. < HK.CE 2005 Paper IT· 39 >
p
I
+ ! 1.SV -
i 1.SV
; 1.SV -
'
'
!
)1.SV--
' .
'-·-·-·-----·-----·-·-·-·-·-·-· '
i.-•-•-·-•••-•-•-•-•-•-•-·-•• I
battery box
The diagram shows the circuit of a camping light which uses four 1.5 V cells and four identical light bulbs. The current
passing through each light bulb is I A. What is the cun'ent passing through the point P and what is the power of each light
bulb?
Current passing through the pointP Power of each bulb
A. 4A 6W
B. 4A !SW
A student wants o
t measure theresistance ofaresistor Rand sets up a circuit as shown above. Which of the following C. IA 6W
descnDe(s) themistake(s) made by the student in setting up the circuit? D. lA l.SW
{1) The polarity of the ammeter is reversed.
(2) The polarity of the voltmeter is reversed.
(3) The voltmeter is connected across both R and the rheostat. 91. < HKCE 2006 Paper II- 26 >
A. (1) only
B. (2) only
c. (1) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) only
"""""'
Brightness ofX Brightness of Y
cell assumlllg the vota
l ge remains constant during the discharge.
A. 16mW A increases
B. 40mW B. increases decreases
C. 120mW C. decreases increases
D. 960mW D. decreases decreases
92.
DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
battery
X y
6Q 4Q
In the circuit shov;n, a voltage of 10 Vis applied acrossXY. What is the current passing through the 8 Q resistor?
amm-
A. 0.5 A
B. 0.8 A voltmeter
C. IA
D. 2A
A student sets up the above clrcuit to study the effect of the length of a resistance wire on its resistance. As the crocodile
lQ clip is moved fromA to B along the resistance wire, which of the following statements is/are correct?
2'l (1) The readlllg of the ammeter lllcreases.
A (2) The reading ofthe voltmeter lllcreases.
sn (3) The voltmeter reading: is directly proportional to the reading of the ammeter.
�-
A. (l)only
If the ammeter in the above circuit reads 3 A, what is the voltage of the battery? B. (2) only
A. 8.SV C. (1) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) only
B. 9.6V
C. 21 V 97. < HK.CE 2008 Paper II- 20 >
�:-�1,
D. 24V
The figure shows two light bulbs A andB, which are connected iD series.
The voltages across A and B are 3 Vand l V respectively. Which of the
94. < HK.CE 2007 Paper 11 - 22 > following statements is/are correct ?
(1) The resistance of A is greater than that ofB.
The voltage and the capacity o�Jhe-ce� of a portable music player are 3.6 V and 70_0 mA h respectively. The continuous , (2) The current £lowing through A is greater than that through B.
playing time of the player is 1"5 hours./The capacity 700 mA h indicates the quantity of electric charges that the cell will (3) AisdimmerthanB.
discharge in 15 hours ofplayirig;• Assume that the voltage remains constant during discharge, what is the estimated power of A. (1) only
the player when it is playing? B. (3) only
�
A 0.047W C. (1) & (2) only
B. 0.168W D. (2) & (3) only
C. 0.194 W
98. < HKCE 2008 Paper Il - 23 >
D. 0..252W
A cell fully discharges at a constant ljUITCD.t225 mA in 10 hours. If its average voltage is 1.2 V, what is the estimated total
energy stored in the cell ?
95. < HKCE 2007 Paper II- 23 > A. 2.71
B. 67501
In the following circuit, three identical light bulbs are connected to a cell. Under what conditions will light bulb P have the C. 8100 J
maximum brightness? D. 91201
6'2
12'2 A.}-c:'.=f-i
6Q
SwitchX Switch Y
In the above circuit, the reading of the ammeter is 0.3 A. What is the voltage Vofthe battery?
A. open closed A. 4.8V
B. open open B. 5.4V
C. closed closed C. 9.0V
D. closed open D. 14.4 V
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
100. < HKCE 2008 Paper Il-18 >
PD-EM2- M/29
y- y
In the circuit above, voltmeters P and Q of very high resistance are connected across the switch and the light bulb
respectively. What are the voltm.eter readings when the switch is open ?
A.
reading of P JV
0
reading of Q/V
0
--y
B. 0 1.5
C. l .5 0
z D. LS 1.5
"'* '-l-----+------§'
104. < HKCE 2010 Paper II- 21 >
x
A circular loop is made of uniform resistance wire. Let X. Y and Z be the equivalent resistance of the loop when connected
___,_a p
R
cp,
as shown above. Which of the following is correct ?
A. X= Y=Z
B. X> Y=Z
C. X<Y=Z
D. X<Y<Z
�-- •--1--�
Two identical resistors are connected in series in the circuit shown.
12V correct?
What are the readings of the voltmeter when S is open and when S
is closed respectively 7 (1) The voltage across PQ is greater than 6 V.
(2) The voltage across QS is zero.
Sis open Sis closed
s (3) If Ybums out and becomes open circuit, Zbecomes brighter.
""' A. (1) & (2) only
A.
B.
C.
=•
12V
6V
12V
6V '-------{v
B. (1) & (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only
D. 12V 12V D. (!), (2) & (3)
102. <IIKCE 2010 Paperll-17> 105. < HKCE 2010 Paper II- 41 > s
A car bas two doors and an indicator lamp is installed to act as j\ car door watlling signal. When either or both doors are
"'
E�
open, the lamp lights up. A student designs four different circuits for this application. A switch is installed in each door.
The switch is open when the car door opens. Which ofthe following circuits is correct ?
A. R
R
1n
Q
A
c. D. �
In the circuit shown, wires Xand Yare to be connected to two points in the resistor networkPQRS. Across which two points
should.X and Ybe connected to so that tbeammtu:r reading will be a .minimum ?
A. Pand.Q
B. QandR
C. RandS
D. SandP
I DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD -EM2-M/31 I I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/32 II
106.. < HKCE 2011 Paper Il - 18> Part B : HKAL examination questions
The figure below shows the current-voltage (l-V) graphs oftwo resistors P and Q.
I 110. < HK.AL 1980 Paper I- 21 >
p The voltmeter reads 3 V in the circuit shown. The e.m.f. of the battery is
15 V. If the internal resistance of the battery is negligible. What is the
internal resistance of the voltmeter ?
Q 3kn
,1,_____
A 0.75kn lk.G
B. I.SO kn
C. 3.00kn '--------i
D. 3.75kn lSV
Which ofthe following statements about the two resistors are correct ?
(1) Both ofthem obey Ohm's law.
(2) The resistance of Pis greater than that of Q. 111. <BKAL1980Paperl-47>
(3) If they are connected in parallel to a battery, the current passing through P will be greater than that passing
throughQ. When the switch Sis closed in the circuit shown, only L1 lights up.
A. (1) & (2) only Which ofthe following possibilities would account for this ?
B. (1)&(3)only (1) There is a short circuit across 4
C (2) & (3) only (2) The :filament ofLz is burnt out.
D. (1), (2) & (3) (3) The :filaments ofbothl,z and[,,. are burnt out. 2V
I ?.
A (1) only
107. < HKCE 2011 Paper Il- 19 > B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only
Which of the following resistor networks gives the largest equivalent resistance across PQ if all the resistors have the same D. (2) & (3) only
resistance?
A. B.
112. < HKAL 1982 Paper I- 22 >
In the circuit shown, an electron travelling from Yto X through R1 loses
energy E1, and an electron travel.ling from Yto Xtbrough R2 loses energy
E2. What is the relation betweenE1 andE2?
c. D. A. 4E1 = Bi xr-----,==i----➔r
B. 3E1 = E2 & = 30
C. E1 = Bi
p Q D. Ei = 3E2
113. <HKAL1983PaperI-20>
In the circuit shown, X and Yare two identical cells, of e.m.f. 10 V and
108. < HKCE 2011 Paper n - 20 > 6Q internal resistance 4 n. What is the current given out by each cell?
A. zoro
Jn the circuit shown, the ammeter reading is LOA when Sis open. X SQ y
What is the ammeter readingwhenS is closed? B. 0.42A
A
A. I.SA C. 050A
60
B. 2.0A D. 0.83 A
C. 2.5 A 3!l s
D. 3.0A
114. < HK.AL 1984 Paper I- 21 >
109. < HKCE 2011 Paper Il- 40 > An ideal voltmeter is connected between points X and Yin the circuit 12V 3!l
shown. Find the readings of the voltmeter when the switch is open and
In the circuit shown, both bulbsXand Yligb� up normally. Both the closed respectively.
ammeter reading and the voltmeter reading are non-zero. Which of
the following will cause theammeter reading to drop to zero while
X
y
A
switch open switch closed
the.:voltmeterreading is stillno'i-zero? Assume meteria!'e ideal. A. l.SV 25V y
A. Bulb Xbecomes short circuit. B. 2.SV 8.0V
B. Bulb Ybecomes short circuit.
C. BulbXis burnt out and becomes open circuit. C. 12V 4.SV
'-----/ V }-----_J
D Bulb Yis burnt out and becomes open circuit. D. 12V 75V
11
115. <HKAL 1985 PaperI-44 >
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-E
M2-M/3
311 I
119. <HKAL1989P.aperI-28>
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-
EM 2-M
/ 3411
,
�;�7
The e.m.f. of a battery is equal to
(1) the electrical power it given out divided by the cunentit delivers.
(2) the elecirical energy it transfers to unit coulomb of charge passing through the battery.
CL---��
(3) its terminal voltage when the battery is on open circuit.
A. (3) only
B. (1) & (2) only
C. (2) & (3) only In the circuit shown, Vis a voltmeter nfbjgh intemal resistanc'I and A is an ammeter oflow internal resistance. What is the
D. (1), (2) & (3) voltmeterreading when (a) switchK is open, (b) switchK is closed?
Kopcn K closed
116. <RKAL 1986 Paperl-34 >
"' sn ,n
A.
B.
C.
av
av
3V
OV
2V
2V
D. 3V av
A
"' X y "' B 3n
120, < HKAL 1989 Paper I- 29 >
"'
In the circuit shown, four resistors are connected to form a network.
"' "' The equivalent resistance between A andB is
A. o.s n.
sn�sn
A�t
In the circuit shown, if a battery of e.m.f. 20 V with neglig1Dle internal resistance is connected across XY, what is the current B. 120.
given out by this battery ? c. un.
A. 1.0A. o. 2.on.
B. 2.0A. 40
c. 2.5 A.
D. 4.0A 121. <HKAL 1990 PaperI-33 >
In the circuit shown, the battery has negligible internal resistance.
The cuttentl delivered by the battery is
117. < BKAL 1987 Paper I - 31 >
A. 0.5 A.
B. 0.9 A.
A"--'r---..-c=:H
s B sn C. 1.2A.
D. 1.5 A.
A B A B A B A B
Two cells of negligible internal resistance are connected with two resistors Three resistors of resistanceRi,Ri andR; are connected in parallel. It is known thatR1 > R2 >RJ. The equivalent resistance
as shov..n. What is the potential difference between% and Y? of this combination isR. Which of the following statements is/are correct?
A. 1.33 V (1) Energy dissipated in moving l C ofcharge through the resistor ofresistanceR1 is greater than that throughR2.
(2) RissmallertbanR1.
B. 1.67V (3) Ifthe resistor with resistanceR; is removed, the resulting equivalent resistance is increased.
C. 2.00V A. (I) only
D. 233V B. (3)only
C. (!) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only
124. < HKAL 1997Paper IIA- 25 >
Two cylindrical wires, Xand Y, are made from the same metal and have the same volume. The length ofXis three times that
�----1
128. < BKAL 1999Paper IIA - 19 >
of Y. If currents of 1 A and2 A pass tbroughXand Yrespectively, the ratio of the power dissipation inXto that in Yis
A. 1: 4 In the circuit shown, the battery has negligible internal resistance.
B. 9 :2 The three resistors have same resistance. If switch S is closed, what
C. 3:4 would happen to the electric potential at pointsX and at Y?
D. 9:4 Potential at X Potential at Y
R,
A. increase in,,,.,, X R,
y
125. < HKAL 1998Paper llA - 19 > B. increase decrease
,n.,,.,,, R, ,j s
=
current/ A C. decrease
D. decrease doo,ease
5.0 -------------------
129. < RKAL 1999Paper IIA- 16 >
1.0
'-====---'------'-----�
,._.___......, V ,._______,
o voltage/ V
10 20
The variation of current with the voltage applied across a device is as shown in the figure. 'What is the change in resistance R
of the device when the voltage in.creases from IO Vto 20 V? The above circuit can be used to find the r esistance of the resistor R. The voltmeter and the ammeter are not ideal. Which of
A. It increases by 2.5 .n. the following statements is/are correct?
B. It decreases by 15 .0.. (I) The reading of the ammeter is in fact larger than the actual current passing throughR,
c. It increases by 6 n. (2) The ratio ofvoltm.eterreading to ammeter reading is in fact smaller than the resistance ofR.
D. It decreases by 6 .Q_ (3) The circuit is suitable fur measuring high resistance.
A. (!) only
'11, (3) only
126. <HKAL1998PaperlIA-39>
--.....,11 ......--
C. (!) & (2) only
TJ. (2) & (3) only
In the above circuit, the two resistors are identical. The battery has an e.m.£ of 4V and it has negligible intemaJ. resistance.
The voltmeter is ideal. What are the voltmeter readings 'Ml.en Sis open and when Sis closed ? 1Q R
The figure shows part of the circuit in a network of resistors. According to the matl<:.ed values, find the magnitude and
Sopen Sclosed
direction ofthe current passing through the resistorR.
A. 2V 4V A. 0.2 A from right to left
B. 2V 2V B. 0.2 A from left to right
C. ov 4V C. 0.4 A from right to left
D. 4V ov D. 0.4 A from left to right
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
131. < HKAL 2003 Paper IlA - 25 >
6V
PD-E
M2-M 3
/ 7
11
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
135. < HKAL 2008 Paper 11A - 15>
PD-EMZ-M/ 81
3
'--c=:::i-----c=:::i-
"' -
2"
A. 0.3A C. (1) & (2) only
B. 0.5A D. (2) & (3) only
C. 0.6A 20
D. LOA y 136. < HKAL 2009Paper IlA- 28 >
p
133. < BKAL 2003 Paper IIA- 20 >
R X
B=---C:=J--�C p
R
9V-=-
100 R V
y
A'----C:=J----">oD Q '-----Q
In the network of resistors shown above, the resistance of Sis infinitely large and the two resistors R are identical. If the Figure(a) Figure (b)
equivalent resistance across CD is 25 n, what is the equivalent resistance across AC? Figure (a) shows a rotary-type potential divider PQR connected to an 9 V battery of negligible internal resistance. The
A. 250 internal structure of the potential divider is shown in Figure (b). XYZ is a uniform resistance wire in the form of a circuit arc
B. 35.0 with centre O and LXOY= 90°. OZ is a sliding contact and LXOZ= 120°. Find the reading of the ideal voltmeter.
c. son A. 2.5 V
D. infinitely large B. 4.0V
C. 5.0V
D. 6.8V
134. <IIKAL 2007 PaperllA- 16>
voltage VIV
137, <.HKAL 2010 PaperJIA- 23 >
In the network shown, the resistance ofeach resistor is 6 n.
4 Find the equivalent resistance·ofthe network across a and b.
I
2
0 ' A. 1.20
B. 1.5n
C. 2.00
;/ Y, D. 2.4Q
6
4
'
2 138. <HKAL2010PaperllA-25>
� current!/ A
0.2 Which of the following statements concerning an ammeter are correct ?
0.4 0.6
The above figure shows the V-1 characteristic curves ofresistance wire X and filament bulb Y. If they are connected in series
t0 An ammeter should be connected in series to a circuit.
R,] An ammeter should·have a low resistance.
to a 12 V d.c. supply ofnegligible internal resistance, what is the voltage across the resistance wireX? (3) An ammeter ofhigh resistance significantly changes the current in the circuit to which it is connected.
A- 9V A. (1) & (2 ) only
B. 8V B. (1) & (3) only
C. 7V C. (2) & (3) only
D. 6V D. (1), (2) & (3)
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Crrcuits
139. < HKAL 2013 Paper IIA- 24 >
PD-E
M2-
M/3
911 I
143.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-
EMZ
-M/
4011
In the above circuit,XYis a -uniform resistance 'Mte. What is the change of the reading of the ammeter A when the sliding
}40. < BKAL 2013 Paper IlA- 25 > contact Pis moved fromXto Y?
,n A. graduallyincreases
B. gradually decreases
C. increases and then decreases
D. decreases and then increases
144, Which of the following statements concenrlng two identical resistors ' connected in parallel compared with one resistor is/are
3V correct?
I.n the above circuit, the cell has an e.m.f. of 3 V and negligible internal resistance. Ammeters Ai and A2 have zero (1) Two resistors consume more power than one resistor,
resistance. Whatare the readings ofthe two ammeters ? (2) Two resistors draw more cittrent than one resistor.
ammeter Ai ammeterAz (3) The equivalent resistance oftwo resiston; is greater than that of one resistor.
A. LOA 1.5A A (!) only
B. ISA 3.0A __B. (3) only
C. l.SA 4.SA C. (!) & (2) only
D. 2.SA 4.SA D. (2) & (3) only
142. Two light bulbsP and Qare CODD.ected in series to a power supply. The resistance ofPis greater than that ofQ. Which of
the following statements is/are correct?
(I ) The voltage across Pis greater than that across Q.
A cell has a constant e.m..t: and internal resistance. If a resistor of resistance 5 n is connected in series with. the cell, the
(�) The current tbroughP is smaller than that ofQ. current is 2.0 A. If the resistor is replaced by another resistor of resistance 10 n, the current in the circuit becomes l.2 A.
(3) Pis brighter than Q. 'What is the value'ofthe internal resistance?
A. (1) only A. 1.SQ
B. (2) only B. 2.on
C. (!) & (l) onl y c. 2sn
D. (2) & (3) only D. 3.0n
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/41 II DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-M/42
Part D : HKDSE examination questions 150. < HKDSE Practice Paper IA - 29 >
147. <HKDSESamplePaperlA-27>
�-�1��A k
y
1---+n.\----i A k p
In the circuit shown, three identical light bulbs are connected to a cell. Under what conditions will light bulb P have the
maximmn brigh1ness?
In the above circuit, the bulbs are identical. If the reading of ammeter A1 is 1 A, find the readings of ammeters k and/4. SwitchX SwitchY
Reading of.k Reading of -43 A closed op ,n
B. closed closed
A 2.0A 2.0A C. op,n open
B. 2.0A 3.0A D. open closed
C. O.SA LOA
D. O.SA I.SA
151. < BKDSE Practice Paper IA - 27 >
c-+--1'--------------·
' : •I
148. <HKDSE Sample Paper IA- 30 >
+
:'
The :figure shows a battery ofo.m.f. 3.0 V and internal resistance 2.0 0: is connected to a light bulb of resistance 10.0 n.. A
voltmeter of internal resistance 10 ill is connected in parallel with the light bulb. What is the reading of the voltmeter?
A. 2.4 V
B. 2.5 V
C. 2.9V
D. 3.0V
A student wants to measure the resistance ofa resistor R and sets up a circuit shown. The student made which of these
mistakes in setting up the circuit ?
(1) The polarity of the ammeter was reversed. 152. < BKDSE Practice Paper IA - 28 >
(2) The polarity of the voltmeter was reversed.
(3) The voltmeter was COilllecied across both R and the rheostat
A. (I) only
B. (2) only
C. (!) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) only
.�� L,
a�b
12"
In the above network, the resistance across terminals a and bis 6 n. If the 12 n resistor is replaced by a 6 n resistor, the
resistance across terminals a and b In each of the above circuits, the cell has constant e.mf: and negligible internal resistance. When the sliding contact S of
A. becomes 2 n. each rheostat shifts from the mid-position to the right, how would the brigh1ness of each bulb change?
B. becomes 4 n. bulbLz
bulbL1
C. becomes 6 .Q..
D. cannot be found as the value of R is unkno'M.l. A becomes dimmer remains unchanged
B becomes dimmer becomes brighter
C remains unchanged becomes dimmer
154. < HKDSE 2012 Paper IA- 27 > D becomes brighter remains unchanged
What will happen ifthe variable resistor is set to zero in the circuit?
A. The light bulb will bum out 158. < HKDSE 2013 Paper IA- 32 >
B. The light bulb will not light up.
C. The brightness ofthe light bulb will increase.
D. The brightness ofthe light bulb will remain unchanged.
"'
y
155. < HKDSE 2012 Paper IA- 28 >
.___,V,____.
X
6Q In the above circuit, the cell has.negligj.Jili}�.s.istance, When switch Sis closed, both bulbs are not lit. The voltmeter
has a reading but the ammeter reads zero. If only one fault has been developed :in the circuit, which of the following is
possible?
In the above circuit. the cell has e.m.£ 12 V and internal resistance 2 n. What is the current in the 6 n resistor? A. Bulb Xhas been shorted accidentally.
A. 0.5A B. Bulb Yhas been shorted accidentally.
B. LOA C. Bulb Xis burnt out and becomes open circuit
C. 1.5A D. Bulb Y is burnt out and becomes open circuit
D. 2.0A
X
y
z
Resistors X, Y and Zin the above circuit are identical wiu1e the battery of negligible internal resistance supplies a total power The figure shows two light bulbs P and Q connected to a cell of e.mf. 6 V and negligible internal resistance. The voltmeter
of24 W. What is the power dissipated in resistor Z? reads 6 V when the switch Sis closed. Which of the following is possible?
A 3W A. BothP and Qare short-circuited.
B. 4W B. BothP and Qare burnt out and become open circuit.
C. 6W C. P is short-circuited or Q is bumt out and becomes open circuit.
D. SW D. Pis burnt out and becomes open circuit or Q is short-circuited.
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-E
M2-M
/451
1 I DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2- / 46
M
II
160. <BKDSE 2014Paper IA- 24 > 163. <HKDSE 2016 Paper IA- 25 >
0- l0Mn
ion
"' lOkQ
R
+---�,
In the above circuit, the variable resistor R can be adjusted over its full range from 0 to 10 MO. What is the approximate
range of resistance between a and b ?
In the above circuit, the cell has constant e.m.£ and a fixed intemal resistance. When Sis closed, the ammeter reads 3.0A. A 00.to l0kQ
When Sis open, which of the following is apossfble reading of the ammeter? B. l0Qtol0kQ
A. 1.6A C. l0Otol0MQ
B. 2.0A D. l0kQto l0MQ
C. 2.4A
D. 3.2A
164. <HKDSE 2016 Paper IA- 26 >
161. < HKDSE 2015 PaperJA - 26 > Two :filamentlightbulbsX and Yare connected in parallel to a dry cell. Xis brighter than Y. 'Which statements are correct?
(1) In 1 s, the number of charges flowing tbroughX is greater than that flowing through Y.
(2) In 1 s, the electrical energy dissipated by Xis greater than that dissipated by Y.
R, (3} For every unit charge passing, the electrical energy dissipated by Xis equal to that dissipated by Y.
r---=}-----{A 'A. (lJ & (2) only
,'--------' B.' (1) & (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (!), (2) & (3)
In the above circuit, the cell has a finite intemal -resistance and both meters are ideal. In which situation below will the
readings of the ammeter and the voltmeter suddenly increase? 165. < HKDSE 2016 Paper IA- 27 >
A. R1 is faulty and becomes a short circuit.
B. & is faulty and becomes a short circuit.
C. & is faulty and becomes a short circuit.
D. & is faulty and becomes an open circuit.
C. D.
In the circuit, all resistors ·are identical. The internal resistance
of the battery can be neglected. Vlhat is the potential difference I 91'
Ii-- •
\s,
betweenXand Y?
A. 1.5V
I
B. 3.0V y
C. 4.5V
s, s,
X
D. 6.0V
167. <HKDSE 2019 Paper IA-24> 169. <HKDSE 2020 Paper IA-22>
A-
B.
•
C.
D.
ibiee identical resistors,. a battery ofnegligi'ble internal resistance and an ideal voltmeter are connected
168. <HKDSE 2019 Paper JA-25> to form Circuits (a) and (b) .respectively.
Given that the voltmeter reading is & V in Circuit {a). what is the voltmeter reading in Circuit (b) ?
A. 4V
B. 6V
C. 8V
D. 12V
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EMZ-MS/0111
HKEAA.'s M.axking Scheme is prepared for the :ma.tkeu' refe:ren.cc. It sboo1d not be regard.Ii as a set of model answers.
Stwients and t:cacbers who are not invo1'Vcd in tbc inarldug process are advised to inter;Ptet 1he Maddng Scheme with care. M.C. Solution
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-MS/02
M.C. Answers 1. D
Voltage given to the upper two resistors = 6 V
1. D 11. C 21. C 31. C 41. A 51. D
Since voltage is proportional to the resistance for two resistors in series,
2. A 12. B 22. D 32. C 42. A 52. A
3. D 13. A 23. B 33. B 43. C 53. C voltage across the upper 8-n resistor = 6 x _8_ = 4V
4+8
4. C 14. B 24. B 34. D 44. A 54. C potential difference between points P and Q = 4 V
5. B 15. D 25. A 35. C 45. C 55. A
2.
6. C 16. C 26. C 36. A 46. C 56. C
When K is closed, the voltage across the upper resistor Rremains unchanged.
7. B 17. D 27. A 37. C 47. B 57. C
Thus same current flows through the ammeter A, reading of ammeter will not change.
8. C 18. D 28. A 38. D 48. C 58. A
9. A 19. C 29. C 39. B 49. D 59. C 3. D
10. D 20. A 30. C 40. D 50. B 60. A Kopen:
all voltage of the cell would. be across the voltmeter since its resistance is very large
61. D 71. A 81. D 91. C 101. C 111. A v..-2v
62. D 72. C 82. D 92. C 102. D 112. C
K closed:
i 63. A 73. C 83. D 93. A 103. C 113. C all voltage of the cell would be across the 100 n resistor but no voltage across the ammeter
64. C 74. A 84. B 94. B 104. C 114. D V=0V
65. C 75. B 85. A 95. D 105. D 115. D
4. C
66. D 76. C 86. D 96. A 106. B 116. B
As the length is halved, the resistance of the heating coil is also halved
67. A 77. D 87. C 97. A 107. D 117. C
since Ro::£:. R ➔ ½R
68. C 78. C 88. B 98. D 108. A 118. B
69. A 79. B 89. D 99. C 109. D 119. D Power: P= V2 :. p oc .!. :. P➔2P
70. D 80. C 90. A 100.B 110. C 120. A Since E = P t , as same energy is required for boiling,
130. A 140. D 150. A 160. C 170. B V;.D =IR"" (10 x 10-3) x (5000) = sov
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/03 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/04
EM2 : Electric Orcuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
7. B 13. A
The two resistors at the left hand side are in parallel, equivalent resistance is R Equivalent resistance = 2 + 3..2 = 3 n
The three resistors at the right hand side are in parallel, equivalent resistance is R Cumntflows throughR1 = !:._ = =2 A !.
3 R 3
:. R=�+�=1 .67Q 2
2 3 Current flows through� = 2 = 1 A (as�andRJ are equal.)
As D and B are at the same potential, equivalence resistances across AB and AD are the same.
Powerdissipatedby� = I2 R = (1)2 (2) = 2W
8. C
Let the voltage of the cell be V 14. B
When Kis open, the equivalent resistance of the two resistors is 2R. ✓ (1) Radius decreases ⇒ cross..secrional area decreases ⇒ R in.creases
v 2 ✓ (2) Length increases ⇒ R increases
P =
2R
(3) Resistance of wire is independent of its shape.
When Kis closed, one ofthe resistors is shorted and the resistance ofthe circuit is R
:. P ' = vi :. P' = 2P
R 15. D
'When connecting in series, same current flows through 2 resistors
9. A .·. 0 12 R o:: R ·. Bi_ = Pi = 1
is Pz
✓ {l) Weight is a type of force which is a vector that has both magnitude and direction 4
'When connecting in parallel, same voltage flows through 2 resistors
(2) Charge is a scroaI"which has no direction(+ or - only indicates two types of charge)
(3) Voltage is a scalar which has no direction P=V2 o::.!... B._= Rz =4
R R P2 R,_
10. D
16. C
Since the voltal?Y across L, rroiains ,mcbngedalthoughLJ burns out
Reading ofA1 : same voltage across and same resistance ⇒ same current :. reading remains unchanged
:. the current through Li and the power given out by L1 remain unchanged
Reading ofk: 8 closed ⇒ voltage across the resistor with.k increases ⇒ reading of/4 increases
.-. brightness of Li remains unchanged.
Reading ofAJ : S closed ⇒ no current flows through A; as it is shorted .·. reading becomes zero
(Notethat L;, will go out when L3 burns out)
11. C 17. D
Total current flows into a juncti.on point = total current flows out of the junction point
Since power: P= V
2
R decreases ⇒ power given out by the cell increases => total brightness increases
3+2 = 1+1
:.
R
As more lamps in parallel => equivalent resistance R decreases :. C gives the maximumbrightness overall. I= 4A
12. B 18. D
As the voltmeter has same resistance R, Energy given out by the heater= y •t = (200f x(3x60) = 144k1
z
R (50)
the equivalentresistmce of the voltmeter and the resistor in parallel is !!:. or O.SR
2
Euetgyabsorbed by the water = m cl:J.T = (1) x (4.2) x (2 0) "" 84 k1
Voltage acrossthevoltme1er = 6 x O.SR
I2V Energy wasted = 144- 84 = 60 kT
R+O.SR+R
DSE Physics · Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/05 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM2-MS/06
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
19. 25. A
(a) R = Rx3R = IR WhenK1 is closed, voltmeter reads 12 V ⇒ Wlknownresistance = 6 n.
• R+3R 4
= 2Rx 2R = Both switches are closed ⇒ equivalent resistance ofparallel circuit= 3 n
(b) R R
b 2R+2R
V = 24x-3 - = SV
(c) R • = fi 3+6
4
:. &<�<.&,
26. C
Reading ofA1 : same voltage across the resistor withA1 and same resistance ⇒ same CUIIent
20. A
Reading ofAi : S closed ⇒ voltage across the resistor with Az increases ⇒ reading ofAz increases
Brightness ofP :
Reading ofAJ : S closed ⇒ shorted circuit :. no current flows throughAJ
equivalent resistance of the circuit decreases
⇒ current from cell increases
27. A
⇒ voltage across resistor increases
Assume the resistance of each resistor is 1 n.
⇒ voltage across P decreases
(3) 11, • .!.n
Brightness ofR 3
same voltage across R after the switch is closed
⇒ same brightness
28. A
21. C P is blown ⇒ equivalent resistance ofthe whole circuit increases
Since A1 indicates the current flowing through the three bulbs, ⇒ current given out by the battery decreases
butk indicates the current flo'Wing through one of the light bulb. ⇒ voltage across Q and S decreases :. Q and.Sboth become less bright (:. B, C and Dare wrong.)
·· LS • 0.6A ⇒ voltage acrossRincreases (:. A is correct)
A, •
3
29. C
22. D
There is a drop in potential when current flows through a resistor.
t oc R as same energyE is required for same heating process
.·. Q and R are at the same potential.
23. B 30. C
• A. Resistance ofV >> resistance ofbulb :. voltage across voltmeter "" voltage across the cell Cun-ent passing through 1 11 row = current passing through 213d row = I A
✓ B. Resistance ofA is very small :. very large current flows to ammeter :. ammeter bums out
Current passing through 3ni row = I x ;: = 0.5 A
• C Very small current through the bulb :. the light bulb would not bum out but go out
• D Only the ammeter will bum out ; there is only very small current through the voltmeter
Current delivered from the battery = 1 + 1 + 0.5 = 2.5 A
31. C
24. B
✓ Length increases ⇒ resistance increases For parallel circuit, voltage acrossX = voltage across Y.
(!)
• (2) Cross-sectional area increases ⇒ resistance decreases Same voltage and same charge ⇒ same energy required, by E = Q V
✓ (3) Tincreases ⇒ resistance increases :. Ei = Ez
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS /07 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/08
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
32. C 38. D
Potential difference between P and Q = voltage across the 3 n resistor 2
E=Pt= V •t
3
:. VPQ = __ x 12 = 9V R
3+1 As same energy Eis required for boiling :
toc
1
V'
33. B
t2 = v;2
IfXis closed, all the lamps will be shortwcircuited and go out. ti v;i
If Y is closed, current will only flow throughL but not the other two lamps, L would then give out maximum brightness.
34. D 39. B
Ro,:.!.. 3 4
Since
A equivalent resistance of the circuit "" 4+ ( + l)x = 6 n
(3+1)+4
For the same length : area A oc volume o:: mass m
currentthroughJ.'Y = !x! = 0.5 A
.. Rcc.!..oc..!.. 6 2
A m p.d. betweenX and Y = voltage across the 3 n resistor = 3 x 0.5 = 1.5 V
RA = me = �
RB mA 4 40. D
(1) same voltage across Li ⇒ no change in current throughL1 :• same brightness
35. C
WhenK is open, power dissipated by A :
✓ (2) Li and 13 are in series => same current flowing through ⇒ equal brightness
Pi= (V/2)
2
= 1-.v2 ✓ (3) voltageacrossL1 = 2xvoltage acrossL,, => Pi>P2(by P = V2 !R) ⇒ Li is brighter
R 4 R
When K is closed, power dissipated by A : 41. A
2 Sis closed
Pz= (V/3) = _!._V
2
R 9 R ⇒ equivalent resistance J,
⇒ current given out by the battery t (.·. D is incorrect but A is correct by P = VI)
⇒ voltageacrossPt (:. Bis incorrect)
36. A ⇒ voltage across Q J-
Reading of ammeter A ⇒ current across Q-1- (by V = IR)(:. C is incorrect.)
K is closed ⇒ equivalent resistance of circuit decreases ⇒ current through ammeter increases
Readingofvoltmeter V: 42. A
Kis closed ⇒ thepartwithKis shorted ⇒ no voltage acrossK ⇒ no voltage across V Voltmeter Vi: Sis closed ⇒ short circuit across the voltmeter ⇒ Vi = 0 V.
Voltmeter Vi :
37. C
Connect the additional resistor parallel to theresistor(s) of the largest R (excluding the bulb}
43. C
⇒ equivalent resistance of that part ofcircuit decreases
(1) Equivalent resistance "" 1 n
⇒ current given out from the battery increases ⇒ greatestbrightness ofthe light bulb
(2) Equivalent resistance "" 1 Mn (106 Q)
:. The additional resistor should be connected across CD. (3) Equivalent resistance "" l kO
(If connected across the bulb, the equivalent resistance with the bulb J, and voltage across the bulb ,I,) :. Equivalent resistance in descending order : (2), (3), (1)
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/09 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM2-MS/10
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
44. A 51. D
✓ (1) momentum is a vector which has direction A. Large resistance voltmeter in series ⇒ current is very small ⇒ ammeter would notbum out
• �) power is energy per time, power is a scalar B. Very small current ⇒ light bulb would not bum out
45. C
52. A
ByE=QV
Sis closed ⇒ no cummtthroughL1 as itis shorted ⇒ brightness ofL1 decreases to zero
:. (lOJ) = (lC)x(lOV)
Without Li, all the voltage of thebattery is given to k, thus brightness of k increases.
C is correct while A and B are incorrect.
Same voltage across L3 as L3 is connected in parallel to the battery ⇒ brightness ofM is no change
Voltage has no direct relationship with resistance .·. D is incorrect.
53. C
46. C
Equivalentresistance ofthecircuit: R = 4+i = 6 .Q
IfSis closed, the second row resistor and the third row resistor are shorted, 2
current flows through Ai, S, the 1st row resistor and.A, only :. A3 becomes zero
Current flows from the battery : I = � = i = 1A
As equivalent resistance decreases current given out by battery increases :. A1 increases and Az increases R 6
(A.1 = A2 after the switch Sis closed) Current flow through pointX = 0.5 A
P.d. betweenXandY= 0.5x4 = 2V
47. B
Cmrentofthecircu.it: J = .!'.:: = -'- = 0.4A 54. C
R 10+5 A. Work ➔·unit: J (watt: unit of power)
Power dissipated in the 10 Oresistor: P = /2 R = (0.4)2 (10) = 1.6W
B. Electromotive force➔ unit: V (Newton: unit offorce}
✓ C. Momentum➔ unit:N s or kg m s-1
48. C
D. Heat capacity ➔ unit: J 0C-1 Goule per kilogram: specific latent heat)
✓ (1) As they are in parallel, thus same voltage across Lz and £3 to give same brightness
✓ (2) Current through L1 is the sum of current through M and L3, thus L1 is brighter.
55. A
(3) Consider Lz and L3 as one equivalent bulb L, same current flowing Lt and L,
p.d. between P andQ = p.d. across 5 n resistor
but equivalent resistance of L <Li ⇒ P2 +P3 <P1 (by P = 12 R)
� (0.6)(5) ~ 3V
49. D
56. C
The 1st row has an equivalentresistance of 2R while the 2nd row has a resistance of R
(1) Same voltage across the light bulb withA1 ⇒ 11 : no change
As V =JR, thereading ofA2mustbe twotimes the reading ofA1
✓ (2) S closed ⇒ equivalent resistance decreases ⇒ more current given out by battery ⇒ h increases
readingofk = 2x2 = 4A
✓ (3) Sarne voltage across voltmeter after Sis closed since the voltmeter measures the voltage of the battery
k = A1 + A2 = 2 + 4 = 6A
50. B 57. C
A. The voltmeter should not be connected in series to the light bulb. • A. Charge:C=As Current: A
✓ B. Voltmeter is connected in parallel correctly while ammeter is in series correctly. • B. Work:J voltage;V
C. Ammeter should not be in parallel and voltmeter should not be in series. ✓ C. Kmetic energy : J Heat: J
D. Voltmeter should not be in series with the ammeter. • D Force :N Momentum: N s
DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM2-MS/11 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM2-MS/12
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
58. A 64. C
Since the resistance is 5 kn, it is a large resistance. • A. IfXburns out, mmneter becomes zero.
Circuit in A is used to measure a larg e resistance. • B IfYburns o ut, ammeter becomes zero.
✓ c. As Xis shorted, current by-passes Xand flows to Y. Thus, vollmeter gives zeroreading.
Current measured by ammeter current flowing throughR
•
=
D. If Y is shorted, current would flow through X and voltmeter would give a non�zero reading.
Voltage across R >> voltageacross ammeter ⇒ voltage measuredby voltmeter ,.. vol t age acrossR
65. C
59. C
Voltage across 6 n. = (0.4) x (6) = 2.4 V Current through the 12 Q resistor = 2·4 = 0.2 A
✓ A. Force x displacement = Work 12
✓ B. ½ x mass x (speed)2 = K.E. Current through the resistor R = 0. 4 + 02 = 0. 6 A VoltageacrosstheresistorR = 6-2.4 = 3.6V
• C (Cunent) x resistance = Power
2
Resistor: R = !..
= 3.6 = 60.
I 0.6
✓ D. Current x voltage x time = Power x time = Energy
66. D
60. A (1) Ammeter reads the total current through the resistorR and the voltmeter.
Voltage across the lower6 Qresistor: V =IR = (0.3)(6) = 1.8 V ✓ (2) Since the voltmeter is connect ed in par allel w ithR :. voltmeter gives the actual voltage acrossR
61. D 60
Equivalent resistanceof two 60 n. resistor s = 2 = 30 n = the resistance at the 3rd row (30 .Q r esistor)
Equivalent resistanceof (a) = 2R Equivalent resista nceof (b) = !!..
2 Current through 30 n resistor = !.
2
Ammeter reading : .
I=� oc .!_ ⇒ I'= l:!!:.....J = 41
R R R/2
68. C
Total power dissipated: p.,, v2 o::..!.. ⇒ P'=l:!!-_ ·P=4P
R R R/2 (!) For same voltage : I=! o: ..!_ :. current throughR1 is doubled thatthrough,fu
R R
✓ (2) R1 and,Rz are in parallel => same voltage acrosseachof them
62. D
✓ 6 12
✓ (3) Equivalent resistance ofPQ = x = 4 n :. Voltag e ac ross PQ and 4 n resistor are the same.
A. "!!_o::p 6+12
: . Energy dissipated by each coulomb of charge are the same. (ByE = QP)
✓ V' - p
B.
69. A
✓ C. Fv = P
✓ S closed => equivalent resistance of circuit J. => CUITeD.t t
• D m•.€ v= E
(!)
71. A 78. C
Alllmeter: in serie s with the bulb an drheostat ⇒ wire(1) connected to P Suppo se each length ofthe·square has a resistance of 1 n.
Voltmeter: in parallel with bulb => wires (2) an d(3) co nnected t o Q andR X= 1x3 = 0.750 Y= 2 xz = lQ Z= lx3=0.75n
Cunent flows into vol1meter via(+) tenninal => wire (2) connecte d to Q 1+3 2+2 1+3
:. X= Z < Y
72. C
✓ A Resistance = Voltage / CUIIent :. n = VA-1 79. B
✓ B Power = Energy / time :.W=Js-1 The curre nt flows through theresi stancecoil between XB only.
C = Cun:ent time
Charge C = As
= 40 x �= 30 n
X X
Resistance of coil betweenXB
✓ D Voltage = Energy/ charge V - JC-1
Current: I= f= 2_ = 0.2A
73. C R 30
✓ A As equivalent resistance of the circuit -1-, current given out by battery t :. reading ofAi t
✓ B Si ncestill same voltageacross A2 and the resisto r in series :. same current th roughA2 80. C
Q It
C Voltage betweenXand Y is equal to the voltage across the battery which is unchanged
✓ D As current given out by battery t .·. power delivered by battery t (190 X 10-J) X (}6 X 60 X 60)
= 10944C
74. A
81. D
Equivalentresistanceofthecircuit = �+3=3.670 Since the ammeter bas no resistance, thetwo resistor s at the righ t are shorted and no current flows through them.
2+1
The curre nt will flow through the resistor at the left and the n through theammeter.
Voltage ofthebattery = IR = (3) x (3.67) = 11 V
Ammeter reading = 2. = 3A
2
75. B
Slope of V-1 graph = R. Al, Yhas a greater slopethanX resistanceofYis higher than thatofX
Voltmete r reading = 6V
(1) :.
(2) The equivalent resistance ofX and Yin series must be greater :. the slope must be greater than Y.
82. D
✓ (3) The equivalent resistance ofXand Yin parallel must be smaller :. the slcpemust besmaller than X
Let the resistanceof XbeR.
v'
By P= - .-. (20) - (6)' R = un
76. C R R
When switch S is open, It = 1 A si nce same voltageofthe battery is across the3 n-resistor Equivalent resistanceofYandZ = 1.S = 0.9n
= (1)(3) = 3 V
Voltage across the 3 Q..resistor "" voltage of the battery 2
Voltage across the 6 0-resistor = 3 V V2 = (1Z) 2 = 160W
TotalpowerdissipatedinYandZ =
Current through the 6 Q..resis tor = 3 V = 0.5A
R (0.9)
6Q
Cnrrent through the ammeter k = 1 + 0.5 = 1.5A 83. D
Si nce thevoltage of thebattery 12 Vis shared betweenR1 andR2,
77. D the resistances of R1 and & have to begiven i n o rder to calculate the reading of the voltmeter.
Fo r a thinner wire, theresis tanceshoul d be greater.
Sincethe slope of the V-I graph represents the resista nce of the wire, 84. B
thus theslopeshould be greater as shown i n D. Whe n temperature 0 is increased, resistanceof the tb.ennistor is decreased, thus the current shoul d increaseas shown in B.
DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM2-MS/15 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM2-MS/16
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
85. A 93. A
Since the voltmeter measures the voltage across the battery, the reading should be constant.
Equivalent resistance of the whole circuit = � + 2 = 2.833 n
1+5
86. D Voltageofthebattery: V= IR= (3 )x(2.833) = 8.5V
Reading ofA2 is two times that of A1 since the resistance is halved. Thus, reading ofk = 2 A
ReadingofA3isthesumofA1andk :. readingofA3 = 1+2 = 3A 94. B
By Q = It (700mAh) •I(15h) :. I = 0.04667 A
87. C By P = VI P = ·(3.6) (0.0 4667) = 0.168 W
✓ (1) The polarity of the ammeter is wrongly connected in reverse direction..
Current should flow into the(+) temrinal and out of the(-) terminal.
95. D
(2) The voltmeter is correctly cormected. If switchX is closed, the left light bulb is shorted,
✓ (3) The voltmeter should be connected across the resistor R only. and the equivalent resistance of the circuit would decrease, thus current given by the cell is increased.
If switch Y is closed, the light bulb P would be shorted and would not light, thus Y must be opened.
88. B
(j) Capacity: Q = 800 mAh = (800 x 10-3 A) x {3600 s) = 2880 C 96. A
10368 (2) As current increases, the voltage across the rheostat increases, thus the voltage across the wire decreases.
P=!= 0.04W=40mW
t 3x24x3600 (3) Since the resistance of the wire is not constant,
the voltage across the wire will not be proportion to the current through the wire.
89. D
(j) Q =It= {0.8)x(lx60) = 4 8C 97. A
90. A (2) Current must be the same for two light bulbs in series.
Current passing through point P = 4 x 1 = 4 A (3) By P = VI, since A has greater voltage and same current, power ofA is greater, thus A is brighter.
Voltage across each light bulb = 4 x 1.5 = 6 V
Current through each light bulb = 1 A 98. D
Powerofeach lightbulb = VI"" (6) x (l) = 6W Q =It = (0.225) (10 x 3600) = 8100 C OR P = VI = (1.2) (225 x lo-3) = 0.27W
E = Q V = (8100) (1.2) = 9720 J E =Pt = (0.27) (10 x 3600) = 9720 J
91. C
If filament of bulb Zbreaks, equivalent resistance of the whole circuit increases. Current delivered by the cell decreases.
99. C
Voltage across bulb X decreases, thus brightness ofX decreases.
Current through the upper 6 n-resistor = 0.3 A
Voltage across bulb Y increases, thus brightness of Yincreases.
Current through the lower 6 n-resistor = 0.3 A
Voltage across the 8 n and2 Qresistors = 10 V Thus current delivered from the cell = 0.6 A
Equivalent resistance of the 8 n and 2 n resistors = 8 + 2 = 10 n Total equivalent resistance of the circuit = 12 +� = 150.
2
Current through the two resistors : I = � = � = I A
R 10 Voltage of the battery V = IR = (0.6)(15) = 9.0 V
PD-EM2-MS/17 PD-EM2-MS/18
I
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
100. B 106. B
Assume the circumference of ihe circle consists of 4 equal arcs. each arc has a resistance ofR. ✓ (!) Since both of them are straight line passing through the origin, Io: V, thus they obey Ohm's Law.
X : The equivalent resistance is two resistors, each of2R in parallel, i.e. equal to R. Resistance is equal to t he reciprocal of slope, i.e. R = 11 slope.
(2)
Y : The equivalent resistance is two resistors, one of3R and the other ofR, in parallel, i.e. equal to 3 R / 4. As the slope ofPis greater, resistance ofPis smaller.
Z : The equivalent resistance is two resistors, one ofR and the other of3R, in parallei ie. equal to 3R / 4. ✓ (3) In parallel, I cc 1/R, since resistance ofPis smaller, current passing throughP is greater.
.·. X> Y=Z
107. D
When Sis closed, the two resistors are in series, and each resistor shares half ofthe voltage of the battery.
Re= 2xlO = 1.67 n Rn=�=3Q
2+10 2
The voltmeter measures the voltage of the right resistor, thus the reading is 12 x ½ = 6 V. Network D has the largest equivalent resistance.
102. D 108. A
X A, When both switches are open, the lamp would not light up. Voltage ofthe cell = (1) (6 + 6) = 12 V
X B. When either switch is open, the lamp would not light up. When Sis closed, total equivalent resistance of the whole circuit = 6 + � = 8 n
6+3
c. When only one switch is open and one is closed, the lamp would not light up.
X
✓
CUtrentgivenoutbythe cell = g_
= l.SA
D. When either or both switches are open, the lamp lights up.
103. C 109. D
When the switch is open, no current is given out by the cell. IfXis short circuit, current still flows throughX, Y and the ammeter.
As no current flows through the light bulb, voltage across the light bulb is zero, thus reading ofvoltmeter Q is O V. B. If Yis short circuit, cumnt still flows throughx; Yand the ann:neter.
All the voltage of the cell is then given to the switch, thus the reading of voltmeter Pis 1.5 V.
C. IfXis open circuit, no current can flow through X, thus both ammeter and voltmeter have zero reading.
✓ D. If Yis open circuit, since ideal voltmeter has infinite resistance, no current flows from the cell.
104. C
Reading ofammeter is zero.
(!) Let the resistance of each bulb be R. However, the voltmeter will read the voltage of the cell and is non-zero.
The equivalent resist=:<: of Y and Z is R/2, which is less than that ofX
Thus the voltage across PQ should be less than 6 V.
✓ 110. C
(2) As Q and S are shorted, there is no voltage across these two points.
As 1 kn.resistor andvoluneterarein parallel, Vw1,mom = Vm = 3 V.
✓ (3) If YblllilS out, voltage across Z would increase to 6 V, thus Zbecomes brighter.
For series circuit, V ccR 15-3 3
:. R = 0.75kil
3 R
105. D
11 1 1 1 1
Equivalent resistance betweenPQ = 133 n -=-+- --=-+- :. R..,=3kQ
R Ria R v (0.75) (1) R,,
Equivalent resistance between QR = 0.83 n
Equivalent resistance between RS = On 111. A
Equivalent resistance between SP = 1.5 n ✓ Short circuit across 14 ⇒ current does not flow through L;, and £3 ⇒ Lt lights only
(!)
As the equivalentresistance across Sand P is the maximum, minimum murent would be given out by the cell,
(2) Filament-ofL;,bumtout ⇒ cunentcanflowtbroughl.\ ⇒ 14can alsolight
thus the ammeterreadillg is the minimum.
( 3) Both filament burnt out ⇒ no current flow through.Li ⇒ L1 does not light
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/19 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/20
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
112. C 118. B
ByE=qV Xisthemid-pointofAB ⇒ RAx. = RXB = 60.
ill
=
e R,.
Equivalente.m.£ ofthetwo cells= 10 V
114. D :. readlng = 3 V
<D When Sis open, the voltmeter is connected in series with the 12 V battery, K closed: Voltmeter is in parallel with the ammeter, all the voltage of the cell is givento the 10 Q-resistor
thus thereis no current flow as the resistance of the voltmeter is infinite. There is no voltage across the annneter
There is no voltage shared by the 3 n resistor.
:. reading= 0V
Thus all the voltage of 12 V is given to the voltmeter to give the reading of 12 V.
122. D
To measure a high resistance R., voltmeter should be connected in parallel across the resistor and the ammeter.
The ammeter canread the actual current flowing through the resistor.
117. C
Since the resistance of the an:imeter is small COillpared with the resistor, the voltage across the ammeter is negligible.
Since resistmce of voltmeter is infinite, there is no current flows through AS, thus no voltage across AS.
Thus, the voltmeter reading is close to the actual voltage across the resistor.
Voltmeter thus measm:es the voltage across the battery which is always equal to 2 V.
Circuit A is used to measure a low resistance R.
Thus, the graph should be a horizontal line. Note that CUITellt flowing through the ammeter and voltmeter must be from(+) terminal to the(+) terminal ofthe meters.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/21 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/22
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
123. D 129. C
The cell 3 V is discharging and gives out current while the 1 V cell is under charging. ✓ (!) Reading of ammeter gives the sum of current flowing tbroughR and voltmeter.
Ncte.m.£ = 3-1 =2V ✓ (2) By R = T , larger measured I => smaller measured R
:. I =-2
- = 0.333A
High resistance of resistor R => large current across voltmeter ⇒ incorrect ammeter reading
2+4 (3)
Vin = 0.333 x 4 = 1.33 V
p.d. acrossXand Y = 1.33 + I = 2.33 V 130. A
Ju:,.
= 0.3 - 0.2 "" 0.1 A (from left to right)
124. D Vsn = (0.2)(5) = 1 V Vin = (0.l)(l) = 0.1 V
££ 1 £ · 2- 2 :. The lower intersection point is at a higher potential since the potential drops only 0.1 V which is less than 1 V.
pl 2 2
P = J2R = 12·- cc 1 2·- oc -- cc I -£ where volume of wire : V = A. i.
'
A A•f V
/30 =�= 0.3A (from bottom to top)
:. h = 0.3-0.l = 0.2A(from.righttoleft)
131. D
125. D
The potential of earthed point is O V.
Note that the device does not obey Ohm's law, resistance is found by R = !..
I Before switch Sis closed, potential difference across the 10 .Q resistor - 2 V.
Thus potential at P = + 2 V.
After switch S is closed, potential difference across the 1 O .Q resistor = 3 V.
The resistance decreases by 6 0.
ThuspotentialatP = +3V.
68
126. A
132. C
The circuit diagram can be redrawn as :
When the voltmeter with infinite resistance is connected, there is no current flowing through the two l .Q resistors.
S open: Voltage of the battery is shared among 2 resistors. Since voltage across the middle 2 .Q resistor is 2 V, the battery has e.m£ of 6 V.
Th.en, voltmeter measures voltage across 1 resistor only,
When the ammeter with zero resistance is connected, the equivalent resistance ofthe whole circuit is 5 n.
which is equal to half of the e.m.£, that is, 2 V.
Current delivered from the battery is 1.2 A. Current flows fromX to Y is 0.6 A.
S closed: The right resistor is shorted, all the voltage of the battery V
S
is given to the left resistor.
133. B
Thus, voltmeter measttres the e.m.f. of the battery, that is, 4 V.
Across CD, no current flows through the 10 .Q resistor and S. B
127. D The two resistors R and R are in parallel
10n R
(1) Resistors in parallel have same voltage => same energy dissipated by the 1 C charge (by E = Q V) :.B.=25 :. R=SO.Q
2
✓ (2) For parallel circuit, equivalent resistance < resistance of every individual resistor, :. R <R1
Across AC, no current flows tbroughS. A
✓ (3) Less resistors in parallel ⇒ R t R
B=---C=}----(C 500
128. D 10n
10n R A B
Sis closed ⇒ equivalent resistance ofR1 andR:z J. ⇒ p.d. acrossR1 .J, butp.d. acrossR3 t son
Potential at the earthed point is 0 V. _J-----wQ-__:c,,,iD
Potential atX: decrease (as p.d. across Rt J,)
Potential at Y: decrease (as p.d. across & t) Equivalent resistance = 10+ � = 35 n
2
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/23 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/24
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
134. A 139. C
voltage VIV ✓ A. The p.d. betweenPQ is equal to the p.d. across the battery,
14 which is equal to the e.m.:E of the battery, thus it is unchanged.
12 ✓ B. After switch Sis closed, equivalent resistance of the whole circuit decreases,
10
8 thus more current flows out from the battery, and the p.d. across R1 increases.
6
I/ Y,
As the right hand side of Ri is earthed at zero potential, the potential at P increases.
4
X C. The p.d. across R2 decreases after the switch is closed.
2 I/
I--' current I/ A As the left hand side of Rz is at zero potential, potential at Q should increase.
0 0.2 0.4 0.6
✓ D. As the p.d. across Rz decreases, the current flowing through& decreases.
Si.nee the current through the two light bulbs are the same, draw a vertical line such that Vx +Vy = 12.
The current is 0.3 A and Vx = 9V, Vy = 3V.
140. D
L½ �"?7
135. A
137. C
Current through the 3 n resistor "" � = 1A
3
141. B
a b
X (1) As they are connected in parallel, their voltages must be the same.
Equivalent resistance: R = £ = 2n ✓ (2) As the resistance of Pis greater, the current through it is smaller.
3
X
(3) By P = VI, as current I through P is smaller, power ofP is smaller, thus P should be dimmer.
138. D
✓ (1) As an ammeter is used to measure current, it should be connected in series for current to flow through it. 142. C
✓
X (2) As they are connected in series, their currents must be the same.
(3) For high resistance ammeter, it would increase the equivalent resistance of the circuit,
thus it would seriously affect the current of the circuit. ✓ (3) By P = VI, as voltage to Pis greater, power ofPis greater, thus Pis brighter.
DSE Physics • Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/25 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS/26
EM2 : Electric Circuits E.M2 : Electric Circuits
143. D 150. A
WhenP is atX, current flows directly fromXto P without pasSlllg through the resistance wireXY, current is maximum. X should be closed so that current would not pass through the light bulb below the switchX.
When P is at the mid point ofXY, current flows fromX and Y to P through. the resistance wire XY, current is minimum. fshould be opened so that current would not pass through the light bulb beside the switch Y.
WhenP is at Y, current flows directly from Y to P without passing through the resistance wire XY, current is maximum. If no current flows to other light bulbs, the current or voltage of P would be maximum, thus the brightness is maximum.
As a whole, current decreases and then increases when P is moved fromX to Y.
151. B
144. C Since the resistance of the voltmeter is vecy large, negligible current is drawn by the voltmeter.
✓ (1) Two resistors consume two times the power compared with that of one resistor.
Current given out by the battecy = 2.:_Q_ """ 025 A
✓ (2) Two resistors draw two times the current compared with that of one resistor. 2+10
(3) The equivalent resistance of two resistors in parallel is halved of that of one resistor. Voltagegiventotbe lightbulb = 0.25xl0 = 2.SV OR Voltage given to the light bulb = 3.0 x ....!£_ = 2.5 V
2+10
145. D
152. B
Ohm's law states th at the voltage across a conductor is directly proportional to the current
provided the temperature is constant, Voltage across each resistor in Figure (a) = ½V
which is equivalent to sey that the resistance of a conductor is constant provided the temperature is constant. Voltage across each resistor in Figure (b) = V
ex: V2
2
By p = V :. p :. V ➔ 2 V ⇒ P ➔ 4P
146. C
e = (2.0)(S+r)
e = (1.2)(10+r) 153. B
Combine the two equations : Assume the equivalent resistance of the four resistors R is R '.
(2.0){S+r) = (1.2)(10+r) :. r = 2.50. By .!.=..l.+l..
6 12 R'
147. B :. R' = 12n
Reading ofk is two times th atofA1 since the resistmce is halved. Thus, reading ofA2 = 2 A If the 12 n resistor is replaced by a 6 9- resistor,
148. C
154. B
✓ (1) The polarity of the ammeter is wrongly connected in reverse direction.
Current should flow into the(+) tenninal. and out of the H tem:rina1 If the variable resistor is set to zero, the light bulb is shorted,
( 2) The voltmeter is correcilyconnected. all the current will flow through the zero resistance path,
✓ The voltmeter should be connected across the resistor R only. thus no current will flow through the light bulb, the light bulb will not light up.
(3)
149. D 155. B
156. B 160. C
Let the e.m.f. of the cell be &and the internal resistance of the cell be r.
21
When Sis closed, the 3 .Q resistor is shorted, thus, the total resistance of the circuit is (6 + r) .Q.
X
y :. e=3x(6+r)
I
When Sis open, the total resistance ofthe circuit becomes (3 + 6 + r) .Q, Let the current be I.
I z :. e = Jx(9+r)
Combine the two equations :
Let the current passing through Z be I. 3x(6+r) = Ix(9+r)
Current passing through Yshould also be I. x A IfJ=l.6A,then3x(6+r)=l.6x(9+r) r is negative .-. it is impossible
Thus the current passing through Xis 2 L X B. If I= 2.0A, then 3 x (6+r) = 2.0 x (9+r) r = O.Q it is impossible
TotalpowerdissipatedbyX,YandZ =- (2I) 2R + 12 R + 1 2 R = 24 ✓ c. If I= 2.4A, then 3 x(6+r) = 2.4x (9+r) r = 6n possible
:. J2 R=4 X D. As the total resistance increases, the current must decrease and less than 3 A it is impossible
Power dissipated in resistor Z = 12 R = 4 W
161. D
157. A X A. IfR, becomes a short circuit (that is,R1 = 0 ),
current would not flow through R:i and RJ.
Voltmeter reading would become zero.
X B. IfR:i becomes a short circuit (that is, R:i = 0 ),
the voltmeter reading would become zero. R,
L, X c. IfR3 becomes a short circuit (that is, RJ = 0 ),
1---C:::::J---{ A
the total resistance of the circuit decreases. ;-----;;--1
Cw:rent given out by the cell increases.
L 1 : The above two circuits are equivalent Current would not flow to the right part of the rheostat
When the slider shifts to the right, the resistance of the rheostat increases, cun-ent decreases, tbusL1 becomes dimmer. Asterminalvoltage:V= s-1r· :.lt ⇒v-! "---+:
I -+. :
•---------·
Reading ofammeter would decrease.
Li : & the light bulb and the rheostat are connected in parallel to the cell, the voltage across L:i. is constant ✓ D. IfR:i becomes an open circuit (that is, R:i = oo ), the total resistance of the circuit increases.
Thus the brightness of L2 is not affected by the rheostat, and therefore brightness ofLi remains unchanged. Current given out by the cell decreases.
Astennmalvoltage:V= s-lr :.1-1- ⇒ vt
158. C As voltage across R1 increases since it is equal to the tenninal voltage, cmrent through R1 increases.
A IfXis shorted, the ammeter A should have reading but voltmeter V reads zero and Y is lit Reading ofammeter thus increases and reading of voltmeter also increases.
B. If Yis shorted, both the ammeter A and the voltmeter V have readings, and Xis lit.
✓ IfX is burnt out, no current flows through ammeter A,Xand Y, thusX and Yare not 'lit. 162, C
C.
However, the voltmeter V reads the voltage of the cell, thus the reading ofV is not zero. The light bulb will light up'only when S1 is closed (seat is occupied) and S1 is open (seat belt not yet fastened).
D. If Yis bum.t out,Xand Y are not lit, but both the voltmeter V and al]]Illeter A have no readings. Option C is correct. Ifboth switches are closed (seat is occupied and seat belt fastened),
the light bulb is shorted by S2, current would pass through the resistor, S,, ands, and the light bulb is shut off.
159. D OptionD is not a good design since the cell would be shorted and damaged when both switches are closed.
Ifthe voltmeter reads 6 V when switch S is closed, then one ofthe following may happen
Pis burnt out and becomes open circuit 163. B
The voltage of the cell would then share between Q and the voltmeter.
When the variable resistor is adjusted to O n, the equivalent resistance is 10 .Q and 10 kQ in parallel.
As the resistance of the voltmeter is much larger than Q,
all the voltage of the cell would be given to the voltmeter and the voltmeter reads 6 V. Since IO .Q is much Simllerthan 10 kn, the equivalent resistance is about 10 n.
<l) Q is short-circuited. The voltage across Q becomes O V. <l) When the variable resistor is adjusted to 10 Mn, the equivalent resistance is 10 MO and 10 kn in parallel.
All the voltage of the cell would be given to P and the voltmeter reads 6 V. Since l O kQ is much smaller than IO Mn, the equivalent resistance is about 10 kn.
DSE Physics - Secti.on D : M.C. Solution PD-EM2-MS /29 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM2-Q I 01
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
The equivalent resistance of P and Q is 1 0. They are in series with R and share the voltage of 6Vin proportional.
Thus, voltage across P and Qare both 2V and voltage acrossR is 4 V. Part A: BK.CE examination questions
As T and Sare in series and connected across the supply voltage of 6 V, each of them shares 3 V.
1. < HKCE 1980 Paper I- 8 >
The highest voltage across the l i ght bulb is R, thus, R will burn out first
1.0
166. B
�--1:
In the circuit, all the resistors all identical. 9V
Assume the resistance of each resistor is 2 n. I/A
I 0.5
The voltage across R1 is 9V and is irrelevant R,
-1=:J----iY
Resistors & and R.i are in parallel,.
R,
their equivalent resistance = � = 1 n
A student performed an experiment to investigate Ohm's Law using the circuit as shown above. The results are sbovro. in the
l = 3V graph above.
Voltage acrossXY = 9 x__
2+1
(a) What is the range of voltages for which Ohm's Law is obeyed'! (1 mark)
(b) Suggest a reason why Ohm's Law is not obeyed outside this range. (2nwks)
(i) O.SV;and
�: The figure above shows an experiment set-up to measure the resistance ofa light bulb.
(a) Draw a circuit diagram for the experiment. Indicate on your drawn diagram the positive terminals of the ammeter and
�,witch voltmeter with"+" signs. (5 marlcs)
voltmeter
(b) State where you should set the slider of the rheostat at the beginning of the experiment. State the reason for your choice.
(3 mms)
(c) Ifthe resistor were connected in reverse direction.how would the readings of the ammeter and voltmeter be affected?
( 2,nms)
(d) Using the same components provided, draw a circuit diagram you would use to measure a resistance comparable to that
of the voltmeter. (3 marks)
(b) If the slider in the rheostat moves from A to B, how does the reading of the ammeter change ?
I
3. (c)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-
EM2-Q
/04 1
1 I
4.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
The figure shows the apparatus of an experiment to study how the resistance of a metallic coil changes with temperature.
The temperature is controlled by changing the output voltage of the DC supply.
3
DC supply
0
&!)
ammet«
(0-500mA) (0-5V)
�
The figure above shows the voltmeter and the ammeter used in the experiment. What is volt:mcter
(i) the ammeter reading, and �
coil
(ii) the voltmeter reading
as indicated in the diagram? Hence calculate the resistance of the light bulb at this moment.
(a) Draw the wires connecting the temrinals of the apparatus to complete the circuit for the experiment. (4 ,,,,,;,)
(ii) Make a rough sketch of the voltage across the light bulb against the current. (2marks) (d) How would the resistance ofthe metallic coil chaz:ige with temperature ? (2 marks)
(e) For a particular output voltage, if the resistance coil were shortened, how would the an:uneter and the voltmeter reacling
cbangC?
(The :intcmal:resistance of the DC supply and the ammeter are negligible.) (3 marks)
/ ti
..
=====aa:EM2
5.
E
. aa:S=Ph=
y
: Electric
..
11
6V
,.-----,111-----,
✓Spring
Figllrel
D
An electronic device Dis connected to a resistor Rand a 6 V power supply as shown in Figure I above. The resistance of R Stretching force / N
is 470 .Q. A voltmeter of high resistance is connected across R. Figure 2 shows the variation of the resistance of the device D
with temperature. A spring is ha:nging freely from the ceiling and John stretches the spring with his hand as shown in Figure I. It is known that
40
Resistance I .Q the extension ofthe spring is directly proportional to the stretching force (see Figure 2).
(a) Using Figure 2, :find the stretching foree if the extension of the spring is S em.
15
(b)
IO _.,, ,
Figure2
F.igure3 �'.1 ; 2 0 on
1
1
y·
John wsnts to use a voltmeter to measure the force he applies to stretch the above spring, He sets up a device as shown
(a) The reading of the voltmeter is 4.7 V. At this instant, find in Figure 3. XYis a uniform.resistance wire of length 20 cm andP is a metallic sliding contact XYis fixed vertically
andP can slide smoothly alongXYas the spring is stretched. The voltage of the battezy is 4.5 V and the resistance ofXY
(i) the current flowing through R, is 20 n. The resistance of the variable resistor is set to 40 n. P touches endX of the wire when the stretchin.g force is
'""·
(i) Draw a circuit diagram for the circuit in Figure 3. (4""'1<s)
(tl) the resistance ofthe device D,
{b) How would the voltmeter reading change ifthe temperature of the device D increases? Explain briefly.
(ii) Show that the voltmeter reads 1.5 V when P touches end Yofthe wire.
6.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
(b ) (ill) Ifthevoltmeterreadingis 1.2 V, £nd
PD-EM2-Q/081
I
7.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-E
M2-
Q/0
(b) Iris conducts the experiment for a zinc-carbon cell, an alkaline cell and a lithium. cell separately. Figure 2 shows the
911
variation of the voltage across the bulb with time fur the cells. The bulb will light up as long as the voltage across it is
(1) the distance of P from cndX, above0.6V.
(2) the stretching force. (4 """"J
Voltage/V
12
(iv) John .finds that the device is not sensitive enough (i.e. the voltmeter reading shows no observable change when be
slightly alters bis stretching force). In order to increase the sensitivity, be suggests :reducing the resistance of the Figure 2
variable resistor. Explain whether John's suggestion is appropriate. (3 marks)
-,i
0 2 4 6 7 8 9 10
Time/hour
(i) A salesman claims that the lifetime of a lithium cell for lighting up the bulb is five times that of an alkaline cell.
7. <HKCE 2005faperl-9 > Determine whether the claim is correct or not (2 marl.cs)
to be connected to a
"'
bulb
data-.logger
(ii) The prices of the three types of cells are shown in the Table below.
Figure 1
Type of cells Price per cell
.zinc..cm:bon $15
,lkalino $ 3.8
Iris uses the apparatus shown in Figure 1 to study the lifetime of AA-size cells for lighting up a bulb. She connects a cell and
a switch to the bulb and uses a voltage sensor to me3S\ll'C the voltage across the bulb. lithium $25.0
(a) Draw a circuit diagram to illustrate how the apparatus is connected. Use the symbot G) to denote the voltage sensor.
(3 """") Which type of cells is the best buy, in terms of the cost per hour for lighting up the bu.lb ? Show your calculations.
(3 """")
1
8.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
< HKCE 2006 Paper IM 11 >
PD-EM2 -QI 10
I 8.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
(c) The teacher asks Mary, ''VVhat happens ifthe variable resistor is set to zero ?''
"The light bulb will burn out," M.uy answered.
PD-EM2-Q/II
low voltage power supply Explain ml.etherMazy's answer is correct ('2 m,,k.,J
( with negligible internal resistance)
switch I I I,.____
lightbolb
ammeter
sealed box
A teacher gives Jane a sealed box in which a light bulb is connected to a variable resistor. The teacher asks Jane to find out
how the bulb and the variable resistor are connected together inside the sealed box. Jane then sets up a circuit as shown in A teacher conducts an experiment to study the energy conversion of a filament light bulb. A simple circuit is connected as
the above Figure. She reduces the resistanceR of the variable resistor and records the changes as shown in the below Table. show:n in the above :figure and the bulb is ittmlersed into 0.09 kg of oil inside a foam cup as shown below. The bulb is lighted
up for 300 s, and the temperature of the oil is increased from 20"C to 42°C.
Data: Voltageofthepowersupply = 3V
Initial value ofR = 15 n Initial ammeter reading = 2.6 A
Final value ofR = 5 Q Final ammeter reading = 3.0 A thermometer
foam cover
Observation: Brightness of the bulb remains unchanged
(a) (i) Jane correctly concludes that the variable resistor and the bulb are connected in parallel inside the box. Give a filament light bulb
reason to support Jane's conclusion. (1 muk)
oil
In the experiment, the ammeter and voltmeter readings are 1.4 A and 12 V respectively. The specific heat capacity of the oil
(ii) Draw a circuit diagram to illustrate how the apparatus shown in the above Figure are connected, inclutling the is 2100 J kg""1 0C--1 •
components inside the box. Use the symbol � � to denote the low voltage power supply. (2 marks)
(a) Calculate the energy absorbed by the oil.
(b) Describe the energy conversion when a current passes through the filament light bulb. (1 mark)
(iii) Using the data in the above Table, find the resistance of the bulb. (3 """"'l
(c) (i) Estimate the amount of energy that is converted into light enexgy in the experiment, and state ONE asSUIJiption
made in your calculation. (4 marks)
(b) Jane's classmr,te Mary conducts the same experiment by replacing the low voltage power supply with two 1.5 V dry
cells which are connected in series. If the internal resistance of the dry cells is not negligilile, explain why the brightness
of the bulb decreases when R is reduced. (3 marks) (ii) Hence, determine the percentage of electrical energy consumed by the :filament light bulb that is converted into
light energy. (2 m arks)
10.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
l 11.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-Q/13
(b) (ii) Measurements are repeated with different settin gs of the variable resistor. The Table shows the data obtained.
Using the apparatus shown in the figure below, describe the procedures of an experiment to study how the resistance of a
nichrome wire depends on its thickness. Trial Voltmeter Reading VIV Ammeter Reading I I A
(4 marks)
1 1.4 022
2 2.8 0.42
3 4.1 0.64
4 5.6 0.82
Plot a graph of voltmeter reading against ammeter reading in the Figure below. Use a scale of 1 cm representing
1 VandO.lA.
11. <HKCE2011Paperl-5>
Jane wants to find the resistance of a resist'ance wire by me asuring the voltage across and current through the resistance
wire.
(a) As shown in Figure (a), Jane bas connected the resistance wire in series with a ba ttery, an ammeter, a switch and a
variable resistor. Add a voltmeter(@) in Figure (a) to complete the circuit. (l mark)
Figure(a) (ii i) From the graph plotted lll (b) (ii), find the resistance of the resistance wire.
ilr---=l---__J (c) Now the resistance ofa :filament ligh t bulb is studied using the same experimental se tup. The voltag�t graph
(b) After the teacher has checked the circuit, Jane performs the experiment.
obtained is shown in Figure (c). Explain why the graph is not a straight line. (2 marks)
(i) The ammeter readin g Ula certain trial is shown in Figure (b). In this setting, the maximum cunent that can be V
measured by the ammeter is I A What is the reading shown? (1 mark)
Figue (c)
Figure (b)
Amm.eterreadin g - _______
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM2-Q/14 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM2-Q/15
EM2 : Electric Orcuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
Thermistor's resistance
+--------{ V f----➔ ""'
""
L_c;z:S--< A
R a
The above circuit is employed to measure the e.m.f., e, and the :internal resistance, r , of a dry cell. Assume that the voltmeter
and the ammeter used are ideal. 12v -=- A �"
VIV
120n ""'
'"
" '"
Temperature / °C
(ii) What is the potential difference VAB across A and B at 25°C ? (2 marks)
The voltmeter readings, V, and the ammeter readings, I, obtained for different rheostat settings are used to plot the above (b)
grap h.
12v-=..
V
(b) Hence deduce from the graph the e.m.£ and the internal resistance of the cell. (2 marks) B
Kelly wants to confirm the above calculation by measuring VAB using a voltmeter of about 1 kQ resistance, She
finds that the reading registered is slightly different from the value found in (a) despite making careful measurements.
Explain why this is so. Suggest how the accuracy of the measurement could be improved (3 marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD -EM2-Q / 16 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD -EM2-Q /17
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
13. (c) (i) 14. <HKDSE2016PaperIB-7>
(a) The circuits in the above Figure each contains two resistors connected in series with a 6 V battery of negligible internal
resistance, The resistors in circuit I are IO ill each while those in circuit II are 100 n each.
6V 6V
�----,111-----�
12v-=- Al----
To
electtonic
�----,110----�
120n
switch
circuit I circuit II
B lOk.Q lOkQ
The potential difference VAB is used to drive an electronic switch connected across AB to turn on a fan if
temperature rises above a certain value such that VAB is 6.0 V or above. Using the information provided in the
graph, find the minimum temperature needed to keep the fan on. Show you working. (2 marks)
A voltmeter of intemal resistance Rv = 10 k!l is used to measure the potential difference across one of the resistors as
shown.
(ii) Jn fact, the potential dif:ference across each resistor before connecting the voltmeter is 3 Vin both circuits. Explain
why this voltmeter gives a relative inaccurate value for circuit I. Hence state the general principle of selecting a
suitable voltmeter for such measurement. (2 marks)
l
(ii)
(b) Circuit ill shows a possible method for measuring resistance using a voltmeter and an ammeter. The internal resistance
for the voltmeter and the ammeter are Rv and� respectively and their readings V,,, and[,,,_ give the measured resistance
12v-=- R,,,_ = Vm • The true resistance value of the resistor isR.
1.
To
electronic
switch
--------<111-----
circuit ID Rv -
V f ----1
Without using additional components, complete the new circuit diagram below to illustrate how the circuit can be
modified to tum on a heating device when temperature falls below a certain value. Explain the action ofthe circuit.
R
No calculation is required. (3 marks) '------C:=J---(A "'
(llJ Find the percentage error associated with.Rm when measuring the resistance of this resistor.
Given: Rv = 10 kn,&= 1 n andR = 10 n. (2marks)
I DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-Q/18 II DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM2 : Electric Circuits
PD-EM2-Q / 19
15. <HKDSE2017 Paper IB- 8 > 15. (c) The student claims that since the resistance of the light bulb is not a constant, the equation R = VII cannot be used to
A student uses the following apparatus to measure the resistance of a tungsten :filament light bulb. calculate the resistance ofthe light bulb. Briefly explain why his cl.aim is wrong. (1 mark)
(a) Figure l shows an incomplete circuit for the experiment. The '+' symbol represents the positive terminal of the
ammeter.
(d) Determine the resistance of the light bulb at V= 0.1 V and2.5 V.
Use suitable circuit symbols to complete the circuit, and mark the positive tenninal of the voltmeter with '+'. (3 marks)
+
Figure 1 A rrr,
(e) It is given that the cross--sectional area of the tungsten :filament in the "light bulb is I.66 x 10➔ and the resistivity of
tungsten at room temperature is about 5.6 x 10-a n m Estimate the length of the tungsten filament in the light bulb
using the appropriate resistance found in (d)._ (3 marks)
Vol e across the Ii ht bulb VIV 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 1.0 2.0 3.0 16. <HKDSE2019 Ppaper-IB-7>
Current JJ mA 0 76 112 126 133 139 170 226 273
You aro provided with a batteey (of fixed e.m.f. � and internal re,istance r), a YBl:iable resistor {with seven,!
300 known rnistance values R to be ,ele<tcd), a switcl!, a voltmotor (assumed ideal) and a few connecting wi=.
250
__,..,,,- 0--
200
!
Fignre2 ._, 150
�
100
(a) With tlie aid of , cin:uit diagram. doscn1,c the prooedwo of an experiment to study how the terminal
voltage I'"delivered by the batt<;:rY depends on tho remtance R comectl:d to it Stw:, ONE pm;aution of
50
Ille experimem. (5 mori<s)
(b) Describe lhe variation of I'"wi1h Rand cxprcss Vin tem>s of,; rand R. (2 morb)
0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5
Voltage across the light bulb VIV
(b) Briefly explain the variation of the resistance of the light bulb with the voltage across the light bulb. (2 marks)
17. <HKDSE2020Paper lB-8>
Figure 8.1 shows a simplified circuit of the lighting system of a car. Each of the taillights (Ti, T2)� high-beam
headligbts (H,, H,) and low-beam headlights (L,, .l,) has resistance 30 n, 2 n and 3 n respectively. The
internal resistance of the 1_2 V battery and the resistance of the fuse are negligible.
B
A,-------------..-------,C
L,
T, 3Q
30 n
;ure S.1
T,
30n
1s,
fus1_
L,
3Q
12V-=..
F '------<l�------_._.-------'D
Vlhen switch S1 is closed and switch S2 is set at the position shown in Figure 8.1, only 71 and 72 as well as
H1 and H2 are lit. The current drawn from the battery is at a maximum in this setting.
(a) Explain why £1 and L2 are not lit. (I mark)
(b) (i) What is the potential difference across the taillight T2 ? (I mark)
{ii) Indicate on Figure &. I the direction of current in each of the branches AB, GB and BC. Which branch
carries the largest current?. (3 marks)
(c) Calculate the power delivered by the battery and show that the equivalent resistance of the circuit is
slightly less than 1 Qin this setting. (4 marks)
(d) Based on your answer in (c). explain whether a fuse rating of l5 A js suitable for this circuit or not.
(2 marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM2-QS/Ol DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM2-QS/02
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits .
BKEAA's Maml1g SclJe:rne is PICPaICd for the ma.kets' teference. It should not be regatded as a set ofntOdel answers.
I
Students and teachers who are not involved in the marking process are advjscd to .lllteip:[et the Marl::ing Scheme wit.b. care, 2. (d) [3]
I
Question Solution
L (a) From.0 Vto 1 V, Ohm's Lawis obeyed [!J
�
(b) The temperature of the lamp increases, [ll
thus the resistance of the lamp increases. [ll
V
(c) (i) R=�=�=l.33.Q <accept1.3Qto1.4Q> [!]
I 0375
< The cells, the switch, the rheostat, the resistor and the ammeter are in series> [!J
(ii) R = !::.. = � = 1.55 n <accept 1.53 n to 1.56 n> [I] <The voltmeter is connected in parallel> [!]
I 0.97
< The voltmeter is connected across the resistor and the ammeter> [!]
2. (a)
�,1
3. (,) [5]
(b) (Q
DCa,pply
+
y
p
voltmeter
(d) Resistance increases when temperature :increases. [2] (iv) His suggestion is apPiopriate.
Ifthe resistance of the variable resistor is reduced, the voltage acrossXYis increased. [!]
(e) Amtneterreadingincreases. [l]
Thus a change in the position of P will result in a greater change in the voltmeter reading. [!]
Voltmeter reading remains unchanged. [2]
So the sensitivity of the device is increased. [!]
(b) When temperature increases, resistance ofthe deviceD decreases. [!] < Cell, switch and bulb in series> [1]
Voltage across the device D thus decreases. [!] < Bulb and sensor in parallel> [1]
Therefore, voltmeter reading increases. [1] < Correct circuit symbols > [1]
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM2-QS/05 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM2-QS/06
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
7. (b) (i) lifetime oflithiumcells = 8.2 hours < accept 8 to 9 hours> 8. ( b) When the resistance R decreases, the current through the dry cells increases. [l]
lifetime ofalkaline cells = 4.4 hours < accept 4 to 5 hours > [l] The voltage across the internal resistance ofthe drycells increases. [l]
Since S.2 = 1.86 ;o 5 Thus, the voltage across the light bulb decreases. [l]
4.4
Therefore, the brightness ofthe bulb decreases.
so the claim is not correct [l]
CostperhourfurZUl.C..ca:rbon cells= LS=$ 1.07 < accept 1.00 to 1.15 > (l]
* since the voltage across the light bulb is zero
1.4
CurrentthroughR = 2_ = 0.2A CummtthroughR = l = 0.6A [l] 10. Connect the two crocodile clips across a certain length of the thin.nichrome wire. [l]
15 5
Record the ammeterreading. [l]
Current throughthe bulb = 2.6 - 0.2 = 2.4 A Currenttbroughthe bulb = 3-0.6 = 2.4A [I]
Repeat the experiment using the thicker nichrome wire ofthe same length, [l]
Rerutallce ofthe light bulb = 2-_ = 125 .Q [l]
2.4 The ammeter reading should be larger, showing that the resistance ofthe thicker wire is smaller. [l]
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM2-QS/07 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD -EM2-QS/ 08
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
< The voltmeter is connected in parallel across the resistor only.> [l] (ii) VAB = 12 x lZO [l]
120+80
(b) (i) Reading = 0.32 A [l] = 7.2V [l]
VIV (b) As Rv and 120 n are in parallel, their equivalent resistance is smaller than 120 n. [l]
Therefore, the voltage shared across AB is smaller th.an that expected. [l]
The accuracy can be improved by using a voltmeter with resistance mu.ch higher than 120 Q. [l]
(n)
120n
--
12V ::
To
IJ elewonic
R
switcl>
I/A
< circuit diagram : 120 n andRare interchanged> [l]
(ill)R = slope of the straight line 14. (a) (i) Circuit I:R= 10 kO
[l]
= 6-0 = 6.67 n < Acceptable range ofR: 636 - 6.83 n > [l]
Equivalent resistance = !Q. = 5 kn
2
0.9
V=6x__5
[l]
{c) As the temperature of the filament increases with the current, [l] 5+10
its resistance increases with the temperature. [l] =2V [l]
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM2-QS/09 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD -EM2-QS / 10
EM2 : Electric Circuits EM2 : Electric Circuits
Resistance of voltmeter should be much higher than the resistance of the resistor connected in panllel. [I]
••• ,e = 0.0391m <accept0.039m> [I]
(b) (i) V,,, does not give the true voltage for the resistor. [I] 16.
[!] Solution
= 10% [I]
mep}
oxpe,imont
+
A � Firstsettbe vmable RSistcrto ifs maxir:mm:t / a IA
val� ...,,
- Opontbeswttclulter...,h.........,.,. 0"1l
Airy- reasonabW 4b5WCt
5
< correct symbols of light bulb, voltmeter and variable resistor (rheostat)> [l]
< correct positions ofthe components > [I]
< correct positive temrinal of the voltmeter> [I]
(b) As the voltage across the light bulb increases, tempcrato.re of the light bulb increases, [I]
thus its resismlce increases. [l]
y
=
5. Wave Nature ofLight (ic,6gitttl,�•!±)
D.C.
6. Sound(*½)
Section D - Electricity and Magnetism ( 't ;fa .;Jt)
Z 210
1. Electrostatics (ff-1t4':)
2. Electric Circuits C1l!:l3-)
3. Domestic Electricity ( �� m 11!:) X 180 K
4. Magnetic Field(x&tlf)
5. Electromagnetic Induction (1tllt!i1..!&)
6. Alternating Current (Sf.ilii.1t) In the circuit shown, Yis as A fuse, Z andX are 3 A fuses. When the switchK is open the current passing through the 21 n
Section E- Radioactivity and Nuclear Energy (:$:.M-1.11../ll:fa*-«.fi'E.) resistor is 2.4 A. WhenK is closed, which of the fuses will be blown ?
1. R.adiation and Radioactivity(fflM:fo:M:.M� �) A. Xonly
2. AtomicModel(.ilT��) B. Yonly
3. NuclearEnergy(al'lll6) C. Zonly
D. XandZonly
Physics - Elective part (;J!.if":,,-)
Elective 1 -Astronomy and Space Science (��tf::fo#t.ic.tl-4!=)
L The universe as seen in different scales c;i;: JSJ !Z. r., �Ii. ""'f {i!J �'iliiliitt.) 2. < HKCE 1982 Paper Il- 26 >
2. Astronomytbroughhist:ory (?(.:$C.${i!J.ft-hl!t.) The table below shows the voltage and power rating for various electrical appliances. Which of the electric appliances has
3. Orbital motions under gravity ( i: h r lr!i M..utr.u1.,) the Slllallest working resistance 7
4. Stars and the universe(·IJ.£.ifo�'ili)
Appliance Voltage PoWer/W
Elective 2 - Atomic World (lfi. Tilt�)
1. Rutherford's atomic model (il�#>Bf,TfA-it!) A Air-conditioner 200 2000
2. Photoelectriceffect(X.'t/1.t.li) B. Television 200 250
3. Bohr's atomic model of hydrogen (�i {i!J A\,,1$ T-ffi1:!) Q Heat� 100 2000
4. !'articles or waves(Jlti.T �i't.)
D. Hair-dryer 100 20
5. Probingintonano scale(��#H�'l!t�)
Elective 3 - Energy and Use of Energy Cile."iofoif6i!li.{!{J#!.JH)
1. Electricity at home C �,I§, ffl 1t) 3. < HK.CE 1982 Paper Il - 28 >
2. Energy efficiency in building (,tffi.{i!Jli6i&tt.$-)
3. Energy efficiency in transportation(>{#;� {i!J �f;it./1.t.�) A set of Christmas tree lights consists of20 bulbs in series. Each bulb has a rating of"l0 V 5 W". One of the bulbs burns
out and Jimmy goes to buy a replacement. When he gets back, he finds that although the new bulb is .marked 5 W, it looks
4. Non-renewable energy sources ( � -r -i+!t.li6 �)
dimmer than the others when the lights are turned on. The most probable reason for this is that the new bulb
5. Renewable energy sources (,r .j!j.;£111;.i.!f,)
A. has a smaller current flowing through it
Elective 4 - Medical Physics ( ,& 4!= Jti,; J.t �)
1. Makingsenseoftheeyc(��lr!i�'ff) B. has a filament with a higher resistance.
2. Making sense of the ear (.lf-#,p;!J;. 'Ir) C. has been shorted accidentally.
3. Medical imaging using non-ionizing radiation (�F- 1@:Ml'-#.Af-l-$1${8!.$) D. is designed to work at a lower :voltage.
4. Medical imaging using ionizing radiation(il!:Nr-.ti.Afll-<!!>�i#.,Jf;)
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/02 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/03
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
4. <HKCE1982Paperll-29> 10. < HK.CE 1986 Paper JI - 36 >
fifteen bulbs, each labelled '200 V 60 W', are connected in parallel to a 200 V supply. Which of the following fuses should P and Qare bulbs ofrating"40W, 200 V" whileR and Sare ofrating "60 W, 200 V'. 'Which ofthefollowing circuits gives
be used in the circuit? the maximum brigh tness ?
A. 2A (Assume all circuits are connected to the same voltage.)
B. 3A A.
C. 4A
D. SA
p
6. <HKCE1984P aperll-30>
Which of the following has the greatest current when it is operated at 200 V ?
A. a lamp with a reststance of 400 n
B. arice-cooker with rating of 400 W at 200 V
C. an electric iron with rating of400 Wat 220 V C.
D. ahair-dcyerwithratingof600 W at200 V
¾
C. D. of R if the lamp is to work as rated?
A. zn
B. 3n
C. 40
n. sn
I
13. <HKCE1987Paperll-27>
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
PD-EM
3-M
/ 04 I 17. <HKCE1991Paperll-28>
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
PD-EM3-M/05
For safety, the correct way of connecting the fuse and switch to electrical appliances should be
A. fuse in live wire, switch in neutral \\ire.
B. fuse in earth wire , switch in live wire.
C. both in neutral wire.
D. both in live wire.
-
18. <HKCE 1991 Paper Il- 36 >
In the three-pin plug as shown. X, Y and Z are respectively connected to the Two light bulbs A andB of ratings '10W, 6 V' and '5 W, 6 V' respectively are connected in series to a 6 Vbattety. 'Which
-
X y z ofthe following is/are correct 7
(1) The resistance ofA is smaller than thatofB.
A. neutral livo (2) The current throu gh A is the same as that through B.
B. live neo"'1 (3) AisbrighterthanB.
c. noutr.,J ,arth live A. (1) only
D. nou"'1 live B. (3) onfy
C. (1)&(2)only
D. (2) & (3) only
14. <HK.CE1988 Paper Il- 33 >
A 31>in plug is connected to a boiler ofrating "2000 W, 200 V". Vlhich of the following statements is/are true ? 19. < HKCE1993 Paper II- 33 >
(1) A 5 A fuse should be used in the circuit. Which ofthe following is NOT a correct unit for the corresponding physical quantity?
(2) The fuse should be placed on the brown wire ofthe cable.
Physical quantity Unit
(3) The yellow and green wire of the cable should be connected to the earth pin.
A. charge coulomb
A. (1) only
B. eurnnt ampere
B. (3) only
C. (!)& (2) only
c. resistance ohm
D. voltage joule
D. (2) & (3) only
- - -
(3) The cooker consumes 1 kWh of electrical. energy in 2 hours.
A. (1 ) only
A stanrlard three-pin socket on the wall is shown in the figure. \Vhich of the following is correct? B. {2) only
C. (1) & (3) only
Pin (1) Pin (2) Pin (3) D. (2) & (3) only
A. nou"'1 live
B. neutral livo 21. < BK.CE 1994 Paper II -29 >
c. live nou"'1
D. neutral livo Which of the following diagrams correctly shows the connection of the wires ofan iron to the pins ofa plug 7
(J,: Live, N: Neutral, E: Earth )
A. B.
16. <HKCE 1989 Paper 11-37 >
N�
Operating voltage 220V/50Hz E
p, 1500W
FuseRating 30A L
C. D.
The diagram shows the label attached to an electric appliance. How much electrical energy is supplied to the appliance
:in2 hours?
A. 2.0kWh
B. 2.SkWh
C. 3.0kV/h
D. 6.0kWh
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/06 I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/071
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
=-
Which of the following values is equivalent to one kilowatt hour? The kilowatt-hour is a unit of
A. 1000W A. charge.
B. IO00J B.
C. 3.6xl06 W C. energy.
D. 3.6 x 106 J D. power.
23. < HK.CE 1995 Paper Il- 35 > 27. < BKCE 1997 Paper n - 30 >
Which of the following statements about the earth wire in an electric iron is/are correct?
X(Bcown (1) The earth wire should be cOJlllected to the metal body ofthe iron.
Fuse
(2) If the iron is working properly, no current pass through the earth wire.
Y(Blue) � (3) In case the neutral wire is broken, the earth wire provides a spare wire for the return path to the mains socket.
A. (I) only
Z (Green/ yellow)
B. (3) only
C. (I) & (2) only
The diagram above shows a three-pin plug and the wires connected to it To which of the pins should each of the wires X, Y D. (2) & (3) only
andZbe connected?
p Q R
28. < BKCE 1998 Paper II - 33 >
A. z y X
z
, 7_,__ ,,
B. y X Power supply
c. y z X
D. z X y
totalres.istanceR
�
24. < HKCE 1995 Paper Il - 30 >
An electric appliance is connectedto a power supply of voltage Vby long cOJlllecting wires of total resistance R as shown in
the circuit. It is found that the cun:ent passing through the appliance is only ½Io, where Io is the current required for the
appliance to work at its rated value. Which of the following changes could
increase the current through the appliance to Io ?
Voltage of power supply Total resistance of connecting wires
A. increases to 2V remains unchanged
B. increases to 2 V reduces to R/2
A Christmas tree is illuminated with four strings of light bulbs. Each string has ten identical light bulbs connected in series C. remains unchanged increases to 2R
as show.n fu the figure. If one light bulb suddenly bums out, which ofthe following will happen? D. remains unchanged reduces to R/2
A Only that light bulb will go out.
B. One light bulb in each string will go out.
C. One string of light bulbs will go out 29. < BKCE 2000 Paper II- 35 >
D. All ofthe light bulbs will go out.
--1-
The above diagram shows the main parts of an electric iron. Jn which of the following situations will the fuse blow when the
switch is closed?
(1) The insulation at contact point Xis worn out so that the wire touches the metal case.
The switch S and the fuse of an iron are incorrectly fitted in the neutral wite as shoMt above. Which of the following (2) The insulation at contact point Yis wom out so that the wire touches the metal case.
statements is correct ? (3) The heating element is broken.
A The iron will not operate even when Sis on. A. (I) only
B. The iron will still operate even when Sis off. B. (3) only
C. The iron will still operate, but ifthere is a high current the fuse will not blow. C . (1)&(2)on!Y
D. The iron will still operate, but the heating element will remain at a high voltage even when Sis off. D. (2) & (3) only
DSE Physics - Section D : MC. PD-EM3-M/08 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/09
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
•--1
w
12V
C. D. R
L�
;-:---� Three light bulbs P, Q andR of ratings '24 V, 80 W', '12 V, 80 W' and '12 V, 40 W' respectively are connected in parallel
to a 12 V battery. Vlbich of thebulbs will be the brightest, and which will be the dinunest ?
The brightest The dimmest
31. <BK.CE2001Paperll-32> A. p Q
B. p R
Two electric heatersXand Y are of ratings '110 V, 40 W' and '110 V, 80 W' respectively. Which ofthe below deductions c. Q p
about the two beaters is/are correct ? D. Q R
(1) The operating resistance ofXis twice that of Y.
(2) X will consume a power of80W when it is connected to a 220 V mains supply.
35. < HKCE 2003 Paper II 35 >w
(3) Both heaters wotlc at their rated values 'When they are connected in series to a 220 V mains supply.
The photograph shows a tlireewp:in plug ofan appliance. Which of the following is a
A (1) only function ofpin P ?
B. (3) only A. It prevents the appliance from being shortweircuit.
C. (1) & (2) only
B. It protects the user from getting an electric shock.
D. (2) & (3) only
C. It provides a retum path for the current
D. It can break the circuit when the current flowing through the appliance is too large.
32. <BK.CE 2002 Paper 11- 34 >
Three identical lamps L1, Lz and L; of ratings '6 V, 12 W' are connected 36. < HKCE 2003 PaperII 36 > w
C tri!if
is con-ect?
ENERGY LABEL
A. The voltage across Lz is 3 V.
B. ThC current passing through L1 is 2 A. jg;;Ji
C. The total power drawn from the battery is 12 W.
Brand AA!T XXX
D. The total power dissipated in£, and¼ is smaller than that inL;.
Model ffl!!df: XXX
_,
Actual cousumptlou will depend ou where tbi: appllaucc ls
Live wire located and how itjs II.Std. Alm!111l 260 washes per yeu.
$�t•���s��•�Aa�m��-
1UU:�4ii,1¥-ilt� 260 .:J:. •
Energy Efilciency Grade
I
42.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
< HK.CE 2006 Paper JI-21 >
PD-EM3 M
- /ll
ll
An electrical appliance is protected by a fuse in a domestic circuit. 'When the appliance is switched on, the fuse blows 45. < BK.CE 2007 Paper II-18 >
immediately. Which of the following statements is/are possible reason(s) for this phenomenon?
(1) The resistance of the appliance is too large. A household circuit breaker is marked '220 V, 15 A'. Now an electric iron rated '220 V, llOO W' and a cooker rated
(2) The appliance is short-circuited.. '220V, 550 W' are connected in parallel to the mains socket How manylight bulbs rated '220V, IOOW' at mostcan still be
(3) The rated value of the fuse is too small . connected in parallel to the mains witb.cut triggering the circuit breaker?
A. (I) only A. 12
B. (3) only B. 16
C. (1)&(2)only C. 17
D. (2) & (3) only D. 20
51. <HKCE2010Paperll-16>
DSE Physics - Section D : MC
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
PD-EM3-M/13
Two •identical bulbs, X and Y, are connected in parallel to the mains. X The photo below shows the back of a microwave oven.
The current passing through Xis 0.4 A. What is the energy consumed
by the two bulbs in 5 hours ?
y Power supply: 220V - 50Hz
A. 0.44kWh
Power consumption: 1150W
"v--�
B. 0.88kWh
C. 440kWh �--220V Microwave output :
Microwave frequency :
750W
2450MHz
D. 880kWh
48. <HKCE2009Paperll-20>
The power ratings and resistances of two light bulbs are "24 W, 6 n'' and "9 W, 4 0" respectively. Ifthese two light bulbs 'iVbich of the following statements is/are correct?
are connected in parallel to a power supply, what is the maximum current drawn from the power supply so that both light
bulbs are working within the :rated power ? (1) The current flowing through the microwave oven is about 3.4 A.
A. 2.0A (2) Around 65¾ of electrical energy is converted into energy carried by microwave.
B. 2.SA (3) The wavelength of the microwave emitted is about 0.12 m.
C. 35A
A. (1) only
D. 4.8A
B. (2) only
C. (1) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) only
49. <BKCE2009Paperll-23>
-:'t&
52. < HKCE2010 Paper n. 20 >
Which of the following is the COIIect connection ofX, Y and Z to the mains ?
"""
X y z beating element
A. live
'""' """
neutral
In the figure above, the kettle is wired incorrectly. Which of the following statements is correct when point P is accidentally
"""
B. live neutral
connected to the metal case ?
C. neutral live
D. neutral live A. The kettle will still operate at its rated value when Sis closed.
B. The fuse will blow when S is closed.
50. <BKCE 2009Paperll-41 > C. The heating element will bum out when Sis closed.
- -
D. A current will flow through the live wire even when Sis open.
A ma.ms heater has two identical heating elements of same resistance R.
!i.
· R
s,
When S1 aD.dSi are closed andS3 is open, the power of the heaterisP. What is the power of the heaterwbenS1 and S2 are In the circuit above, the rating of the bulb is "6 V, 12 W", Find the resistance of R so that the bulb will work at its rated
open and S3 is closed? value.
A. 0.25P A. 2n
B. 0.5 P B. 30
C. 2P C. 4Q
D. 4P D. 6Q
DSE Physics · Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/14 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM3-M/15
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
54. < HK.CE 2011 Paper JI- 11 > Which of the following statements concerning the fuse in an electrical appliance are correct?
As shown in the figW'e, a 2 W light bulb is immersed into 50 g of water. (I) A �e is made ofa metal with low melting point.
The bulb is operating at its rated value. After 10 minutes, the (2) Jfthe fuse in an electrical appliance is blown, it should not be replaced by a piece of copper wire.
temperature of the water increases by 4.5°C. Estimate the amount of (3) If copper is used to replace the blown fuse, it will cause short circuit of the appliance as copper has low resistance.
light emitted during the 10 minutes.
Given : specific heat capacity ofwater = 4200 J k g-1 0
c-1 A.
B.
(I) & (2) only
(1)&(3)only
C. (2) & (3) only
A 255J
D. (!), (2) & (3)
B. 690 J
C. 945 J
D. 1200 J 59. Small light bulbs of rating "12 V, 6 VI" are to be used in a circuit. The voltage of the power supply is24 V and the cmrent
drawn from the supply is 2 A What is the number of light bulbs connecting in the circuit so that each light bulb is under
nonnal rating ?
A. 2
B. 4
Part B : BKAL examination questions C. 8
D. 16
55. < HKAL 1980 Paper I - 22 >
Torch bulbs marked ''3 V, 1.5 W'', are to be used in a circuit by using 6 V battery. What should be the number of bulbs 60. Which of the following statements concerning two light bulbs with rated values, '200 V, 100 W' and '200 V, 40 W', are
connected in the circuit ifthe steady current drawn from the battery is to be2 A and each bulb gives normal brightness ? correct?
A. 2 (1) The energy dissipated by the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater than that of the '200 V, 40 w• light bulb when
B. 3 they work at their rated values.
C. 4 (2) The current flowing through the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater than that ofthe '200 V, 40 W' light bulb when
they work at their rated values.
D. 8
(3) The resistance of the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater than that of the '200 V, 40 W' light bulb when they work
at their rated values.
56. < HKAL 1983 Paper I- 43 > A (1)&(2)only
A set ofChristmas tree lights consists of20 light bulbs in series connected to a supply of 200 V. Each light bulb has a rating B. (I) & (3) only
of"l0 V, 5 W''. When one bulb bums out, Jenny goes to buy a replacement When she gets bac k, she finds that although the C. (2) & (3) only
newbulb is marked 5 W, the light it gives is dimmer than the other bulbs. Which of the following is a possible reason ? D. (!), (2) & (3)
(1) The supply voltage bas dropped below200 V.
(2) The current through the circuit is less than 0.5 A 61. Which ofthe following concerning the household circuit is/are correct?
(3) The rated voltage ofthenewbulb is less than 10 V. (1) Fuse.should be installed in the live wire ofan electrical appliance.
(2) Switch should be installed in the neutral wire ofan electrical appliance.
A. (1) only
B. (3) only (3) Current always flows from the live wire through the appliance to the neutral wire.
C. (1) & (2) only A (1) only
D. (2) & (3) only B. (3) only
C. (I) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only
Part C : Supplemental exercise 62. Which of the following statements concerning two light bulbs with rated values, '200 V, 100 W' and '200 V, 40 W', is/are
correct?
57. In a household circuit, as more lamps are switched on, which of the following statements are correct? (1) The resistance of the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater than that of the '200 V, 40 W' light bulb.
(1) The equivalent resistance of the whole circuit increases. (2) The current flowing through the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater than that of the '200 V, 40 W' light bulb when
(2) The total power consump6on increases. they are connected in series.
(3) The total current drawn increases. (3) The power dissipated by the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is smaller than that of the '200 V, 40 W' light bulb when
they are connected in series.
A (1) & (2) only
A (1) only
B. (1) & (3) only
B. (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only C. (1) & (2) only
D. (!), (2) & (3) D. (2) & (3) only
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
I
67. <HKDSE2013Paper1A-33>
DSEPhysics-SectionD: M.C.
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
PD-EM3-M/1711
Which of the following domestic electrical appliances consumes a power close to 1 kW in nonnal working conditions?
63. < HKDSE Sample Paper IA - 26 > A. an electric fan
B. a microwave oven
If a 15 A fuse is installed in the plug of an electric kettle of rating value '220 V, 900W', state what happens when the kettle C. a fluorescent lamp
is plugged in and switched on. D. aTVset
A The kettle will not operate.
B. The kettle will be short-circuited.
C. The output power of the kettle will be increased. 68. < HKDSE2015 Paper IA - 28>
D. The chance of the kettle being damaged by an excessive current will be increased. Which statement is NOT a reason why mains socket at home are connected in parallel instead of a-series circuit?
A. Electrical appliances connwted to differep.t sockets can be switched on or offindependently.
B. Voltage supplied to each socket is :fixed and all eleetrical appliances can operate at their rated voltage.
64. < HKJ)SE Sample Paper IA-25 > C. The current supplied can be reduced and thinner cables can then be used.
D. When an electrical appliance breaks dO'Wll and becomes an opep. circuit, other appliances can still work.norm.ally.
The table shows three electrical appliances which Clara used in a. certain month:
· =·��;;::=
,.-----;:::;-E?-!
B. 0.720kg
L(_:::tf:��,
C. 576 k g
D. 720kg
s
L
'--+"l--.J c
h
The�is�en checke d h
wit switchScJ oscd. Using avoltage tester totouc h pointsban dcin rums
the �r.mdicates
tb8: bo � points
test er mdicates only pOinta IS athighare athigh voltage. When touching point5 a and in ru.ms, the
.
v oltagt. Whichof th e follo wing can be a reason fo d
rthe fault?
A. The Switc h
Shasbe en damaged.
B . The filamen t ofbulb Lhasb eenb'1rl)toutand becomes an open cireu: it.
There is a sh
o rtcircuit!,e!Wffll a
C. and
D . There isanopen circuitbetween c andd. d.
The batter y shown has a capacity of 1100 mAh. How much energy is delivered
tte s op
e ho ur ? Assume that the ba ry' eratinthe vbatt,ry
when l ta
cum,mof250 mA for on o ge
operates nOtnJally a a g
1
A. (3.7 X� X 3600 )]
1000
(J.7x�x3600 )J
B.
1000
C. (37 x �x
1000
l)J
•
(37 x � x l)J
D. . 1000
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/Ol DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS /02
EM3 : Domestic Electricity BM3 : Domestic Electricity
HXEAA's Marki:og Scheme is prepared for the markers' :reference. It should not be reganied as a set ofmodel answCIS.
Students and t.eachers who arc
not involved in the mamng process arc advised to interpiet the Marking Scheme with care. 4. D
I==� x 15 = � x 15 = 4.5A
M.C. Answers V, 200
I. B 11. D 21. A 31. A 41. A 51. D 61. A 71. D Value of fuse should be equal to or greater than]
2. C 12. A 22. D 32. D 42. B 52. D 62. B 72. B 5 A is the appropriate one
13. B 21. A
The longest pinX i s the Earth pin.
The switch should be connected in the livewire L so th at the iron can be cut off from high volt agewhen ti is off
Pin Yis the Live pin and pin Xis the Neutral pin.
T heearth wire E should be connected to the metal caseofthe iron.
14. D
2000 = 10 A > 5 A 22. D
(1) I= � = :. 5 A fuse should not beused, otherwise, it will beblown.
V, 200 lkWh = (l000W)x(60x60s) = 3,6x106 J
✓ (2) As thebrown wire is the live wire, the fuse should be placed on itto allowthe fuse cutting off the circuit
when the current is too large. 23. A
✓ (3) Yellow and green wire is the earth wire. P, Earthwire ⇒ Green/yellow ⇒ Z
26. C
18. C
2 kWh• kW•h • (PJ(� • Ene,gy
✓ (1) By R cc v; oc 2.. :. A: larger rated power P, ⇒ smallerresistanceR
P, P,
27. C
✓ (2) In series ⇒ same cunent pass ing through
✓ (1) Presence of Earth wire connected to metal case
(3) By P=l 2R, A; smaller�esistanceandsamecurrent ⇒ sma l ler power output ⇒ dimmer ⇒ provides a path for conduction of current. to the Earth
⇒ prevent electric shock
19. D ✓ (2) Current returns back to power supply v i a neutral wire instead.
Voltage : unit V (volt)
(3) Earth wire is not connected to znams socket, fi neutral wire is broken, no current flows.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/05 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/06
EM3 : Domestic Elec1ricity EM3 : Domestic Elec1ricity
28. A 34. C
1 Light bulbPis not un derrated con d ition, since P oc V2
I = ; ⇒ resistanceof ap plia nce = resistance of wire s = R
:. V➔½V ⇒P➔¼P :. actual powerofPis20W
:. equivalent resistanceof thee lectrical appliance and the con necting w ires = 2R
Light bulb Q is under rated condition, thus the actual power is 80 W
By V=IR Light bulb R is alsounder rated condition, thus thea ctual power is 40 W.
I f voltageofpower supply : V➔ 2V and no change to the resistance The brightestlight bulb isQ and the dimmest light b ulb i s P.
:. It gives a current of J••
35. B
29. i.. Pin Pis the earth pin which is connected to the metal case of ht e electric appliance.
✓ (1) Current flows to the ground clirectly ⇒ no cunent through the beating element Whe n the live wire accidentally touches the metal case, theearth wire p rovidesa low resistance path
⇒short circuit ⇒ current becomes very large ⇒ fuse blow s to conduct the c urrent totheearth, thus prevent theelectric shock ofhuman bodies.
(2) Current flows through the heating element beforereaching the metal case => no increase in J
36. B
(3) Heating element broke n ⇒ the circuit not completed ⇒ no cuuent flow s through the fuse
No. of wa shesperyear = 260 Av eragetime pe rwash = l.8hours
Total operating time = 260 x 1.8 = 468 h ours
30. D
By E = Pt
Both the switch and the fuseshoul d be con ne cted to the live wire
(250 kWh) = P (468 h)
32 D E = �kWx8h = 1.20kWh
1000
Resistanceoflamp = 6'/12 = 30
Since the cost is p roportional to the amount o felectrical energy used
Total resistance = 3 / 2 -+ 3 = 4.5 n
Cw:re n tflow:from the battery = 6 / 4S = 1.33 A
38. C
VoltageacrossL; = I.33x3 = 4V
Totalelectrical energyused = 1.2kWx250h + 0.25kWx80h + 0.1SkWx60h = 329kWh
Voltagea c rossL1andLi. = 6-4 = 2V A isnot correct.
CmrentthroughL 1 = 133/2 = 0.67 A B is not correct. Cost ofe lectricity = 329 x $ 0.86 = $ 282.94
Total power drawn from the battery = 6 x 1.33 = 8 W C is not correc t.
Total power dissipated in.Li andLz = 1.332x1.5 = 2.7 W 39. D
Power dissipated in.L3 = 1.332 x 3 = 5.3 W .·. Di s correct. A. The kettle will op erateno matter which fuse is installed .
B. The kettle will not be short-circuited unles s ht elive touche s the neutral.
33. D c. The kettle will still work properly with therated power of 900W.
Ifthelive and neutral wires are interchanged, then the switch woul d become connected on the neutral wire.
✓ D. Since the rated current = 900 / 220 = 4.09 A. The fuse value of 15 A istoohigh.
In this case, when the switch i s off, thekettlewill still stand at a high voltage. Ifthe current exceeds the 4.09 A b ut les s than 15 A,
However, the kettle would work properly when the switch is on. the fuse will not blow and the ket lt e may bedamaged.
DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EM3-MS/07 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/08
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
40. D 46.
(220/ = 1613 Q.
2
X (I) If the resistance is too large, the cmrent would be too small, and the fuse would not blow. Resistanceofeachb ulb = ...t...
v.
= --
P, (3 0)
✓ (2) Ifthe appliance is short-circuited, the current would become very large and the fuse willblow.
Total equivalent resistance for three bulbs in series = 1613 x 3 = 4840 n
✓ (3) If the rated value ofthefuseis too small, then the rated cmrentmay exceed the fuse value
V2 = <220f
and the fuse will blow. Totalpowerdissipated = = IO W
R (4840)
41. A
47. B
Resistance of the '220 V, 50 W' light bulb = (2 Z0)2 = 968 n Totalcur.rentgiven outbythe mainssupply = 0.4x2 = 0.8A
(50)
Total power given out by the mains supply: P = VI = (220 ) (0.8) = 176 W
Resistance of the '220 V, 100 W' light bulb = (2lo)2 = 484Q Totalenergyconsumed: E =Pt= (0.l76kW)x(5h) = 0.88kWh
QOO)
Totalequivalent resistance of the two light bulbs in series = 968 + 484 = 1452 n
48. B
Current drawn from the mains supply = 22 0 = 0.15 A 2
1452 By R= v,
P,
By (6)=� V. = 12V :. Ratedvoltageofthe6Olightbulbis l2V.
42. B
(24)
According to the label, 600 revolutions indicate an electrical energy of 1 kWh, i.e. 3600 000 J.
By (4) = V,.2 .. V. = 6 V :. Rated voltage of the 4 n lightbulb is 6 V.
For24revolutions, E = 24x� = 144000] (9)
600
As the two light bulbs are in parallel, theymust have the same applied voltage V.
Electric power: P = !. = l44000 = 1200W If the applied voltage is 12V, then the 4 n light bulb would be burnt, thus the applied voltage should only be 6 V.
t 2x60
Equivalent resistance ofthe circuit: R = � = 2.4 n
6+4
43. A
When Sis closed, the SR resistor isshorted. The equivalent resistance of the whole circuit is R. Current delivered from the power supply: I = KR = ..!.. = 2.5 A
2 .4
When S is open, the SR and R resistors are in series. The equivalent resistance ofthe whole circuit is 6R. OR
V' I
By P=-cc :. Power consumed in the mode ofkeepingwarm = 600 x .!:... = 100 W Current delivered from the power supply: I = � + � = 2.5 A
6 4
R R 6R
44. C 49.· D
Live wire : current drawn is 2A Yislive as switch and fuse are on the live wire.
voltage is at high voltage of220 V Xis neutral to complete the circuit
Neutral wire : current is equal to that of live wire, i.e. 2 A Zis the earth that is connected to the metal case of tho appliance.
voltage is at low voltage of0V
Ear th wire: no current through earth wire when operating, i.e. 0 A so. A
no voltage in the earth wire, i.e. 0V
When S1 and� are closed and 83 is open, the two resistors are in parallel, equivalent resistance is ½ R.
45. B When Si and 82 are. open and 83 is closed, the two resistors are in series, equivalent resistance is 2R.
The equivalent resistance is increased 4 times.
Maximum power given by the mains so·c1cet without triggering the circuit breaker = VI_ = 220 x 15 = 3300 W
Assume n light bulbs at most can be connected. :. 1100 + 550 + 100 n = 3300 :. n = 16.5 By P = v2 , as power is inversely proportional to tho resistance, the power should become .
R .
¼.
Thus, maximum number of lightb ulbs that can be connected = 16. Thus the power is 0..25 P.
DSE Physks - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/091 DSE Physks - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/10
EM3:DomesticElectricicy EM3: Domestic Electricicy
51. D 57. C
(1) ByP = VI .·. (1150) - (220) I :. 1=5.23A (1) As more lamp s are switched on in parallel, the equivalent resistance should decrease.
58. A
52. D
✓ (1) Fuse should be made of metal with low melting point
When S is closed, current would flow from live t o the metal case and then to earth as it is a shorted path,
so that it would be melted by the heating effect of the excess cµxrent
thus no current would flow through the heati ng element and the kettle will not operate.
✓ Copper has a high melting and cannot be melted easily,
B. As the cwrent would not flow through the heating element and the fuse, the fuse would not blow.
thus even the cmrent exceeds the rated current of the fuse, copper would not be melted and blown.
C. As there is no cmrent flowing through the heating elemen t, the heating element would not bum out
(3) Both the fuse and the copper wirehave negligr.ble resistance,
✓ D. When S is open. current can still flow through the live wire to the metal case, as they are connected in series to the appliance, they would not cause short circuit ofthe appliance.
and then to the earth wire to complete the circuit.
59. C
53. B
For the bulb being fully lit,
Rated current = !i.,_ = g
= 2A
(!) Number ofbulbs in each series path =
24
=2
V, 6
12
Voltage across the two resistors = 9 - 6 "" 3 V
(2) Current flowing through each parallel circuit= current flowing through eachbulb= � = £ = 0.5 A
V 12
Equivalent resistanceof the two resistors = !'.'.:. = ! = 1.5 n
I 2 Number of parallel circuit connected to power supply=..!_= 4
0.5
As the two resistors are in parallel: � = 1.5 :. R = 30
2 .-. Total numberof bulbs= 2 x 4 = 8
OR
54. A Power giveno� by the power supply = VI = (24) x (2) = 48 W
Electrical energy supplied to the light bulb = Pt = (2)(10 x 60 ) = 1200 J Number ofl ightbulbs = 48 = 8
Heat energy given out by the light bulb = m c !:i.T = (0.050) x (4200) x (4.5) "'.' 945 J
Lightenergygiven outbythe light bulb = 1200-945 = 255 J
60. A
✓ (!) When they work at their rated values, power given out by the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is l 00 W
55. D
which is greater than the 40 W given out by the '200 V, 40 W' light bulb.
Total power givenout by the battery = VI= (6) x (2) = 12 W
✓ (2) By P = V1, as the power given outby the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater,
For each li ght bulb to give normal brightn ess , the P?Wer given out by each lightbulb is 1.5 W.
the cmrent drawn is greater.
Total number oflight bulbs in the circuit = E..
1.5
= 8
(3) By R = )i'?J Pr , asthepowergivenoutby the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater,
its resistance is smaller.
56. B
61. A
(!) Voltage droppedbelow 200 V ⇒ all light bulbs would become dimmer
✓ (!) Fuse should be installed in the live wire,
(2) Smaller current ⇒ all ligh t bulbs become dimmer
so that the appliance is cut offfrom high voltage when the fuse is blown.
✓ As R =
V' , for same rated power 5 W but lower rated voltage, the new bulb has smaller resis tance
p
(3) (2) Switch should also be connected to the live wire,
so that the appliance is cut off from high voltage when the switch is off.
As P = 1 R for light bulbs in series, P«:R :. the new bulb has less power than theother bulbs
2
(3 ) Since household circuit is an a.c. circuit, Cl.llieDt flows from L toN and fromN to L alternately.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/11 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM3-MS/12
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
62. B 70. A
(1) By R = Vl I Pr, as the ratedpower P,ofthe '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is greater, E =Pt= (0.0015kW)X(l6bx30) = 0.72kWh
its resistance is smaller.
Carbon dioxide emission = 0,72 x 0.8 = 0.576kg
(2) When they are connected in series, the current flowing th rough each ofthem must be the same.
✓ (3) As the resistance of the '200 V, 100 W' light bulb is smaller, 71. D
by P = 12 R, same current I in series, thus, P cc R, therefore, the power d issipated i s small er.
A. Fuse should be installedin the live wire.
63. D B. The fuse is still required to limit the current to avoid overheating.
64. C 72. B
Total electrical energy used= 1.2 kW x 250 h + 0.25kW x 80h + 0.15 kWx60 h = 329 kWh Since the voltage ofR1 is equal to the sum of voltage ofRz and&,
(3) IfXand Z are short circuited, current must still flow through the resistor and wouldnot b e too large.
67. B
A microwave ovennor.mally has apower around 1000 W.
Other appliances : electric fan, fluorescentlamp and TV, have power much less th.an 1000 W.
68. C
Inparallel circuit, current supplied by the mains is the sum of current in each parallel path.
Current cannotbe reduced by usingparallel circuit
69. D
A. The :fre quency of the a.c. mains docs not affectthe working ofan electric iron.
B. As the appliedvoltage is smaller th.an that in HongKong, thus the power cannot be the same.
C. As the applied voltage is smaller than that in Hong Kong, thus the power cannot be hi ghe r.
✓ D. For th e s ame res istance of an appliance ; P = V2 IR :. p 0:: V2
Since the mains voltage of country Xis lower, thepower given out is smaller, thus the iron si colder.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/01 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/02
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
The following list of formulae may be found useful : 1. (b) (i) A 15 A fuse is connected to thesocket Which line : earth, neutral and live, should the fuse be placed? (1 mark)
Resistors in parallel 1 1 1
-=-+-
R R, R,
(c) (i) If the efficiencyofthekettleis 80%,howlongwillittaketo heat 1 kg ofwaterfrom20°C to 100°C? (4 marlcs)
Power ina circuit
-
1. <HKCE 1981 Paper I- 8>
c-----'
A household electric circuit consists of a heating unit ( 220 V, 1100 W) and a lighting unit ( 220 V, 220 W) connected in
A ___,,!,-. parallel to themains of220 Vas shown in the above :figure.
(a) Find the maximum cummt drawn from the mains. (2nra,ks)
Electric kettle
The above figure shows a220 V supply socket, a 3-pin pl ug, and an electric kettle with a rating: '220V 1.65 kW'. The kettle
has 3 wires A, B, C leading from it. Wire A is joined through a switch S to the heating element Hofthe kettle ; wtte B
completes the circuit of the kettle; wire C is joined to the metal case ofthe kettle.
(Given: Spel?ifiC heat capacity ofwater = 4200 Jkg-1 0C-1) (b) Is a 5 A fuse suitable for use in the fuse box? Explain briefly. (2 marks)
(a) (i) To which of the pinsX, Y, Z of the plug should each of the wires A, B, Cof the kettle be connected? (3 nra,ks)
(c) If ele ctrical energy costs $0.90 per kWh and the whole system is switched on for 150 hours, what will be the cost of the
electricity used? (2 marks)
(il") What is the fimction of the 'earth' tenninal in the socket? (1 mark)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/03 DSE Physics c Section D : Question . PD-EM3-Q/04
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
3. < HKCE 1986 Paper I- 7 > 4. < HKCE 1988 Paper I- 7 >
The figure shows a simplified system of a 220 V domestic circuit N and L denote the neutral and live wires respectively. Given socket A and socket B, an unqualified electrical technician wires the two sockets to the live L, the neutral N, the earth
B of the 220 V mains supply for a heater rated at "220 V, 1000 W" and a cooker rated at "220 V, 800 W'' as shown in the
:figure below. (The sockets are viewed from the front)
5A Fusebox
NeutralN LlveL
(a) (i) If either one of these appliances is plugged into one of the sockets, would there be any current drawn from the
mains with the switch ofthe appliance on? Explain briefly. (2marks)
(a) Give a reason why the lamps are all connected in parallel instead ofin series.
(b) The light bulbs of the circuit shown in the above :figure are all marked "60 W 220 V''. Suppose that all the light bulbs (ii) Ifboth appliances are plugged into the sockets, would the appliances work at'the rated power (1000 W and 800 W)
are switched on. (5 marks) with switches on? Explain briefly. (2 marks)
(i) What is the total resistance of the lighting circuit ?
(iliJ Draw a diagram to show how the two sockets should be connected to the live, the neutral and the earth of the mains
supply with a fuse placed at a proper position. (4 marks)
(ii) What is the total current drawn from the power supply'!
(c) (i) Explain the use of the fuse in the circuit. (2m,oo)
(ii') Give a reason why the switches should be connected to the live wireL instead ofto the neutral wireN. (2 marks)
(iii) What physical quantity does the meter measure ? (2 m,oo) (b) Suppose the heater and the cooker are switched on in the correct wiring circuit for 2hours, calculate
(i) the total current drawn from the mallls supply, and (3=ks)
(d) The household voltage supply in Hong Kong has changed from 200 V a.c. to 220 V a.c. in 1995. Give one reason for
the change. (2 marks) (ii) the total cost of electricity if one kilowatt-hour of electric energy costs $0.90. (2m,oo)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/05 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q /06
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
I
The above Figure shows a 3-pin plug and a kettle.
(a) To which ofthe pins A, Band C ofthe plug should each of the wires x; YandZ ofthe kettle be connected? (2 marks)
(a) On the above figure, use suitable circuit symbols to complete the circuit Indicate on your diagram the positive terminals
ofthe ammeter and voltmeter with''+'' signs. (5 marks) (b) (i) Explain why itis safer to have pin A ofthe plug longer than the other two pins.
(il) Explain why switch S ofthe kettle is connected in wire X instead of wire Y.
(c) The below figure shows the result obtained in the experiment.
,. 30
(c) The ratingofthe kettle is '220 V, 2000 W'.
(i) Ifthe kettle is switched on for halfan hour, calculate the cost of electricity.
(Given: One kilowatt-hour of electricity costs $0.9.) (2 marks)
(i) Whatis (1) the voltmeter reading, (2) the ammeter reading?
(n) Calculate the resistance of the light bulb. A housewife plugs the kettle and an oven of rating '220 V, 2500 W' into a 15 A socket as shown in the above
figure. Explain why this connection is dangerous. Show your calculations. (3 marks)
(ii) Explain why the resistance found in (d)(i) is much greater than that found in (c)(i:i). (2marks)
DSE Physics • Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/07 DSE Physics • Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/08
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
M
OiiilJ
=N OA 30A !SA
Figure z
Figure 1 shows the front viewofa socket and theearth (E), live (L) and neutral (N) wires of the 220 V mains supply.
\ To water
. heater=
(a) On F'igure 1, show how the socket is connected to the mains supply. (2 marks)
(b)
ModelNo. : CS301
Ring cifcui.t in
F>gw-,2 220V SOHz the kitchen
2500W
Figure 2 shows the label attached to an electrical appliance. If the appliance is switched on for 150 hours in a month,
calculate the cost of electricity. (Given: I kWh ofelectricity costs$ 0.87.) (2 marks) Figure 2 shows a household electrical wiring circuit The roams cable (containing live and neutral wires) is connected to
a consumer unit via a meter M At the consumer unit, the wires branch out into a number of parallel circuits. Figure 2
also shows the power circuit in the kitchen. It is in the fonn of a ring circuit with three sockets tapped off from the ring.
(i) Name the meter M What physical quantity does the meter record ? (2mm)
Appliances Rating
a refrigerator 220V, 600W
an electric kettle 220 V , 2000 W
Flg,rel
an oven 220V, 1500 W
If the appliances are all switched on, find the total current drawn :from. the mains supply. (3 marks)
Mazy wants to estimate the efficiency of an electric water heater in her kitchen. She uses a container to collect the water
and a thermometer to measure the temperature (see Figure 1). She finds that when the heater is switched on, 1.6 kg of
water at 23°C is heated to 67°C in one tninute. The rating value of the heater is '220 V, 6000 W' and the specific heat
capacity of water is 4200 Jkg- 1 •c-1 •
(iii) Explain why the water heater mentioned in part (a) is not connected to the sockets in the rings circuit but directly
(i) Fmd the energy absorbed b y the 1.6 kg ofwater in one minute. (2 marks) connected to the m.ains via a separate circuit (2 marks)
(Iii) State one reason to explain why the efficiency found in (ii) is less than 100%. (lmmk)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/09 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/10
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
•• <HKCE 2002 Paper I- 7 > 10. (b} Assume that 80% of the power ou1put ofthe ixonis used to generate steam. Estimate the maxml.um mass of steam that
can be generated by the iron in l s. (2 marks)
(c) The ixon is designed to operate at220 V or 110 Vwith the same poweroutputofll00 W.
�---i Heating coil and fan I----
(i) Ineach of the following cases, find the resistance ofthe heating element of the iron:
In a science project c ompetition, a student constructs a hand-dryer. He connects an electric fan of rating '20 W, 24 V' and (1) whenoperatingat220V,
a heating coil to a 24 V power supply as shown in the Figure l. When switch Sis c ol sed, the fan will operate at its rated
v,Jue. (2) when operating at 110 V. (3nwks)
(a) Are the fan and the heating coil connected in series orin parallel? Explain your answer.
(ii)
(u') the total cmrent drawn from the power supply when Sis closed. (4 marks)
Figure2
L (Live wire)
N (Neutral wire)
E (Earth wire)
The heating element of the ixon consistsof two identical resistance wires as shown inFigure 2.
(1) Draw two diagrams to show how the resistance wires are connected when the ixon is operating at220 V and
at 110 V respectively. (3 marks)
10. <HKCE2003Paperl-8>
water tank
Figure 1
(a) Calculate the energy requjrcd to vaporize 1 kg ofwater at 20°C into steam. (2mmsJ
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/11 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/12
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
11. < HKCE 2006 Paper 1- 6 > 12. < HKCE 2008 Paper I- 7 >
Figure 1 shows a ceiling lamp in Jack's home. The lamp has two filament light bulbs, each rated "220 V 40 W''. The lamp is
tumed on or off by a switch (see Figure 2) on the wall.
filament
light bulbs
Figure! Figure2
__
----�....., . ..
.,.....,.
__,wi...,,i,
,.,,
.....,,
Rated Capacity
Heating time
24.1 litres
(a) Give two advantages of connecting the two light bulbs to the 220 V mains supply in parallel. (2 marks)
(b) Explain why the switch should be connected to the live wire of the mains supply. (2m,m)
The above Figure shows the energy label ofa water heater from which some information is listed in the above Table.
Given: mass ofl litre of water "' 1 kg,
specific heat capacity of water = 4200 J k.g-1 0C-1
(a) The heating element ofa water heater is usually installed on the lower position ofthe water tank. Suggest one reason for
this design. (1 mark)
(c) Jack decides to replace each :filament light bulb Vii.th an energy saving bulb of the same brightness. The Table below
shows the details of the two kinds of bulbs. Considering the_ price of the bulbs and the electricity fee, find the total
money saved per energy saving bulb after operating for 4000 hours.
(b) Using the information in the above Table,
Price per bulb Powe, Electricity fee
(i) estimate the energy required to heat a full tank of water from 15°C to 65 °C, (2 marks)
:filament light bulb $5 40W
$0.95/kWh
JI
l
energy saving bulb $35 SW
(ll') hence estimate the current drawn by the water heater when it is operating at 220 V. (3m,m) (3 marks)
(c) Explam why thick wires are used to connect the water heater to the mains-supply. (2marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3-Q/13 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM3 -Q / 14
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
l
,----------------- ,-----------
' '
l
' ' I
□
12 V d.c. power supply
,,<r..;..---
circuitX to 220 Va.c.
--- mains supply
p-;-
' heatoc
' '
I ________________ : I•• •--••••• I
,-----------------''
:
'
A 12 V heater is operated Uildet a steady d.c. voltage of12 V. The energyconswned by the heater in 2 minutes is measnred
' by ajoulemeter as shown in the Figure. The initial and final readings of the joulemeter are 126 J and 2525 J respectively.
'
circuity ' to 220 V a.c.
' mains supply (a) Estimate the electrical power of the heater.
'
'
' '
' ' '
I-••••• •••••--•••: ! ••••-••••• I
l
,-----------------'
' '',-----------'
"o�--j
circuitZ to 220 V a.c.
- _.___ mains supply
-,,
: (b) Hence, find the current through the heater. (2 marks)
' ________________ : '
I•-----•••• I
'
(c) A 5 A fuse is installed in the power supply. Explain whether the fuse will blow if another identical heater is connected
in parallel with the original heater. (2 marlcs)
(b) Fill inX, Y and Zin the appropriate spaces in the below Table. (1 mmk)
(c) Explain why the hair dryer does not riced an earth wire. (1 mmk)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMJ-Q/15 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMJ-Q/16
EM3 : Domestic Electricity El'v.I3 : Domestic ffiectricity
15. < HKDSE2012 Paper IB - 8 > 16. (b) What is the total power dissipated when mode Xis _selected ? Assume that the resistance of each heating element
remains unchanged. (2 marks)
In the circuit shown in the Fi gure, resistors R1 and&. represent the heating elements in a heater using mains supply. Both
resistors arc immersed in water.
·----------,'
:
rs 'v 220Va.c. (c) Without the need of calculations, explain 'Which mode of operation has the largest total power dissipation. (2 """"')
(d) (i) Iffuses 3 A, 5 A and 13 A are available, determine which will be the most suitable to limit an excess etment. Show
yourwork. (3 marks)
The heater can be operated in two modes, namely, heating and keeping warm, and it is controlled by the switch S. The power
consumed by the heater in the heating mode is 550 W and in the mode of keeping warm is 88 W. The mains voltage
is 220 V a.c.
(a) In which mode is the heater operating when switch Sis open? (1 mrul<) (ii) A student claims that since a.c. is used for the heater, the switch S can be installed in either wire A or wire B.
Comment on this claim. (2 marks)
(iii) Ifa fault resulted in the live wire having contact with the metal case of the heater, which wire, A, B or C, could
prevent an electric shock of a person touched the case of the heater ? Explain. (2 marks)
(c) When switch Sis closed, calculate the ClllTent passing through resistor&. (3 marks)
The Figure shows the schematic diagram of an electric heater consisting of four identical heating elements, each having a (a) Figure 1 shows the schematic diagram of an eleetric heater which can operate in two modes, namely, 'heating' and
'keeping warm'. The heating elements of resistances 4R and R are connected to the mains supply via a 3-way switch
rated value of '500 W 220 V'. A user can use the rotaty switch to select one of the three modes of operationx; Y, Z. Wrres
with its two poles tied together. That is, both poles can be connected to one ofthe three pairs ofterminalsX, Yor Z.
A, B, Cfrom the heater are connected to the 220 V a.c. mains via a 3-pin plug.
'
3.way sw·tch
·- metal.case
4R
--;--
metal case
ofelectric
ofeleclri1/
heater
L
7• I' -
x\
�:L=-·�4s~��=r�oA Y,
z,
�-------------t------=B fuse
'-------------" -------c -
mains supply
(a) Find the resistance R ofa heating element. (1 mrul<) (i) To which pairs oftenninals, X, Y. or Z, should the switch connect to when the heater is in 'heating' mode ?
(1 mrul<)
I
17.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
(a) The power consumed by the heater in 'heating' mode is 800 W.
PD-EM3
-Q/
1 71 1
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution
EM3 : Domestic Electricity
BKEAA's Matkjng Scheme is prepared for the markers' reference. n
PD-EM3 - S I 01
Q
(ii) Calculate the current drawn from the 220 V roams supply when the heater is in 'heating' mode. (2 mark s)
Question Solution
I. (a) (i) A ------+ Y [l]
B----->Z [l]
(iil) Find the power consumed by the heater in the mode of 'keeping wann'. (3 """"J
c-----,x [l]
(ii) To prevent electric shock if there is any leakage ofele ctricity to the metal case. [l]
OR
To prevent electric shock by conducting the current to the Earth through the earth wire. [l]
=3--------
[l]
I::
V
fuse M switch
□
r=i = 1650 = ?.SA [!]
D
Figurel 220
:.....,.__.....:
+ Maximum number ofkettle 15
7.5
� 2 [l]
(i) What physical quantity does the meter Mrecord?
(c) (i) Actualpowergiventothewater = 1650x 80% = 1320W [l]
(ii) An RCCB is a kind of safety device that cuts off the supply automatically whenever there is a small difference Energyrequiredtoheatlk.gofwater = (l)x(4200)x(100-20) = 336 0001 [l]
between the currents in the live (L) and neutral (N) wires. State, in each of the following situations, which
device(s) will respond (i.e. the fuse blows and/or the RCCB cuts off the supply). Time taken = 336000 [l]
1320
(1) A short circuit occurs between points X and Y. (1 ""'1<)
= 255 s [l]
(2) A short circuit OCCUIS between point Y and the metal case of the appliance. (1 ""'1<) (h) E = 1.65kWx�h [l]
3600
""0.117kW h [l]
OR
E
= 336000 x 100
[l]
3600000 80
= 0.117kWh [ l]
Cost= 0.117x0.80
= $ 0.0936 < accept $ 0.0933 > [!]
There is question in next page
M fuseK
IIlilll
30A !SA
To2'.20V Earth
mains supply
X YZ ligb6"8 setL,,
(a) Indicate on F� 8.1 how tho mains sockat should l>e connoctod to wiresX, Y and Z. (l marl:)
(b) Liglmng sets L1 oad L2 of power ratings 300 W and 450 W respe<tively are oollI!eCtOd in parallel to the
braDch with fuse K.
(i) State one advantege of connecting L, and L, in parnJ]el instead of in series to the branch. (l mark)
(ii) Iffuses nmrked3 A, 5 A, 10 A and 13 A are available, which oueis themostsui:tablem befusoK?
Explain yom choioe. · (3 marks)
Bow much should be peid perdayt<> rua these appliances if I kWh ofe!eotrical eoergy cosu S0.9 ?
(3 mmts)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM3-QS/02 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM3-QS/03
EM3 : Domestic Electricity EM3 : Domestic Electricity
(iii) E nergy [2] (b) The variable resistor is used to vacy the current flowing through the bulb. [2]
(d) EitherONE ofthe followings: [2] (c) (i) (1) 0.84 V [!]
9. (a) The fan and the heating coil are connected in parallel [!]
7. (a) So that they can operate at their rated values. [!]
E L N <For earth wire>
--V'
[!]
<For neutral and live wire > [!] (b) (i) R [!]
= 24 = 2.88 n
1
[!]
200
(2) R - (110)' -ll<l [l] 12. (a) Both light bulbs can work underrated voltage. [l]
1100
When one light bulb burns out, the other light bulb can still work. [l]
Cu) (1) 220Vmode 110Vmode
(b) When the switch is o� the light bulb is cut off from high voltage. [I]
Thus no electric shock occurs when the light bulb is touched. [l]
{c) Total cost of filamentlight bulb "' 5 + 4000 x � x 0.95 = $ 157 [l]
1000
Total cost of energy saVlllgbulb "' 35 + 4000 x _S_ x 0.95 "' $ 65.4 [l]
1000
L (Live wire) L (Live wire) Total money saved = 157 - 65.4 = $ 91.6 [l]
.____.,.__ N (Neutral wire) '---...-- N (Neutral wire)
E (Earth wire) B (Earth wire)
< In 220 Vmode, the two resistors are in series> [l] 13. (a) Equivalent resistance: R = � "' 25 n [l]
50+50
<In 110 Vmode, the two resistors are in parallel> [!]
V'
< All the connections are correct> [!] p [l]
R
(2) Resistance of each wire = 22 n [l] = 2202 ""1936W <accept 1940W> [l]
25
(iii) The iron cannot function properly. [l]
When the iron is in 220 Vmode, its resistance is 44 n. (b) [l]
Power output settings Circuit
(110)' = 275 W
Thus the power output = -- Low z
[!]
44 Medium X
This power is much smaller than the rated value. [l] High y
[!J
t 2x60 since the equivalentresistance of mode Z is the smallest [!J
= 20W [!J
(d) (i) ModeZdrawsthelargestco.rrent [!J
(b) ByP= VJ
I= ZZO x2 = 4.SSA VJ
•·• (20) - ( 12) I [!J 96�
:. I= 1.67A [!J OR
I= SOO x2 = 4.55A [!J
{c) Totalcurrent = l.67x2 = 334A [!J 220
As the total current is less than 5 A, the fuse will not blow. [!J The 5 A fuse would be the most suitable one: VJ
(ll) The claim is not correct The switch mustbe installed in the wire A which is the live wire [!J
so that the heater is cut offfromhigh voltage when the switch is off. [!J
15. (a) keeping Wllim
(iil.) Wire C is the Earth wire that could prevent an electric shock [!]
z
(b) By p = v since current would be conducted from the case through this wireto the Eartll. [!J
R
2
:.(88)= (220) [!J
R, 17. (a) (i) To X [!J
Ri = sson [!J
(ii)P=VI ;. (800) - (220) I [!J
(c) Powergivenoutbytheresistor� = 550-88 = 462W . [!J :. I= 3.64A [!J
ByP=VI
i
(iii)ByP= r-2+ v = sv
2
�=-•-
fJ.J
The following list of formulae may be found useful :
JillQQS socket
Z(L}
IA Force onamoving � inan:egwtic.Eeld F ""BQvsinO
Two close, long, parallel, straight metal wires X and Yform part of the circuit shown above. Xand Y
A. attract each other. 8. <HKCE 1992 Paper II· 33 >
B. repel each other. A srnal.1 compass is placed near a long current carrying wire. In which of the folloWlllg diagrams is/are the compass needle
C. first repel and then attract each other. pointing in the correct: direction ?
--e-----
D. first attract and then repel each other. (I) Compass above the wire
The figure shows the path of an electron in a magnetic fieldPQRS. What should be the direction ofthe magnetic :field? A. (1) only
A. PQ B. (2) only
B. QR c. (1)&(3)only
C. into the paper D. (2) & (3) only
D. out ofthe paper
t--+-
(1) Anelectricbell
(2) A telephone receiver
0 0 ®
i
(3) A moving-coil loudspeaker Left +- rught
A. (3) o,Jy X y z
B. (!) & (2) o,ly DownWMds
c. (2) & (3) only
D. (!), (2) & (3)
The above diagram shows the cross-section of three parallel strai ght 'Wires x; Y and Z. X and Y car:ry currents flowing out of
the p aper and Z carries a current flowing into the paper. What is the <lirection of the resultant force acting on Y?
12. <HKCE1995Paperll-34> A. towards the left
B. towards the right
C. upwards
soft iron core
D. dovmwards
±
(1) increasing the number ohurns of the coil
13. < HKCE 1996 Paper II - 35 > (2) reducing the resistance of the variable resistord--l
(3) replacing the battery with a 12 V a.c. power supply
A. (1) only
B. (3) only
C. (1 ) & (2 ) only
D. (2) & (3) only
�
Two long insulated wires canying equal CUIIents are placed perpendicular to each other on a table as shown in the figure.
The points P, Q, R and S are all of equal distances from the wires. At which point(s) is the resulting magnetic field pointing 17. <HKCE2002Paperll-32>
out of the paper ?
A. Ponly
B. Qonly
C. Ronly
D. Sonly
14. <HKCE1998Paperll-31> P, Q and R are three parallel straight wires carrying equal cw:rents flowing out of the paper. R is equidistant from P and Q.
!OQ
What is the direction ofthe resultant force acting on R by P and Q ?
A.
12V M
.....
B
A motor is connected in series with a 10 n resistor and a 12 V power supply as shown. Jfthe current in the circuit is 0.5 A,
t
C.
find the power consumed by the motor.
A. 3.5W
B. SW
C: 6W D.
D. 7W
PD-EM4-M/06 PD-EM4-M/07
1
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
18. < HKCE 2003 Paper II- 37 > 21. < HKCE 2005 Paper Il- 22 >
Qg
Which of the following diagrams shows the magnetic field pattern formed around a flat circular current-canying coil, in the
planeas shown above ?
Two compasses P and Qare placed near thepoles of an electromagnet as shown above. In which of the following diagrams A. B.
are the northpoles of the compass needles pointing in the correct directions ?
p Q
A.
CD CD
B
.
CD CD C. D.
C.
CD CD
D.
CD CD
19. < HKCE 2004 Paper II- 30 > 22. < HKCE 2005 Paper Il- 23 >
David wants to design a battery-powered toy car. Which ofthe following circuits should he use? The figure shows a simple motor. Which of the
A. B. following cha nges can increase the turning effect of
the coil?
(I) usingastrongermagnet
(2) reducing the resistance oftbe rheostat
(3) using a coil with a smaller number oftums
C. D. A. (1) & (2) only
. (1) & (3) only
B
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (1), (2) & (3)
1
Two parallel wires carry equal currents flowing in the same direction. Which of the following statements are correct ? p
(2) Fis reversed if the current direction is reversed.
(1) The magnetic forces acting on the two wires form an action-reaction pair. (3) Fis larger if stronger bar magnets are used. y
(2) The two wires attract each other. A. (l} &(2) only
(3) If the directions of the current in the two wires are both reversed, the wires will repel each other. B. (1) & (3) only
A. (1) & (2) only C. (2} &(3) only F
B. (1) & (3) only D. (1), (2) & (3)
c. (2) & (3) oruy
D. (1),(2)&(3) 28. < HKCE 2009 Paper II- 21 >
The figure above shows two parallel straight wires carrying equal cunents. Which of the following diagrams correctly shows
--' --+➔- uniform magnetic field the resultant magnetic field lines?
-+ l---
A. B.
''
Q
� observer's eye
C. D.
The above figure shows a rectangular loop of wire carrying a steady current I. The rectangular loop can rotate freely about
PQ. Ifa uniform magnetic field to the right is applied, which of the following is correct?
Resultant magnetic force acting Rotation of the rectangular
on the rectangular loop loop about PQ
A. clockwise
B. anti-clockwise
C. clockwise 29. <HKCE2010Paperll-22>
D. anti-clockwise Q
--J
the direction in which the north pole of the compass needle points?
p
X �y
L
(The tip ofthe arrow represents the north pole of the compass needle.)
A ClllTCnt carrying wire Y is placed between two bar magnets as shown above. The wire experiences an upward force. Which
Polarity of P Compass of the following is/are the posSible combination(s) of the direction of the current in Y and the magnetic poles ofX and Z?
B. + e p Q (1)
(2)
N
S
fromPto Q
fromPto Q
S
N
e (3) N fromQtoP S
C. A (1) only
e
B. (2) only
D. C. (1) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) onl y
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/10 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/11
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
30. < HKCE 2011 Paper n - 21 > 33. < HKAL 1980 Paper I- 46 >
Rectangular coil PQRS is carrying a current flowing in clockwise direction. It is placed inside a uniform magnetic field Which of the following affects the magnetic field strength on the axis of a long solenoid?
pointing into the paper as shown in the figure below. (1) The diameter ofthe solenoid
x x x x x x (2) The number of turns per unit length of the solenoid
Q�--R (3) The current flowing through the solenoid
X X X X X X A. (!) only
X X B. (3) only
C. (!) &(2) only
X X X X
magnetic field direction of cUtrent
x x x x x x D. (2)&(3)only
X X X X X X
P�--�s 34. < HKAL 1981 Paper I - 44 >
X X X X X
A free electron travelling horizontally with speed v enters a uniform vertical magnetic field B. Which of the following
X
Which of the following statements are correct? statements is/are correct?
(1) A magnetic force pointing to the right acts on RS. (1) The path of the electron is circular on a vertical plane.
(2) No magnetic force acts on QR. (2) The speed oftbe electron remains constant.
(3) The resultant magnetic force acting on the coil is zero. (3) The radius ofcurvature ofthe path ofthe electron is inversely proportional to the magnetic field B.
A. (1) & (2) only A. (1)only
B. (!) & (3) only B. (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only C. (1) & (2)only
D. (1),(2)&(3) D. (2) & (3) only
31. < BKCE 2011 Paper n - 41 > 35. < HKAL 1981 Paper 1- 13 >
In the figure below, the arrow shows the direction of the magnetic field at Z due to a i:.mrrent--canying solenoid. A vertical wire of 0.4 m Jong carries a constant current of 5 A. It is placed in a magnetic field of strength I o-3 T, which dips
at an angle of30° to the horizontal. Detennine the magnetic force acting on the wire.
z---. A. 5.0 x 104 N
B. 8.7 x 104 N
C. I.5x10-3 N
D. I.7xl0-3 N
X
rrrrrrrTTl,�ftrronoo,o
36. < HKAL 1982 Paper I - 43 >
�
A solenoid with a solid core has a diameter d and n turns per length. It carries a current!. The magnetic :fieldB inside is
The direction of current through the solenoid and the magnetic north pole ofth.e solenoids are (1) independent ofd.
Direction of current Magnetic north pole (2) proportional to n.
(3) independent of the material ofthe core.
A. fromPto Q X A. (I) only
B. fromPtoQ y B. (3) only
C. fromQtoP X C. (1) & (2) only
D. fromQtoP y D. (2) & (3) only
n
by the mass, charge and initial speed of the particles. Which of the following quantities are also fixed. When a current 2 A is passed from R to P through X, and a current 1 A is passed from Q to S through Y,
alone could cause the observed difference in the paths ? which of the following diagrams best represents the shapes of the two wires?
(1) Xhas a smaller mass than Y. A. B. C.
1t
D.
(2) X1"'sa small"' ,iwg, than l'. �
Y X
(3) Xhas a greater speed than Y.
A. (!) only
B. (3) only
C. (!) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/ 12 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/13
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
.t=:::
43. <llKAL 1988 Paperl-37>
A particle ofmass m and charge q moves in a circular orbit inside a magnetic field B. The time taken for a single orbit is
I X I X A .!!.!L. B. 2•m
2sm Bq
J
C. D.
B 2mq Bm
.t�
c _ D.
2 •q
I X \ I X
44. < HKAL 1989 Paper I -32 >
p
.q
I
40. <BKAL 1985 Paper I- 27>
A small particle with mass 32 x 10-26 kg and charge -1.6 x 10-19 C
enters a unifunn magnetic field of flux density 0.08 Tat a speed of
10 5 m s· 1, as shown in the above figure. It will
-x
X X
X
X
X B into paper B
-0 6--
A pass undeviated through the magnetic field.
B. be deflected upward in a circular arc of radius 0.25 m. X X X
A square loop canying a current! is placed in a unifonn magnetic field B in the xy plane as shown in the figure. If the loop is
C. be deflected upward in a circular arc of.radius 0.50 m. free to rotate, the magnetic forces acting on the loop will cause it to
A. rotate about the y-axis as indicated byp.
D. be deflecteddownward in a circular arc of radius 0.25 m. B. rotate about the y-axis as indicated by q.
C. rotate about the x-axis as indicated by r.
D. rotate about the x-axis as indicated bys.
41. < IIKAL 1987 Paper I-34 >
c
As shown in the figure, Sis an a.c. supply of frequency 50 Hz connected to a resistor R via two long, parallel, straight metal A beam of parti les, of different masses, charges, polarities and speeds, travels long PQ and passes through a narrow slit S1.
wires X and Y. The magnetic forces acting onX and Y In the region between S1 and S1, an electric field E and a magnetic field B are directed perpendicularly to each other. The
A. are always equal to zero. E�eld acts vertically upward and theB-field acts out of the plane of the paper. The particles that are undeflected and emerge
from slit S2 must have the same
B. always attract A. polarity.
C. 'always repel. B. speed.
C. charge.
D. sometimes attract and sometimes repel; the frequency of variation is 50 Hz.
D. mass.
46.
DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EM4 : Magnetic Field
< BKAL 1992 Paper I - 36 >
PD-EM4-M/14
Two parallel straight wires separated by a distance r carry currents in the same direction. Which of the following statements
I
50. <BKAL1994PaperilA-32>
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM4 : Magnetic Field
PD-EM4-M/15
11
path of X X X X X
is/are correct ?
(1) The two wires attract each other, the electron
::(J:
(2) The force acting on each wire is inversely proportional to r 2• X
(3) The current in two wires produce a magnetic field with maximum flux density midway between them. uniform magnetic field
A. {I) only field
B. (3) only X
C. (I) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only X X X X X
An electron moves in a circular path of diameter 0.01 m in a plane with a uniform magnetic field of 0.02 T directed
47. < HKAL 1993 Paper I - 49> perpendicular into the plane as shown in the figure. Find the speed and the direction of circular motion of the electron.
X X X X
A. 1.76 x 107 m s-1 in anticlockwise direction
(J):Q
X X X X B. 1.76 x 107 m s·1 in clockwise direction
C. 3.52 x 10 7 m S-1 in anticlockwise direction
X [sX X X X
D. 3.52 x 107 m s· 1 in clockwise direction
X X X X X
Two particles P and Q of the saIIle charge and mass but moving vr.ith different speeds Vp and VQ respectively enter a region 51. <HKAL 1995Paper IlA- 34 >
of uniform. magnetic field B directed into the plane of the paper. The subsequent circular paths are as shown in the figure . B
'Which of the following sta±eoieu.ts is/are correct?
(1) Both particles P and Qare positively ch arged. y
(2) Speed ofparticleP is smaller than that of Q. ''
. .:
(3) The period of circular motion ofPis shorter than that of Q. '
A. (I) only
B. (3) only
C. (I) & (2) only
. ----------'
\ Uniform magnetic field
•T (outofpaper)
N s
Four parallel long straight wires carrying cummts of equal magnitude pass vertically through the four comers of a square
The above diagram shows a rectangular current--canying coil ABCD in a uniform magnetic field between two pole pieces. PQRS. In one wire, the current is directed into paper. In the other three wires, the currents are directed out of paper.
The magnetic field is perpendiculartci the plane of the coil. Which ofthe following statements is/are correct? Which of the following can produce a resultant magnetic field with the indicated direction at the centre O 1
(1) There is a magnetic force acting on the side BC of the coil. Current into paper Cw-rent out of paper
(2) The magnetic forces acting on the coil tend to reduce its area.
(3) There is a resultant force acting on the coil. A. p Q,R,S
B. Q P,R,S
A. (1) only C. R P,Q,S
B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only
D. s P,Q,R
D. (2) & (3) only
57. < HKAL 2000 Paper IlA - 27 >
54. < HKAL 1998 Paper IlA - 26 > A beam of charged particles passes through a region of crossed unifonn electric and magnetic fields without deflection.
X X X Which of the following quantities must be the same for the particles making up this beam ?
A. charge to mass ratio
B. velocity
C. mass
D. sign of charge
X X X X
The above figure shows a charged particle moving in a circular orbit with a constant speed v on a plane perpendicular to a 58. < BKAL 2002 Paper IIA- 29 >
unifom1 magnetic field directed into the paper. Which of the following graphs represents the relation between the time Tfor
the particle to complete a circle and its speed v ?
A. B. c. D.
T T T
,t=_,
o�,
Two long, straight parallel wires, each carrying a current I into paper, are
separated by a distance r as shown in the figure. What is the magnitude and
direction of the resultant magnetic field at the point P at the same distance r
from both wires ?
o�,
59.
A.
-
Three long straight parallel wires P, Q and R carrying currents of the same magnitude are situated at the vertices of an
equilateral triangle as shown. The currents in wires P and R are directed out of the paper. Which of the following indicates
the direction of the resultant magnetic force acting on the wire P 1
60. < HKAL 2003 Paper IlA- 30 > 63. <HKAL 2006PaperIIA-17 >
In a vacuum, an electron moves in a circle vvith speed v in a uniform magnetic field of flux density 1 mT. If an ct..y.micle
¼
with speed v is to follow the same path, what magnetic flux density in the opposite direction is required ?
(Given: mass ratio ofan C1'-particle to an electron is 7200 : 1; charge ratio ofan ct-particle to an electron is 2 : L)
20cm 10cm p A. 0.9T
B. I.ST
C. 3.6T
B! D! D. 7.2T
In the above figure, AB and CD are two parallel long wires with separation 20 cm carrying currents 11 and h respectively.
The resul:tantmagnetic field at the pointP 10 cm from wire CD is zero. Ifhis equal to 0.6 A, determine the magnitude and
direction of the current Ji in the wire AB. 64. < HKAL 2006 Paper IIA-18 >
A 0.2 A flows in the same direction as I,. A long straight wire carrying a Ctll'rent J is placed at a distance r from the point P.
Both the wire andpointP are in the plane of the paper. When the current I increases long str,ight-
B. 0.2 A flows in the opposite direction ash by 0.5 A, the magnetic flux density Bat pointP increases by 5.0 x I� T. Find r.
C. 1.8 A flows in the same direction as h I p
,_•
A !cm f
D. 1.8 A flows in the opposite direction ash B. 2cm
C. 4cm
D. 8cm
61. < BKAL 2004 Paper IlA - 29 >
65. < BKAL 2006 Paper IIA-16 >
f;
Three long, parallel, straight current-carrying wires P, Q and Rare placed in the same plane as shown in the figure.
IA
► p
::: Q
R
For two long, parallel, straight Wlles placed a distanced apart and each carrying a current of I A, the magnetic force per unit
Two long, parallel wires PQ and.RS are connected to a sinusoidal a.c. supply as shown in the figure. Which of the following
graph bestshows the time variation of the magnetic force Fbetween the two wires?
A
. F B. F
length is F. What is the resultant magnetic force per unit length acting on the wire R shown in the above figure ?
A. 0
B. F
C. 2F
D. 3F
.�------+ o '-------->
62. < BKAL 2005 Paper IIA -18 >
a-particle's path
c. F
D.
Magnetic field
out of paper
proton's path
A proton and an ex-particle move in a uniform magnetic field as shown in the above figure. The magnetic field is directed 66". <HKAL2007PaperIIA-20>
out of the plane of the paper. Within a square region WXl'Z, the proton takes time ti to complete a half circle fromXto Y A beam of charged particles passes through crossed uniform electric and magnetic fields vvithout deflection. If the electric
while the a-particle follows a quarter circle fromXto Zin time tz. What is the ratio t1 : t2 ? field is removed, the particles will splitup into several beams. This splitting may be due to the particles having different
(Given: mass ratio ofan o:-particle to a proton is 4: 1; charge ratio ofan ct-particle to a proton is 2 : L) (1) charges
(2) masses
A. 1 :2 (3) incident velocities
B. 1: 1 A. (1) only
B. (3) only
C. 2: I C. (1) & (2) only
D. It cannot be determined as the ratio ofthcir speeds is not given. D. (2) & (3) only
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/20 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/21
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
67. <HKAL 2007 Paper IIA- 18 >
Q <p----------� R 70. <HKAL 2009 Paper IlA- 30 >
'' ''
'' '''
''' ''
'' ''
P(;)-----------©s
Four long straight wires perpendicular to the plane ofthe paper are placed at the four comers of a square PQRS as shown in
the figure. Same current I flows in the wires at P, Q and S directed into the paper while the =ent fl.owing along the wire at
R is in the opposite direction. Ifthe wire atP experiences no net magnetic force, find the current flowing in the wire atR.
A. Il.fi
B. 1/2 A square coilPQRS, each side has a length of0.15 mis placed in a uniform magnetic :fieldof0.4 T as shown in the figure.
The number of turns in the coil is 20 and the current in the coil is 1.2 A. The magnetic field isparallel to the plane of the
C. .fiI coil. The side PQ makes an angle of 30 ° with the magnetic field. Find the magnetic force acting on the side PQ of the coil.
D. 2I A. 0.7Noutoftbepaper
B. 0.7Nintothepaper
68. <HKAL 2007 Paper IlA - 19 > C. 1.3Noutofthepaper
A segment of a vertical wire 0.50 m long carrying a current of 8.0 A is horizontal
D. 1.3 N into the paper
placed in the Earth's magnetic field. The direction of the field dips at an
angle of20 ° to the horizontal. If the magnetic force acting on the wire is �
7.5 x 10-5 N, find the magnitude ofthe Earth's magnetic field.
"""''·
71. < BKAL 2010 Paper IIA- 28 >
A. 6.4Xl0➔T � magnetic
� When moving charged particles enter a muform magnetic field at right angle, they are deflected. This deflection can be
B. 1.8 x 10-5 T
increased by
c. 2.0 x 10-sT ------._ field
D. 5.5 x 10-S T (1) increasing the mass m of the particles
.,.
(2) increasing the charge Q oftheparticles
<HKAL 2009 Paper IIA- 29 > (3) increasing the magnitude B of the magnetic field
solenoidX
jj
solenoidX solenoid Y
radius 5cm 3""
tum density 1200 m·l 240om·1
cnrrent LOA 0.S A
(cloclcwise as viewed fromE) (anticlockwise as viewed fromE)
Point P is on the common axis while point Q is 4 cm from the axis. Both P and Q are well inside the two solenoids.
Which of the following statements is/are correct? 'Iwo Jong straight parallel wires, X and Y, carry equal cun:ents in the same direction as shown in the figure:. W= X
(1) The resultant magnetic :field at P is zero. experiences a magnetic force of 0.1 N. Ji now a unifonn magnetic field pointing into the paper is applied to both wires
(NOT shown in figure), the resultant magnetic force acting on wire X becomes 0.5 N. Find the resultant magnetic force
(2) The magnetic field at Q is 1.5 mT. acting on the wire Y. (Neglect the Earth's magnetic field.)
(3) The magnetic field at Q points to the left. A. 0.3Nm-1 to the left
A. {1) only B. 0.3Nm-1totheright
B. (1) & (2) only C. 0.6 Nm-1 to the left
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (1), (2) & (3) D. 0.6Nm-1 to the right
PD-EM4-M/22 PD-EM4-M/23
1
DSE Physics - Section D : MC. DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
73. < HKAL 2011 Paper llA- 30>
• • • • • • • • • • Part C : HKDSE examination questions
-----�···✓-
• • .,x. • ;'!il... • • • '
'
0 ,
/' '
A positively charged particle enters a unifonn magnetic :field B with a speed v making an angle 0 (0 ° < 0 :,:; 9CP) with the
boundazy of the field. The magnetic field points out of the paper and the particle leaves the field at the same boundary as
shown. The time of transit for the particle inside the magnetic field is
0) proportional to the angle 0.
(2) depettdent on the speed v.
(3) inversely proportional to the field strength B. Which diagram shows the magnetic field pattern fonned around a flat circular clllTent--carrying coil, in the plane shown ?
A. (!) & (2) only A. R
B. (!) & (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (!), (2) & (3)
I,
Two long straight parallel wires carrying currents Ii andh (with h > Ii) is shown in the figure. The separation between the 77. <HKDSESamplePaperIA-28>
two wires is r. If now another wire canying a current I in the same direction is placed midway between the two wires, what
would be the magnetic force per unit length experienced by this wire, in both magnitude and direction?
A. µJ(l2-fi) totherigbt
X,
B. µJ(I2-fi) totheleft
X,
X,
--��=-----
each wire. Removing which wire would increase the magnetic field
SmTunifonn
► magnetic:field A. _,
strength at a ?
R VlireQ Q--�-
' ''
C. Vlll'eR '' '
R S
D. 'Wire S
The figure shows a current of 1.0 A flowing in a metal rod oflength 0.5 m. The rod is placed inside a region with a unifonn
magnetic field of strength 5 mT. What is the direction and the magnitude ofmagnetic force acting on the rod ? 82. < HKDSE 2013 Paper IA- 26 >
Direction Magnitude
A. into the paper 1.25x10- 3N
B. out of the paper 1.25 x 10- 3 N
C. into the paper 2.17x10-3N
D. out ofthe paper 2.17xlQ-3N
A straight wire carrying cuuent I pointing into the paper is placed in a magnetic :field between pole pieces X and Y. The
figure shows the resultant field line pattern.. What is the polarity of pole piece X and in what direction is the magnetic force
acting on the wire? Ignore the effect ofthe Earth's magnetic field.
In the above figure shown. X, Y and Z are three long straight parallel wires with Z placed midway between X and Y. X and polarity ofX direction of magnetic force
Z carry currents of 1 A in the same direction while Ycarries a CUtTent of3 A in the opposite direction. The magnetic force A. N to right
per l.lllit length experienced by wire X due to 'Wire Z is of magnitude F. The magnetic force per unit umgth acting on wire Z B. N to left
due to both X and r is C. s to right
A. 2F to the right. D. S to left
B. 2Fto the left.
C. 4Fto the right. 83. < HKDSE 2013Paper IA� 28 >
D. 4Ftothe left. magnetic
fiold
80. <HKDSE2012PaperIA-30>
An electron enters a region in which both a unifotm electric field E and a uniform magnetic field B exist The magnetic field
Bis pointing into the paper. In which direction should the electric field be applied so that the electron could beundeflected?
A. a
electric field electric field
e- �
elcctro11
�
X X X X
e-�
clectronxxxx
� A copper rod XY is placed on a pair of smooth inclined conducting rails which are located in a magnetic field applied
r·:-1}.r':·
X X X X
vertically downward. The rails make an angle 0 to the horizontal and a battery is connected to the rails as shown above.
:-
·�·��"r-
Which diagram shown below represents the magnetic force FB acting on the rod when viewed from end Y?
C. D.
:! ill:'1:'
el� xxxx
e
elc��xxxx
X X X X e:,
X X X X
X X X X X
X X X X
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/26 .DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM4-M/27
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
84. < HIIDSE 2014 Paper IA- 26 > 87, < lEDSE 2018 Paper IA - 27 >
A straight wire carrying a current J pointing out of the paper is
placed in a uniform magnetic field between two pole pieces as
shown. At which point, P, Q, R or S, can the resultant magnetic
field be zero ?
Neglect the effect of the Earth's magnetic field.
r;}
A, p
B. Q
C. R
D. 8
Four long straight parallel wires P, Q,R and S carrying currents of equal magnitude are situated at the vertices of a square as
shown. P, Q and R each carries a current directed into the paper while S canies a current directed out of the paper. The 88. < HKDSE 2018 Paper IA- 28 >
direction of the resultant magnetic field at the centre O of the square is along
A. OP. wufmm ""''""' fiold
B. OQ.
C. OR. . . poim:ing out ofthe paper
D. as.
charged
partiell:S p Q
85. < HIO)SE 2014 Paper IA- 28 > P and Q are two particles carrying the same amount of charge but of different masseS. They travel with the same speed and
The figure shows a closely packed long solenoid of cross-sectional area enter a unifonn magnetic field pointing out of the paper as shown. Semi-circular paths with. different radii are descnbed
A and length L having a total of N turns. If the solenoid carries a before they emerge from the field. Which descriptions below-are correct?
constant direct current throughout, which of the following changes can (1) Both P and Q are positively charged
increase the magnetic flux density Bat its central cross-section?
(2) P and Q emerge from the field with the same speed.
length cross-sectional area total number of turns (3) The mass ofQ is greater than that of P.
A
A. 2L 2A 2N A, (I) & (2) o,,Jy
B. L 2A N B. (I) & (3) only
C. 2L A N C. (2) & (3) only
D. L A 2N D. (!), (2) & (3)
1x x x x
negatively x x x x x
1/ uniform magnetic
field pointing
charged o---;-;--;tx--x-- into the paper
particle
A negatively charged partic1e goes undeflected through a region in whieh a uniform electric field and a
uniform magnetic field arc set up as shown. The electric field is set up by the potential difference
across the two parallel metal plates:. Which of the following changes may cause the charged particle to
deflea downward ? Neglect the effects of gravity.
(I) increasing the potential difference across the phnes
(2) increasinglhemagnitude of the charge on the particle
(;) increasing the particle", sp<e<i entering 1he n,gion
A, (!)only
B. (3)only
C. (1) and (2) only
D. (2) and (3) only
-----
What arc the clucdions ofthe following ?
ure 9.1
!
is set up between the plates and the rod is twisted by an angle of20 ° as shown in Figure 9.2.
'' ,,
Top view
ho�
::
+Q
sure 9.2 A B
-0
- ,' '
,,
,'
{a) On Figure 92, sketch the electric field lines due to the potential difference across the plates. (2 marks)
{b) The potential difference across A and Bis 5.0 kV and the separation between the metal plates is 10 cm.
The force due to the electric fieJd acting on each sphere is 2.0 x l 0-5 N, find
(i) the moment acting on the rod as shown in Figure9.2 due to the electric forces on the charged spheres.
(2 marks)
*(ii)the strength of the electric field E due to the potential difference across the metal plate,s.
1. C 11. B 21. A 31. A By use of Right hand grip rule, the direction of magnetic field is upwards.
41. C
Both the upper ends of the two iron rods are N•pole and lower ends are S•pole.
2.
'�
A 12. A 22. A 32. D 42. A
�'
Since like poles repel, they repel away from each other.
3. B 13. B 23. B 33. D 43. B Tl:m, A moves to the left and B moves to the right.
4. B 14. A 24. A 34. D 44. D
s. C IS. A 25. C 35. D 45. B 3, B
There exists repulsive magnetic force between two currents flowing in opposite directions.
6. C 16. C 26. C 36. C 46. A .-. Magnetic force on Q is to the right
7. B 17. D 27. D 37. A 47. C
8. B 18. D 28. D 38. D 48. D 4, B
For a d.c. source, there are 2 possiOle cases.
9. C 19. A 29. D 39. D 49. C Case I ; Cllil'ent from wire Xto wire Y
10. B 20. B 30. B 40. D 50. B Case II : Current from wire Yto wire X.
In both cases, directions of current in the 2 wires are opposite ⇒ repulsion
51. A 61. D 71. D 81. C 91. A
k
Direction of current: from B to D, F
(1)
60. D 70. A 80. C 90. D
(2) Direction of B-field: into paper.
By Left-band rule, an upward force acts on the copper rod
M.C. Solution :. tension in each thread decreases
1. C 7. B
Charged particles will be deflected by a magnetic field.
Wire AB : CUIIent flows from B to A
• (1) Electromagnetic waves : contain. no charged particles.
W'rre CD: current flows from CtoD
✓ (2) Beam of electrons : negatively charged particles
Since the two cum:nts flow in opposite directions, the forces between them are repulsive.
✓ (3) Beam of protons : positively charged particles Thus the force acting on CD is towards the right.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/03 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/04
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
8. B 15. A
Direction of needle gives the direction ofB-field, which canbe found by Right-hand screwmle, ConsiderXandY,samediTI:ctionofCUtteI1t ⇒attractio n⇒ Ytotheleft
X (1) the needle should point upward Consider Y and Z, opposite direction of current⇒ repulsion ⇒ Yto the left
✓ a downward B-field acting on the compass
(2) :. Combining the tvro results, Yexperiences a net force to the left.
X Q) the needle should point upward
16. C
9. C ✓ (!) Increase the number of turns ⇒ strength of magnetic field is increased
10. B 17. D
For Z andX, current in opposite direction ⇒ repulsion ⇒ %experiences a force to the right Currents in wires .flowing in the same direc tion will attract each other
For Y and.X, current in same direction ⇒ attraction ⇒ X experiences a downward force The force acting on R by P will act towards P
.-. Resultant force acting o n Xis the vector sum of the aboveforces, i.e. Q. The force acting on R byQ will act towards Q
The resultant force acting on R by P and Q is downwacl.
11. B
✓ (1) An electricbell contains a soft iron core. 18. D
'When current flows through the coil, the soft ironbecomes an electrmnagnet. ByRight hand screw rule,
✓ (2) A telephone receiver makeuse of theelectromagnet the magnetic pole at P is North, as the compass needle points a"Way from North, it points upwards ;
to give varying magnetic force to make the iro n diaphragm. vibrate. the magnetic pole at Q is South, as the compass needle points towards South, it points downwards.
X
(3) Moving-coil loudspeaker is an application of magnetic force acting on current inside a magnetic field.
19. A
12. A Since the toy car is battery operated, option B and D are not crurect as the supply is a.c.
✓ (1) R J, ⇒ rt⇒ strength of magnetic field is increased The switch should be connected in series as sh.own in A
X (2) Steel : difficult to magnetize and dimiagnetize⇒ strength ofB-field is decreased. Option C is not correct as thebattery is shorted when theswitch is closed.
X
(3) a.c. source gives the same strength of B-fi.eld but the direction of the magnetic field would vaxy
20. B
13. B
Consider the vertical wire : For a downmrd current, P and S : B-:field into paper ; Q and R : B-fieid out ofpaper
Consider the horizontal wire : For a current to the right, R and S : B-field into paper ; P and Q : B-field out of paper
For the resulting field out of paper, B-field from both wires should be out of paper, i.e., the case for Q.
The resultant magnetic field due to Bp and.BQ is the vector sum of them and points towards the right
Thus thecompass needle would point along the B-:field direction towards the right
14. A
24. A 30. B
✓ (1) These two magnetic forces are equal and opposite and act on each other. ✓ (1) By Left hand rule, the magnetic force acting onRS is towards the right
✓ (2) Two cunents flowing in the same direction attract each other. • (2) By Left hand rule, the magnetic force acting on QR is pointing upwards, not zero.
• (3) Hthe directions of the two cutrents are both reversed, they are still in the same direction and attract ✓ (3) The four magnetic forces acting on the four wires balance each other, thus there is no resultant force.
25. C 31. A
p
By Lefthand rule, the magnetic force acting on the right wire
is into the paper and that on the left wire is out ofpaper.
X y
Since these two forces arc oquaJ in magnitude ' ' 11F
and opposite in direction, their resultant force is zero. I ' ✓ uniform magnetic field
' '
p
However, these two forces give a clockwise turning effect
�
F
The magnetic field line is completed as shown in the figure.
on the coil to make it rotate.
End Xis the North pole as magnetic field lines come out here.
By Right hand screw rule, the cunent is from P to Q through the solenoid.
� observer's eye
32. D
26. C
From the diagram, the circular path ofXhas a greater radius, i.e. rx > ry
Since the left hand side ofthe solenoid is N-pole, compass
2 m,' mv mv
,=-oc-
by Right hand screw rule, current in solenoid is as sho\Vll. ByF=BQvand F = mv BQv=-
' BQ Q
Since the current flows frm:n (+) tennina1 to (-) tenninal of a N�S • (1) 11lx < my ⇒ rx <ry
L0
d.c. supply, Qis (+) and Pis(-). ✓ (2) Qx < Qy ⇒ rx > ry
Direction of magnetic field lines inside the solenoid is ✓ (3) Vx > Vy ⇒ rx > ry
towards the left, thus the compass needle is towards the left.
p Q
33. D
27. D
Fora long solenoid, B = µonl
✓ (1) By using Left hand rule, thumb representing magnetic furce F points downwards, • (1) Bis independent ofthe diameter ofthe solenoid
the middle finger representing current J points into the paper,
✓ (2) B is proportional to the number of turns per unit length n
thus the .finger representing magnetic fieldB should point to the right
Therefore, Xis North pole and Y is South pole, to give magnetic :field pointing to the right.
✓ (3) B is proportional to the current I
✓ (2) Ifthe cUtteirt direction is pointing out of paper, the tnagnetic force points upwards, thus reversed.
34. D
✓ (3) The magnetic force depends on the strength of the magnetic field, • (1) By Left..hand rule, the magnetic force actihg on the el�n horizontal.
thus stronger magnets can increase the furce F.
:. The path of the electron should be circular on a horizontal plane.
✓ (2) Since magnetic force is always perpendicular to the direction ofmotion
28. D :. no work done on the electron by the magnetic force :::,. constant speed of electron
Current out of paper should give magnetic field in anticlockwise direction.
✓ mv'
By BQv = - m, 1
r=-<X:-
Both currents give anticlockwise magnetic field, and give the resultant pattern as shown in option D. (3) -
, BQ B
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/07 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/08
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
35. D 42. A
The horizontal component of the magnetic :fie!dBcos 8 is perpend icular to the vertical current
F =
B cos 8 xJL = (10- 3 cos30°) x (5) x (0.4) =
1.7 x J0--3 N
k_h
ByRigbt-,hand screw rule, B-:fieldproduced by current in wire PQ at position RS is Bi into the paper.
36. C
By Left-hand rule, the magnetic force acting on the wire RS is in +y direction.
For a long solenoid, B = µ, n I
✓ (1) Bis independent of the diameter d ofthe solenoid B
43.
✓ (2) Bis proportional to the number oftums per unit length n By BQv =mrw'- and v = r@
x (3) Bdepends on the material of the core, µ, represents the permittivity of air BQ=mai=m 21t
37. A T= 2nm
BQ
Two cmrents in opposite directions have repulsive forces between them.
These two forc es are action and reaction that have th e same magnitude, 44. D
thus two wires have the same change ofshape. By Left hand rule, magnetic force acting on the upper wire is out ofpaper and that on the lower wire is into the paper.
Thus the loop would rotate in anticlookwise direction when v ei wing from right handside indicated bys.
38. D
F = µofilz L ex; l1·l2 45. B
2Nr r
Electric force = qE
F' = (2)(2) -F =2F Magnetic force = Bq v
(2)
Forundeflect edmotionofachargedparticle: qE = B q v v= -
39. D
:. Only those particles that have the same speed v equal to BIB can hav e no deflection in the cross-field region.
Since the nragneti.c field inside the solenoid is unifonn, Bis constant and thus be a horizontal l in e.
Near the end of the solenoid, the :field then decreases gradually to zero outside the solenoid. 46. A
✓ (1) Two currents in the same direction ⇒ attraction between the two wires
40. D
F = µ. 1 � oc _!_
x I l L
By Left-hand rule, direction of magnetic force on the particle is downwatd. (2)
21tr r
m,'
BQv=-
• (3) There should be a neutral po ni t in midway between them where the magnetic fieldis zero.
-26
3 )(lO�)
(0.08)(l.6xl0-1g) - ( . 2xl0 r = 0.25m
C
r 47.
✓ (1) From the diagram, the magnetic force is upwards.
41. C By Left handrule, the current is in the same direction as the motion.
:. Both P and Q are positively charged.
When the upper part is at a higher potential,
current flows from left to right alongX and flows :from right to left along Y ✓ (2) By F"" BQv andF=-
=' BQv= m,; . mv
·· r=-ocv
r r BQ
:::::,. current flows in opposite direction along the 2 w i res ⇒ repulsion
<l) When the lower part is at a higher potential, • (3) ByF=BQvandF=mrw'- mr@w = BQv 2
m•v- n: =BQv
T
cun:ent flows from right to left alongX and flows from left to right along Y
⇒ current flows in opposite direction along the 2 wires ::::;. repulsion
T = 2 nm which is independent ofthe speed of the particle
BQ
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/09 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS /10
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
48. D 53- C
ByRight-hand screwrule: ✓ (1) BC is perpendicular to the magnetic field, thus a magnetic force acts on it.
At.,\", the B-tield by the upper wire is into paper and that by the lower wire is also into paper. ✓ (2) By Left-band rule, magnetic force acting on AB is downwards and that on CD is upwards,
: . The resultant B-field is into paper. magnetic force on BC is out of paper and that on AD is into paper.
:. The magnetic forces on the four wire s tend to reduce the area of the coil.
2 X (4nxl0-7)·{1) =4xlo-6T
2,(0.l) (3) As the magnetic forces actillg on AB and CD balance each other,
and that on BC and.AD balance, there is no resultant force acting on the coil..
49. C
54. B
For two long, straight parallel conducting wires: F = µ. 11 12 L = µ I2 L /2 L
21tr oc ByF=BQv andF=mr(J) 2
21tr 21tr
✓ The force is inversely proportional to the distance between the wires r.
mra>OJ = BQv
(I)
2
✓ (2) The force is proportional to the length of that section of the wires /1,. m•v• 1t = BQv
(3) The directions of current flow only affect the direction of the force but not the magnitude. 21tm
T ""
BQ
50. B Tis independent of the speed v and is a constant, thus the graph is a horizontal line.
BQv = mv'
55 D
· v BQr 0.02xl.6x10·19 xQ.005
.. = = - l.?6xl01ms•l B,
m 9.lxl0-31
l>- B
' 'i'
For the direction, consider the point at the rightmost position
r ,' '
By Left hand rule, since current is upwards, velocity of electron is downwards B
' \
:. the electron moves in clockwise direction w
11 --------@h
- '-->I
51. A
By Right-hand screw rule, the B-field by each wire is given as shown.
2
By F = B Qv and F = mv
' Current11 produces the magnetic fieldB1 perpendicular to P 11.
Currcntlz produces the magnetic fieldBz perpendicular to PI,,.
mv' k=.fL,..2.... .!.
BQv=- o: The resultant magnetic fieldB is the sum of the two horizontal components ofB1 and }h.
m Br r
B = B1 cos 30 ° + B2 cos 30 °
k' = .:!,_,k = !:_
'• 2 µ I ✓3 ✓3 I
==2B1 cos30 ., =2• � · µ
= 1t; (totbenght)
2 r z Z
➔
52. A
56. D
In order to have a B-field along the diagonal RP,
(1) B-field byP andR should be eliminated one another (as B-fi.eld produced by P andR at Ois along QS),
(2) B-field byQ and S should be from Oto P (as B-:field produced byQ and Sat O is along PR).
By filght-band screw rule, the B-field by each wire is given as shown.
Same current carried bythe 4 wires ⇒ same magnitude ofB-field To satisfy (1), current of P and R should be in the same direction (either into or out of paper).
:. The resultantB-field is given byI. To satisfy (2), by Right-hand screw rule, current ofS: into paper; CUITent ofQ : out of paper.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/11 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/12
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
57. B 62. B
Electric force "" Q E Magnetic force = B Q v In a magnetic field, charged particle performs circular motion with period T.
21t =
Crossed£.. andB- fields ⇒ both forces in opposite directions ⇒ no deflection if the 2 forces equal By BQv = mr(})2 .·. B Q=m(})=m (asv r(}))
T
... E
v= - 2 1t·m
:. T =
B·Q
:. With same E-field and B-field, the ions should have the same velocity.
For the proton iP , it performs halfofa cycle 11 =.!.r=.!.x �=�
2 2 B-Q B·Q
58. A
59. B 63.
mv'
Inside the magnetic field, the magnetic force provides the ceniripetal force By BQv=-- ( ris the same)
.
· · BQv
='
=-- :. r=!!!!..
BQ
B . = m. � xQ,
x
B0 m0 V 0 Q0
(!) IfthefiUK density B has decreased gradually, the radius r should be gradually increased.
(2) Ifthe charged particle has lost its charge q gradually, the radius r should be gradually increased.
✓ (3) When the charged particle has lost its kinetic energy gradually, its speed vis gradually decreased,
thus the radius r would also gradually decrease. 64. B
µ,, ·I
By B•-
60. D 21t·r
•M
b.13 µo
=
Bp = µJ1 - µ� (0.6) = 0 2x·r
2•(30) 2•00)
{41txl0-1)·(0.5)
(S.0xl0-.,1) =
Ii is in the opposite direction so that the direction of the magnetic field produced is opposite to that by h 21t·r
r = 0.02m= 2cm
6l. D
IA 65. C
p
d Since the current through PQ and the current through RS must be always in opposite direction,
p "-
2A
force between the two wires must always be repulsive. I
2A µJ1I2 L
R F= cx::I'-
. V
2,., O ,_____,,___ I\
F,
The shape of the graphFshould be same as the graJXl fl • t
ForceactingonRbyP: R = µ.· (lH,"2) = p (upward s) Ifthe charged particles passes crossed field without deflection, then Q E =BQ v :. V = !
I 21t•(2d) B
The beam of charged particles must have the same velocityv.
ForceactingonRbyQ: p2 = µ.•(2H2) = 4 F (downwards) ' = �
21t•(d) If only the D1agDetic :field is present, B Q v = � :. r
BQ
Netforce onR = 4F-F = 3F
Different masses m or different charges Q can give different radius of curvature r, and thus they split up.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/13 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C, Solution PD-EM4-MS /14
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
67. D 71. D
Ifthe wirePhas no net force, then the resultant magnetic field due to Q, R, S must be zero atP. mv'
By BQv=-
The magnetic field due to the three wires is shown in the figure. '
Letthe separation between QR be r, then the separation between PR is ✓2 r. mv
.. r=-
BQ
BQ=Bs = B
TheresultantofBQandBsis .fi.B. For greater deflection, radius r of the circular path should be decreased.
B,
B, • .fiB • (!) By increasing the mass m, radius r increases, thus deflection decreases.
µ,I' ✓2 .&!_ ✓ (2) By increasing the charge Q, radius r decreases, thus deflection increases.
✓2
X
2,( ,) 2n,
✓ (3) By increasing the flux density B, radius r decreases, thus deflection increases.
:.1'=21
OR 72. B
Let the distance of each side ofthe square be r. The magnetic furces betweenX and Y are attractive.
Q (v----------{8) R Magnetic force on Xby Y is 0.1 N rightwards and magnetic force on Yby Xis 0.1N leftwards.
Magnetic forces between any two currents are given by !.... = µ. 11 Ii ,\
:1
r--,
L 21tr When the magnetic field into the paper is applied. by use of the Left hand rule, X y
F\ :
� �
For two currents flowing in the same directl.on, attractive forces exist. I the magnetic force is in rightward direction.
For two currents flowing in the 0PPos1te direction, repulsive forces exist. l \ Since the resultant magnetic force onXis 0.5N,
F- -- - --@ S
r-7
Consider • the te$Ultant of attractive forces by Q and by S balances the repulsive force by R. p • the magnetic force due to the applied magnetic field is 0.4N rightwards.
p
�
-.fix µ0 I
= µ0 ·I' l
The same magnetic force of 0.4 N in rightward direction also acts on Y.
2'1tr 21tx✓Zr F,
The resultant magnetic force on Y = 0.4- 0.l = 0.3Nrightwltrds
:.1'=21
73. B
68. C
Consider the horizontal component of 1he Earth's magnetic field that is perpendicular to the current.
Horizontal component of the magnetic field is B cos 0. 0
ByF=Bcos0·I-L
(J.5 x 10--s) = (B cos 20°) (8.0) (0.5)
B = 2.0x 10- 5T
69. D
✓ (!) B = !,.lo 11xlx - µ,, n.,, ly = µ.,(1200xl - 2400x0.S) = 0
✓ (2) The magnetic field at Q is due to solenoidX only, as no magnetic field outside a solenoid. Let r be the radius ands be the arc length oftransit
74. A 79. D
Magnetic force per unit length between two parallel currents : !... "° µ,, l; 12 Magnetic force per unit length between two parallel currents : F = A 1112
L 21tr 2s,
Magnetic forces between 2 parallel currents : Moreover, magnetic forces between 2 parallel currents in the same direction are attractive,
same direction are attractive ; opposite direction are repulsive. and magnetic forces bet\Veen 2 parallel cnrrents in the opposite direction are repulsive.
Magnetic forceper length on the middle wire b y ]z = µ,, 12 1 = &.!J!.. ( to the right)
2,r(r/2) 1tr
.,
R.ewltant magnetic force per length on the middle wire = µ,, I2 I Al; I µJ(Ia-I1) (totheright)
1tY 1tT
By Newton's third law, the magnetic force per unit length on Zby Xis also F .
75. A
Magnetic force per unit length on Zby X - A (1) (l) ... F ( to the left)
✓ (!) Bis proportional to I 21t(r)
✓ (2) B is proportional to n, the :number of turns per unit length
Magnetic force per unit length onZby Y = Po (l)( 3) = 3 F (to the left)
(3) B is independent of the area A for a long solenoid 21t(r)
Resultantforceperunitlength onZbyXand Y = F+3 F = 4F (to the left)
76. A
By using Right hand screw rule, 80.
:j:;:j:
the magnetic field line at the centre of the loop points into the loop
as indicated in A
77. A X X Fa X X
✓ �) Using stronger magnet can increase the strength of the magnetic field, thus increasing the turning effect. When the electron moves towards the right, it represents a murent to the left
✓ (2) Reducing the resistance of the rheostat can increase the current, thus increasing the turning effect Since the magnetic field ispointing into the paper,
by Left hand rule, the magnetic force Fa is downwards.
(3) Using a coil with smaller number of turns would decrease the turning effect
To make the electron be undeflected, the electric force FP. must be upwards.
As the electron canies negative charge, the electric field should be downw.trds
78. A
so that the electric force is upwards.
C
� By the use of Right hand screw rule to find the direction ofB-field due to a straight wire current:
Bsin30�
Direction ofB-field at point O due to P: out of paper
Direction ofB-field at point O due to Q : out of paper
Consider the component of the magnetic field peipendicular to the current, th at is, B sin 30".
Direction ofB-field at point O due to R : into paper
The direction ofmagnetic force is into the paper by use of the Left hand rule.
Direction ofB-field at point O due to S: out ofpaper
F = Bsin30° xJxL
TheB-field given by R is in opposite direction to that of the other wires.
= (5 x 10-3}sin30 ° x (LO) x (0.5) = I.25 x 10-3N Thus, removing wire R can increase the resultant magnetic field at 0.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS/17 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM4-MS /18
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
82. C 86. A
✓ A. When the coil is vertical, the magnetic forces on the founvires are either directed away from the centre
or towards the centre. Thus, the magnetic forces do not have moment to give turning effect
B. The magnitude of magnetic force acting on BC is constant at any position of the coil
=
since F BI l, magnetic field B, current!, and length l are all constant.
D. The direction of cunent in the coil reversed ever:ybalf cycle due to the commutator.
From th e pattem. of catapult field, the magnetic force is towards the right
87. C
From the figure shown, the direction of current is into the paper. The magnetic field produced by cun-ent I is anticlockwise around I. At point R, the B is towards the right.
By using the Left band ra1c, the direction of magnetic field is upwards.
The magnetic field produced by the poles of magnet is towards the left (from North to South).
As direction of magnetic field is from N-pole to S-pole, the magnetic pole at Xis South.
Thus, at R, the resultant magnetic field can be zero.
8 3. C
88. D
Direction of current :fl.owing through the rod is from Y to X,
✓ (1) Consider the charged particles entering the magnetic field.
into the paper as seen by the eye.
The magnetic field B is out of paper, magnetic force Fis towards the right,
Direction ofmagnetic field is downwards. by using Leftband rule, the current is upwards.
By using Left hand rule, the magnetic force is towards the left. As current is the flow ofpositive charge, the charged particles must be positive.
✓ (2) Since magnetic force is always perpendicular to the motion, no work is done,
84. A thus the kinetic energy and speed must remain unchanged after emerging from the magnetic field.
By using Right band grip rule, ✓ m vi asB, q, v are the same, mass mis proportional to the radius r.
(3) By B q v "" ,
B-field due to Pis along OS at O.
AI; the radius of Q is greater, the mass of Q must b e greater than that of P.
B-field due to Q is alollg OP at O.
B-:field due to R is along OQ at O.
B-field due to Sis along OP at O.
The B-fields due to P and R are in opposite direction
and they balance each other.
The resultant ina.gnetic :field due to Q andS are in the same direction and thus theirresultant magnetic field is along OP.
85. D
(tl) -----------------------------
Magnetic field inside a long solenoid
(b) 'Wbatis the direction of rotation ofthe coilPQRS
(ml _____________________________
Part A : HK.CE examination questions (c) What would happen to the rotation of the coil PQRS if the input voltage supply reversed at a high frequency
(e.g.50Hz)? (2�)
1. < BKCE 1984 Paper IM 8 >
(d) Suppose that instead of being connected to the battezy V, the tenninal of the solenoid at A is cmtnected to F and the
tenninal of the solenoids atD is connected to G. F and G remain connected to the external voltage supply as :indicated
in the above voltage-time graph.
(!)
�observer
(2) --------------------------
The figun: above shows a simple experimental set-up to smdy the motion of a motor. AB and CD are solenoids connected to (3)
a battery V. F and Gare connected to an external voltage supply. Its variation with time is shown in the following figure.
(Positive voltage Vindicates the current flows from F to G via the coil.) (ii) What would happen to the rotation of the coilPQRS if the input voltage :reversed at high frequency (e.g. 50 Hz) ?
(2 marl<,)
V
--
(e) State 3 me1hods to increase the turning speed of this motor. (3 marl<,)
time/minute
1 2 3
-
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/03 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD - EM4 - Q / 04
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
2. < HKCE 1993 Paper I- S > 3. < HK.CE 1993 Paper I- 5 >
A student designs a simple door bell as shown in the below figure. When switch S is pressed and then released, two notes The figure below shows a solenoid passing through a piece of horizontal cardboard. A Wl'llct current passes through the
"ding-ding'' are heard. solenoid from A to B to produce a magnetic field.
/t'. A.LJF:.X1:
-Iron spring
- Ip
;r'! ,(1 I Q
/ I
r-- (a) DescnOe a method to find the magnetic field pattern on the cardboard using iron filings.
SofUron corJ
�
Metal plate__J Metal plate
(•) State the polarities at the two ends of the soft-iron coreP and Q. (2marks)
(b) Draw a diagram to show the pattern and direction of the magnetic field on the cardboard. (2mm)
(o) Explain why soft iron is used as the core in the above design. (2 marks)
(d) Suggest one way to modify the bell so that two notes of different frequencies "ding-dong'' are produced. (2 marks)
A rectangular coil can rotate in a magnetic field as shown in the above figure. Initially the coil lies horizontally. The switch
is now closed.
(o) Comment on the follo'Wing two statements :
Statement 1 : The bell does not work Uthe spring is made of copper. (a) State the initial direction of rotation ofthe coil as seen by the observer.
Statement 2 : The bell does not work if the polarities of the battery are reversed. (4mm)
(b) The coil turns, oscillates a few times about the vertical position and then comes to a rest Explain the motion of the coil.
(4nwk,)
PD-EM4-Q/05 PD-EM4-Q/06
1
DSE Physics - Section D : Question DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
.. ,
moostat
main switch p Q
to22ovJ R
m,in,
Figure 1 Figure2
Figure I shows a simple hmdryer designed by Joseph. He makes use ofa motor-driven fan and a heating element to generate
warm air. Figure 2 shows the circuit diagram of the dryer. The motor and the heating element are connected to the 220 V
chain of iron clips
mains. The switch S can be connected to either contact P or Q.
In a physics lesson, you are asked by the teacher to investigate the relationship between the strength of an electromagnet and
(a) Carmen uses the dryer to dry her wet hair. Explain, in terms of molecular motion, how the dryer can speed up the rate of the number of turns of its coil by using the apparatus shown in the above Figure. Describe the procedure for the experiment
evaporation of water from wet hair. (2 marks) you should conduct State clearly how you can measure the strength of the electromagnet. (5 marks)
(b) Switch Sis connected to contactP and the following data are given:
spring balance
--_
insulating thread
(c) If switch S is connected to contact Q instead, explain whether the temperature of the air flowing out of the dryer would
be higher than '\WenS is connected to contactP. (3 marks) A C
XX X XXXXXXXXXX
p xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx Q
xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
\ xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
B xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx D
connected connected
tothe+ve copper rod tothe-ve
temrinal tennmal
I I
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/07 PD-EM4-Q/08
I
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
7. (a) (i) In the above Figure, indicate the direction of the force F acting on the copper rod due to the current passing from p 8. < HKCE 2008 Paper I - 8 >
toQ. (!Wll'k)
Figure 1 shows the simplified structnre of a motor with the plane ofthe coil at horizontal position. At this moment, it carries
a cwrent in the direction indicated by the arrow.
(ii) Suggest THREE me1hods to increase the force F. (3nwks)
(iii) Express the magnitude of force F in terms of the reading R of the spring balance and the weight W of the copper
rod. (1 mark)
Figure!
(b) A teacher conducts an experiment with the setup in the above Figure to find out how the reading R of the spring balance
changes with the current!. The Table below shows the data collected.
(i) Plot a graph ofR against[ in the below Figure. A scale of 1 cm representing 0.25 N and 0.25 A is used. (a) Mark the direction of the magnetic force acting on the side AB in Figure 2. (1 mark)
(4marks)
(b) Explain how the commutator helps to keep the coil rotating in one direction.
(c) When the coil reaches the vertical position, the current is zero. Explain why the coil keeps on turning even no magnetic
force is acting on it. (1 mark)
Figure2
N
A
(11) Findtheweight ofthecopper rod. (! Wll'k)
/
commutator
/
(fu) Find the maximun1 value of/ such that the insulating threads remain taut. (1 mark)
+ -
(iv) Ifthe experiment is repeated with a heavier copper rod, sketch a graph of R against I you would expect to obtain in (d) If the coil is not fully inserted between the magnets as shown in Figure 2, describe and explain how this would affect
the above Fi gure, and label it as L. (2 marks) the motion ofthe coil. Assume the current is the same as before. ( 3 marlcs)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/09 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/10
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
•• <HKCE 2069 Paper I- 8 > 10. < BK.CE 2010 Paper I - 12 >
The Figure below shows two long resistance wires X and Y which are connected in series to a d.c, power supply. X and Y are Figure 1 shows a simple motor that contains two electromagnets.
made ofthe same material but Xis thiilner than Y.
electromagnet\
electromagnet
/
wi,eX wueY
coil
soft:ironcore
soft iron core
(,) State the direction oftbe magnetic field at Y due to the current passing throughX (l mark)
(a) State the polarities (north/ south) ofthe electromagnets at Q and Rand the direction (up/ down) of the electromagnetic
force acting on side AB of the coil at the instant shown. (2 marks)
(b) There are magnetic forces Fx and Py acting onXand Y respectively due to the current passing through them.
Q R ______
(i) Indicate the direction of Fy in the Figure below. (I mark)
AB---------
(b) Figure 2 shows the instant when the coil has rotated by 180 °. By considering the electromagnetic force acting on side
AB, explain why the coil can continue to rotate in the same direction. (4 marks)
wueX wireY
coil
soft iron core
-+ A soft iron core
connected to a d.c. power supply
b,ttccy
(ii) Compare the magnitudes of Px andFy and explain briefly. (2 """")
...... ,
(o) Explam \Wether X and Y 'Will attract and repel each other alternatively when the d.c. power supply is replaced by an a.c.
power supply. (2 marks)
(c) Suggest two methods to increase the speed ofrotation ofthe motor.
.// r;:====================================,:;i PD-EM4-Q/ 11 PD-EM4-Q/12
1
DSE Physics - Section D : Question DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM4 : Magnetic Field BM4 : Magnetic Field
11. <HKCE:2011PaperI-6> Part B : HKAL examination questions
The magnetic field between two slab-shaped magnets with unlike poles facing each other is uniform. Describe how to use the
apparatus in the Figure below to illustrate this. (4 marks) 1:2. < HKAL 1996 Paper I- 8 >
simple current
balance rid�
The above :figure shows a simple current balance consisting of a horizontal rectangular metal loop ABCD pivoting on the
axis XYwhich is at the middle between AB and CD. Part of the current balance is inside a flat solenoid such that CD is
perpendicular to the axis of the solenoid. The length of CD is 20 cm. When current I flows through the current balance
YCDX and then to the solenoid, a rider of mass 0.1 g has to be placed on AB to restore equilibrium. The length, Z, and the
number oftums, N, ofthe flat solenoid are 50 cm and 600 respectively.
(a) Indicate on the Figure below the direction of the magnetic field inside the solenoid. (1 mark)
simple cunent
brum� rida
(b) (i) Express, in tenns of I, an expression of the magnetic field strength inside the solenoid. Hence, find the magnetic
force acting on arm CD in tenns ofJ. (3 marks)
(u1 By considering the equilibrium of the current balance, deduce the value of the current I.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4- QI 13 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/14
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
13. < HKAL 2006 Paper I - 4 > 14. (b) (i) By considering the equilibrium of the current balance, find the average magnetic fieldB in the gap between the two
In a vacuum, a beam of electrons with a horizontal velocity 3.7 x 101 m s-1 enters midway into a region of electric field solenoids. (2 marks)
between two horizontal square metal plates as shown in the Figure below. The length ofthe side ofthe plates is IO cm. A
voltage of320 Vis applied across the plates and the separation between them is 1.6 cm.
Diagram NOT
drawn to scale (ll) By considering the current flowing in the two solenoids, calculate the magnitude B' of the magnetic :field at tite gap
produced by the two solenoids. (2 marks)
10cm
(fu) State TWO possible reasons to account for the discrepancy between the two values ofB andB'.
(b) A uniform magnetic field normal to the paper is applied between the two plates so as to make the electron beam travel
horizontally. Find the magnitude ofthe magnetic :field applied. (Neglect the weight ofthe electron.) (2 marks)
{a) Particles with the speed v of 1.63 x 107 m s- 1 are directed into an evacuated region with a uniform magnetic field B
14. <HKAL2007PaperI-3>
of 0.5 T perpendicular to the initial velocity of the particles as shown in the Figure below. Given that the charge to
The Figure below shows a current balance which consists of a copper wire loop PQRS balanced on two razor blades. Two mass ratio ofa particle is 4.82 x 107 C 1cg-1 , find the radius of the path descnOed by the particles in the field region.
identical solenoids, each of 1500 ttnns, are placed coaxially such that one ann RS ofthe current balance is in the narrow gap (2 nwk.s)
between the two solenoids. Each solenoid is 30 cm long and has a square cross-section of3 cm x 3 cm.
X X X X X X
rider particles X X X X X
solenoid x x
uniform.magnetic
X X X X x -;---_ fieldB pointing
X X into the paper
X X X X
copper wire frame
to rheostat and
smooth d.c. supply 2•0 A
:__...=;:::;...- (b) Explain whether the particles would emerge with a greater speed from the region ofmagnetic field.
When a current of2.0 A flows in the arm RS of the current balance, and the same current flows in the two solenoids in the
same direction (not shown in the figure), placing a rider ofniass n mg on the arm.RS can restore the balance.
{a) Indicate in the above Figure the direction of the magnetic force acting on the arm RS and the direction of the current in
the solenoids. (2 marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-QI 15 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/16
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
Part C : BKDSE examination questions 17. A unifonn magnetic field pointing into the paper is applied over the region ABCD containmg part of the rod. When switch S
is closed, the rod 'kicks' out and leaves the liquid surface.
16. < HKDSE 2013 Paper m- 4 > (a) State the direction ( to the left / to the right / out of the paper) that the rod 'Icicles' and describe the subsequent motion
An electron moving with speed 1.2 x 10 7 m s· 1 enters a square region.AB CD with a uniform magnetic field of0.01 T pointing of the rod. (3 marks)
into the paper as shown in the figure below. The electron descnbes a quarter circle from A to C and it emerges from C with
the same speed. Neglect the effects of gravity.
electron O
A B
X7.-XXJ11
\>< X X X X X X >11
�xxxx X
XX X X XX X � umfonn magnetic field (b) When swimhSis closed, the initial moment aboutpointP that makes the rod 'kick' out is 7.2 x 10-4 Nm. Assume that
!>< X X X X X X � pointing into the paper the magnetic force acts at the midpoint of the part of the rod within the magnetic field.
�xxxxxxx
:><xxxxxxx {i) Calculate the magnetic force acting on the rod at that instant. (2 marks)
Xxxxxxxx
D Kxxxx.x.x..K c
(a) (i) Find the magnitude of the magnetic force acting on the electron at pointP on its path. (2 marks)
(ll) Hence, find the strength B of the magnetic field if the current flowing through the rod is 3.2 A when the circuit is
closed. (2 marks)
(ll1 Indicate in the above Figure the direction ofthe electron's acceleration at the pointP. (lmarlc)
{b) Although the electron accelerates due to the magnetic force, explain why it emerges from the magnetic field with the
same speed. (2 marks)
(c) Now the uniform.magnetic field is removed and a bar magnet is placed underneath the container as shown in Figure (b).
The rod is held tilted at an angle to the vertical but with its lower end still in the conducting liquid.
(c) Deduce the speed of the electron when entering the magnetic field such that it would descnbe a semi-circle from A to D
instead. (2 marks) �server'seye
s p
Figure(b)
) Diagram.NOT drawn to scale I
17. <BKDSE2015PaperIB-9>
Figure (a) shows a set-up for demonstrating one of Faraday's discoveries. A light metal rod is free to rotate about point P
while its lower end just touches some conducting liquid in a metallic container.
'-=HI\
p battery
Diagram NOT drawn to scale
Figure (a) (i) Sketch on Figure (b) the field lines around the rod due to the bar magnet. (1 mark)
(ii) After closing switch Sand the rod is released from rest, descn"be its subsequent motion viewed from above.
metallic (1 mark)
'-=HI\ container
battery
. DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM4-Q/17 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/0l
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
HlCEAA's Marking Scheme is prepared for the marked reference. It should not be regarded as a set of model answers.
18. <HKDSE2017PaperIB�9> Students and t.eachers who are not involved in the marking :PJ;OceSS are advised to i:ntcip.ret the Marking Schelne with care.
(a) Two long straight current carcying wires, P and Q, are parallel tci each other and lie on the plane of the paper as shown
in Figure 1. The currents in the wires, /p and IQ , flow in the same direction. Question Solution
wireP wireQ
'j ·j
1. (•) (,) S-pole [1]
I I
(ii) N-pole [1]
Figure 1
� right
(b) (i) clockwise [1]
(li) In Figure 1, draw the direction ofthe magnetic force acting on Q due to P. ( d) (i) (1) clockwise [1]
(1 m,,I<;)
(2) clockwise [1]
(ili) Show that the magnitude of the magnetic force per unit length F1 acting on Q due to P is
(3) clockwise [1]
f J
F. - µ. P Q.
I - 21tr (n) The coil would rotate continnously. [2]
whereµ,, is the permeability of free space and r is the separation between the two wires. (3 marks)
(e) AnyTHREEofthefollowing: [3]
* Increase the voltage supply
* Increase the number oftoms in.PQRS
* Increase the number of turns in the solenoids
(iv) For the magnetic force acting on Q due to P and the magnetic force acting onP due to Q, if/p :f:;lQ, briefly exp].WD.
whether the two forces are equal in magnitude. (2 marks)
* Insert iron rods into the two solenoids
(b) When S is pressed, CUil'ent flows through the coil and the soft iron core is magnetized. [1]
It attracts the iron spring towards the left. [1]
The hammer strikes the left metal plate to produce the first note. [1]
Fignre2
iVben Sis released, the iron core is demagnetized.
The hammer then springs back to strike the right metal plate to produce the second note. [1]
Read the fol1owing passage about a magnetic-,dly levitated {maglev) train and answer the questions that
follow.
'A maglev train car is just a box with magnets on the four comers; says Jesse Powell, the son of the
maglcv trai.11 inventor. The electromagnets employed have superconducting coils (i.e. coils with extremely
low resistance). They therefore can generate magnetic fields 10 times stronger than ordinary
electromagnets, enough to levitate and propel a train.
magnetic
-'--�-'-----'--�pole Q
LEVITATION
Two sets of magnetic fields are set up for different functions. One is to make the train float a few
centimetres above magnelic poles P and Q as shown while the other is a propulsion system run by an
alternating current for moving the train car along the guideway by magnetic attraction and eyulsion. This
floating design enables a smooth movement of the train. Even when the train travels up to 600 knt per
hour. passengers inside experience less vibration than travelling on traditional trains.
(a) Explain why electromagnets employing superconducting coils can produce much stronger magnetic fields.
(2 marks)
(b) State the polarities of the magnetic poles P and Q and explain how this arrangement enables the train to
float. (2 marks)
(c) Referring to the resistive forces experienced by the train, explain why a maglev train ride is {i) smoother
and (ii) raster. (2 marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/ 02 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/03
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
2. (e) Statement 1 is correct. [1] 5. (b) Power given out by the heating element:
Copper is not a magnetic material, it cannot be attracted by the electromagnet. [1] V'
p O
The magnetic field pattern is shown by the pattern of the iron filings. 8= 39.4 c c <accept B= 39.36° C> [1]
[1]
(c) If Sis connected to contact Q, the current flowing through the motor is reduced [1]
(b)
The speed ofthe rotation of the fan is decreased. [1]
Change the number of turns of the coil and repeat the above procedure. [1]
< Direction magnetic field lines correct> [1] Record the change of the number of iron clips when the chain just falls down. [1]
< Pattern of magnetic field lines correct> [1] In each trial, the current should be kept constant. [1]
(b) When the switch is closed, current flows through the coil. As the coil is placed in a magnetic field,
P-----'------Q
there are magnetic forces acting on the wires to rotate the coil and the coil turns clockwise. [1]
When the coil turns to the vertical position, the turning effect becomes zero.
(ii) (D Increase the strength ofthe magnetic field. [!]
Due to inertia, the coil shoots tbrough the vertical position to the other side. [1] @ Increase the current. [!]
The direction of the turning effect acting on the coil reverses @ Widen the magnetic field so that the length of the rod in the magnetic field is increased. [!]
and the coil rotates back in the opposite: direction (anticlockwise). This process repeats. [1]
< Do not accept: increase the length of the rod>
As energy is lost against friction during the motion, the coil will finally stop in the vertical position. [1] < Do not accept: decrease the resistance of the rod>
< Do not accept : decrease the weight of the rod >
wire Y
1----►Fy
l
[1]
(11) The magnitudes ofthe two forces are equal ( OR Fx = FY) [1]
0. because they are action"1"eaction pair. [1]
(c) The directions of the cmrent in X and Y are always opposite. [1]
The forces are always repulsive. (OR The forces will not attract and repel alternately.) [l]
I/A
8. (a)
* Use a battery ofhigher voltage. (OR Increase the current.)
* Increase the number ofturns ofthe coil.
[l] * Increase the area ofcoil in then:tagDetic :field.
* Insert a soft iron core in the coil.
(b) Commutator can reverse the direction of the CUtTent through the coil
* Increase the number of turns of the winding in the solenoid.
[l]
whenever the coil hasrotatedhalf cycle. [l]
(c) duetoinertia [1] 11. Put the cardboard on top ofthe magnets. [!]
Sprinkle some iron filings onto the cardboard. [1]
(d) Since length of wire inside the magnetic :field is decreased, [l]
magnetic force acting on the wire decreases, Tap the cardboard gently to show the magnetic fiel d pattern. [!]
[l]
thus the rotation speed ofthe motor decreases. [l] The iIOn filings will form evenly spaced parallel lines between the magnets. [1]
-
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/06 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/07
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
12. (a) simple current rider 14. (b) (ii) B'=µcnl
1500
= (4xx!0-')( )(2) [!]
0.3
flat solenoid [!]
B = 0.0126 T [!]
I
< direction of a: towMds the centre ofthe circular arc> [!]
< Magnetic force Fis upwards > (!]
(b) Fis always peq,endicular to the velocity of the electron, [!]
< CurrentJ is anticlockwise when viewed from left> [!]
thus, no work is done and the kinetic energy remains unchanged. [!]
(b) (i) F=mg=BIL OR
(72 x lo-') (9.81) = B (2) (0.0 3) [!] Electron only changes direction while speed remains unchanged, [!]
:. B = 0.0118 T [!] no work is done and the kinetic energy remains unchanged. (!]
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/ 08 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM4-QS/09
EM4 : Magnetic Field EM4 : Magnetic Field
i
16. (c) F=BQv= mv [I]
18. (a) (iii) ThemagneticfieldatQduetoP:
B - µ.I, [I]
:.v= BQr Q - 21tY
F A IP IQ
Fi =1 =
�
[I]
17. (a) The rod 'kicks' to the right. [I]
The rod then leaves theliquid and the circuit is not complete.
(iv) The two forces form. an action and reactionpair, [I]
Therefore, current stops flowing and the rod swings back t o the original position. [I] thus they are equal inmagnitud e. [I]
The above process then repeats so the rod continually kicks out and thenreturns. [I]
(b) (i) As current passes inthe same direction between two adjacent wires, [I]
(b) (i) Moment=Fxd the wires attract each other, thus the solenoid is compressed. [I]
:. (7.2 X 10-4) = px (0.06 + 0.03) [I]
(ii) Currents between two adjacent wires always flows in the same direction at any instant, [I]
:. F = 8 x 10-:i N [I] thus, the solenoid will always be compressed.
(ri)ByF=BIL
�---s ---------c
(c) (i) �server's eye
P
'-=HI[
bat tery
18. (a) (i) The magnetic field at Q due ot P points out ofthe paper. [I]
(ii) [I]
Hong Kong Diploma of Secondary Education Examination DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EM5-M/Ol
Physics - Compulsory part (;t,iH1'1l-) EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
Section A -Heat and Gases (#.:::fl'�fflt)
1. Temperature, Heat and Internal energy (�Lt , $'fl' � �)
2. Transfer Processes (#.:#$.i/!.U.) The following list of formulae may be found useful:
3. Change of State (m.669tt �)
/:J.(J)
4. GeneraIGasLaw (f--l&Att�#) Induced e.m.f. c""N
S. Kinetic Theory ( �7:!l$'Jtj,) 6t
Section B -Force and Motion (}]ift,i(t;) Force on a current-carrying conductor in a magnetic field F=Bllsin0
1. Positio n and Movement (-fir..:f:f,,$-t;)
2. Newton's Laws ( 4-.tfPt#)
Magnetic field due to a long straight wire
3. Moment of Poree (:h,1£)
4. Work,EnergyandPower(ft.>Jli, �:i:fv.>h4l-)
5. Momentum (to:IJ Magnetic field inside a long solenoid
6. Projectile Mo tion (t.!!f:t�j/J )
7, CircularMotion(OOffil�t;))
8. Gravitatio n (31 71)
1
Section C - Wave Motion (it.1») Use the following data wherever necessary:
1. Wave Propagation (ilt#,$:i@.)
2. WavePhenomem(.!t:-.!R.l.) Permeability of free space µ, = 4n x 10-7Hm- 1
3. Reflection and Refraction of Light (;\:.69.&.M.&.#M)
4. Lenses (iUt) Charge of electron e = 1.60x 10- 19 c
5. Wave Nature ofLigh11 (;;lc.#,/lt:li,.'/fo/i.) Electron rest mass m0 = 9.11 X lQ-ll kg
6. Sound ( *i-)
Section D - Electricity and Magnetism ( 11::fu@) Acceleration due to gravity g = 9.8Ims-2 (closetotheEarth)
1. Electrostatics C*11t�)
2. Electric Circuits (ilt4)
3. DomesticElectricity(t':-®-Jll'lt)
4. MagneticField(.Jllf:Jf-) Part A : HKCE examination questions
5. Electromagnetic Induction ( 11t.@H)i�)
6. Alternating Current ( ;t1:t {t)
1. < HKCE 1981 Paper II - 34 >
SectionE -Radioactivity and Nuclear Energy (1.t:MlR.�,f<>;/'i/t)
I. Radiation and Radioactivity ($£1/t;ftt.a,ttl'J!.t.) Which of the following statements concerning the generator shown in the
:figureis/are correct?
2. Atomic Model ()!j. 'T.ffl;1'.!)
3. NuclearEnergy(:ltht) (1) The direction of the current through the load reverses periodically.
(2) The maximum magnitude of the current depends on the speed of
Physics -Elective part (±aft--��*) rotation of the coil.
Elective 1 -Astronomy and Space Science (3'tX."f,>fl';lln:3't#*) (3) The rnaxhnum magnitude of the current depends on the resistance
1. The universe seen in different scales (;;i- J;;J 1t r.rn�& Til9 ':f" 'iii imtt) oftheload.
2. Astronomy through histozy (Jt:lt �il91i-Al.ll:)
A (I) only
3. Orbital motions undergraVity(:!thTil9�ia.lU&)
B. (3) only
4. Stars and the universe (•IJ.£.,f,,*W) C. (1) & (2) only
Elective 2-Atomic World (,l!'tTif--n.) D. (2) & (3) only
1. Ruthetford's atomic model (li:;E;/8,)!j.7"��)
2. Photoelectric effect (;le 111:tl:t.4)
3. Bohr's atomic model ofhyrlrogen (Jtii lro i.&7"#&1'.!) 2. < HKCE 1983 Paper Il- 33 >
4. Particles or waves (�'T�.it)
5. Probingintonanoscale(»l,�h,;i/<1!t$)
Elective 3 -Energy and Use of Energy (Jl5:!tfP"�E.ii.€r:1-ftM)
I. Electricityathome(*,§,ffl'lt) e------------lN_ sI
2. Energy efficiency in building (¢11fil9��tt.$)
3. Energy efficiency in transportation (il#r#ilro Jlt�tt,ll.)
The figure shows a bar magnet moving along1he diameter ofa metal ring. Which ofthe following will happen?
4. Non-renewable energy sources (;;i-�*!U'6�)
5. Renewable energy sow:ces (� *.i.Jlt�) A. An induced current will flow in a clockwise direction in the ring.
Elective 4 - Medic3l Physics ( i}�4tg�) B. An induced current will flow inan anticlockwise direction in the ring.
1. Making sense of the eye (11.tU{l � 't) C. An altcmatingcurrent will be produced in the ring.
2. Makingsenseoftheear(.lf��'t) D. No induced current will be produced
3. Medical imagingusingnon-iocizingradiation U�'llt,tfE.fiRH}c'f>Wil!f>)
4. Medical imaging using ionizing radiation ( 11!:lllft-tiMU-<'ffe��lj/:)
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/021 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/03
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
3. <BKCE 1984 Paperll- 25 > 7. <HKCE 1989 Paperil-35>
Which of the following devices is designed to convert mechanical energy into electrical energy? A>-
A. dynamo
B. transformer
C. motor
D. electric cell
••
5. < HK.CE 1987 Paper II - 34 >
-
< HKCE 1990 Paper II- 36 >
[Q
Direction
X y of motion
""""' Figure 2
In Figure 1, the galvanometer deflects to the left with a reading of IO µA. The north pole of the same magnet is now pushed
towards the coil from the other side at a faster rate as shown in Figure 2. The deflection on the galvanometer will be
A light coil of wire XY is suspended by insulating string such that it can swing freely. A solenoid connected to a cell with a A. more than IO µA to the right.
switch Sis placed near to the end Y ofthe coil as shown. What would happen to the coilXYjust when the switch S is closed ? B. less than 10 µA to the left.
A. The coil moves towards the solenoid. C. more than 1 O µA to the left.
B. The coil moves away from the solenoid. D. less than IO µA to the right.
C. The coil would move down.
D. The coil would move up.
9. < HKCE 1990 Paper II - 39 >
6. < HKCE 1989 Paper ll - 42 >
51ill
5
The figure shows the display on a CRO with the time base set at 1 ms cm-1 and Y-gain at 0.5 V cm-1. The peak voltage and 10@1
frequency of the a.c. voltage applied across the Y--plates are
peak voltage frequency
A. 1.5V S00Hz
In the figure above, the peak current through the resistor is
A. 2mA
= Y-gain IV cm-1
B. UV 250Hz B. 4mA
C. 3.0V 50Hz C. 8mA
D. 3.0V 2S0Hz D. 4A
. DSEPbysics-SectionD: M.C. PD-EMS-M/04 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/051
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
10. <HKCE1993Paperil-34> 13. < HKCE 1994Paper II- 36 >
'-----C=J------"
coil
R
p Q
R
Two coils of conducting wires are wrapped on a soft-iron core as shown in the above figure. Switch Sis closed and after a pL--C:::J-___JQ
while re,.opened. Which of the following statements is/are true?
A magnet is initially placed between the ends of a soft iron core as shown above. The magnet is then quickly rotated
(1) At the moment when Sis closed, a current flows through R fromP to Q.
clocl:cwi3e through one complete revolution. Which of the following statements correctly descn"bes the induced Cllirellt
(2) When S remains closed, there is no current flowing through R.
(3) At the moment when Sis re-opened, a current flows throughR fromP to Q. flowing through the :resistorR?
A. (1) only A. The current flows throughR fram.Pto Q, andthen reverses its direction.
B. (3) only B. The current flows through RfromQ to P, and then reverses its &rection.
c. (!) & (2) only C. The current flows through R from P toQ.
D. (2) & (3) only D. The current flows tbroughRfromQtoP.
The above diagram shows a simple generator. Which of the following graphs below shows the time variation ofthe voltage
The diagram shows the trace ofa signal on a CRO with the time base switched off
The Y-gain is set at 1 V cm·1• Which of the following statements correctly describes i-:tt-�ir.1t;:f ��� ! 1 cm
;::�"?� -t ��
produced by the generator? the input signal?
.J.w..;.. ·,·
A. B. A. It is an a.c. ofpeak voltage 1 V.
voltage
P�v
B. Itis an a.c. ofpeak voltage2 V.
C. Itis ad.c. of constant voltage 1 V.
D. It is a d.c. of constant voltage 2 V.
0
,rv/b
signal applied across the Y·plates.
(\ Peak voltage / V Frequency/ Hz
A. 1 16.7
B. 1 25
c. 1 50
12. < HKCE 1994 Paper Il- 31> D. 2 25
Which of the following statements about direct current (de.) and alternating current (a.c.) is/are correct?
(I) All d.c. sources produce constant voltages. 17. <HKCE1996Paperll•3l>
(2) The direction of current in an a.c. circuit changes with time.
(3) Both d.c. and a.c. produce a heating effect in a resistor. Which of the following devices is not an application of electromagnetic induction?
A, (!) only A. a bicycle dynamo
B. (2) only B. a magnetic tape playback head
C. (!) & (3) only C. amoving coil microphone
D. (2) & (3) only D. a moving coil loudspeaker
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/06 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/07
1
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
18. < BKCE 1997 Paper II- 36 > 21. <HKCE 1998 Paper II- 34 >
X X X X X X
Metal rod
p X X X X X X Upwwds
X X X X X X
j____.,.
l
Left +- Right
X X X X X X
G Downwards
Induced current
In the � e circuit, the terminal Q and the sliding contact R of the variable resistor are connected to the f-input of a In the above diagram, a metal rod is placed inside a magnetic field pointing into the paper. In which direction should the rod
CRO. IfR ts moved towards P, how would the amplitude and period of the trace displayed on the CRO be affected ? be moved in order to produce an induced cmrent as shown in the diagram ?
A. into the paper
"""""
Amplitude of the trace Period of the trace B. out ofthe paper
A. remains unchanged C. upwards
B. increases increases D. downwards
====� ..
c. decreases remains unchanged
D. decreases decreases
22. < HKCE 2000 Paper II- 38 >
A bar magnet is placed near a solenoid. Which of the following correctly shows the direction of the induced current in the
0 Metalring
n:
19. < HKCE 1997 Paper Il- 34 >
solenoid ? (Note : The arrow " + " indicates the direction of motion ofthe magnet or solenoid.)
B.
A.
j .. ...
� �
I 4>--1 ill�
L@-J'
· n: · n: n: · n: w,
� metal ring is released and falls vertically around a magnet as shown in the above diagtam. Which of the following C. D.
diagrams correctly descnOes the directions ofthe induced current, if any, in the ring at positions Xand f?
C
23. <HKCE2001P3perll-35>
20, < HKCE 1997 Paper ll- 37 >
Load
long solenoid is placed in a vertical position and its two ends are connected to the Y-input of a CRO (with the time base
A
The diagram shows an electricity generator connected to a load. Which of the following can increase the voltage produced switched on). A bar magnet is released above the solenoid so that it falls through the solenoid. Which of the following
by the generator ? figures best represents the trace shown on the CRO ?
(1) Rotating the coil at a greater speed B.
(2) Reducing the resistance oftbe load
(3) Replacing the coil with one of larger area
• '' H-f
'
' '
�j,4\-J
A. (1) only
1±1:' '
B. (2) only
'
C. (1) & (3) only
D. (2) & (3) only '
. DSE Physics - Section D : MC. PD-EM5-M/08 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/091
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
□➔
24. < HKCE 2003 Paper II - 37 > 25, < BKCE 2004 Paper II - 35 >
A xxxxxxxxxxxx B
xxxxxxxxxxxx ,-
'
'''
xxxxxxxxxxxx
xxxxxxxxxxxx
''
xxxxxxxxxxxx
xxxxxx:xxxxxx
xxxxxxxxxxxx
xxxxxxxxxxxx
'
R xxxxxxxxxxxx
uniform magnetic field
pointing into the paper
A rectangular coil is moved with a uniform speed from position A to position B as shown above. 'Which of the following
graphs represents the variation of the current induced in the coil 'With time?
A. B.
I I
Two coils Pand Qare wound on a soft-iron core as sho'Ml. above. Switches Sis closed and then opened again. Which of the
foUowing shows the directions of the induced cun:ent flowing through the resistor R?
At the Instant Sis closed At the instant Sis opened again
C. D.
B.
R
26. < HKCE 2004 Paper ll- 36 >
C.
IJ IJ;. -
D. The diagram shows a generator connected to a load. Which of the following statements is/are correct?
(I) The generator produces an alternating cumn.t through the load.
·_,:.:\''. (2) At the instant shown, a current is flowing through the load fromPto Q.
R ::-::,:;::/. .·. R (3) The current produced reaches a maximum when the coil is vertical.
,•,,,;-·
,, ...
,c•,:··"''
_-; __
·'-•' •'
A.
B.
(1) only
(3) only
:>,s,,
(: C.
D.
(l)and(2)only
(2) and (3) only
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-Mi 10 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/11
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
27. <BKCE2004Paperll-38> 30. < HK.CE 2007Paper Il- 40 > metal rod
Voltage per cm Time per cm /
xxsxxxxxx Pxxxxxxxxxxxxx
xx�"''"""''""•"'cx-,r.<,<cx-;n<,<,_x-,"'-- metalrail
xx xxxxxx xxxxxxxxxxxxxx
xx xxxxxx xxxxxxxxxxxxxx unifoxm:�gn�
xx xxxxxx X X XXXXXXXXXX X X - eldpomtmgmto
c
:1: : i--
)C " " " )( >< X >< >< >< X X X >< ><
�,ex X
><� ➔ 31. < HK.CE 2007 Paper Il- 42 > direetioo. of
rotation
D ><£Y- " " "A" ><D>< "
,/0�
)C � )C
>< ><A>< A
" " " )C
The above figure shows a simple structure ofa d.c. generator. 'Which of the following statements is/are correct?
(1} The CUIIent delivered to the load is constant
29. <BKCE2007Paperil-43>
(2) The current generated in the coil is alternating, but the current delivered to the load is unidirectional.
(3) The current flows through the load fromXto Y.
A. (I) only
B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only
closed-loop D. (2) & (3) only
copper coil
11
36. <BKCE2010PaperII-42>
, DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
A copper ring R is falling through a solenoid along the ax.1S as showtt. The
PD-EMS-M/Bll
� observer's eye
� '/
ODTL\
� soft iron rod plane of the ring is kept horizontal throughout The solenoid is carzying a
' ;..\,..\, .\,-- "" steady current I. Yis the centre of the solenoid c:::t==>R
4
-W
�J Which of the following combinations about the directions of the induced IX
coil A coilB current in the ring (if any) atXand at Y as observed from O is correct?
An experiment about electromagnetism is designed as shown above. Coil B has a greater number of turns th:m coil A. Coil atX at Y
Bis connected to a sensitive ammeter. Which of the following statements is/are correct?
(1) 'When the switch is closed, a steady Clltrent flows through the a.mmeter. A. clockwise clockwise
(2) At the moment the switch is opened, a current flows through the ammeter momentarily. B. clockwise no current
(3) If the soft iron rod is replaced by a glass rod, the ammeter will have a greater deflection at the moment the switch C. anticlockwise anticlockwise
is opened. D. anticlockwise no current
A. (I) only
B. (2) only
C. (1) & (3) only 37. <BK.CE 2011 Paper II -44>
D. (2) & (3) only X X X X X X X ' X X X X X X X X
X X X X X X X X X X ' X X X X X
Q
A metal rod PQ is moving with a uniform speed v on a metal rail placed in a uniform magnetic field as shown in the figure
above. A resistor is connected across RS. Which of the following descriptions is/are correct?
(1) Kinetic energy of the rod is converted into electrical energy.
(2) CWTent flows through the resistor from S to R.
(3) The induced cunent will be reversed ifthe rod moves in the opposite direction.
A. (!) only
- w -�- - - - -�-
The magnetic flux through a coil ofN tums increases at a uniform rate from zero to 11> in time t. What is the magnitude of
the e.m.£ induced in the coil ?
35. < BKCE 2009 Paper II- 39 > A. N(J)t
X B. (J)t/N
Q
y pillillill]_
(9 N(f)/t
magnet -----------� D. Nt/(J)
When a magnet is moving towards end for a solenoid, it is found that a north pole is induced at end Q. As shown in the
39. <HKAL 1982 Paper I - 25>
figure above, the magnet passes throughQand moves away from the solenoid, what are the polarities of end P of the solenoid
and endX of the magnet?
Sis a long solenoid. L1 is a wire loop just inside the solenoid, and
14 is a wire loop just outside the solenoid The current in the solenoid s
is increased at a steady rate, such that the e.m.£ induced in Li
poJarity of end P polarity of end X .is--:\_.2 V. Find the e.m.f. induced in 4
A. s s ¼J av. L,
B. s N B. 0.6V. �£30
C. N s c. 1.2V.
D. N N D. 2.4 V.
40.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
< BKAL 1983 Paper I - 21 >
PD-EMS-M/14
1
I
45.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
Q R
following statements is correct at the instant shown in the figure 7 X X X ..:_..
A. Toe magnitude of the magnetic flux through the coil changes with time.
B. An induced cunent is flowing in the coil in the anticlockwise direction. X X X X
C. An electromagnetic force acts on the side PQ in a direction opposing its motion. p C]s
D. There is no induced current flowing in the coil. X X X X
A uniform magnetic field acting perpendicular into paper is inside a circular region of radius 8 cm. A circular loop of radius
41. < IIKAL 1984 Paper I- 27 > 1 0 CJXl is placed outside the field region as shown in the figure. If the magnetic field is now decreasing at a constant rate of
0.01 T s-1, what will be the magnitude and direction of the induced e.m.f. in the loop ?
Magnitude Direction
A. 2.0 x 10 -4 V fromA to Bvia the loop
B. 2.0 x 10 -4 V fromB to A via the loop
��--;Q���g-, " Q
A large copper disc mounted on a horizontal axle is spun in the clockwise direction between the poles of a horseshoe magnet. C. 3.1 x 1Q-4V fromA to B via the loop
D. 3.lxlo-'V from B to A via the loop
6 Two rectangular wire loops P and Q are placed in t he same plane side by side. Loop P includes a battery and a switch S,
A short bar magnet moving with uniform velocity passes through an air-cored solenoid of connected to a galvanometer as
which is initially open. IfSis suddenly closed, what is the direction of the induced current in loop Q? Are the magnetic
48. <BKAL 1989 Paper I- 3S > 52. < HKAL 1995 Paper IlA - 35 >
A certain length of a copper wire is bent to fonn a circular coil of one tarn. The coil is then placed in a uniform magnetic A bar magnet is moved perpendicularly towards a copper disc. Which of the folloWUlg statements are correct ?
field with its plane normal to the direction of the magnetic field. The flux linkage through the coil is <I>. The same length of (1) Eddycunent is induced in the copper disc.
wire is now bent to form a double loop of smaller radius. The flux linkage through the coil would become
(2) Temp erature ofthe copper disc incxcases.
A $/4.
(3) A repulsive force is experienced by the magnet.
B. ¢12.
C. ¢. A. (1) & (2) only
B. (I) & (3) only
D. 20. C. (2) & (3) only
D. (1), (2) & (3)
49. < HKAL 1992 Paper I- 38 >
X
53. < HKAL 1997 Paper IIA- 23 >
X
X Q X X X
A metal rodPQ moves with constmt velocity across a uniform magnetic field directed perpendicularly into paper as shown in
the above figure. A voltage is induced across the rod. Which of the following statements is/are correct?
{I) The magnitude of the voltage depends on the length of the rod
(2) PointP is at a lower potential than Q.
(3) A magnetic force is acting on the rod to oppose its motion.
A (I) only The above figure shows a small coil, connected to a light beam galVSilometer, placed in a region of uniform magnetic field
B. (3) only between the poles of a magnet. The plane of the coil is parallel to the pole faces. Which of the following actions would
C. (1) & (2) only produce a deflection of the galvanometer?
D. (2) & (3) only
(I) Moving the coil to and fro between the poles.
(2) Moving the coil away from the region between the pole faces.
50. < HKAL 1992 Paper I - 40 >
(3) Rotating the coil about a diameter through an angle of 180°.
A. (I) only
B. (3) only
C. (I) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only
-
54. < B]{AL 1997 Paper llA - 31 >
X X X X
An aluminium ring floats above a coil cany:ing alternating current. Which ofthe following will affect the height of the ring?
(1) theresistivityofthering A B
X X X X
(2) the density of the ring
(3) the frequency ofthe alternating current X X X X
A. (1) & (2) only
B. (1) & (3) only X X X
C. (2) & (3) only D
D. (1), (2) & (3) X X X
l X
A rectangclar m etal wire :frameAJJCD moves to the left with a uniform speed across a region ofunifor.m magnetic field acting
51. < HKAL 1994 Paper IIA- 37 > perpendicularly into paper. Which of the following is/are true at the instant shovm in the figure ?
The magnetic flux linkage for a coil placed in a urtifor.mmagnetic field depends on (1) A current is flowing in the clockwise direction.
{I) the resistance ofthe coil (2) The electric potential atB is higher than that at C.
(2) the mmiber oftl:l:llls of the coil
(3) the angle between the nor:mal of the coil and the direction of the magnetic field (3) The side AD experiences a magnetic force acting to the right
A. (I) only A. (1) only
B. (3) only B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only C. (1) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only D. (2) & (3) only
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-Mi 181 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/19
□S
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
55. < BKAL 1999 Paper IIA- 36 > I 59. <BKAL2003Paper�-34>
Loft Right
A coil ofmetal wire is placed on a plane perpendicular to a uniform magnetic field. ,.!) 180°
The coil is rotated through 180° about a diail1eter as shown. The induced e.m.f. in X X x' X X I
the coil is independent of p
A. the area of the coil. X X
-' ►
B. the flux density of the magnetic field. X X
C. the nu:mberoftu.rnsofthecoiL
D. the resistance of the coil. X x
l
X X Q R
.,,,,
The figure shows a rectangular metal coil PQRS moving from left to right with a unifonn speed across an insulated metal
56. < HKAL 1999 Paper wire canying a steady cuttentl. Which of the following gives the correct sequence for the direction of the current induced in
IIA -::stra
ight the coil PQRS ?
A. Clockwise and then anticlockwise
wire canyizzg search
B. Anticlockwise and then clockwise
ana.c. current f6-�;2-� C. Clockwise, then anticlockwise and finally clockwise again
---<:l'['il==::l;i=t
To CRO D. Anticlockwise, then clockwise and finally anticlockwise again
:;
A long straight wire canying an a.c. cunent lies on the plane of the paper as shown. A sear ch coil connected to a CRO with
the time-base off is used to measure the peak value of the magneti c field produced by the a.c. current When the search coil is 60. < HKAL 2004 Pape r IIA- 28 >
placed atB, the length ofthe trace on the CRO is 2 cm. If the search coil is placed at A, the length of the trace would be A search coil is placed at one end of a solenoid as shown in the figure. The solenoid is connected to an a.c. somce so that an
A. 0.5 cm. a.c. cw:rent is flowing in the solenoid. The induced voltage on the search coil is shown on the CRO connected to the search
B. 1 cm. coil.
C. 2cm. solenoid
CRO
0
D. 4cm.
□ □
58. < HKAL 2002 Paper IIA- 28 > X X X X X
graph. The wire MNis in the planeof the coil and the current[is positive (+) when it is in the direction fromMtoN.
N I
X x unifonn magnetic field
/ into paper
X X
X X
T/2
T
X X X X X
A circular frame and a square frame, made from the same type of metal wires, are placed in a uniform magnetic field as
shown. The length of each side of the square is equal to the diameter of the circle. When the flux density of the magnetic M
�d is increased at a steady rate, find the ratio of theinduced cunent in the cll"cular frame to that in square frame. Starting from t= 0, how does the direction oftbe current induced in the coil vary in one period?
'� 1:1 A. Clockwise first and then anticlockwise
B. 1 :1t B. Anticlockwise fust and then clockwise
C. 1t:4 C. Clockwise -+ anticlockwise ➔ clockwise ➔ anticlockwise
D. 2:n D. Anticlockwise ➔ clockwise ➔ anticlockwise ➔ clockwise
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/20 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. PD-EMS-M/21
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
62. < HKAL 2005 Paper IIA- 16 > '. 65. < BKAL 2008 Paper IIA -18 >
X X R X X Q X X Jxxxxx:
uniform p QX :
X l
X X X X X magnetic
1/field X X,
--';>-
X X ;
X X X X X X
X X '
R :
X X s X X p X X xx x xx
)_ __ _ __ __ :
Two conducting rods PQ and RS are placed on two smooth, parallel, horizontal conducting rails. A uniform magnetic field is In the figure, PQRS is a metal plate placed perpendicularly to a uniform magnetic field directed into the paper. At the instant
directed into the plane of the paper as shown. Ifnow rod PQ is given an initial velocity to the right, which of the following showJ'l, the magnetic field is moving to the right and eddy current is induced in the metal plate. Which of the following
statements is NOT correct? diagrams best represents a possible path ofthe eddy current induced in the plate ?
A. The induced cummt is in the direction ofPQRS. A R
B. The magnetic force acting on the rod PQ is towards the left.
:xxxxx-:
,-----------------
'xxxxx:
C. Rod RS starts moving towards the right. '
D. Rod PQ would keep on moving with a uniform speed. p QX : 0 :
X\
X x
�X X,
xi
� f-+
63. <HKAL200SPaperllA-17> X X( X X:
X X• X x:
s R J: ' R
x
: X__ X _ X __
'
;_ X__ X __X __ X__ X
__ X :
: 2n :
c. D.
� -----------: fxxxxx: :xxxxxl
generator p QX X:: p QX :
X \
Two '12 V, 6 W' lamps are operating at their rated values. The internal resistance of the generator is 2 Q. What is the X x,
percentage ofthe electrical power generated by the generator dissipated by the two lamps ? X x,
A 75% X X f-+ X X!
B. 86%
i
X X ' X X(
C. 92%
D. 100%
R
:_ X__ X _ X __ X__ X :
l s ' R
,xxxxx•
'
, ________________ J
□
66. < HKAL 2009 Paper IIA -32 >
X X X X X X X X
A metal wire in shape of a square with each side 15.7 cm is placed in a uniform magnetic field of 0.6 T directi!:d into the
paper as shown. Suppose its shape is now changed into a circle within a time of0.5 s. Find the average induced e.m.f. and
L,
X X X X X X X X
the direction of the induced current in the :frame during this period.
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
p Q
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
XO
X X X X X X X X X x x X After0.5 s X X
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
X
In the figure, a thin metal rod PQ is placed along the x--direction and it is at right angles to a uniform magnetic field pointing X X X X X X X X X X X
into the plane ofthe paper. In which of the following cases will there be an e.mi. induced along the length ofthe metal rod?
X X X X X X X X X X X X
(1) Rotating the rod about an axis through its centre along they-direction
(2) Moving the rod in thex--dlrection average induced e.m.L / mV direction of the induced current
(3) Moving the rod in the y-<lirection
A. (1) only A 8.1 clockwise
B. (3) only B. 8.1 anticlockwise
C. (1) & (2) only c. 4.0 clockwise
D. (2) & (3) only D. 4.0 anticlockwise
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EM5-M/22
i
Ii DSE Physics - Section D : MC.
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS-M/23 i
o
67. < HKAL 2010 Paper IIA- 26 > : 69. < BKAL 2010 Paper IlA - 30 >
i
X X X X X 'X X X X X X
'
X X X X X X X X X X
X X X X
X X X X X X X X X
Q Q s X X X X
X X X X X X X J x X R
X X X X
' X X X
L
! sX X
X X X
X X X
X
X
0• X
R
X X X X X X X X X X o·
y In the above :figure, PQRSis a small rectal:!.gular metal frame suspended from a fixed point Oby a plastic string. The frame
X X X X X X X X X X X
is released from the position shown and it swings across a uniform magnetic field pointing into the paper within the dotted
rectangle. Neglect air resistance and friction. Which of the follo'Wing is/are correct '1
In the figure, PQ and R£ are two parallel metal rails with separation L. A metal rod Xf resting on the rails moves with (1) A current is induced in the frame in the direction PQRSP when it is entering the field.
velocity v peipendicular to its length across a uniform magnetic field B pointing into the paper. If the rod makes an angle of (2) The current induced in the frame is at a maximum when it passes 00 '.
30° with the rails, what is the potential difference across Q and S? (3) The direction of the magnetic force experienced by the frame is opposite to its motion when it passes 00 '.
BL, A. (1) only
A B. (1) & (2) only
oos30°
C. (2) & (3) only
B. BLv cos30 ° D. (1), (2) & (3)
yj
C. BL,
sin30° < HKAL2011 PaperIIA- 27 >
D. BLv sin30" S P
-
current-carrying wire
68. < HKAL 2009 Paper IIA-12 > □
X R Q
A Jong straight wire XY canying a steady current lies in the plane of the coil. A rectangular coil PQRS is moving to the right
with constant·speed. Which of the following gives the correct direction of the induced current in the coil and the resultant
magnetic force acting on the coil at the instant shown in the above figure '1
s direction of induced current in the coil resultant magnetic force acting on the coil
A. anti-clockwise to left
B. anti-clockwise "''
C. clockwise to left
D. clock.wise "''
71. <HKAL2011PaperIIA-31>
R
'
A bar magnet is suspended by a spring from a rigid support. It is oscillating above a hollow aluminium cylinder placed below s'
/ uniform magnetic field
72. < HKAL 2012 Paper IIA- 24 > I Part D : BKDSE examination questions
(I) (2)
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X . 75. < BKDSE Sample Paper IA- 31 >
X X X X X PX X X X X X X PX X X X R X X Q X X
X X X X X X X X X X X X X uniform
X X X X X X
---- magnetic
X X X X X X X X X X X X ➔ ficld
X X X X X X
X X
Q -- ------------------
0 X X X X X X X
Q -- ------------------
0 X X X X X
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X s X X p X X
In the above figures, a metal rod PQ making an angle 0 with the horizontal moves with speed v across a uoifonn magnetic The figure shows conducting rods PQ and RS are placed on two smooth, parallel. horizontal conducting rails. A uniform
field pointing into the paper in two different directions shown. What is the ratio of the e.m.f. induced across the rod in magnetic field is directed into the plane of the paper as shown. PQ is given an initial velocity to the right and left to roll
Figure (I) to that in Figure (2)? Which statement is INCORRECT?
A. The induced cur.rent is in the dir ection PQRS.
A. 1:sin0
B.
B. I ' sin 0
2
C.
The magnetic force acting on the rod PQ is towards the left.
Rod RS starts moving towards the right
C. sin B : I D. Rod PQ moves with a uniform speed.
D. sin20: I
76. < HI{DSE Practice Paper IA - 33 >
A square metal frame of side length L is placed inside a uniform
magnetic field B as shown. What is the change in magnetic flux x x f x
x,x x
Part C : Supplemental exercise through the frame when it is rotated about the axis � by 90° and
180° respectively?
73. A solenoid has a length of 0.30 m and cross-.sectional area of 3.2 x I0--4 m2• There are 1000 turns of wire wound on it.
'When the solenoid catties a current of 1.5 A, the magnetic flux linkage through the solenoid is 90° 180°
A 6.0 x 10-1Wb. A. 0 0
l______
78. <BKDSE2012PaperIA-32> I
-
j 81. < HKDSE 2015 Paper IA-24 >
•
p _____ Q
• .
• � magnetic field
:_ • • oftheEart:h
magnetic field
A copper rod PQ is placed horizontally as shown below. It is released and then falls vertically, cutting across the magnetic
field of the Earth pointing out ofthe paper. Neglect air resistance. Which of the following statements is/are correct?
(1) A voltage is induced across PQ.
Y,
(2) A steady induced CU1:Ient is generated in the rod.
(3) Due to the effect of the Earth's magnetic field, the copper rod falls with an acceleration less than the acceleration A rectangular metal frame is made to rotate steadily about its axisXYin a unifonn magnetic field. At the instant shown, the
due to gravity. frame is in the plane ofthe paper and side Pis moving out of the paper while side Q is moving into the paper. Which
statement is INCORRECT at this instant ?
A. (l)only
A. The induced e.m.t: in the frame is at a maxmrom.
B. (3) only
c. (1) & (2) only B. The induced cuncnt produced in the frame is flowing in anti-clockwise direction.
D. (2) & (3) only C. The magnetic force acting on sideP is in a direction pointing into the paper.
D. The magnetic forces acting on the frame produce a moment opposing the frame's rotation.
79. <BKDSE2013Paper1A-29>
A metal rod DP is rotated about O in a clockwise direction in the plane of xxxxxxxxx 1 82.. < HKDSE 2016Paper IA - 29 >
the paper with a uniform magnetic field pointing into the paper. Which
statement is correct ? xxxx xx x A student uses.a search coil to study the strength of the magnetic field inside a l�ng solenoid which is connected to an a.c.
signal generator set at a certain frequency. The search coil is connected to a CRO with time-base switched of:E When the
A. An induced current flows in the rod from O to P.
xxxxx� xx magnetic field is detected, a vertical trace on the CRO is displayed. Which of the following can improve the accuracy of this
XXXX XX . X experiment ? \
B. An induced current flows in the rod from P to 0.
xxxixxxxx (1) Rotate the plane of the search coil until the length of the vertical trace on the CRO is the maximum.
A
r�
E.m.f. is induced in the rod with end Oat a higher electric potential.
E.m.f. is induced in the rod with endP at a higher electric potential.
xxxxxxxxx
xxxxxxxxx
(2) Increase the signal generator's frequency and use the same cummt as before.
(3) Set the axis of the solenoid along an east-west direction to avoid the effects of the Earth's magnetic field.
A. (1) & (2) only
B. (1) & (3) only
80. <BKDSE2014PaperIA-27>
C. (2) & (3) only
I D. (1), (2) & (3)
N
83. <HKDSE2017h.perIA-28>
A metal rod PQ of length 1 is moving along smooth p
X X X X
T horizontal metal rails X and Y with constant speed v in a X
Figure (a) I Figurt (b)
0 uniform magnetic field of magnetic field strength B pointing
into the paper. The met.al rails X and Y are separated by a X X X X
distance of d and are connected to a resistor of resistance R R d l 1---->v
as shown. Which of the following descriptions about the X X X X
induced current is correct?
y
M magnitude direction X X
A. Blv :fromXto YthroughR
A long straight cunent-carrying wire MN and a rectangular coil PQRS are :fixed in the same plane as shown in Figure (a).
The cunent I is taken as positive when it flov,,s from M to N and it varies with time t as shown in Figure (b). The direction of
the induced current in the coil during the time interval O - Tis B. Blv from Y to X throughR
A. first anti-clockwise and then clockwise.
C. Bdv fromXto Y throughR
B. first clockwise and then anti-clockwise.
R
C. anti-clockwise throughout. Bdv
D. from ftoXthroughR
� clockwise throughout R
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. PD-EMS-M/28 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EMS-MS/01
=�-
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
�•s Matkin sScbemeis pre,pazed Qfflhe maikers' It showd .not be :regardi,das a setof:snodel answers.
·84. <HKDSE2017PaperIA-27> Studen:tsand t:eac: hel::avhoueno· :ib.v , QW.in'the-markingproc.ess are.advised to.lllft:Il)tettbe Matking:Scheme'With care.
A metal disc is rotating about its centre C with constant speed. Part of the metal disc is inside a uniform magnetic fiel
'
pointing into the paper as shown. AD. eddy current flows in the metal disc. 'M.C. Answers
D]. I 1. B 2!. D 3!. D 41. D SI. D
·2. D 12. D 22.f 32. C 42. B 52. D
3. A 13. A 23. A 33. B 43. D 53. D
4. D !4. D 24. C 34. D 44. A 54. A
X X X X X X X s. B JS. A 2S. C JS. D 4S. A 55. D
After which of the following changes will the eddy current increase?
i 6. B !6. B 26. A 36. D 46. D S6. Ii
A. Reverse the direction of the magnetic field B. Increase the strength of the magnetic field
7. B !7. D 27. A 37. D 47. D 57. D
s. C !8. A 28. A 38. C 48. B 58. A
'9. B !9. B 29. D 39. C 49. A S9. C
IO. C 20. C 30. B 40. D so. D 60. D
Q) Since commutator is used, itis a d.c. generator, thus the current always flows in the same direction.
✓ (2) !he maximum current depends on the induced voltage which depends on the rotational speed ofthe coil.
f"alling hollow
magnet aluminium tube
When a small strong magnet falls through a hollow aluminium tube as shown. eddy c!D'mll.s are
induced. Which of the following oom:ctly dcscnl>es the mction cf current induced in the tube when
-viewed by an observer :from above 7
3. A 9. B
Dynamo (generator) changes the mechanical energy of the rotating coil into electrical energy ofinduced current Peak voltage : Vo "" 2 cm x 10 V cm·1 "" 20 V
4. D
Peakcmrent: 1., = "t =
5
:�o' = 4mA
10. C
✓ (1) When Sis closed, current flows in primary coil to give magnetic field lines directed towards the right.
Current is induced in secondacy coil from P to Q through R
to give magnetic field lines directed towards the left to oppose the change.
(1) By Right-hand .rule, current should flow from D to C thr ough P.
✓ (2) When S remains closed, there is no change of current, thus there is no change of magnetic field,
✓ (2) By Right-hand rule, induced current flows from B to A through Q.
therefore, no current is induced in the secondary coiL
✓ (3) By Faraday's Law, induced voltage (e.m.f) is setup across AB where e = B v 1.
(3) When Sis opened, cummt stops flowing in the primary coil and the magnetic field decreases to zero.
Current is induced in the secondary coil from Q to P through R
s. B to give magnetic field lines directed towards the right to oppose the change.
When the switch Sis closed, current starts to flow in the solenoid
which produces amagnetic field with N-pole at the left hand side. B
An induced current would then flow in coil.XY to oppose the change such that the pole at Y is North. As commutator is used, it is a d.c. generator,
The two solenoids thus experience opposing magnetic forces so the coil would move away from the solenoid. d.c. generator gives a vmying de. voltage (unsteady voltage) as shown in option B.
6. B
12. D
Peakvoltage: Vp=05Vcm-1 x3cm= 1.5V
(1) A d.c. generator is a de. sourcebut it produces varying d.c. voltages.
Period: T = 1 ms cm-1 x4cm = 4ms
✓ (2) All a.c. sources wo uld give out current with changing d irections.
Frequency: f = l.. = _l_3 = 250 Hz
T 4xl0- ✓ (3) Both d .c. and a.c. give heating effect by P"" 12 R.
7. B 13. A
Figure (1): As the N-pole of magnet moves towards the ring, N-pole is induced at the upper end ofthe ring, At the time shown, when N-pole of the magnet moves away from the right hand side ofthe core,
thus the induced current is in anticlockwise direction observed by the eye. S-pole is induced on the right hand side ofthe core, thus induced current flows fromP to Q through.R.
Figure (2): As the magnet is inside the ring, there is no change of magnetic field , thus there is no induced current. After half of a cycle, when N-pole ofthe magnet moves away from the left hand side ofthe core,
S-pole is induced on the left hand side ofthe core, thus induced current flows from Q to P throughR in reverse direction.
Figure (3): As the S-pole of magnet moves away from the ring, N-pole is induced at the lower end of the ring,
thus the induced current is in clockwise direction.
14. D
8.
X A. microphone : sound energy ➔ electrical energy
C
In Figure 1, as the S -pole of magnet moves towards the coil (solenoid) from the left, X B. loudspeaker: electrical energy ➔ sound energy
the left side ofthe coil is induced to be S-pole, X C. dynamo : mechanical energy ➔ electrical energy
and the induced current flows through the galvanometer and d eflects to the left. ✓ D. motor: electrical energy ➔ mechanical energy
In Figure 2, as the N-pole of magnet moves towards the coil (solenoid) from the right,
15. A
the right side of the coil is induced to be N-pole, that means the left side of the coil is induced to be S-pole,
thus the induced current flows in the same direction as Figure l, As the trace of the signal is a line, it is an a.c. voltage.
and as the magnet moves at a faster rate, the induced current is greater and is more than 10 µA. Peak voltage: Vo = 1 cm x 1 Vcnr-1 = 1 V
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMS-MS/04 DSE Physics - Section D : MC. Solution PD-EMS-MS/05
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
16. B 22. C
Peak voltage = 2 cm x 0.5 V cm- 1 = 1 V A. As they move away from each other, the left side of the solenoid should be induced in N-pole,
1
thus induced current should flow from left to right through the galvanometer.
Period: T = 4cmx lOmscm- = 40ms
B. As the solenoid moves away from the magnet, the left side of the solenoid should be induced in S-pole,
Frequency: f = ..!. = __l_ = 25 Hz thus induced current should flow from right to left through the galvanometer.
T 40x10 -3
✓ C. As the solenoid moves towards the magnet, the left side oftbe solenoid should be induced with S-pole,
thus induced current flows from right to left through the galvanometer.
17. D
D. As the magnet moves towards the solenoid, the left side of the solenoid should be induced with N-pole,
✓ A. A bicycle dynamo gives induced voltage, which is an application ofelectromagnetic induction. thus induced current should flow from left to right through the galvanometer.
✓ B. When a magnetic tape moves across a playback head, a.c. current is induced.
✓ c. When sound wave is incident onto a microphone, the coil is set into vi'bration :inside a magnetic field, 23. A
thus a.c. cur.rent is induced. (i) When the magnet is approaching, an induced voltage is set up in the solenoid.
D. Loudspeaker makes use of the magnetic force produced by the current inside a magnetic field. @ When the magnet is inside the solenoid, no induced voltage is set up.
@ When the magnet is leaving, an induced voltage is set up in the solenoid but in the opposite direction.
18. A
When R moves towards P, the resistance of RQ increases, 24. C
Period (or :frequency) depends on the a.c. source, thus it remains unchanged.
s R
19. B
When the ring moves towards the magnet at.X: cunent is induced so that the lower side of the ring is N-pole.
When the ring moves away from the magnet at Y, cunent is induced so that the upper side of the ring is N-pole. I,
By using Right hand grip rule, the induced current in both cases can be determined. When Sis just closed, the current through coilPproduces a magnetic :field downwards and upwards through Q.
In order to oppose the change of magnetic field, coil Q induces a cunent which produces a magnetic field in oPPosite
20. direction (downwards), thus by Right hand grip rule, the current through R is in upward direction.
C
✓ Rotating the coil at a greater speed can increase the rate of change of magnetic flux, When Sis just opened, current through coil P suddenly stops flowing,. thus the magnetic field through Q decreases.
(1)
thus induced voltage by the generator increases. In order to oppose the change of magnetic field, coil Q induces a cut:rent which produces a magnetic :field :in the same
direction, thus the induced current should be opposite to that when Sis closed.
(2) Reducing the resistance can increase the induced CUlTellt,
but the resistance would not affect the induced voltage.
✓ A coil of greater area contains more magnetic flux, thus the induced voltage increases. 25. C
(3)
When the coil just enters the field region, an induced current flows in anticlockwise direction{+).
When the coil moves inside the field region, there is no induced current
21. D Metal rod
x/ When the coil just leaves the field region, an induced current flows in clockwise direction (-).
The induced current in the metal rod flows from left to right. X X X J X
27. A 33. B
Since the time base is !Oms per cm and the time for one cycle is 10 cm X (I) When the switch is closed, only a pulse of induced current flows momentarily through the ammeter.
period T = 10 cm x 10 ms cm- 1 = 100 ms ✓ (2) At the moment the switch is opened, an induced current flows through the ammeter momentarily.
29. D 35. D
Since the bar magnet is moving towards the coil, :induced current flows to oppose the change. When the magnet is at the right side and moving towards the solenoid,
The top of the coil becomes South-pole due to the induced current. as N-pole is induced at Q, thus endX should be N-pole, as opposing forces should exist between them.
Action and reaction pair then exists between the magnet and the coil. When the magnet is at the left side and moving away from the solenoid,
For the magnet, an upward force acts on it by the coil. as end Yis S-pole which is leaving, endP should become N-pole as attraction forces should exist between them.
For the coil, a downward force acts on it by the magnet
The reading of the balance is then greater due to the dovmward force on the coil 36. D
The top of the solenoid is S-pole and the bottom is N-pole, by Right hand screw rule.
30. B As the ring moves towards the solenoid atX, by Lenz's law, to oppose the change,
By Right hand rule, the induced current in the rod is from Q to P, a current is induced so that the bottom of the ring is S-pole, and by Right hand screw rule,
X
(1)
thus current through the galvanometer is fro� R to Q. the induced current is in anticlockwise direction observed by the eye.
X (2) If the magnetic field is reversed, the direction of the induced current would reverse. When the ring is at Y, as there is no change of magnetic field, thus no current is induced at Y.
However, the opposing force is still towards the left, and the rod should still move in unifonn speed.
37. D
✓ (3) Since the direetion ofthe induced cunent is reversed,
the pointer of the galvanometer should deflect to the opposite direction. X (I) Since the rod is moving with uniform spe� its kinetic energy remains unchanged.
✓ (2) By Right hand rule, the induced C1UTent flows from Q to P, then flows from S to R through the resistor.
31. D ✓ (3 ) If the rod moves to left, by Right hand rule, the induced cwrent flows from P to Q through the rod.
X (1) The current delivered to the load by a d.c. generator is an unsteady d..c., thus the current is not constant.
✓ (2) Due to the commutator, cummt delivered to the load is a d..c., i.e. the �nt flows in one direction only. 38. C
✓ (3) By use ofthe Right hand rule, the induced current in the coil is in anticlockwise direction,
and thus the current flows fromXto Ythrough the load.
s = �(N<l>)
.,
= !!..!!'.:::!!. = !!.!!_
32. C
XX XX
By Right hand rule: xxxx
xxxx 39. C
induced current flows upwards in the left wire. X X
-to,right The magnetic flux through the coil k is equal to the magnetic flux through the coil Li,
By Left hand rule : XX XX as both of the contams the same number of magnetic field lines inside the solenoid..
xxxx
this current gives a magnetic force towards the left. XX XX
Thus,both of them induce the same e.m.f ofl2 V.
_ DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMS-MS/OS DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM5-MS/09
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
40. D 46. D
An e.m.f. is induced from P to Q as PQ cuts the magnetic field lines. In the position shown, there is no cutting of magnetic field lines, thus no induced currenL
Similarly , an e.m.£ is also induced from S to R as SR cut the magnetic field lines.
As the frame moves, during the time interval that theleft wire of the frame cuts across the magnetic field,
Since there is no net e.m.f. in the circuit, thus no induced current flows in the loop.
current is induced upwards and flows in the frame in c lockwise direction, which is negative,
and since the frame moves with Ullllorm velocity, the induced current is constant.
41. D
The magnetic field due to the magnet is perpendicularly into paper.
47. D
At the right hand s ide of the magnet, the disc moves from a region without field to a region with magnetic field,
When the switch Sis suddenly closed, current flows in loop Pin anticlockwise direction.
to oppose the change. eddy current is induced in anticlockwise direction to produce magnetic field out ofpaper.
As the current in the right wire of loop Pis upwards, it then produces a magnetic field into paper at loop Q.
At the left hand si& oftbe magnet, the disc moves from a region with magnetic field out to a re gion without field,
to oppose the change, eddy current is induced in clockwise direction to produce magnetic field into paper. When loop Q suddenly experiences a magnetic field into paper,
a current is induced in anticlockwise direction so as to produce a magnetic field out of pa per to oppose the change.
42. B Asthe current in the right wire ofloop P is upwards and the current in the left wire ofloop Q is downwardll,
For a solenoid:B= µ.N I repulsive force occurs between them as currents in owosite directions repel each other.
4> =BA::: µ.
'
NI
.A Forthe samelength.ofwireformingthe doubleloop:21tr = 2(21tr') :. r' = r/2
The radius of the new loop is halved, thus the area of the new loop becomes one-quarter.
Flux linkage =
( 41txl0-1)(1000)(1.5)
= (0.3)
_(3.2xl 0-4) NBA cc NA
As N ➔ '1N and A ➔ ¼ A, the flux linkage becomes ½ $
=2.0xlO...s Wb
43. D 49. A
Frequency ofthe voltage is equal to the rotational frequency of the coil, thus the fre quency increases. ✓ (1) = B-�
"'
e = ;il'J) = BvL cc L
t,J t,J
Peak vol tage is proportional to the rotational speed of the coil, thus the amplitude increases.
(2) By Right�hand rule, induced e.m.f. is from Q to P, thus P is at a higher potential
44. A (3) As the circuit is not complete , there is induced e.m.f. but no induced current,
thus no magnetic force acts on the rod to oppose its motion.
When the bar magnet moves towards the solenoid, induced current in the coil is in one direction.
When the bar magnet moves away from the solenoid, induced current is in the opposite direction.
50. D
Ocly the graph in option A shows that the induced cur:rents are in two directions, thw; it is the answer. ✓ If the resistivity of the ring is smaller, then the resistance of the ring is smaller,
(1)
thus greater eddy CUIIent can be induced in the ring and the ring would float at a greater height.
45. A ✓ (2) If the density of the ring is smaller, then the mass or weigh t of the ring would be smaller,
Note that only the small loop contains magnetic field. thus the same upward ma gnetic force due to eddy current would make the ring float at a greater height
Thus, in calculating the magnetic flux: ct> = BA, the area A should be the smaller loop. ✓ (3) If the fr equen cy ofthe a.c. increases , then the rate of change of magnetic flux in the coil increases,
thus greater eddy current is induced, and the ring would float at a greater height
By e = ii!l> = AM
t,J 6t
""20 X 104 V (1) Resistance would not affect the flux linkage of a coil.
As the magnetic field is decreasing, to oppose the change., ✓ (2) Flux linkage is proportional to the number oftums of the coil.
the induced cm:rent would produce a magnetic field in the same direction, that is, into paper, ✓ Since the magnetic flux through a coil depends on the component of the magnetic field through the coil,
(3)
thus, the induced current is in clockwise direction. the angle would affect the flux linkage of the coil.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMS-MS/10 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EMS-MS/11
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
52. D 58. A
✓ (!) When th e magnet moves towards copper, the copper experiences a change in magnetic field, M
(j) 6 : A oc A il) R = pt oc t
thus eddy current is induced in the copper disc. A
✓ (2) As eddy current is induced, the current produces a heating effect, thus temperature increases. J=!.oc:'!-..
✓ The eddy current .flows in the direction to give a repulsive force to oppose the motion of the magnet. R l
(3)
le _ Ac. f 8 _ (1tr2) _ {4x2,j _
1
I� As Pc (2r) 2 (21t r)
53. D
• (!) It gives no change ofmagnetic flux through the coil, thus no e.m.f. is induced.
59. C
✓ (2) The flux through the coil changes to zero, thus e.m.f. is induced.
(j) When the coil is at the left and moves to the right,
✓ (3) The flux through the coil changes, thus e.nt..f. is induced
the coil experiences an increase ofmagnetic flux out of paper.
In order to oppose the change, a clockwise cun:en.t is induced to produce a magnetic field into paper.
54. A
✓
"' When the coil is justabove the wire,
(!) By Right-hand rule, indu.ced current flows fromB to C, and then to D and A in clockwise direction. the coil experiences a change of magnetic flux from out of paper to into paper.
(2) The induced e.m.f. is from B to C, thus C is at a higher potential. In order to oppose the change, an anticlockwise cnrren.t is induced to produce a magnetic field out ofpaper.
Side ADisnot in the magnetic field, it eXperiences no magnetic force. When the coil is at the right andmoves to the right,
(3)
the coil experieo.ces an decrease ofmagnetic flux into paper.
In order to oppose the change, a clockwise current is induced to produce a magnetic field into paper.
55. D
h.(1)
s "" N == � 60. D
f,J t
The secondary coil is a search coil which gives the peak voltage by Vo = 2 nfN Bo A
s depends onN,B,A, tonly
✓ A. /t ⇒ v,t
& is independent of the resistance ofthe coil.
✓ B. Nt ⇒ Vot
63. B 69. A
Tota.lpower consumedbythetwo lamps = 6+6 = 12W ✓ (1) When the frame enters the field, to oppose the cliange,
Current passittgtbrough eachlamp = £ = 0.5 A the frame induces a c:unent in anticlockwise direction to produce a magnetic field out of paper,
12 thus the induced current is in the directionPQRSP.
Power dissipated by the internal resistance of the generator = 12 r = (0.5 + 0.5)2 (2) = 2 W (2) There is no induced current when it passes 00' as there is no change of magnetic flux.
Perctntage of power dissipated by the lamps = �xlOO¾ = 85.7% = 86% (3) As there is no induced current when it passes 00 ', there is no magnetic force acting on the frame.
12+2
70. C
64. B
Direction of magnetic field due to the current along XYis into the paper by Right hand grip rule.
(1) There is no cutting of magnetic flux when the rod rotates about the axis along y.
As the coil moves away, the strength of B gradually decreases and thus the flux also decreases.
(2) By right.hand-rule, the induced e.m.t: isbetween the top and the bottom of the rod, not along the rod.
To oppose the change, the coil induces a current in clockwise direction to produce a flux into the paper.
✓ (3) By right-hand-rule, there is an induced e.m.f along the length ofthe rod.
Since the induced cunent along RS is upwards, the magnetic force between XY and RS is attractive,
thus the magnetic � on the coil is to left.
65. D
When the field moves away, at the left hand side of the field, the metal there experiences the loss of the field.
71. D
To oppose the change, current is induced in clockwise diteciion to produce a magnetic field into paper.
(1) The cunent is from S to R, by Left band rule, the magnetic force should be downwards.
The eddy current should be at the edge of the field, since the change ocCUIS there.
✓ (2) Magnetic force on RS is downwards and force onPQ is upwards, they fonn a couple to give a moment
✓ (3) There is no magnetic field lines passing perpendicularly through the loop, thus the flux is zero.
66. B
By Lenz's law, to oppose the change, the induced current acts to give a magnetic field out of paper.
74. B
Thus the induced current flows in anticlockwise direction.
✓ (1) By Right band rule, B is into paper, I is downwards, thus, motion is leftwards.
67. C (2) By Right hand rule, induced e.m.L is downwards from low to high potential.
Potential difference across Q and S indl.lced e.m.f: along the rod between QS Thus, potential of Bis higher than that ofA.
Bvl = BvL ( l is the length of the rod) ✓ (3) By Left hand rule, Bis into paper, I is downwards, thus, magnetic force Fis rightwards.
°
sin3O OR
For induced current, magnetic force must oppose motion, thus magnetic force is rightwards.
68. B
76. D 81. B
The flux through the metal frame: rJ> = BA = B L2 ✓ A. The two sides of the frame P and Qare moving pe.tpendicularly to cut the magnetic field lines,
When the frame is rotated by 90 °, the flux changes fromB L2 to zero, thus the change isBL 2• thus the induced e.m.f.is at a maximun:i. at this instant.
When the frame is rotated by 180°, the flux changes fromB L2 to -B L2, thus the change is 2B L2 • • B Consider the sideP, it is moving out ofpaper. The direction of magnetic field is towards the left.
By Right hand rule, the induced current inP is in upward direction.
77. B The induced current in Q is in downward direction.
The!Cfore, the induced current in the frame should be in clockwise direction.
When the square metal frame moves the distance L into the field region, current is induced.
✓ C. Whenever there is induced current, there must be a magnetic force opposite to the m otion.
When the square metal frame moves inside the field region, no current is induced.
As Pis moving out of paper, the magnetic force onP is into the paper.
When the square metal frame moves the distznceL away from the field region, cllirCJlt is induced. ✓ D. The magnetic force on Pis into the paper and that on Q is out of the paper.
Thus the total time that current is induced = d = 2L These two magnetic forces form a moment to oppose the rotation of the frame.
V V
78. A 82. A
✓ (!) By Right hand rule, an e.m.f. or voltage is induced across PQ. ✓ (!) Rotate the search coil so that the search coil has different orientation angle with the magnetic field.
• CZ) As the rod is not a complete circuit, there is no current.
"When the vertical trace on the CRO is rnax:immn, the plane of the search coil is petpendicular to the field.
• (3) Since there is no current, there is no opposing m agnetic force, thus the rod falls with acceleration g.
If the vertical trace is not the maximum. the search coil only measures a component of the field.
✓ CZ) Since the induced voltage is proportional to the frequency of the a.c., high.er fuquency gives longer trace,
79. D thus, percentage error of the length ofthe trace is reduced, and accuracy is improved.
Since the rod is isolated, there is no complete circuit, thus there is no induced cumnt • (3) The Earth's magnetic field would not affect the experiment,
By Right hand rule, the induced e.m.f is from Oto P, thus the endP is at a higher electric potential, as search coil cannot detect steady magnetic field such as that of the Earth.
as induced e.m.f. points from low to high potential
83 . C
80. D By using Right hand rule, indllced cumnt flows upwatds along the rod, thus it flows fromXto Ythrough R.
From t= 0 to T/2, the current is positive and flows from MtoN. Since only the length d ofthe rod can have current flow, induced cunent is B d v IR.
N
By Right hand grip rule, themagne6c field in the coilPQR.S
due to Iis directed into paper. magnetic fieldB
p �ueto �t / 84. B
As current is decreasing, magnetic :field B in the coil is decreasing. · X X
IS deccea.smg
• A. Reverse the direction of magnetic field can only reverse the direction of eddy current,
Byleru:'s law, to oppose the change of magnetic field, I � but cannot increase the magnitude of eddy ewtent.
the coil induces a cWTentto give aB-field in same direction, xx
magnetic field ✓ B. Increase the strength oftbe magnetic field can increase the rate of change of magnetic flux,
thus, theB-field by the induced current is also into the paper. Q R due to induced
cuxrertt in the coil thus, the induced eddy current increases.
By Right hand grip rule, the induced current in the coil is in • c When the whole disc is inside the magnetic field, there is no change of magnetic flux,
clockwise direction of PSRQ. M
thus, no eddy current is induced.
From t"" T/2 to T, the current is negative and flows fromNto M. N • D. Cut several slits give lamination that will reduce the induced eddy cun:ent.
The magnetic field in the coil PQRS due to I is directed out of paper. magnetic field B
As eurrent is increasing;, magnetic fieldB in the coil is increasing. P ?u_e toc�tJ 85. D
..
1sm�g
• As the magnet moves down along the aluminium tubing,
By �•slaw, to oppose the change,
the coil induces a current to give aB-field in opposite direction
I B:X the alumiDium experiences a change of magnetic flux of the magnet,
thus, the B-field due to the induced cutrent is into the paper. magnetic field thus, eddy current is induced in the alumfn.ium tubing.
Q R due to induced
By Right hand grip rule, the induced CWTent in the coil is in =t in the coil As eddy current is induced, there is an opposing magnetic force acting on the magnet
clockwise direction ofPSRQ. M Thus the net downward force acting on the magnet is less than mg, its down-ward acceleration is less thang,
In conclusion, the induced current in the coil is in clockwise direction throughout the time interval. therefore, the magnet drops slower.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
I
2. < HKCE 1981 Paper I- 7 >
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS-QI 0211
�,
A light rectangular conducting loop EFGH moves from left to right with mrifoxm velocity across a uniform magnetic field
-
Induced e.m.f.
....
e = N t,.<ll pointing into paper. Figure1, 2 and 3 show three subsequent positions of theloop during its lllOtion.
g,:
" " " " < < < <
)�
Force on a current-carrying conductor in a magnetic field F=Bllsin.0
• <
Use the following data wherever necessary: (a) What can you say about the induced current in each of the three cases shown in Figure 1, 2 and 3 ? (3 marks)
(a) In the figure shown below, sketch a graph to show how the induced voltage varies with time when the coil is turned
through one revolution, starting: with the plane of the coil lying parallel to the field. (2 marks)
Induced voltage
(a) From the wave pattem obtained, estimate the peak voltage of the input signal. (1 mark)
{b) Estimate the time taken for the spot on the screen to produce a complete cycle.
(b) The generator is used to deliver a d.c. cur.rent. What modification to the generator is necessary to enable this to be
done 1 (2 marks) (c) What is thefrequencyoftheinputsignal?
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS-Q/03
,,J{i,�r-- \
directions indicated. Neglect the effect ofthe Earth's magnetic field.
solenoid ✓ llVL
iron ,-,c;.;+-H-+H+H-+-,
"'" X
(a) Sketch on the diagram above, the magnetic field pattern near endX and end Y.
(a) Descn'be briefly with the aid of a diagram how the alternating current generator can be converted into a direct current
generator. (4 marks)
Indicate
(b) What happens to the neutral point in each of the following cases :
(i) the iron core is taken out of the solenoid at the left hand, and, Cl =kl
(b) Sketch a graph ofthe output voltage of the a.c. generator against time. Indicate on the time axis ofyour graph the times
at which
(i) the plane of the coil is parallel to the magnetic :field (using the letter H), and
(ii) the plane of the coil is perpendicular to the magnetic field (using the letter V). {5 m arks)
(n) the battery is replaced by a centJ:e..zero galvanometer? (2 =rl<,)
(,)
~----spiral spring
pointer----tt➔·-t---:(
N
11�----- magnet
(a) Draw a diagratn to :indicate the directions of motion ofthe wire, ofthe tnagneti.c field and of the induced current (if any)
(i) if the wire is moving quickly upwards.
A student sets up an apparatus as shown in the above figure and claims that it can be used to measure a current flowing from
(ii) if the wire is moving quickly sideways towards the north pole. tenninal A to B through the solenoid.
Descnlle briefly what happens to the galvanometer pointer in each case. (6nwks)
(a) (i) Explain why this set-up can be used to measure current. (3nwks)
(i )
(i.11 Suggest TWO methods to increase the sensitivity of the set-up. (2marks)
(it) (ill) Can this set-up still measure current if the magnet is replaced by a soft iron bar 7 Explain briefly.
(b) A andB are now connected to a centre-zero galvanometer. The magnet is set to viotate up and down. It is kept out of
the solenoid Is there any cur.rent passing through the solenoid when the magnet
F"ignrel
A bar magnet is pushed with constant speed from left to right through a solenoid as shown in Figure 1. Descdbe the
change in the direction of the CUitent passing tbrough the galvanometer during the motion of the magnet (3 matks)
(b)
R j
(a) What is the name of the parts labelled
(i) A, \R
I" /
(Li) B, and p
(iii) C? '=
I= f
Figwe 2 Figure 3
Figure 2 shows the structure of a simple a.c. generator. A voltage is induced when the coil is set into rotation. The
(b) Sketch the variation of the output current against time and determine the direction of the current passing through the output ofthegcneratoris displayed on a CRO as shown in Figure 3. The time base of the CRO is set at 20 ms cm- 1 and
resistor R at the momer,t shown in the figure. (3 marks) Y-gainat SOmV cm-1.
(i) Which points (P, Q, R and S) shown inFigure 3 correspond to instants at which the plane of the coil is parallel to
the magnetic .field? ( 2 m arks)
{it) Find the peak voltage and :frequency of the output of the generator. (3 awk,)
(c) Yon are given a voltmeter and an ammeter. Draw a circuit diagram to show how they can be used to measure the power
output by the generator. (3 marks)
(iii) Describe what happens to the peak voltage and frequency of the output of the generator in each of the following
cases:
(1) Increasing the speed ofrotation ofthe coil.
(2) Winding the coil on a soft-iron core. (4 m,rk,)
(d) The ctllW3t output is 0.7 A when the voltage betweenXY is 12 V. Determine the power output by the generator at that
moment (2 marks)
(e) State TWO advantages and TWO disadvantages of using wind to generate electrical energy. (4 marks)
(Iv) Steam is commonly used to drive generators in power statiOllS to generate electricity. Suggest two other practical
means of driving generators. (2 marks)
I DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-
EM
5 -Q
/ 09 I I DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-E
M 5- /
Q 10 I
10. < HKCE 1998 Paper I - 5 > 11. < HKCE 2002 Paper I- 6 >
Aluminium ring
paper cone
A soft-iron rod is inserted into a solenoid AB, which is connected to a battery and a switch Sas shown in the above figure.
InitiallySis open. An aluminium ring i s also inserted into the rod and placed beside the solenoid. Sis now closed.
The Figure above shows a type of motor. PQ and RS are solenoids. The solenoids and the coil ABCD are connected in
parallel to a battery. (b) Explain why the aluminium ring will move away from the solenoid. {3 marks)
(a) State
(i) the polarity at end Q ofthe solenoid PQ,
(11) the direction ofrotation of the coil as seen by the observer. (2uwks)
(d) A student says "If the battery in the above Figure is replaced by a SO Hz a.c. supply, the coil will only oscillate to and
fro. Hence the motor will not function properly."
Explain why the student is incorrect. (4marks)
(e) Desmibe, with the h elp of a diagram, how the motor in the above Figure can be converted to a <lirect current generator.
Figurel Figure2
(3 mmks)
(a) Name two essential.components ofa motor.
(b) Explain why the bulb lights up when the blades are turning. (3 marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMS-Q/11 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMS-Q/12
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
13. < HKCE 2008 Paper I" 11 > 14. < BI(CE 2010 Paper I" 13 >
A student uses the setup in Figure 1 to study the current induced in a solenoid when a magnet is falling through it 'When a A hand•shaken torch does not require any battezy. Shaking it for a short while will produce a current and give out bright
cutren:t is passing through the current sensor from A to B, a positive reading is obtained Figure 2 shows the result after the light. Figure I shows the structure of the torch.
magnet is released at a certain height
Figure I
(a) Describe how current is produced in the fixed coil when the torch is shaken. (2marks)
(b) Explain why the reading of the induced current is negative when the magnet leaves the solenoid. (3 marks)
{d) In another design as shown in Figure 2, the fixed coil covers the whole length of the path ofthe movable magnet It is
found that the torch becomes dimmer than the original design when operating it in the same way. Explain briefly. (The
resistance of the fixed coil can be neglected.) (2 marks)
Figure2
(c) Explain why the magnitude of"negative peak" is greater than that of"positive peak''. (2 marks)
light emitting rubber cushion
emitting
component
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS-Q/131
(iii) The heat capacity of the ring is 7 .8 J K-1 and its temperature is found to rise from 25°C to 40°C during the first 50 s
Figtae 1 Figure2 when the a.c. supply is on. Find the average rate of increase in internal energy of the ring. (2 marks)
A centre.zero galvanometer A is connected in series with a resistor, R. and a 1.5 V cell as shown in Figure 1. The pointer of
A deflems to the left. The galvanometer is now connected to a coil as shown in Figure 2 When a bar magnet is moved with
uniform speed by a student towards the coil. the pointer ofA deflects to the right.
(a) On Figure 2, indicate the direction of the induced cumnt in the coiland also the poles of the bar magnet. (2 marks)
(b) Where does the electrical energy in the circuit come from ? (lm..-k)
17. <HKAL2000Paperl-7>
(a) In the figure below, there are two parallel wires carcying currents in opposite dttections. The current in the left wire is
perpendicularly out ofpaper while the cwrent in the rlgbtwire is perpendicularly into paper. Sketch in the space below
the magnetic field pattern around the two wires. (2 marks)
(c) Suggest THREE waY5 to increase the deflection ofA. (2 marks)
0
16. < HKAL 1996Paper I- 7 >
retort stand
(b) In the figure below, if the current flowing through both wires is 5 A and the separation between them is 0.05 m, find the
rn
d.c. supply magnitude of the resultant magnetic field due to these two wires at pointX, which is 0.02 m from wire Q. (2 marks)
A coil and a retort stand made of iron are arranged as shown. The coil is connected to a d.c. supply via a switch S. Wben the
switch is pressed on, the allllllinium ring placed on top of the coil jumps up momentarily and then falls back to the top of the ----◄ X
coil. 0.02m
(a) Briefly explain this observation. (3 marks)
Q
0.05m
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMS-Q/15 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMS-Q /16
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
17. (c) Two long parallel current-carrying wires are now connected to a signal generator giving out a.c. current. A search coil 19. < HKAL 2001 Paper I- 4 >
connected to a CR.O is used to investigate the magnetic field around the two wires. With the time base of the CRO
The figure below shows a solenoid of diameter 5.0 cm and length 50 cm. The solenoid has 1000 tums and it carries a
switched off; a vertical trace is observed on the screen of the CR.O.
steady current of 60 mA.
----soon---+
solenoid
(a) Calculate the magnetic field strength at the centre O of the solenoid. (2marks)
(i) Explain what is represented by the length ofthe trace observed on the CRO. (2 marks) (b) Calculate the magnetic flux fulkage through the solenoid.
(ii) Explain whether the :measurement of the magnetic field by the se3Ich coil would be affected by the Earth'sll:laglletic
field. (2 marks)
X X X X
I .
20km
X l Not to scale
X X
cable
X
/j
X X X X
The coil is tumed through 90° by an extema1 force until its pl.an.e is pexpcndicular to the magnetic field.
shu�
X X
(a) Would the coil resist bclng turned? Explain briefly.
X X X X X
(c) The coil is now fixed with its plane perpendicular to the magnetic field. The flux density of the field is increased at a
uniform rate of0.3 T s-1 • Find the magnitude of the current induced in the coil. (3 marks)
(b) Find the e.m.£ induced across the cable. State one assumption that yau have made in the calculation. (3 marks)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMS-Q/17 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EMS-Q/18
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
retort stand
(uon)
"''"" aluminium low voltage
ring d.c. supply
connecting
The bulb lights up when the blades are turned rapidly. Explain why and state the energy conversion talcing place in this t=,lnru,
process. (4marks)
light-beam
galvanometer
conducting wire
slab-shaped magnets
on steel yoke (b) Descnbe what would be observed if the experiment in part (a) is repeated with
(ii) a low voltage a.c. supply and an aluminium ring with a slit cut through it as shown [ 0 ]. (1 muk)
24.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
I
24. (b) (i)
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS-Q/20
State the direction of the magnetic field ( to the left/ to the right/ into paper/ out of paper) produced at point Oby
the lightning current. Estimate the magnetic field strength's peak value at 0.
I
(.3 ma:rks)
thundercloud
(i.l.J Explain why within the very short duration of lightning, an induced cumnt :first flows in the coil in a certain
direction and then reverses. Your answer should include the directions of the induced current in the coil.
(3 ""'1<,)
induced charges dl lightning =nt (iii) Among the physical C(Ualltities related to lightning, electric fiel� in the atmo �here, ligh�g cu �t :m,d
magnetic field due to lightning, suggest which one can be morutored so as to give fore-warmng of lightnm g.
'½ground Explain your c hoice. {2 marks)
++++++++++++++++
Lightning occurs when diarges accumulate in the clouds to such an extent that the electric :field in the atmosphere is
strong enough to cause the air to Jose its insulating properties. The threshold electric field for 'breakdown' to occur is
about 3 x 10s V m-1 above which electrons or ions in the atmosphere can pass through the air between clouds and the
ground or between clouds and clouds. The peak cummt ofa typical lightning bolt can reach about 30 000 A. How the
charges are separated and accumulated in the clouds is not fully understood yet. In most cases, negative charges are at
the base of the cloud and positive charges are induced on the ground.
�,�� : . · 1· . . •:.!
25. < HKDSE 2018 Paper m - 9 >
p/""________
(a) (i) What is the meaning of'breakdown' in the passage? (I """")
magnetic J 1
:'' . . . . . .:''
fieldB�• • • • •
: L --i,,V : resistor
(ii) The thundercloud's base and the ground can be modeled as two parallel plates with opposite charges. If the
negative charges distributed at the cloud's base are about d = 2 k:tn from the ground, find the potential difference
between the cloud and the ground when the electric field in the atmosphere just reaches the threshold of
' I •
' e • e e el
L------------ _____________ J
-wn•. (2 ""'1<,)
Q '---�-----
The Figure above shows a metal rod PQ of length L moving with constant velocity v across a uniform magnetic fieldB
pointing out of the paper. An e.m.f? is induced across rodPQ as it cuts the field lines. When the rod is connected to a
resistor outside the field, a current I flows in the circuit.
A lightning detector having a small square coil inside is placed at point O which is 1.S Ian from the lightning bolt The coil
and the lightning's direction are in the same vertical plane as shown. Assume that the lightning current flows verticaily (i) Indicate the direction of/in the above Figure. (I mark)
upwards to the thundercloud from the ground.
(ti) Explain why an external force Fis required to maintain the uniform motion of rod PQ. Find Fin terms of the
/ Diagram NOT drawn to scale physical quantities given. (3 matks)
square coil
u
pw.u-d �
lightning 1.Slan----a
(iii) This set-up works as a generator, By considering the mechanical power input by external force F to the set-up,
eumnt
show that ? =BL v. (2 marks)
ground
I
25.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS -Q /2111
(b) At a certain place the Earth's magnetic field runs along the S-N llirection such that the field lines make an angle 0 with
the horizontal as shown inFigure (a) .
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution
EM5 : EJectromagnetic Induction
PD-EMS-QS/01
BKEAA's Maik:ing Scheme is im,pa:red for the marker.s' refe:rcnce. It should not be regarded as a set of model answers.
Students and t.eachets who are not involved in the marldng process are ad'Vised to interpl'etthe Marking Schemewithcare.
X Question Solution
Earth's magnetic field
NO !. (a) Induced voltage
�
horizontal
• t
Referring to (a)(ili), calculate the e.m.f: induced acrossXY and state whether the distribution of free electrons along
the mast is more at end X, more at end Y or uniform along XY. (3 marks)
(b) In figure 1, an applied force along1:he direction ofmotion is required to maintain the motion ofthe loop [11
since there is an opp osite magnetic force acts on the wire GFwhen current flows in magnetic field. [11
Jn figure 2, no force is required [1]
sfuce there is no llllIIent flowing in the loop. [1]
There is question in next page
In figure 3, an applied force also along the diiection ofmotion is required to maintain the motion of the loop [!]
since there is an opposite magnetic force acts on the wire HE when cur.nmt flows in magnetic field. [!]
26. <HKDSE 2019 Ppaper-IB-9>
A reotangulerwilP.QRSof:IO turns, each having an S1eaof0.00S m', is placed in a unifonnmaglleticiieldB (c) Figure 9.3 shows a thln I<� aluminfum plale suspended by a long siting. the plare is partly
of .-gth 0.3 Tpomnng into the papor as sbown in Figuro 9.1. . inside a miliimn magnetic field )IM'ided by a strong magnet
X X ·x X X X
X uniform. magnetic field B
X X X X X X X
p
X > Q -'x
•x -
X X X X
a!Uminiumplare X X X:
ne9-l X X X X X X X
!l)re9.3 unili>rm magnetic field
X X X;
x § x x . x suddenly shifled to the right
":'
x
b...;;...., ...,�
X X X X X X X
x x x x x x x x,''
•X X ·x X X•
'
(a) The strength ofthe magne:tic field decreases uniformly to :zero wilbm 0.5 s. ., ______ . ---- .--- t
(i) Explain why a �ent would be ind uced in the coil. The magnet, wllicb is :not in conw:t wifu.11,e plai<\, is mddonly shifted'° !he right
•(ii) Calrolo!e the chan,.., in total magnotic tllllt linkage throogh the coil and the >alue of tho induced (i) On Figure 9.3, draw a ,mall circle at !he !ooatioa whe<o eddy cwrcn!S
· an, indn1'od w, !ho
e.m.f {m !he coll. (3 IIllllks) aluminium plate. Use an orrowt<> indicate 1ho diiccoon. of =reJII. (2 marl3)
(ii) Dmcnoe tho su!>seqneat moti011 oftho alumin!Ulll plare, if any. (l Ill31"k)
(b) Now lhe coil is cototed unifurmly about on axis through 130 ° as shown in Figures 92(a) and 9.2(b)
witlrin. 0.5 s.
X X :X · x X X. X x x x x x x x
F"1gUIO !l.2(a) F(gllre 9.2(b)
(i) Stare the •alue ofthe cllange in total magnotic J'itn< Iinkago through the ooil in tbis case (I marlc)
(i,) At the moment when 1he roil rotaJed tlttolJgh 90°, would the induced Cllrl10lt llow in the dm:<:tion
PQRS, PSRQ or is ll1ere no iod!lced cum,nt in tho coil? · (1 made}
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EMS-QS/02 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EMS-QS /03
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
3. {a) Peak voltage = 3 cm x 2.5 V cm- 1 = 7.5 V [I] 5. (a) Replace the slip rings by a commutator. [2]
4. (a)
• se,
� barmagnet
re:=]
(b) voltage
<Voltage is maxiz:num att= 0 > [!]
n�tr,!
point
;;:,--- < Both positive and negative voltage shown>
< Sh ap e correct>
[!]
[!]
�J/�
' t
<CorrectH> [!]
< Correct V> [!]
< Correct pattern.> [2]
< Indication of direction ofmagnetic field> [2]
(c) (i} The output voltage increases and the frequency also increases (OR double) [2]
<Both of the poles are South> [2]
< Neutral point between two compasses> [!] (ii) The amplitude of the voltage is unchanged but the phase is reverse. [2]
< Correct direction of current> [I] (iii} The output voltage increases (OR double). [2]
(b) {i) The neutral point moves towards X [I]
[I] [2]
magnetic
field "'='
Ll""'
(ri)
ma�tlc�
[2]
fiold
The pointer does not have any deflection. [!]
7. (a) (i) Cutrentf1owing through the solenoid will give a magnetic field to attract the magnet [l] 8. (e) Advantages: (AnyTWO) [2]
The magnet will be pulled down * Wind is cheaper
*
[1]
and the spring will cxten.d. [l ] Wind is ofunlimited supply
* Use a strongermagnet
*
Unsteady output (no output when no wind)
1
8. (a) (i) A is coils.
Frequency: / = ...!. = - - = 12.5 Hz [l]
(1] T 0.08
(ii) B is carbon brush [1] (iii) (l) Peak voltage increases [l]
Frequency increases [l]
(ill) Cisconunutator (OR twosplitrings) (OR twohalf�rings) [1]
(2) Peak voltage increases [1]
(b ) Frequency remains unchanged. [1]
[2]
(iv) Any TWO of the folloWlllg: [2]
[2]
I .,
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution
EMS : Electromagnetic Induction
[2]
* Increase the voltage of the battery' (OR Increase the current passing through the coil ) * coil
* Increase the nl.Ullber oftums of the coil * magnet
* Increase the area of the coil * commutator
[1]
14. (a) When the torch is shaken, the movable magnet moves across the fured coil.
The magnetic field through the :fixed coil changes (OR fue coil cuts the magnetic field lines) [l]
and a current is induced. (OR by Lenz's law, a curront is produced.) [1]
15. (a) 17. (c) (i) The length of the trace represents the peak-to-peak voltage ofthe induced voltage in the search coil [I]
< Correct direction of current> [!] It is proportional to the peak value of the magnetic field produced by the ac. currents. [I]
< Correct poles ofmagnet> [!]
(ii) The working of the search coil would not be affected by the Earth's magnetic field. [I]
Since the Earth'smagnetic field is steady, no e.m.f. can be induced in the search coil [!]
* Useastronger magnet
R ,'
(b) e = BvL
16. (a) WbenS is closed, current starts to flow in the coil and producesmagnetic field.
= (30 X 10-6) X (7690) X (20 X 103_) (!]
Thus an increase of themagnetic field occurs through the ring.
= 4610V [I]
By Lenz Law, an eddy cumnt is induced in the ring to oppose the change.
Opposing magnetic force acts on the ring to make it jump up momentarily. (!] Any ONE ofthe followings: [!]
However, when the current reaches its steady value, no change of.field results and the ring klls back. [!] * The cable is always peipendicu1arto the B-field
(b) (i) The ring will float steadily above the coil in air. (1]
* The magnetic field is uniform over this-20 km cable
� � 20, (a) Yes, the coil would resist being turned. [!]
When the coil is turned, a current is induced.
By lenz's law, magnetic forces acts on the coil to give a moment to oppose its rotation. [!]
= 41tx10-1xs _1__ 1
(b) B ( __)
0.02 0.07
(!]
21t (b) No. (!]
= 3.6x10-ST [1] Since there is no induced cummt through the coil, no magnetic forces act to rotate the coil [!]
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EMS-QS/ 10 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EMS-QS/11
EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction EM5 : Electromagnetic Induction
21. When the blades are tumed, the coil inside the motor will rotate in the magnetic field ofthe magnet [1]
Kinetic energy is converted to electrical energy and then to heat and light energy. [1] < the connection of the 3 wires is ALL correct > [1]
Place the aluminium ring on the top oftbe coil through the rod ofthe retort stand. lll
22. When the switch is closed, the ring jumps up momentarily and falls down. [1]
As the aiunriniUlll ring experiences a sudden increase of magnetic field produced by the coil at the start, 111
according to Lem's Law, eddy cumnts are induced in the ring to oppose this cllange. 111
A repelling upward magnetic force then exerts on the ring to push itup.
When the current and magnetic field becomes constant, the ring :fulls back as eddy current no longer flows. 11]
(b) (i) The alllllliniumring floats above the coil in the air. [1]
< The conducting wire connected to the light-beam galvanometer > [1]
<The wire placed between the pairs of magnets> [1] (ll) The ring retnains at rest on the coil without moving up. [l]
< Two hands holding the wire> [!]
Connect the long wire to the galvanometer and place the wire across the magnetic field.
To investigate the factor affecting the induced e.m.f. : (Any TWO of the followings ) 24. (a) (i) AnyONEofthefollowings: [1]
* Number of turns
(ii) E = !'.:_ [1]
Move the wire across the field. Then wind the wire into a few number of turns and move it again. [1]
The galvanometer would deflect more for more number of turns of the wire. [!] V =Ed= (3 x 105)x (2000) = 6x 108 V [1]
:::_J--;----.----; --;----;----;.;
8. Gravitation ( � J :'1 )
Section.C - Wave Motion ()£1/J)
1. Wave Propagation (i&:1194/ti!)
�-.
25. (a) (i) p -
2 Wave Phenomena (i&:W.,.!Jl..l-)
.. .. .. ..
1
[IJ 3. R eflection and Refraction ofLlght (*Im R...W Jl##)
:'
4. Lenses (.i!;l;t)
'1 5. Wave Nature ofLlght (�iroit.!;-\1:l"-fi.)
.:''
6. Sound ( 4-¼)
:
L ---;i. V , resistor
''' '
Section D- Electricity and Magnetism ('llt't"Zi)
1. Electrostatics (ff-11!:*)
I ■ • ■ ■ • ■I
�------------ -------------J 2. Electrii:: Ciicuits ( it113-)
Q'-----�---- 3. DomesticElectricity(�.§Jll 11;)
4. Magnetic Field (Zit*)
(ti) By l.eJ?Z's law, a magtietic force Fs acts on the rod to oppose its motiOD. [!] 5. Electromagnetic Induction ( 't..Jtlitl&)
6. Altemati:ngCunent(.!tl)it'll!;)
An applied force Fis needed to balance Fs to maintain uniform motion. [!]
Section E -Radioactivity and Nuclear Energy (M:M�&t;ft,;tt�)
:. F=BJL [IJ L Radiation and Radioactivity (-f!Ut'f0'1A:Af-JJ!..t.)
2. Atomic Model (l!i-f�iD
(lll) Mechanicalpowerinput: P = Fv = (BIL)v [!] 3. NuclearEncrgy(#:As)
P ower input = electrical power output
B/Lv = l;l Physics - Elective part (il!ii!-<!' 5/-)
[!]
Elective I -Astronomy and Space Science (�S.:.*'fl'>tt.�#"f>)
:. l;=BLv
I. The universe seen indifferent scales (;i:::I;J �r.1#&Tli9*'ili"W.tt)
2. Astron omythroughhistozy (�:st.*i¥,;.g;.A.i:_)
(b) (i) The horizontal COlllponent is peipendicularto the mast [!] 3. Orbital motions under gravity ( :t-fJ r 6tr.;Jr.it�f/J)
OR 4. Stars and the universe (•/I..l,,fa �'iii)
Elective 2-Atotnic World (/,f.T'l!!:-.rf..)
The vertical component is parallel o
t the mast
I. Rutherford's atomic model (.lt:!i-1:Z.&-f:tit�)
(ii) I; (Bcos30°)Lv
*
2. Photoelectric effect ( 1l!: rt_,m.)
3. Bohr's atomic model of hydrogen (Iltjjij 119 it.&-f.fit�)
- (50 X Io-6 cos 30°) (20) (6) 4. Particles or waves ($:r.-f�it)
5.12 x 10 -3 V ( accept 5.12 mV)
5. Probing into :Mll.O scale Cl1Uliii ffe'!!!:-4-)
[!]
Elective 3 - Energy and Use of Energy ($itifll,ij"6i!ltf/,J-ftffl)
Moreelectrons at endX [I] 1. Electricity at home(*,§ Jli 11!:)
2. Energyefficiency in building (Mt 1Mi{l ��rt$)
(iii) No current [JJ 3. Energyefficiency in transportation (i(.ffl-"1t6tr�,lj,tt,;J:)
4. Non -renewable energy sources (;:i;:� -ii}!!. "/Mi)
Both the cable and the mast cut the field lines, both have same e.m.f. induced 5. Renewable energy sources (""of .i!J-!!.��)
and the two induced e.m.f. oppose each other. [IJ
Elective 4 - Medical Physics ( It $#1 J.f *)
OR 1. Makingsenseo ftb.ecye(mliitrlti,'3)
2. Making.sense ofthe ear (JJ:i¥,;� '5)
There is no change of magnetic flux through the loop of the circuit. [IJ 3. Medical imaging using non-ionizing radiation (.•j/<'Ql;M/l:ti.MU-,$lHJ.,$,)
4. Medical imaging using ionizing radiation ( 'lit $#.M II,} :!f!,M{t *)
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD-EM6-M/01
11
I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD -EM6-M/ 02 II
The following list of formulae may be found useful : 4. < HKCE 1982 Paper II-34 >
In the transformer shown, the ratio of the number oftums on the primazy c011 to that on the secondary coil is 10: 1. If the
power input is 50 W, find the current in the secondary coil, assunring that the transformer has a 80 % efficiency.
Part A : BKCE examination questions A. 1.0A
B. LSA
. .DO»•
1. C. 2.0A
< BK.CE 1980 Paper II• 45 >
-v- D. 2.SA
B C
A$ shown in the diagram, a 200 V mains supply is stepped down to 10 V by a transformer. If the output current is 3 A and
Three coils A, B and C are wrapped around an iron core as shown. Coil A has N turns while coil B and C both have N ½ the efficiency of the transformer is 75%, what is the current in the primary coil?
A. 0.1 A
turns. Ifan input voltage Vis applied across A, what will be the voltage acting across coil C?
B. 0.2A
A. ¼V C. 0.3A
D. 0.4A
R ½V
C. 2V 6. < HKCE 1985 Paper II- 39 >
D
D. (2) & (3) only 7. <HKCE 1985 PaperII-41 >
1000
3. <BKCE 1980 Paperll• 41 >
.;�lye=]
Which ofthe following statements concerning direct current (d.c.) and alternating current (a.c.) is/are correct?
(1) The magnitude ofvoltage in de. isconstant while that in a.c. varies.
(2) The tlircction ofcurrent in d.c. does not change while that of a.c. reverses periodically. The diagram shows a transformer with the prilllary coil connected to an a.c. voltage of 200 V while the secondary coil is
connected to a resistor of 100 fl. If there are l 0 0 turns in the primmy coil and 10 turns in the secondary coil, what is the
(3) Both clc. anda.c. can have beatillg effect on a resistor. current passing through the resistor? (A$sume that the efficiency ofthe transfonneris 100%)
A. (I) only A. 0.0SA
B. (3) only B. 0.1 A
c. (!) & (2) only C. 02A
D. (2) & (3) only D. lA
I
s.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM6 : Alternating Current
In the circuit diagram shown, the transformer is 100% efficient Which of the following statements is/are correct?
(1) The current in the primary coil is 05 A
(2) The resistance ofthe door-bell is 20 n.
(3) The ratio of the number of turns in the primary coil to that in the secondary coil is 20: L
A. (1) only
B. (3) only In the above circuit diagram, the transformer is 100% efficient 'What is the maximum number of identical light bulbs, each
C. (1) & (2) only ofrating '40 W, 10 V' that can be connected in parallel across the secondary coil without blowing the fuse ?
D. (2) & (3) only (Assume that the fuse will blow ifthe current flowing through it exceeds 15A.)
A 3
B. 20
11. < HKCE 1989 Paper II- 36 > C. 60
transmission cable D. 75
p Q factory
. u LI
18. < HKCE 1994Paper II- 35 >
In the circuit shown, the rating of th e light bulb is '40 W, 10 V'.
The efficiency of the transformeris 80%. lithe bulb works at its
Q
�
rated value, :find the current in the primary coil 200V �40W
, !OV
A 0.16A
B. 0.2A Two bulbs P and Q are connected to an ideal transformer as shown. 'Which of the following statements is/are true when
C. 0.25 A switch S is closed ?
D. 1.6A (l) The brightness ofbulb P decreases.
(2) The reading of the ammeter increases.
(3) The reading of the voltmeter remains unchanged.
19. <BK.CE 1996Paperll-36> A. (1) only
B. (3) only
C. (1) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only
200VGE'-:
90-
24. <HKCE 1999Paperll-36>
R A '6 V, 6 W' light bulb is to be operated at its rated value. Three circuits are setup as shown below.
The primary coil of a transformer has 3600 turns and is connected to 200 V a.c. supply. The secondary coil has ISO turns, (1) (2)
which can be tapped at different points as shown above. A '40 W, 10 V' light bulb is connected to the transfomter so that it r-----,.---�
works at its rated value. Which of the following statements is/are correct ?
(1) The bulb should be connected to points P and Q.
(2) The cummt through the bulb is 4 A.
(3) If the efficiency of the transfomier is 80%, the current in the primary coil is 0.25 A.
A. (1) only
B. (2) only (3)
c. (!) & (3) only Number ofturns
D. (2) & (3) only in primacy coil"' 200
in secondru:y coil = 100
20. <HKCE1997Paperll-32>
The power supplies all have negligl.Ole intemal resistance. In which of the above circuits is the bulb working at its rated
Which ofthe following devices converts mechanical energy into electrical energy when it works ? value?
A. a transformer A. (1) only
B. adynatno B. (3) only
C. amotor C. (1)&(2)only
D. a microphone D. (2) & (3) only
1 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM6 : Alternating Cw:rent
PD -EM6 -MI 07 I I DSE Physics - Section D : M.C.
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD-EM6-M/08
11
A 12 V a.c. supply is connected to a transfonnet with turns ratio 1 : 1. The secondary coil is tapped at equal intervals as
....
•=•
A increases increases
B. increases
C. remains unchanged . ,,,.
D. remains unchanged remains unchanged
A. (3) only
■
B. (l) & (2) only
C. (2) & (3) onl y 30. < HKCE 2007Paper II-44 >
D. (1), (2) & (3)
Specification :
The figure shows a model power line. An a.c. supply and Voltage outputs
{}1Q1{}•,v�w
6V & 12V
two ideal transformers are used to operate a lamp of rating
'6 V, 24 W'. The tot.al resistance of the cables AB and CD
is 10 .Q. If the lamp operates at its rated value, find the The above figure shows a portable transformer. It outputs different voltage by varying the turns ratio between the primary
power loss in the cables. and the secondary coils. AsSUOle that there is no power loss in the transformer and the resistance of the load remains
A. 0.4 W I ; 20 step-up 20 : 1 step-down unchanged, when the output changes from 6 V to 12 V, which of the following statements describ.ing the transformer is/are
B. 3.6W ttansfurmer kansfu�u correct?
C. 160W (1) The number of turns of the primary coil should be doubled and the number of turns of the secondary coil remains
D. 1440W unchanged:
(2) The .input current should be doubled.
27. <HKCEZOOSPaperlI-43> (3) The output power should be 4 times as before.
Vlh.ich of the following statements about long distance power transmission at high alternating voltages are correct? A (2) only
(1) Alternating voltages can be stepped up or down efficiently by transformers. B. (3) only
C. (2) & (3) only
(2) For a given traruimittedpower, the curtent will be reduced if a high voltage is adopted.
D. (1), (2) & (3)
(3) The power loss in the transmission cables will be reduced if a high voltage is adopted.
A (1) & (2) on ly
B. (!) & (3) only 31. <HKCE2008Paperll-41>
C. (2) & (3) on ly
D. (1), (2) & (3) Specification :
C)1\ § § •••�··
5 A fuse Electrical power is transmitted from a power station to local substations by an altemating current and high voltage. It is
because
(1) the voltage of an alternating current can be stepped up or down using transformers easily.
(2) by using high voltages, electrical power can be transmitted faster along the cables.
(3) by using high voltages, there is less power loss in the transmission cables.
m, A. (1) & (2) only
B. (1) & (3) only
c. (2) & (3) oruy
In the circuit above, the primacy coil of a transformer is connected to the 220 V mains supply with a 5 A fuse. The efficiency D. (1), (2) & (3)
of the transfonner is 90%. What is the max.imum number of identical 40 W light bulbs, operating at their rated values, that
can be connected in parallel to the secondary coil withoutblowing the fuse?
A. 24
B. 25 Part B : HKAL examination questions
C. 27
D. 28 36. <RKAL 1984Paper! - 26>
A power station supplied electrical power to a user. The power generated by the station is 1200 kW. After stepping up, the
voltage transmitted to the cable is 132 kV. If the total resistance of the transmission cable is 550 0, :find th: electrical power
33. < BK.CE 2010 Paper Il- 43 > available to the user.
mcta1 "'" A. 700kW
B. 1155kW
C. 1195kW
D. 1200kW
I •="If----====0
a.c. supply "v coil A coilB a.c. voltmeter
37. <BKAL1995PaperllA-30>
The figure shows a metal core with two coils. When the switch is closed, the a.c. voltmeter shows a reading. Which ofthe
�@m·
following combinations will give the largest voltmeter reading?
A large machine in a factory consumes 10 kW of electrical power at a voltage of 500 V. Ifth.e generntor from the power
station transnrits electrical power to the :fuctozy through cables oftotal resistance 0.2 n, the voltage produced by the generator
""""
material of the metal core no. of turns of coilA no. of turns of coil B
should.be
A. 500 1000 A. 500V
B. copper 1000 500 B. 501V
c. ;ron 500 1000 C. 502 V
D. iron 1000 500 D. 504V
A heater of resistance 100 Q is connected to the mains supply. The r.m.s. voltage of the mains supply is 1 IO V. Which of the
40. <HKDSE Sample Paper IA-33 > following statements are correct?
Power is transmitted over long distances at high alternating voltages. Which statements are cOirect? (1) The peak voltage across the heater is 156 V.
(2) The power dissipated by the heater is 121 W.
(I) Alternating voltages can be stepped up or down efficiently by transformers.
(3) The power dissipated by the heater will be doubled if the r.m.s. voltage of the mains supply doubles.
(2) For a given transmitted power, the current will be reduced if a high voltage is adopted.
A. (1) & (2) oruy
(3) The power loss in the transmission cables will be reduced ifa high voltage is adopted. B. (1) & (3) ooly
A (1) & (2) only C. (2) & (3) only
B. (1)&(3)only D. (1),(2)&(3)
C. (2) & (3) only
D. (1), (2) & (3)
45. <BKDSE2017Paper1A-30>
The input tenninal of a transformer is connected to the 220 V mains supply. Ten identical light bulbs are connected in
41. <HKDSE2014Paper1A-30> parallel to the output terminal ofthe transfonner. All the light bulbs are working at their rated values of '3 V, 1.5 W'. Ifthe
When a heater is connected to a d.c. voltage oflO V, the power dissipated is P. If the heater is connected to a sinusoidal a.c., efficiency of the tronsfonner is 70%, what is the cunent drawn from the mains supply?
½
the power dissipated becomes P. What is the r.m.s. voltage of this a.c. sow-ce? Assume that the resistance of the heater is A. 0.007 A
constant B. 0.048A
C. 0,068 A
A. ✓5V
D. 0.097 A
B. 5✓2 V
C. IOV
46. <BKDSE2018 Paper IA- 30>
D. 10.,/i V
In the circuits below, if a 12 V sinusoidal a.c. is applied across ab and across xy respectively, the voltages across cd and zw
are both 6 V. Now if a 6 V sinusoidal a.c. is applied across cd and across zw r espectively, what would be the voltages across
42. < BKDSE2016 Paper IA-30 > ab and xy respectively ?
A sinusoidal a.c. of a certain frequency delivers a r.m.s, voltage V,.m.,., If its frequency is doubled and its peak voltage is
halved, what would be the r.m.s. voltage ?
A. .!. v.,.,,,_,,
2
. 1
B ✓?.V,�
C. -1-v-- voltage across ab voltage across xy
2./z · A. 12V 12V
D. V,..,,,,. , B. 12V 6V
C. 6V 6V
D. 12V ov
43. < HKDSE 2016 Paper IA - 31 > 47. <HKDSE 2019 Paper IA-29>
In. the above circuit, each light bulb works at its rated value '22 W, 11 V'. The current in the primary coil is 0.25 A. Find the
efficiency of the transform.et.
A. 20%
B. 40%
C. 64%
D. 80%
48 . <HKDSE 2019 Paper IA-30>
48
□
49. <:HKDSE 2020 Paper IA-29>
12 Va.� ""
□ 6V,0.SA
JV,I.OA
The � shows an ideal transfo<meT with two seeonda,y coils - to two light bulbs matked
'6 V, O.S g and '3 V, J.O N,espectivoly. Whon a 12 V a:c. supply is =ect<d to the primary coil, the
bulbs Workattheir respective rated values. Estimal, the currentin the primary coll.
A. 0.25A
B. 0.S0A
C. 0.7SA
D. 1.0A
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM6-MS I 01 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM6-MS/02
EM6 : Alternating Current EM6 : Alternating Current
HKEAA's Marldng Scheme is prepared for the�• reference. It should not be regatded as a set of model answers.
Students and teachers who are not involved in the marking process are advised to intetpre;t: the Marking Scheme with care. 4.
M.C. Solution
2
R = V:,2 = (200) = 4.Q l=�=SOA
P, oox!o'J 2+4
OR
I.
By P"" VI :. (JO X 103) = (200)/ :. J=SOA
Power loss in the cables: PJ,,.. = 12 R = (50)2 (2) = 5000 W = 5 kW
=
Ve !:'.:.
2
7. C
3. D
9. B
• (!) The magnitude of voltage in d.c. may not be constant, such as that produced by d.c. generator.
✓ (2) R=K=.!.Q.;,2QQ
I 0.5
✓ Nt>=!'.!.=200=ZO
(3)
N, v,
10
11. B
High voltage is used in electricity transmission, thusP should be a step up transfoz:merto step up the voltage in cable.
After transmission, the voltage has to be stepped down to be used in factory, thus Q is a step down transformer.
12. C
✓ (1) motor : electrical energy ➔ mechanical energy
• (2) lQUdspeaker : electrical energy ➔ sound
✓ (3) transform.et : electrical energy 4 electrical energy
13. C
Jp = 0.5A
14. D
.-. (200)(15) - n (40) n = 15
15. D
Tums ratio: Vs = rated voltage = 10 V :. NI' = 5..
= 200 = 20
Ns Vs 10
Al.the voltage cbangesfrom200 V to 10 V, itis a step down transform.er.
Efficiency : = (20x4)
=SO¾
n (200)(0.5)
16. D
• (1) If number of turns of the secondaly coil is increased, secondary voltage is inctealled,
however, power loss would notdecrease, thus the efficiency remains unchanged.
(Although power output :increases, butpowerinput also increases to give the same efficiency.)
✓ (2) Iflaminated iron core is used, eddy ClJifCilt can be reduced, thus power loss is reduced.
✓ (3) If tbicke_r copper wire is used, the resistance of the coils is reduced,
thus beating effect of cunent in the two coils is reduced, sopower loss is reduced.
DSE Pbysics-SectionD: M.C. Solution PD-EM6-MS/05 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM6- MS/ 061
EM6 : Alternating Current EM6 : Alternating Cutrent
24. B 30. B
X (1) Voltage across bulb = 12 V ¢ 6V, thus the bulb cannot work at its rated value. X (!) By Vs: Vp = Ns :N,, ifthe number ofturns oftheprimaiycoil is doubled,
the output voltage would change from 6 V to 3 V.
X (2) Resistanceoftheliglrtbulb: R = Y:_ = (6/ = 6Q
P, ( 6) X (,) Since the output voltage is doubled, by Po,ai = Vi IR, output power Pom becomes 4 times.
Equivalent resistance of the bulb and the left resistor = � = 3 n As there is no powerloss, Pm "" PctJI., thus input power P.m. also becomes 41:hnes.
2 By Pm = Vp /p , as Vp is unchanged, I, should be 4 times.
Thus, voltage across the light bulb is 4 V, the light bulb cannot work at its rated value.
✓ (3) By P = Vi IR, when Vs is doubled, the output power becomes 4 times,
✓ (3) Secondaryvoltage: p; = !OO xI2 = 6V the light bulb work at its rated value.
200
31. A
Since the transformer is ideal, the efficiency is 100%, i.e. powerinput is equal to power output
25. D
Vi•fp = Vsls
✓ (I) The output voltage is 12 V each light bulb shares 6 V work at rated values
(220 VJ I, • (12 VJ (100 mA) :. /p = 5.4SmA"' 55mA.
✓ (2) Two intervals give an output voltage of 6 V work at rated values
✓ (3) Each light bulb is connected across two intervals :. each has an voltage of6 V work at rated values 32. A
Assume the maximum number of light bulbs is n. The maxi:nlum primary CUJ:Telltis 5 A whichis limited by the fuse.
26.
For the lamp to operate at its rated value, the current through the lamp should be 24 = 4 A
6
:. (90%)=� :. n = 24.75
As it is a step down transformer, the current through the wireABCD should be : = 02 A (220)( 5)
2
The maxunutn number oflight bulbs should be 24 so that the fuse would not blow.
Power lossinthecables = I2R = (0.2)2 (10) = 0.4W
33. C
27. D The metal core should use iron so that there is good magnetic flux linkage between the tvro coils.
✓ (I) Power transmission needs transformers for stepping up and down, and transformers work on a.c. only To give larger voltmeter reading, the transf'ormer should be stepped up.
✓ (,) For a give transmitted power, P = VI, thus current I is reduced if voltage Vis increased. Thus, number ofturns in coil A is 500 and number of turns in coil B is 1000 can give the largest voltmeter reading.
✓ (3) By Pi... = I1 R , reduced cunentresulting from high voltage gives smaller power loss.
34. A
28. D Before Sis open,L1 is shorted and thus only I,,, lights up. The resistance isR.
✓ Since the voltage ofa mobile phone is very low, about a few volts, After Sis open, both lamps light up and the equivalent resistanceis 2R, thus the secondacy eumnt decreases.
the adaptor must contain a step-down transformer for stepping down the voltage. ✓ A. Since ls :/p = Np:Ns, with. the same turns ratio, the decrease ofls gives the decrease ofI,.
✓ (,) Since the battery ofa mobile phone is d.c., the adaptor must convert the a.c. voltage of the mains to d.c. X B. The secondary voltage should re.main unchanged as it depends on the turns ratio and V1 only.
✓ (3) Since traru:fotmer would give out heat when it operates, X C. The brightness ofL1 should increase as it is not lit up initially.
black colour can increase the radiation ofheat since black surface is a good emitter of heat.
X D. The brightness of L,. should decrease as the cuttent flowing through it is decreased.
29. C B
35.
(I) Since the secondary voltage of the transformer remains unchanged,
✓ (!) Since 1:ransfonners work on a.c., thus a.c. voltage can be changed easily.
the power dissipated by bulb Xis unchanged, thus the brightness of Xremains unchanged.
X (2) Electrical power istr.msmitted with the speed of light, and is independent of the voltages.
(2) Since secondary current is decreased, by !.£ = Np = constant, primary CUITent should also decrease.
✓
Ip N3 (3) By using high voltage, current in cables is reduced, thus less power is lost in the transmission cables.
DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM6-MS /07 DSE Physics - Section D : M.C. Solution PD-EM6-MS/08
EM6 : Alternating Current EM6 : Aliemating Current
36. B 42. A
3
= !_ = 1200xl0 = 9_09 A By .., = v•
I
V 132000 ,,...,,,,_ ✓2
Thus, ifthe peak voltage is halved, the r.m.s. voltage is also halved.
40. D
✓ (!) Transformers work on a.c. effic iently. Ifthe input voltage is 6V a.c. a.cross cd, since now the turns ratio is l ; 2,
✓ (2) By P = VI, for the same P, higher V means that smaller transmission current I. the output voltage across ab is 12 V and it becomes a step-up transformer.
✓ (3) By P1oa = 12 R, smaller J means that Pi- can be reduced. For the potential divider, ifthe inputvoltage 12V a.c. is applied across xy, the output voltage across zw is 6 V.
41. B
l2V_::J::z
v'
Ford.c.: P = - .·. (F/ - �O)'
R R -----;,- 6V
y w
Fora.c.: P = V,,.. •.• (1.P) Vm/
2
z = Ifthe inputvoltage 6 Vis applied across zw, since current only flows through the lower part ofthe resistor,
R R
no currentflows to the upper part ofthe resistor, the voltage across the upper part of the resistor is O V,
Combine the two equations : ...!... = (10 )2
Ct ) (V..,. )
2 thus, the voltage across xy is still 6 V.
I DSE Physics -- Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD--EM6-Q/01 I DSE Physics -- Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD-EM6--Q/021
The following list of formulae may be found useful : 2, (b) Find the frequency of the output voltage.
In the above diagram, show how you would connect the above pieces of apparatus to display a 10 V a.c. on the CRO.
(6 marks)
(b) Why is the efficiency of a transformer always less than I 00% ? Mention one method of improving transformer
efficiency. (4marks)
4. < BKCE 1983 Paper I - 7 >
(a) 22000 W of electrical power are transmitted through a cable with a resistance of0.5 n at 11000 V.
(c) Explam why a 40 W fluorescent tub e appears to be brighter than a 40 W filament lamp. (2ma,k,)
L_J L__:rta·•
2. < HKCE 1981 Paper I - 7 >
The primazy coil of a transformer is connected to a 200V, 50 Hz a.c. mains supply. Suppose the primary coil has 2000 turns
and the secondary coil has I 00 turns.
(b) DescnOe briefly how an alternating cunent of 11000V can be stepped down to 200V.
(a) Find the output voltage across the secondary coiL
I
5.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
< HKCE 1987 Paper I- 8 >
PD -EM6-Q / 0311
I
6.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
< BKCE 1990 Paper I - 7 >
PD-EM6-Q / 0411
The figure shows an arrangement to study the input and output characteristics of a transformer. z
The below figure shows a 3-pin electrical plug and a transformer. The three wires X, Y, of the transformer are to be
connected to the plug. The plug will be connected to a 200 V a.c. power supply. The output voltage of the 1ransfonner will
be 110 V. Assume the transformer is 100% efficient
X (Green/yellow)
Reading ofAz = 1.8 A (a) (i) To which of the tenninalsA,B, and C of the plug should each of the wires.x; YandZbe connected 7 (2 marks)
Reading of Vi = 12 V
Reading of Vi = 2 V
(iii) Suggest one reason why it is necessary to have the X-wire connection. (2 marks)
(iv) Find the turns ratio (primary coil to secondary coil) of the transformer.
(i) Calculate the current drawn from the transformer by the iron. (2 marks)
(ii) How would the reading of the ammeter A2. change ? (1 mark)
[ii) Calculate the cost of electricity if one kilowatt-hour of electrical energy costs 80 cents. (2nwks)
(c) Suggest TWO changes in the transfonner which will improve its efficiency. In each case, give ONE reason to support
your suggestion. (4marks)
(iii) If fuses marked 1 A, 3 A and 7 A are available, which one is most appropriate to be used in the plug in the figure 7
Explain your choice. (3 marks)
7,
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
I
8.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
< HKCE 1991 Paper I - 7 >
PD-EM6-Q/06
11
Two students suggest using a 24 V d.c. supply and a 24 V a.c. supply sepatately to operate a l.antpXrated at '6 V, 12 W'.
�� ,11---�
(a) 24V
Two long wires AB and CD of total resistance 4 .Qare used to connect a d.c. power supply to a lamp. The lamp is working at
its rated value '12 V, 24 W'. X
R
(a) Find
(i) the resistance ofthe lamp, (2 marks)
A student connectsXin series with a 24 V d.c. supply and a resistor R (see the Figure above). IfXworks at its rated
value,
(ii) the current flowing through the lamp,
(i) find the current flowing through X,
(iv) what percentage of the electric power provided by the d.c. supply is dissipated inR 7 (3 marks)
(i) In the figure below, draw wires to connect the terminals of the components according to the figure above.
(3 marks)
{b) The other student suggests thatX can also be made to work by using a 24 V a.c. su.pplytogetherwifu a transformer.
(i) Draw a circuit diagram to show how X, the a.c. supply and the transformer are connected.
�Traosfurm� �
b1Z!l) 1,mp
Power supply
(ii) What is the advantage of using this method over the one shown in the above Figure?
(li) Explain how the ammgement can reduce the power loss in the wires. (3 marks)
(iii) Determine the tum.s ratio (primary to secondary) of the transformer for Xto work at its rated value, and calculate
the primary CIIrrcnt if the transformer is 100% efficient (4 marks)
I
9.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
< HKCE 2000 Paper 1-10 >
PD-EM6 -Q / 0711
(a) A transform.eris used to operate a '110 V, 1000 W' electric cooker at its rated value from the 220 V a.c. mafus supply in
10.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question
ElYI6 : Alternating Current
< BKCE 2001 Paper I· 5 >
PD-EM6-Q/081
Hong Kong. The primary coil of the transfooner bas 5000 tw::ns and the efficiency of the transfonner is 80%. Find ""'"""'"'
(i) the number ofturns in the secondary coil of the transformer, (2marks)
transmission cables
(b) Explain why a.c. and high voltages are used for long distance power transmission. (3 marks)
(iv) the cunent flowing in the primary coil of the transformer. (2 marks)
(b) Figure 1 shows a travel cooker and the label attached on it. The cooker has a voltage selector switch shown in Figure 2.
Voltage
Model No : EA 2000 11. < HKCE 2004 Paper I-10 >
a.c. 120 V / 240 V
360W
~50-60Hz
120V� 240V
Figure2
(i) A fuse is installed in the cooker. Explain the :function of the fuse. (2 """') ll
el�,,
(ii) Two students make the following remarks about using the cooker in Hong Kong:
John: The voltage selector switch should be set to 120 V and the output ofthe cooker would be 360 W. s
Peter: The voltage selector switch should be set to 240 V and the output ofthe cooker would be less than 360 W.
Explain whether each ofthe above remarks is correct. (4 marks)
The Figure above shows an electric toothbrush. It consists ofa brush unit and a charging unit.
DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM6-Q/09 DSE Physics - Section D : Question PD-EM6-Q/10
EM6 : Alternating Current EM6 : Alternating Current
11. (a) Inside the brush unit, there is a 12 V rechargeable cell for driving a motor. When the toothbrush is in operation, the 12. < HKCE 2005 Paper I -12 >
current flowing through the motor is 1.8 A. Calculate
Vi/V Pi/V
(c) The cell inside the brush unit is connected to coilXIocated at the bottom of the unit. Another coil Y is located inside the 1.0 1.7
charging unit with a soft..iron bar fixed inside it When the brush unit is placed on the charging unit, the soft-iron bar 2.0 3.3
lies inside coil X.
3.0 5.1
(i) The brush unit and the charging unit are completely covered by plastic cases and there is no metal contact between 4.0 6.9
them. Explain how a current is produced in the brush unit to recharge the cell (3 marks)
Table 1 Vi/V
0 4
(2marks)
(b) Josephine wants to studythe relationship between the output voltage and the number of turns in the secondary coil of the
(ii) If coil Yhas 11 000 turas, estimate the number of turns of coil X. Assume the output voltage of coilXis 3 V a.c. transfonner. Descn'be how she can conduct the experiment. (2 marks)
(2marks)
(,)
Figure3
f
i
(d) The charging unitis fitted with a two-pin plug as shown in the above Figure.
(i) To which two wires of the mains supply should the pins of the plug be connected? (1 mark) secon�
y
,oil
Josephine adds a bulb to the circuit as shown in Figure 3 above. Suggest a method that Josephine can use to esti mate the
efficiency ofthe transformer. Additional apparatus may be used if necessary. (3 marks)
(ii) Suggest one reason why it is safe for the charging unit to be fitted with a two-pin plug. (I mark)
1 DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD - EM6 - Q / 11 II DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD-EM6-Q/12
'
axis ofrotation
fixed solenoid
\
�/ fixedsolenoid
cp:,,
,
/
I I
G s0
/
\
, \
,/
/
/
,/
magnet
/
(a) The primary coil of transformer Xhas 500 turns. Find the number of turns in the secondary coil. (1 mark)
X
0
(a) Explain how altemating cunent is generated in the above setup. (3 marks)
(b) Each wire of the transmission cable, MP and NQ, has a resistance of 80 n. Assume the current through the wires
is 0.1 A.
(b) The bulb is now removed from the setup. X and fare then connected to the primary coil of a transformer. The
secondary voltage output of the transformer is found to be 12 V. If the toms ratio of the primary coil to the secondary
coil is 1 : 8, find the primary voltage. (2 roarlcs)
(c) State the advantages of using (iii) Find the power delivered to the loudspeaker. (2 marks)
(ii) highvoltages
:y1
16. < HKDSE Sample Paper m -13 >
Josephine conducts an investigation on transformers. Primary and secondary coils are wound on two soft-iron C-cores to
fonn a transformer. She set up a circuit as shown in Figure 1.
Figure(a)
�c,
transformer
L_j,l�tierub, Figure 1
'---��--, :
a.c. power supply
(i) What is the magnetic pole induced at end U of Ci as the magnet approaches it? (1 mark)
1 ':
secondary
coil
(ii) Iftbe resistor is disconnected and the circuit becomes open, it is found that the magnet passes th.rough Ci in shorter
time. Explain this phenomenon. (2 marks)
(a) Josephine varies the input voltage V1 to the transformer and records the corresponding output voltage V2- The results are
shown in Table 1. Figure 2 shows the graph of Vi against Vi. Draw a conclusion for this investigation. (1 mark)
(b) Now, C 1 and another copper coil of smaller number ofturns, Ci, are wound on a soft iron core as shown in Figure (b) to
make a transformer. Ci is connected to an a.c. supply.
p Vi/V Vi!V
a.c. supply,,.....,_ C, 1.5 2.5
3.0 5.1
soft iron core 4.5 1.6
Figure(b) 6.0 10.0
c,
Table 1
(li) Suggest two ways to improve the efficiency of the transformer. (2 marks)
(b) Deduce the value of V2 that will be produced when Vi equals 8.0 V. (1mm)
(iii) Another power supply is connected to PQ to replace the a.c. supply. The variation of the current through C2 with
time is shown in Figure (c). A CUIIent flowing from P to Q through Cz is taken as positive.
I/A
(c) Josephine wants to study the relationship between the output voltage and the number of turns in the secondaiy coil of the
Figu.re (c) � transformer. DescnOe how she can conduct the experiment. (2 marks)
0 » t Is
Tom claims that no induced current will be produced in Ci as the current in C2 has no change in direction.
Comment on whether Tom's claim is correct or not (3 marks)
I DSE Physics - Section D : Question
EM6 : Alternating Current
PD - EM6 - Q / 15 II DSE Physics - Section D : Question
E1Vf6 : Alternating Current
PD - EM6 - QI 16
□
12 V d..c. power supply
Flgure3
'"'"'
joulemeter
Suppose now the heater is connected to a sinusoidal a.c. power supply. The peak value of the voltage of the a.c. power
Josephine adds a bulb to the circuit as shown in Figure 3 above. Suggest how Josephine can estimate the efficiency of supply is 15 V. How would the output power ofthe heater change? (2 marks)
the trans.funner. State the measurement(s) she must take. Additional apparatus may be used if necessary. (3 marks)
The danger of electric shock is particularly high in bathrooms. Normal electric socket outlets should not be installed
Ignition coil in bathrooms. As electric shavers and toothbrushes are becoming popular these days, a special unit, called 'shaver
supply unit' is now conunon in bathrooms to provide electricity just fur these low power comu:mption electric
An ignition coil is used to produce sparks from the battery of a car In ignite the fuel in the engine. It is
appliances (see the Figure).
used to produce high-voltage pUIBes from a low-voltage d.c. supply.
The shaver supply unit consists of a transformer in which the secondary is not earthed and is completely isolated
An ignition coil consists of two coils of insulated copper wire that are wound around a common iron core. from the 220 V a.c. mains supply connecting to the primary. It can be used with 220 V or 110 V shavers.
One coil, called the primary coil, is made from relative ly few (tens or hundreds) turns of thick copper wire.
The other coil, called the secondary coil, typically consists of many (thousands) turns of thin copper wire.
When an electric current is passes through the primary coil, a magnetic field is created. The iron core Llvo JSharupEp
vo, !yunlt
guides most of the primary cell's magnetic field to the secondary coil. When the current in the primary coil
is suddenly interrupted, a high voltage pulse of many thousand volts is developed across the secondary
coil. This voltage is then sufficient to cause an electrical discharge to produce a spark 220 V a.c.
(a) Explain why a voltage is developed across the secondary coil when the current in ptim.aty coil is suddenly interrupted. Neutral
(2 marks)
(b) Suggest one reason why the voltage developed across the secondary coil is v,:;ry large.
(b) (ii) one of the conducting wires in the shaver circuit outlet
PD-EM6-Q/17
11
Electricity generated from power plants are transmitted at a high voltage through overhead cables in submban areas.
1
(a) Each overhead cable cOllSists of40 strands ofidentical tl:ll:nsn:li.ssnlinesbundled together.
a strand of
transmission line of
(c) What is the turns ratio of the primary coil to the secondary coil of the transformer so as to provide 110 V? (1 mark) an overhead cable
(i) One single strand of transmission line has a cross-sectional area of 1.3 x 1 o-s m2 and resistivity 2.6 x 1o-8 n m.
Find the resistance n,gJg;g ofa single strand oftransmission line. (2 marks)
20. <HKDSE2012Paperffl-8>
In the circuit shown in the Figure, resistors Ri and R2 represent the heating elements in a heater using ma.ins supply. Both
resistors are immersed in water. (ii) Explain why the resistance per km ofan overhead cable is much smaller than that of a single strand of transmission
----------..'
heater line. Estimate the resistance per km ofan overhead cable. (2 marks)
:
ls ""'v 220 Va.c.
''
(iii) Hence, explain why a bird can stand 'With both feet on a highMvoltage cable without getting an electric shock.
'' (2 marks)
The heater can be operated intwo modes, namely, heating and keeping warm, and it is controlled by the switch S. The power
consumed by the heater in the heating mode is 550 W and in the mode of keeping warm is 88 W. The mains voltage
is220 Va.c.
(a) In which mode is the beater operating when switch Sis open? (1 ma,k) (b) Electrical power of 180 MW is transmitted at a voltage of400 kV through an overhead cable.
(c) When switch Sis closed, calculate the cumrrt passing through resistor R2. (3 ""'1<s)
(lii) As the voltage drop across this ovedlead cable is negligible, a voltage of 400 kV at the cable's end is stepped down
by an ideal transfonner with turns ratio 12 : I.
(d) What is the peak value of the sinusoidal current flowing through the heater when switch Sis closed ? (2 ""'1<s) (Il) State ONE factor leading to energy loss in a practical transformer and suggest the COITesponding measure for
improvement. (2 marks)
PD-EM6- QS /01 PD-EM6-QS /02
1
DSE PhYsics - Section D : Question Solution DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution
EM6 : Alternating Cw:rent EM6 : Alternating Current
HKEAA's Maik:iDa Scheme is pn:pm:cd for the markers' refetence. It should not be� as a set of model llllSWCJ:S.
Students and teachets who are not involved :in the mackine process are advised to :i:meilttet the Markin&: Schenlc with cate. 4. (a) (i) By P = VI [!]
(22000) = (11000)1 l=2A
Question Solution [!]
:1[
(c) In a fluorescent tube, less energy is wasted as heat. [2]
1
36
(in) Efficiency = • X 1QQ% = 12% [!)
(200) = (2000) 30
[!)
v, (100)
(b) (i) A 1 decreases [!]
Vs = l0V [!]
(ii) Az decreases [!]
(b) f= SOl!z [!]
(o) (D Use laminated core [!)
"'
to reduce the eddy current induced in the core. [!]
1
to reduce the resistance and heating loss in the coils. [!]
i
""""'
:
D l00V a.c. 10001ullls
6. (a) (i) X connected to A Y connected to C Z connected to B
SO<um, < any ONE correct> [!]
5Va.c. < the other TWO correct > [!]
< Use 100 V a.c. > [!] (iii) To prevent electric shock if a fault develops. [2]
< Use 1000 turns as primary> [2 ]
(iv) Tums ratio = 2 00 [!)
<Use 100 turns as secondary> [2] 110
= 9!1 [!]
v2
{a) (i) = <11 = 6 n
?
7. R = [2]
P 24 (iv) Percentage = 2(1 8) x 100% [2]
2(24)
2
(ii) / = !_ = < 4) = 2A [2] = 75% [I]
V (12)
OR
(Iii) Powerlossinthecables = I2 R = (2)2 x(4) = 16W [2]
Percentage = 2 (9) x 100%
2
[2]
2(24)
(iv) Efficiency = P°", xl00% [!]
P, = 75% [I]
= -3±._x100% OR
24+16
Percentage = � x 100% [2]
= 60% [!] 2(18) +12
= 75% [!]
(b) (i)
[3]
(b) (i)
(Ii) This method can reduce thepower loss in the circuit. [!]
< Two wires. connected from the left side of the other transformer to the lamp> [I] = 0.SA [!]
DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM6-QS/05 DSE Physics - Section D : Question Solution PD-EM6-QS/06
EM6 : Alternating Current EM6 : Alternating Current
(b) (i) If an excessive large current flovvs through the cooker [1] (d) (i ) The pins should be connected to the live and neutral wires. [1]
the fuse will melt (blow) and breaks the circuit. [1]
(ii) AnyONEofthefollowing: [1]
(ii) John is not correct. * The charging unit no metal case.
has
The selector switch should not be set to 120 V, as the applied voltage in Hong Kong is 220 V,
* The charging unit has a completely insulated plastic cover.
that is much higher than the rated voltage. [1] * The charging unit is double--insulat.ed.
The fuse of the cooker will blow. [1]
Peter is COll'Cct.
12 (a)
The switch should be set to 240 V, as applied voltage in Hong Kong is 220 V. [1]
Since the applied voltage is slightly less than 240 V, the output power would be less than 360 W. [1]
[1]
(b) An a.c. voltage is used because it can be stepped up or down by transformers efficiently. [1]
Stepping up the voltage can reduce the cwrent passing through the cables. [1]
12. (b) She should vary the number of turns of the secondary coil nz, and meas1ll'e the corresponding output voltage Vz. [l] 15. (a) (i) South pole [I]
The input voltage Vi and the number of turns of the primary coil n1 should remain unchanged. [!]
(ll) No induced cumnt can flow in the open circuit. [!]
(c) Josephine should use ammeters to measure the primary currentl1 and secondary current lz , [!] The magnet then passes through the solenoid without any resistive magnetic force. [I]
and calculate the input power Vi 11 and the output power Vi Ii [!] (b) (i) To step up the voltage. [IJ
The efficiency ofthe transformer can then be estimated by Vi.12 xl00% [I]
Yi Ii (ii) Use thicker 'Wires in the coils. [!]
Use laminated core. [!]
(iii) As the magnitude of the current is varying, C2 produces a varying magnetic field. [I]
13. (a) The current is induced when the magnetic field between the two s olenoids is changing. [!] C1 will still experience changing magnetic field. [I]
By Lenz's law, the induced CWTeD.t flows in a direction to oppose the change. [l] Current will be induced in C1 and hence, Tom's claim is wrong. [I]
When the magnet rotates towards a solenoid, the induced current flows in one direction,
and when the magnet rotates away :from the solenoid, the induced current flows in the opposite direction. [1]
16. (a) The output voltage V2 is directly proportional to 1he input voltage Vi. < accept Pio:; Vi> [I]
(b) �=Np [!]
Vg Ns
(b) V2 = 8.0x � =- 13.3V <accept 13.2 to 13.6V> [l]
6
v;. a (1) Vr=l.SV [I]
(12) (8)
(c) The input voltage Vi and the number of turns of the primary coil Ni should remain unchanged. [!]
(c) (i) Easyto step up during transmission. [I] She should vary the number oftums ofthe secondary coilN2 of the transformer,
and measure the corresponding output voltage V2. [I]
(ii) Reduce power loss. [I) The relationship can then be studied.
(d) Josephine may use ammeters to measure the primary current 11 and secondaty current 12, [l]
100 She can then calculate the input power Vi 1:i and the ou tput power Pih [I]
14. (a) N8 = 500x
l{)
= 5000 [I]
The efficiency can then be estimated by: efficiency =- outpu t po wer x 100%. [I]
input power
(b) (i) V•IR [!]
a (0.1) (80) a 8 V [!]
17. (a) 'When the primary current is suddenly interrupted, the magnetic field through the secondary coil changes. [!]
(Ii) VrQ = lOO - 8 - 8 = 84V [!]
An e.m.£ is induced across the secondary coil. [!]
(iii) P = VI [!]
= (84) (0.1) = 8.4 W [!] (b) The number of turns of the secondary coil is much larger than that of the primacy' coil. [I]
OR
OR
The rate of change of magnetic flux is very large. [I]
P = VI-I2 R [I]
= {JQQ)(QJ) - (0.1)2 (80 X 2) = 8.4 W [!]
(c) By Vp [p = Vs ls, as secondary voltage is higher, the primacy current is larger. [!]
In order to minimize the beating effect ofthe primary current, thick wire of smaller resistance should be used. [I]
(c) (i) Deliver the power through the cable using a higher voltage.
(OR Increase the number of tums in the secondary coil of transformer X: ) [I]
19. (a) In bathroom, humid air and mist contain much water thatis a conductor. [!] 21. (a) {il) The strands are connected in parallel [!]
OR
The water provides a conducting path between the human body and the source of electricity. [!]
The cross-sectional area of cable is greater than each of transmission line. [!]
OR
The water lowers the resistance bet..veen the human bodyand the sourceof electricity. [!] Resistance of cable per km = 2 -0 = 0.05 n km-1 [I]
40
(b) (i) Thehmnan.bodywould getelectric shock [!]
(iii} The resistance oftbe bird's bodyis much larger than that ofthe s hort segment of the overhead cable. [!]
because cummt flows through the body to the Earth and r eturns to the Neutral wire. [!]
OR
(ii) The human body will not getelectric shock [!] The potential difference across the feet is very s mall [!]
because there is no return path for the cutrent (OR there is no complete circuit) [!] Hence, negligi."ble current flows through the bird's body. [!]
(c) Tw:ns ratio = 2 : 1 < accept tums ratio ,.. 2 > (b) (i) By P"' VI [!]
(180 x 106) = (400 x 10 3) l
:. I= 450A [!]
20. (a) keepin g warm [l]
(ii) R = o.o5x10 = o.sn
V' Pi... = 11 R =(450)1 x (0.5) = 101250W [!]
(b) pa -
Percentageofpow erloss = 1012506 x 100% = 0.05625 % < 0.1 % [!]
(220)' 180xl0
_-_ (88) a [!]
(,) Pow er given out by the resi stor .fu. = 550 - 88 = 462 W [!] (iv) Heating loss due to the beating effectofCUll"ent in the resistance of coils. [!]
P = YI [!] Use thicker wires for the coils. [!]
OR
(4<i2) a ( 22 0) I,
Power loss due to eddy current induced in the s oft iron core. [!]
J2=2.1A [!]
Use laminated soft iron c ore. [!]
OR
Time/minute 0 2 4 6 8 JO 12 y
rn
B. 6 min. Which ofthefollowing signs is used to indicate radioactive material?
C. 8 min. D.
Activity/ Bq
40
16. <HKCE1994PaperII-38>
Anange ex, /3 and y radiation in ascending order of their ionizing powers :
30 A o;, /3,r
B. /3,y,a
C. y,a;jl
D. y,jl,a
20
22. <HKCE 1997Paper Il- 39 > 27. <HKCE 2000 Paper II· 40>
Which of the following statements about j3 particles is incorrect? Which of the following statements about CL particles and y rays is correct?
A. j3 particles can be stopped by a piece of paper. A. Both ofthemaretraosversewaves.
B. j3 particles can be deflected by a magnetic field. B. Both of then;, can be deflected by a magnetic field.
C. j3 particles can blacken photographic films. C. Both ofthem have strong ionizing power.
D. j3 particles can travel through a vacuum. D. Both of them can travel through a vacuum.
23. <HKCE 1998 Paper ll- 40 > 28. < HKCE 2000Paper II - 41 >
Which of the following diagrams conectly shows the directions in which et, P and y radiations are deflected in a uIUform Which one of the following is not a safety precautions for handling radioactive sources?
electric field produced by two ch arged metal plates? A. Users should not eat or drink when handling radioactive sources.
1" ·i
A a B. Users should wear gloves for handling radioactive sources.
C. Radioactive sources should not be held close to the eye for visual examination.
D. Radioactive sources should be stored in wooden boxes after use.
+ + 29. <HKCE2001Paperll-40>
The initial activity of a radioactive isotope is 2000 Bq. After 4 hours, the activity of the isotope drops to 125 Bq.
Find the half-life of the isotope.
A. 15 minutes
"Y
B. 30 minutes
C. 48 minutes
C.
' D. D. 60 minutes
�·
30.
+ + Which of the following particles cannot be deflected by a magnetic field?
A. a-particles
B. !>-particles
C. neutrons
D. protons
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. PE-RAl-M/07 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. PE-RAl-M/08
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
31. <HKCE2003Paper1I-40> 34. < BKCE 2005 Paper Il- 24 >
Which ofthe following statements about ex particles and y rays is/are correct? X X X X X X
(1) They can both be deflected by a magnetic field.
r
(2) ct particles have a stronger ionizing power than rays.
(3) They are emitted with ahnost the same speed in radioactive decay.
source �---;--;--;--;--;--;�
_,.,,,--- � x x x x x x
r=ffi
� Geiget-Mullertube
leadcastle
A. (1) only X X X X X X Q� /
B. (2) only
C. (!) & (3) only
A radioactive source is placed in front of a uniform magnetic :field pointing into the paper as shown above. If a high count
D. (2) & (3) only
rate is recorded at positions P and Q, what kinds of radiation have been detected ?
p Q
32. < HK.CE 2003 Paper II- 41 > A. y "
B. y �
Activity of PI Bq Activity of Q I Bq C. � "
D. � y
800 800
35. < HKCE 2006 Paper n- 42>
A radioisotopeXhas a half-life of2 days while another radioisotope Yhas a half-life of 1 day. Initially there are Nundecayed
atoms ofX and 8 Nundecayed atoms ofY. After how many days will Xand Yhave the same number ofundecayed atoms ?
400
A. 3 days
200 B. 4 days
, L-+-.::::==-
10
C.
D.
6days
8 days
Tune/min Timelmin
The figures above show the variation of the activities of two radioactive sources P and Q with time. Find the ratio of the
36. < HKCE 2007 Paper n - 24 >
half-life ofP to that of Q. Count rate / counts per minute
A. 1: 1
B. 1: 2
C. 2: l
D. 4: l
33. <HKCE2004Paperll-41>
Different absorbers are placed in turn between a radioactive source and a Geiger--Muller tube. Three readings are taken for
each absorber. The following data are obtained:
25mmlead 60 62 58
39. <HKCE2008PaperII-25> C. D.
Which of the following actions will maximise a person's exposure to radiation?
A. Using a GM tube and counter to measure the background radiation in laboratory.
B. Eating food that has been sterilised by exposure to gamma radiation.
C. Listening to radio.
D. Going for a flight to a distant place in a high-flying aeroplane. p Q
p Q
'if 'if
40. < BKCE 2008 Paper n - 27 > o, source o, source
Which of the following statements about p particles is correct ?
A. f3 particles car:ry positive charge. 44. < BKCE 2010Paper Il- 23 >
B. fJ particles can be deflected by a magnetic field.
C. fJ particles cannot be deflected by an electric field. The initial activity of a sample of radioisotope is 960 Bq. Its activity drops to 240 Bq in 2 minutes. How much more time
D. /J particles can be stopped by a sheet of paper. would be required :fur its activity to become 30 Bq?
A. 2minutes
B. 3 minutes
41. <HKCE 2009 Paper Il -26 > C. 4minutes
D. 5 nrinutes
The half-life ofa radioactive sample is 15 hours. The initial count rate recorded is 1000 counts per minute. After 15 hours,
the count rate :recorded becomes 528 counts per minute. What is the background count rate '! (.Measured in counts per
minute.) < BKCE 2011 Paper II- 45 >
A. 25
B. 28
c. 50
D. 56
radioactive source
ina lead box
42. <HKCE 2010 Paper Il-4S >
lov
In the figure, a /3 particle enters a region with a magnetic field magnetic field
Y
pointing into paper and an electric field ofllilknown direction. X X X X X X
The /3 particle has no deflection. What is the direction of the
...
,Bparticle X X X X X X
electric :field? The figure shows a radioactive source placed near two parallel metal plates X and Y that are connected to a power supply.
A. X X X X X X When a GM tube is moved along the dotted line (- · - · -), the count rate shows a significant increase atP and Q respectively.
'Which of the following statements is correct when a magnetic :field pointing out ofpaper is applied betweenX and Y?
B. ➔ X X X X X X A. The count rate at P decreases and the count rate at Q remains the same.
C. r B. The count rates at P and Q remain the same.
C. The count rate at P decreases and the count rates at Q and R increase .
D. .J. D. The count rates atP, Q andR are equal.
PE-RAl-M/11 PE-RAl-M/12
1
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
47. < HKCE2011 Paper II-23 > A dish containing an alpha-source is placed inside a gold leaf electroscope. If the gold-leaf is originallypositively charged,
A radioactive source is put in front of a GM tube. The initial count rate is 1050 counts per minute. It is known that the what will happen to it after a few minutes ?
half.life of the source is 4 hours and the background count rate is 50 counts per minute. What is the most likely count rate A. It will increase in divergence.
after 8 hours ? B. It will increase in divergence and then decrease.
C. It will collapse.
A. 50 counts per minute
D. It will collapse and then re-diverge.
B. 125 counts per minute
C. 250 counts per minute
52. < HKAL 1988 PaperI- 44 >
D. 300 countsperminute
An alpha-source originally consisted entirely of the element polonium. After the emission of an a-particle, each polonium
nucleus becomes a lead nucleus. At the end of two years, the source was found to contain 98%lead and 2% polonium. 'What
is the composition of the sample at the end of one year ?
Part B : HKAL examination questions A. 25% lead, 75% polonium..
B. 50% lead, 50% polonium..
C. 75% lead, 25% polonium.
48. < HKAL 1980 Paper I- 32 > D. 86%lead, 14%polonium.
Which of the graphs below correctly shows the variation of the activity A of a radioactive sample with the number N of the
undecayed nuclei in the sample? 53. < 1IKAL 1990 Paper I - 48 >
A. R C �
A radioactive source is placed in front of a GM counter. Various absorbers are placed between the source and the
GM counter and the count-rate recorded. The following results were obtained:
Absorber Counts per minute
no absorber 712
a sheet ofpaper 504
5 mm thick aluminium sheet 496
25 mm thick lead block 218
From the above result, the radiation(s) emitted by the source is/are
49. <HKAL 1984 Paper I -33 >
A. a: and y rays only
An alpha particle (a:) makes a collision with a helium nucleus (He) in a cloud chamber. Which of the following diagrams best B. /3 and y rays only
represents the probable set of tracks ? C. a rays only
A. B. D. /3 rays only
A counter is placed near a radioactive source that has a halHife of 1 hour. The counter registers 100 counts per minute The activity of a radioactive sample was 70 Bq at time t = 5 minutes and 49 Bq at t = 10 minutes. 'What is its activity at
at noon and 80 counts per min at 1 p.m. The expected count rate at 3 p.m. on the same day should be time t=O?
A. 50 c.p.m. A. 112 Bq
B. 55 c.p.m. B. 100 Bq
C. 60c.p.m. C. 95Bq
D. 65 c.p.m. D. 91 Bq
57. < BKAL 1998 Paper IIA- 41 > 61. < BKAL 2003 Paper IIA- 44 >
The activity of a sample of radioisotopes decreases to ½ of its initial value in 12 s. How much more time is needed for the A nuclide in a radioactive sample has a probability of 10--6 to decay in one second. What is the approximate half-life of
activity to decrease to t of its initial value 7 the sample?
A. 1 day
A. ., B. 1 week
B. 8 s C. 1 month
C. 12s D. 1 year
D. 16s
58. < BKAL 2000 Paper IIA- 44 > 62. < HKAL 2004 Paper ITA- 42 >
A radioactive source emits both a. and y radiation. A GM counter placing close to and i:n front of the source records a count The activity ofa radioactive sample is 1.0 x 106Bq. The half-life of the sample is 5.3 yems. Estimate the number of nuclei
rate of 500 counts per minute. The background count rate is 50 counts per IIllll.ute. Three different materials are placed in lll the sample that decay in the first day.
tum between the source and the counter. The following results are obtained. A. 5.2 X 102
B. 3.2 x 108
Material Recorded count rate / counts per minute C. 8.6 X }0lO
D. It cannot be estimated as the initial number ofnuclei in the sample is not given.
(Nil) 500
Cardboard X
l mm ofaluminium 63. < HKAL 2005 Paper IlA- 24 >
y
Smmoflead z The activity of a radioactive source depends on
(1) the number of active nuclei in the source
Which ofthe following is a sui1able set ofvalues for x, y and z ? (2) the half-life of the source
(3) the nature of the nuclear radiation emitted by the source
X y z A (1) only
A. 350 350 150 B. (3) only
B. 350 150 50 C. (1)&(2)only
c. 350 150 0 D. (2) & (3) only
...
D. 150 150 50
< BKAL 2006 Paper IIA- 24 >
59. <HKAL2001 PaperIIA-45 >
Some typical radiation doses are given as follows :
The table gives the corrected count rate (in counts per minute) from three Slllllples of radioisotopes at three different times.
Radiation dose
Isotopes omm 20 min 40min
Watcbinl!' television 0.005 mSv / hr for watc1..;.._ ev=• dav in a vear
X 480 243 119
fl,,;.,,. in an am:raft 0.001 mSv / hr
y 135 32 9
X-mvcheck 0.020 mSv each time
z 168 118 93
Arrange the following lll ascending order of total radiation dose lll one year.
From the above result, it can be concluded that (1) Watching television for 4 hours every day
(1) X produces the most penetrating radiation. (2) Travelling on an allcraft for 10 hours every month
(2) Yhas the largest decay constant. (3) Taking X-ray check every 6 months
(3) Zhas the longest half-life. A (1), (2), (3)
A (1) only
B. (3) only B. (2), (1), (3)
C. ( 1) &(2) only C. (1), (3), (2)
D. (2) &(3) only D. (3), (1), (2)
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. PE-RAI-M/15 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. PE-RAI-M/16
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
65. < HKAL 2006 Paper IIA - 23 > Part C : HKDSE examination questions
Which of the following gives the correct inteipretation of the decay constant of a radioactive substance?
A. It is the rate ofdisintegrations of the substance. 71. < HKDSE SamplePaper IA - 35 >
B. It is the number of disintegrations of the substance occurring on one half-life of the substance.
C. ltis the fraction of the active nuclei that undergoing decay in one second. On which ofthe following does the activity of a radioactive source depend ?
D. It is equal to the reciprocal of the half-life of the substance. (I) the nature of the nuclear radiation emitted by the source
(2) the half-life of the source
66. < HK.AL 2007Paper IlA -24 > (3) the number of active nuclei in the source
Radioactive source P consists of 64 x 10 11 active nuclei. Another source Q consists of 8 x 10 12 active nuclei. The half-lives A. (1) only
ofP and Qare 2 days and 3 days respectively. After how long will the number of active nuclei in the two sources be equal?
B. (2) only
(Assume that the daughter nuclides ofbothP and Qare stable.)
A. 6 days C. (1) & (2) only
B. 9days D. (2) & (3) only
C. 12days
D. 18 days
72. < HKDSE SamplePaper IA-36 >
67. < BKAL 2011 Paper IIA-43 > Different absorbers are placed in turn between a radioactive source and a Geiger-Muller tube. Three readings are taken for
Radioactive nuclides X and Y have half-lives 2 hours and 4 hOUIS respectively. The decay of both nuclides gives stable each absorber. The following data are obtained:
daughter nuclides. Initially samples Pand Q contain equal number of atoms of nuclide X and nuclide Y respectively. Which
of the following statements are correct? Absorber Count rate I s- 1
(I) The iilitial activity of sample Pis higher than that of sample Q.
(2) After 8 hours, sample Pcontains more active nuclei than sample Q. - 200 205 198
(3) After 8 hours, the chance of a nucleus ofXin sample Pdecaying :in the next second is greater than that ofa nucleus Paper 197 202 206
of Yin sample Q.
S mm alwninium 112 108 111
A. (1) & (2) only
B. (1) & (3) only 25mmlead 60 62 58
c. (2) & (3) only
SOmmlead 34 36 34
D . (1), (2) & (3)
'What type(s) of radiation does the source emit?
68. < HKAL 2012 Paper IlA- 44 > A J3 onfy
The activity ofa radioisotope is 250Bq at time t= 0 and S4 Bq at t=< 30 min. What is its activity at t = 10 min? B. r only
A. I30Bq C. J3 and y only
B. lS0Bq D. et,)3andy
C. l 8SBq
D. It cannot be found as its half-life is not given.
73. < HKDSEPractice Paper IA 35 > M
69. <HKAL2013PaperIIA-45>
Arrange the following lengths in ascending order of magnitudes.
(1) range ofcx-particles in air
(2) grating spacing ofa typical diffraction grating used in a school laboratory
(3) wavelength of ultra-violet radiation
A. (!), (2), (3)
B. (!), (3), (2)
C. (3), (1), (2)
D. (3), (2), (1)
A radioactive source is placed in front of a uniform magnetic field pointing into the paper as shown above. The count rates
70. < HKAL 2013 Paper IIA- 43 > recorded by the GM tubes at X and Y are 101 counts per minute and 400 cotmts per minute respectively. Which of the
following deductions must be correct?
The initial activity of two radioactive sources, X and Y, are the same. Both X and Y decay to give stable daughter nuclei.
The ratio of the activity ofXto that of Y after 12 hours is 4: L If the half-life ofXis 6 hours, what is the half-life of Y? A. The source does not emit a radiations.
A. 1.5 hours B. The source emits ,Bradiations.
B: 2 hours C. The source emits yradwtions.
C. 3 hours
D. 12hours D. The background count rate is about 100 counts per minute.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. PE-RAl-M/17 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. PE-RAl-M/ 18
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
74. < HKDSE Practice Paper IA - 34 > 79. < HKDSE2015 Paper IA -32>
Which of the following statements about Ct and ,8 particles is/are correct ? Some factories make use of radioactive source for manufacturing. Workers are required to wear clothes with film badges to
(1) The mass of an a particle is greater than that ofa ,Bparticle. measure the dosage of radiation received over a period oftime. Which type of radiation below CANNOT be monitored by
(2) aparticles have a monger penetrating power than /J particles. the film badges 7
(3) .An asource can discharge a positively charged metal sphere nearby. A. o;-radiation
A. (1) only B. )}-radiation
B. (2) only C. y-radiation
C. (1) & (3) only D. X-rays
D. (2) & (3) only
(Nil) 450 �
cardboard X
1 mm of aluminium y
2mmoflead z c. + D. +
Which ofthe following is the most suitable set of values for x,y and z?
X y z
A 300 300 100
B. 300 100 50
C. 100 100 0
D. 100 50 50
84. <HKDSE 2019 Paper IA�31 >
The background count iatc in an experiment is determined using a GM counter. Four readings of the
minute
eounttlllC in each me takm. Which setof,eadings below is the most probable?
p-.....:.p--Q
�R -z_ T
T-..s�
DSE Physics - Saction E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl -MS/ 01 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/02
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
HKEAA's Matking Scbcme is prepat'ed for the mamm• refe:cnce. It &hould not be re&aJ;ded as a set ofmodelanswcra.
Students and teachers who are not involved in the nw:king proceas are advised to interpret the Mai:kini: Scheme with care. 3. D
(!) Decay does notmean splitting of the atoms.
M.C. Answers In 20 minutes, that is, 2 half.Jives, there is still 25% of radioactive atomsleft.
(2)
I. B 11. C 21. D 31. B 41. D (3) Half-life is the time taken for half oftbe number ofradioactive atoms to decay.
9. B
M.C. Solution (!) The product of decay also carries mass, thus the total mass of the sample should remain unchanged.
✓ (2) Half-life isthe time taken for the activity to drop to half of the mitial value.
1. B It takes 1 half-life for half of the number of undecayed nuclei to decay,
�)
MassofX: 4g�2g� lg but it does not mean another half is to be decayed in the next half-life.
MassofY: 4-1=3g
10. C
2. D l--4.!_ ---,---), .!_ --)- ,!_
Ionization power : o: > j3 > y 2 . 4 8
In ascending order : y, j3 , o: 24
Half-life = = 8 min.
3
DSE Physics • Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RA1 -MS/03 DSE Physics · Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/04
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
C 19. D
l � .!.. � .!. � l (1) X-rays is a transverse wave, they do not consist of any particles.
2 4 8
✓ (2) X-rays can affect films, and be detected by films.
After 66 years, the fraction of the source remains undecayed is ..!_ ✓
8 Cl) X-rays are used in airport to detect weapons in luggage.
12. B
20. C
Time/minute 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 Charged particles can be deflected by both a magnetic field and an electric field.
a is (+)-charged and J3 is (-)-charged, they can be deflected; y is neutral, it cannot be deflected.
Corrected count rate/ cpm 96 76 60 49 38 30 24
As the initial corrected count rate (96 cpm) reduces to abouthalf(48 cpm) in 6minutes 21. D
half-life is about 6 minutes. .x! 1 x2. 1 ,!. 1 ,!_ l
1 ------1...-). - � - ---4 - � -
2 4 8 16
13. C 60 "" 15
:. Half-life = min.
As activity drops from 40 Bq to 20 Bq in 28 minutes :. halMife = 28 min 4
14. B 22. A
By using Left-hand rule : • A. J3 particles can penetrate through paper but stopped by a thln sheet of aluminium..
ill magnetic force on ct which is positive is towards the left ✓ B. J3 particles are (-)-charged particles:::::, deflected by B-field
@ magnetic force on J3 which is negative is towards the right ✓ C. J3 particles are radiation, they can blacken films and be detected.
Thus, a is deflected to the left while J3 is deflected to the right ✓ D. /3 are particles, thus they can travel in vacuum.
As o: is much heavier, the degree of deflection of o: is much smaller than that of ]3.
23. A
15. B a is (+) charged, it is attracted towards the negative plates and thus deflected towards the right
It is a symbol for all types ofradioactive substances. J3 is(-) charged, it is attracted towards the positive plate and thus deflected towards the left
25. C
18. D ✓ a-source emits a-particles that can iocize airmolecules to give ion-pairs.
(1)
✓ A. J3-particles are particles that can travel in vacuum The ion-pairs can discharge sphere.
✓ B. Infra-red is a type ofelectromagnetic waves that can travel in vacuum ✓ Touching the sphere with a finger js an Earthing process that can discharge the sphere.
(2)
✓ C. Microwave is a type of electromagnetic waves that can travel in vacuum
(3) Since the rod does not touch the sphere,
D. Ultrasonics are sound waves with frequency> 20000 Hz, sound waves cannot travel in vacuum. there is no flow of charge and does the charge in the sphere remains the same
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/05 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RA1 -MS /06
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
26. D 34. B
Corrected count rate initially = 560 - 80 = 480 counts per minute Pdetects y radiation sincey does not deflect in magnetic field
Corrected count rate after 6 hours = 140 - 80 = 60 counts per minute Q detects 13 radiation since magnetic force acts downwards on negative charged particles by using Left hand rule.
Change of corrected count rate after each half..life: 480 --). 240 --+ 120 � 60
35. C
Half-life = � = 2 hours
X: N � ½ N � ¼N � N t
27. D Y: 8N �4N�2N�N�½N�¼N�tN
A a:notawave After 6 days, both X and Yhave the same number of undecayed atoms of ¼N
B. y: do not have charge => cannot be deflected by B-field
c. y : weak ionization power 36. A
✓ D. ct :particles can travel in vacuum; y: electromagnetic waves can also travel in vacuum. From the graph, the backgrolllld radiation is 50.
The initial total count rate is 350, thus the initial corrected count rate is 350- 50 "" 300.
28. D After one half-life, the corrected count rate should drop to 150, thus the total count rate is 150 + 50 = 200.
Radioactive sources should be stored in lead castles but not a wooden box only The total count rate drops to 200 after 4 minutes, thus the half-life is 4 minutes.
33. C 41. D
After inserting the paper, the count rate is approximately unchanged, thus the source does not emit ct. Assume that the background count rate is b counts per lllmute.
After inserting the 5 mm Al. the count rate drops significantly, thus the source emits l3. After one half-life, the corrected count rate is reduced to bali
After inserting the lead, the count rate drops significantly, thus the source emits y.
:. (1000 - b) x ½ = (528 - b) :. b = 56
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/07 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/08
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
42. D 49. D
By Left hand rule, the magnetic force is pointing downwards. After colliding with a helium nucleus, it must be aright-angledfork track.
In order to balance the magnetic force, the electric force should be pointing upwards. Option B is not correct since the angle of separation is not 90°.
Since the electric force is opposite to the electric :field for a negative charge, the ,Bparticle,
thus the electric field is pointing downwards. 50. B
After a period oftime, both the ballsP and Qare dischargedby the ions produced by the o; particles.
Thus, the two neutral balls would not exert forces on each other. 51. C
As the alpha particles would ionize the air, the ions then discharge the gold-leaf;
44. B thus the gold-leaf would collapse.
(j) 11�
(240) = (960) (½) •• t1,2 = 1 min.
211
46. A
54. D
A. All the three types of nuclear radiations can travel through a vacuum.
Letx be the initial count rate ofP, then (600-x) is the initialcount rate of Q.
✓ B. a radiation can be stopped by a piece of paper, and also by a thicker piece of aluminium.
✓
✓
C.
D.
/J particles are electrons moving with high speed.
All the three types of nuclear radiations, including_r, can blacken a photographic fihn.
Q, (600-x)
, ... 600-x
2
,- 600-x
4
(120-b)x ½ = (64-b)
48. C
:. b = 8
By A= k N :. A cc N, activity is rurectlyproportional to the number ofundecayed nuclei.
After inserting the lead sheet, all the a particles would be absorbed.
The graph is a straight line passing through the origin. Thus, the detector can then only measure the background radiation, 'Which is 8 counts per minute.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl -MS/ 09 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/10
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity
56. D 62. C
Let b be the background radiation. Since the time ofl day is much less than the half-life of5.3 years, activity remains constant in 1 day.
57. C
When the activity drops to t ofits initial value : (½A}: A· e-k(l1) k = 0.0916s-1 l!,J,l = 2.41138 X 10 14 - 2.41052X 1014 = 8.6X }0IO
When the activit y drops to ¼ of its initial value: (¼A)= A. e-(M9I6)(t+i1) :. t = 12s 63. C
By A = k N :. Activity A depends on
CD decay constant k or half-life t112
58. A
@ number of undecayed nuclei Nin the source
Cardboard: Due to the abs01ption ofa:--radiation, the count rate should dr op .
2
By t = ln ,decayconstantkisrelatedtotb.ehalf-life.
lmmofA l: Since there is no (3-radiation. the count rate should remain the same as x. I k
SmmofPb: The count rate should drop due to the partjal absorption ofy'"Ill.diation.
However, the lead would not absorb all they-radiation, thus the count rate cannot drop to 50 cpm. 64. C
Thus, the value ofzshould be 150. Radiation dose of watching television for 4 hours evecy day = 0.005 mSv/hr x 4 hr = 0.02 m.Sv
(1)
(2) Radiation dose of flying inan aitcraft = 0.001 mSv/hr x 10 h/month x 12months = 0.12mSv
59. D
(3) RadiationdoseofX--raycheck = 0.020mSvx 2 = 0.04mSv
(1) Type ofradiation cannot be known from the count rate at different times
Ascending order of total radiation dose : (1), (3), (2)
✓ (2) Yhas the shortest half-life since after 20 minutes it drops to about ¼
By decay constant k = 1n 2 :. Yhas the largest decay constant 65. C
tin
Decay constant is the probability of decay per unit time,
✓ (3) Zhas the longesthalf-life since after 20 minutes it drops only to about 70 %
it� the fraction of the active nuclei present that decay in one second.
60. B
66. D
By A = Ao e-kt
Fornu clideP: 64 ➔ 32 ➔ 16 ➔ 8 ➔ 4 ➔ 2 ➔ l ➔ ½ ➔ ¼ ➔ ¼ :timetaken = 2x9 = 18days
(JJ (70) = Ao e-k(5)
FornuclideQ: 8 ➔ 4 ➔ 2 ➔ 1 ➔ ± ➔ ¾ ➔ f :timetaken = 3x6 = 18days
Cl) (49) = Ao e-k{10)
70
49
= "' k = 0.0713 A0 = lOOBq
By (64
OR
61. B
The decay constant k is the chance of decay per unit time.
:. k = I(rs-1
3-t/2=-t/3
Half-life = ln2 = l n2 = 6.93xl0 5 s = 8days "" 1 week
k 10 ➔ t = 18days
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE -RAl-MS/11 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/12
RAI : Radiation & Radioactivity RAI : Radiation & Radioactivity
67. B 73. B
✓ (1) By k = In 2 I t112 ,Xhas shorter half-.Jife, thusXhas greater decay constantk. A. Since there is no count rate recorded at positions aboveX, the source may or may not emit ara.diations.
By A = k N,Xhas greater decay constant k, thus the activity ofX in sampleP is higher. ✓ B. Since the count rate at fis greater thanX, there must be some radiation deflected downwards to reach Y.
(2) After 8 hours, the number ofXin P drops to III6 and the number of Yin Q drops to 1/4. By Lefthand rule, the doV1Dward magnetic force should act on negative particles, that is, ,Bradiations.
Thus the number ofXin sampleP is less.
C. The source may or may not emit yradiation,
✓ (3) The chance of decay in unit time is the decay constant. as the count rate atX may consist of yand background or background only
As. the decay constant ofXis greater, the chance is also greater.
D. The source may emit yradiation, thus the count rate of 101 cpm atXmay be due to rand background.
68. B
74. C
By A= Aoe-"'
✓ (!) The mass ofan aparticle is the mass of a helimn nucleus but the mass of a ,Bparticle is nearly zero.
(54) = (250) e -k(30)
:. k = 0.051I min- 1 (2 ) The penetrating power of ais weaker than ,8.
At t=lOmi n.: A= ( 250)e -(0.05ll)(l0) = 15 0B q ✓ (3) aparticles can ionize the air, the ions then discharge the charged metal sphere.
69. D 75. C
(3) wavelength of ultra-violet radiation is of the o rder of 10---s m By N= N.,(½)1°120 = 0.70 7Nc
(2) grating spacing is of the order ofI0 m -5
f= .!!_ = 0.707
(1) range of o: in air is ofthe order of 10-2m ( a few cm) N.
0.75 > J> 0.5
70. C
ForX:12hoursistwohalf-lives :. Ax =Aox(±'f = ¼Ao 76. C
After 12 hours, Cathode rays (beam of electrons) is emitted fromFwhich is the negative terminal, thus Q is the positive terminal.
Ax:Ay=4:1 When electrons hit the metal target at T, X-rays are emitted from T.
71. D
78. A
(!) The nature or type of radiation (a, /3, y) emitted would not affect or relate to the activity of the source.
Note thaty radiation can never be totally absorbed.
✓ (2) The activity A is proportional to the decay constant k, which is related by the half-life.
Thus, zmust be greater than the background radiation of SO counts per minute.
✓ (3) The activity A is p roportional to the number of active (undecayed) nuclei N.
The only option is A thatz is 100 counts per minute.
72. C
After inserting the paper, the count rate is approximately unchanged, thus the source does not emit er. 79. A
After inserting the 5 mm Al, the count rate drops significantly, thus the source emits j3. a-radiation cannot pass through the plastic bag to reach the film, thus a-radiation cannot be detected by film badge.
After inserting the lead, the count rate drops significantly, thus the source emits y. The other 3 types of radiation can pass the plastic bag to reach the film inside the badge to be detected.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RAl-MS/13 DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAl-Q / 01
RAl : Radiation & Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
By N = No (½)'''�'
Part A : BKCE examination questions
Nx (½)2413 = Nv (½):!414
1. < HKCE 1982 Paper I- 8 >
6
Nx (½)' = Ny (½)
N
Nx N,
,,,,�
Ny I
82. C
X A. Both /3 and r can ionize air particles.
X B. Both /3 and r can travel through vacuum.
✓ C. Both of them can be detected by a film.
X D. Only /J carries charge, r is neutral.
83. A
In an electric field. ,Bthat carries negative charge will deflect towardsthe(+) plate, thus it deflects upwards.
a that carries positive charge will deflect towardsthe (-)plate, 1hus it deflects downwards.
As mass of/J is much smaller than that of a, the deflection of /J should be much great er than that of a.
t I nrin
The above figure show the decay curves oftwo radioactive elements X and Yboth emitting �-particles. No is the number of
radioactive atoms present at time t""' 0 and N is the number at the end oft nrinutes.
(b) A mixture of X and Y is placed in front of a Geiger counter. Initially, they have the same number of radioactive atoms.
Which of ht e two, X or Y, will be mainly responsible for the reading shown on the Geiger counter during the first four
minutes? Estimate the fraction of the total number of counts due to that element. (5 marks)
DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAl -Q /02 DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAl -QI 03
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
(a) Explain why the counter registers a reading even when no radioactive source is placed nearby. (1 mark)
Time/ days 0 2 4 6 8 10
Activity I Bq 100 68 47 32 22 15
(b) When a radioactive source is placed near the counter, the counter registers 520,510 and 514 counts per minute in the
(a) Plot the decay graph below to show the activity against time. first three consecutive minutes. Explain why the three readings differ from each other ? {2 marks)
(c) 'When a piece of paper is placed between the source and the counter, the counter registers 540, SlO and 512 counts per
minute in the first three consecutive minutes. However, when the paper is replaced by an alummium sheet, the counter
gives readm.g of7, 9 and 8 counts per minute in three consecutive minutes.
Whattype(s) ofradiation (ex,� ory) is/are being emitted by the source? Giveareasonforyouranswer. (4marks)
�-=��-B--1
� ...-...,.'•--�
'''
: HI ':
'
' ' ''
''
'--------------'
(a) What is the sign ofthe charge carried by P?
(b) The particle Pis emitted from a radioactive source which undergoes a-, �- and y-decay simultaneously.
(i) the activity of the sample after 5 days, and (ii) Draw a diagram to show how to prevent the other two kinds of particles from reaching H. Show the tracks of the
I
DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAl -Q / 04 DSE PhYsics - Section E : Question PE-RAl-Q/05
RAl : Radiation and Raclioacti.vity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
(a) What should be the count rate of the source after 25 minutes?
(b) Plot a graph to show the theoretical count rate recorded by the GM counter for the :first 100 minutes.
Time/min.
0 IO 20 30 40 so 60
The figure above shows the variation of count rate of a radioactive source measured by a GM counter 'With time.
(a) Find from the figure, the backgrmmd count rate of the room.
(b) Find the count rate due only to the radioactive source at time 0.
aluminium foil (c) The actual readings of the GM counter are as follows:
(a) When the aluminium foils are placed near an ct source, the foils are found to gradually collapse. Briefly explain why. 50 75 100
Time/min. 0
(2marlcs)
Count rate / counts per second 560 154 70 31
(c) Ifa piece of cardboard is placed between the source and the lead block, what type(s) of radiation would be recorded on
the photographic film? (2 marks)
==""'="===
PQ
Photographic film
X X X X
X X X X (d) Suggest an alternative detector to replace the photographic film in the experiment. (2mm)
X X X X
X X X X
Lead block
I SourceX
The above figure shows the set-up of an experiment carried out in an evacuated chamber to study the radiation from a 10. < HKCE 1993 Paper I 7 >
radioactive sourceX X emits ct, 1,3 and y radiation. A magnetic field (pointing into the paper) is applied. The photographic
M
film is developed and marks in the positions P and Qare observed. A cloud chamber is used to observe the tracks ofaMparticles.
(a) In the figure below, sketch and label the paths of the tx, j3 and 'I radiation emitted from the sourceX (5mm) (a) Descn'be the tracks of erparticles in the cloud chamber. (2mm)
X X X X
X X X X
X X X X (h) An a*particle collides with a helium nucleus to form a fork track. \Vhat is the angle of the fork track and what does
this angle indicate? (2 marks)
X X X X
I SourceX
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
PE-RAl-Q / 08
(a) The counter is placed close in front ofaradioactive source P. The following results are obtained:
Mareri,l Recorded count rate / counts per minute
Time t/b.our 0 20 40 60 so 100 120
- 750
Recorded count rate / counts er minute 620 400 270 199 157 133 118
Paper X
(i) Find the corrected count rate at t = O. (1 marl<)
5 mm.Aluminium y
(ii) Plot the graph of the corrected count rate against time on the graph below. (5 =ks) SmmLead z
From the following list, choose suitable values for x,y andz _:
0. 100,195,540, 750
{Note: A reading may be used more than once.)
(b) To find out the kind(s) ofradiation emitted by P, sheets of difference materials are placed in tum between P and the The background count rate recorded by the counter is 100 counts per minute.
counter. The following results ere obtained:
(a) Explain why the three readings for each absorber are not identical. (1 mark)
Marerutl Recorded count rate / counts per minute
- 620
Pancr 623
5 mmAluminiutn 98 (b) Explain how the above results show that the source emits � :radiation only and it does not emit a: andr radiation.
(4=ks)
5mmL,rui 101
Explain howthe result shows that P emits � radiation only and it does not emit ex. or y radiation. (3 -
DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAI-Q/10 DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAI-Q/11
1
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity RAI : Radiation and Radioactivity
Recorded count rate atP I counts per min Carol performs an experiment to measure the half-life ofa radioactive source. She places a Geiger-Muller tube in front of the
Vcrticalliue source and the following results are obtained:
s
d Battery(
Lea
block
R,=w{3j�
w ----�- _____fb=
l
/GMtube
Time t/hour
400
10
225
20
154
30
119
40
107
50
105
60
100
70
102
(a) Plot a graph of the coimt rate against time in the Figure below.
Qi
ij-2ocm-i
Figure2
Figure 1 shows a set-up used to study the radiation from a radioactive source. A GM tube is placed at position P, which is at
"""'1
20 cm from the source. Two coils A and B connected to a battery and a switch Sare placed between the source and the GM
tube as shown. Initially, Sis open and the variation of the count rate recorded by the GM tube with time is shown in Figure 2.
(a) Explain why the count rate shown in Figure 2 is not due too: particles, no matter what kinds of radiation are emitted
by the source. (2 marks)
(b) Now switch S is closed. The GM tube is placed at positions P and Q in turn (see Figure l) and the count rates recorded
are shown in Figure 3 and 4 respectively. When the GM tube is placed at any paint vertically above P, an average count
rate of 100 counts per minute is recorded at each point.
�b._ �t=:.,�
Recorded count rate atP / counts per min Recorded count rate at QI counts per min
Figure3 Flgurc4
(i) State the direction ofthe magnetic field formed between coils A and B. (1 mark)
(ii) What kind of radiation is recorded when the GM tube is held at any point vertically above P ? Explain your
""""· (3 """")
(iii) What conclusion about the radiation emitted by the source can you draw from Figure 3 and Figure 4? Explain your
answer. (4marks)
(iv) Explain why the sum of the average count rates recorded in Figure 3 and Figure 4 is greater than that recorded in
Figure 2. (2 marks)
(b) Estimate the background count rate.
(c) The above experiment cannot determine whether o: particles are emitted by the source. Suggest a method for :finding
out the :mswer. (2 m arks) (c) Estimate the corrected count rate at t = 0. Hence, or othern'Ule, estimate the half-life of the source.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAl-Q/12 . DSE Physics - Section E : Question
1
PE-RAl-Q/13
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
15, < HKCE 2006 Paper I- 8 > 16. < BK.CE 2007 Paper I - 8 >
Workers of nuclear plants are required to wear film badges (see Figure 1) to monitor their exposure to radiation. Inside the In a physics lesson, a teacher uses the apparatus shown in Figure 13 to find the range of a particles in the air. Describe the
film badge, an opaque plastic bag is wrapped around a sheet of photographic film. Aluminium and lead sheets are also procedures ofthe experiment. (4marlcs)
placed inside the badge (see Figure 2) so that the types of incoming radiation can be distinguished.
Cl source with
1 mm aluminium sheet a bolder
3 mm aluminium sheet
5 mm lead sheet
photographic film
v,,rapped inside an
opaque plastic bag
(b) 'Why is an opaque plastic bag used to wrap the photographic film? (1 mark)
(c) The films of three workers John, Mary and Ken were developed. The Table below shows the de gre es of blackening on
different regions of the films inside the badges which they wore.
17. <BK.CE 2008 Paperl-12 >
Degree ofblackening ( 0 - 5 ) {a) A teacher places a radioactive source 1 cm in front of a Geiger-Muller tube (GM tube) and measures the count rate.
Regions on the film ( 0 = not blackened: 5 =most blackened) When be inserts a piece ofpaper between the radioactive source and the GM tube, be finds that there is no significant
John M•-· Ken change in the measured count rate. State the conclusion about the type of radiation emitted from the radioactive source.
(1 marl<)
Benea1h the onen window 5 5 5
Beneath the 1 mm aluminium sheet 5 3 4
Beneath the 3 mm allUllinium sheet 5 1 2
Beneath the 5 mm lead sheet 4 0 0 The teacher then conducts another experiment to investigate the deflection of radiations inside a magnetic field as shown in
Figure 1. The GM tube can be rotated from 0° to 180° around the magnetic field. Figure 2 shows the count rate recorded
(i) Based on the results in the above Table, explain which type(s) of radiation John and Mary are definitely being at different angles with or without the magnetic field.
exposed to respectively. (3 marks) 180 °
/
/
/,,;-;-;: -�-�:;z��
xx xx
xxxx
x x x �..
xxxx
region with magnetic field
pointing into the paper
�
[s :
radioactive source / xx xx :; x \
in aleadbox f ���� xxxx \
(u) Give one reason why different degrees ofblackening were recorded on the films of Mary and Ken. (1 marl<) xxxx xxxx '
Figure 1 x
..;-:--�x�x�ix��H"7-�xi�t�it---,',- 90
°
' xxxx xx
\ XX XX X 1
'
'
xx xx xx
xxxx xxxx
xxxx x xxx ,
,' j
(d) Suggest one hazard of exposure to ionizing radiations. (1 ma,k) '.... ����� ����,/
.... �
.... .. _
.. --- _..... 7'-......,.. GM tube
� connected to co1.mter
DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAI-Q/14 DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RAl-Q/15
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
2oof------------+'·-.�,�-------------- E
, ··,�
V 1,
fr
I• .1
1oof--....::===<F =='-----i'-
withmagneticfi.eld
--
:_t
, ,-,------
I \
, ------
50 �-�•-•L--•�
-�----- ·<�-: ::,-.: ... -::-.-:;,��'
60 120 180 240
�----�'----'�-------�'---,.0/' A radioactive source emits � particles. The corrected count rates are recorded and plotted in the above figure.
0 50 90 180
(a) A student comments that the readings have been taken carelessly because the points plotted in the above Figure do not
(b) Estimate the count rate due to the background radiation. (1 mark) fall on a smooth curve. Do you agree? Explain your reasoning. (l mark)
(c) Using the result in Figure 2, explain why it can be concluded that the radioactive source emits fl and r rays. (4 marks)
(b) Use the above F.igure to estimate the half life of the radioactive source.
(d) Estimate the count rate due to each type of radiation at 6 =: 90° without the magnetic .field. Write the answer in the Table
below.
(d) Express in words the relationship between the decay constant and the probability of an atom decaying. (!mm<)
Type of radiation Count rate/ counts per minute
a 0
/3
r
(2 msooJ
PE-RAl-Q/ 16 PE-RAl-Q/17
1
DSE Physics - Section E : Question DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
Part C : HKDSE examination questions 20. When Voyager I was launched, the number ofplutonium-238 atoms in the source was 3.2 x 10:S.
Given : half-life ofplutonium--238 = 87.74 years.
19. <HKDSE Practice Paper m � 11 >
Take 1 year= 3.16 x 107 s.
The decay of radioactive isotope protactinium-238 (Z38Pa) has a half-life of approximately 136 s. A sample ofZ3 8pa is put in
front of a GM tube and the initial count rate is 1000 counts per minute. The background count rate is 50 counts per minute. (b) (i) Find the activity, in Bq, of the plutonium source at the time of launch.
(a) It is known that the decay of 238Pa does not emit yradiation. Suggest a simple test to verify the radiation from 238Pa is
,8 radiation but not a radiation. (3 marks)
(ii) When a plutonium-238 atom decays, it releases 5.5 MeV of energy. Estimate the power, in kW, delivered by the
source at the time oflauncb. (2 marks)
(c) Hence, or othorwi.se, estimate the time taken for the count rate to drop to 250 counts per minute. (3 marks)
(1ii) The RTG of Voyage I is still in operation as Voyage I just left the solar system in September 2013 after it
'MIS launched 36 years ago. Estimate the corresponding power delivered by the plutonium source, expressed in
percentage ofthe power delivered at the time oflaunch. (2 marks)
(a) The plutonium-238 source is sealed inside a thin metallic casing of the RTG. The photo shows a NASA staff handling
the RTG with his bare bands. Explain why it is fine for it to be handled by the staff in this way. (1 mark)
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RAl-QS/01 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RAl- QS /02
RA! : Radiation and Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
HKEAA's Marlcing Scheme :is prepared for the :markers' reference. It should not be zegarded as a set of model answers.
Students and teachers who are not involved in the marking :PIOCeSS are advised to inteqmet the Marklng Scheme with care. 3. (•) There is background radiation. [ll
0.5
Fraction of total number of counts due to X = = 0.862 [2J 4.
0.5+0.08 (•) The charge is positive. [ll
0
�-
0
< correct deflection of a. to the slit>
I
[ll
< correct indication of the direction of the magnetic :field > [1]
< /3 and y correctly deflected > [l]
OR
Use electric :field [ll
·yYl· �-
< cOJrect deflection of a: to the slit> [l]
< correct indication of the direction of the dectric :field or polarity> [l]
< j3 and y correctly deflected > [ll
< Two axes correctly labeled > [ll
< Scales properly marked> [lJ
< Points correctly plotted> [l] 5. (,) Background count rate = 40 counts per minute [2]
< Curve correctly draVID > [l]
(b) CoWlt rate at time 0 200-40 (ll
(b) {i) activity after 5 days = 39 Bq < accept 38 Bq to 40 Bq >
. [lJ 160 counts per minute (l]
(il') half-life = 3.7 days < accept 3.6 to 3.8 days> [ll (o) HalfMlife = 7 minutes < accept 6.5 minutes to 7.5 minutes> [2]
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RAl-QS/03 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RAl -QS /04
RAl : Racliation and Radioactivity RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity
6. (a) The a. particles ionize air. [1] 8. (b) Both Yes or No are acceptable but the reasons should be consistent. [l]
The ions then. discharge the aluminium foils. [1] Reason for Yes : [2]
(b) The foils would collapse slower [1] * The cumulative effect ofradiation is hannfu1
since y has weaker ionizing power [1] Reason for No : {any ONE) [2]
* The background radiation in a concrete building is weak and not hazardous
7. (a) 280countspersecond [2]
* The chance ofbeing harmed by other factors such as fire in a wooden hut is increased
< No mark is awarded if OIJly answer Yes or No>
[4]
9. (a) p Q
===o=>F====Photogrnphic film
TT
(c) Yes, the GM counter is working properly. 10. (a) Thetracksare(ANYTWO): [2]
[1]
The readings do not match the theoretical curve exactly due to the random nature of radiation. [2] * straight
* thick
* short
8. (a) (i) cosmic radiation from the outer space [1] * of about the same length
(u) from the rock [l]
(b) The angle is 90a [l]
(ili) from the coal (or carbon) [l] The masses of an o; particle and a helium nucleus are the same. [l]
DSE Physics · Section E : Question Solution PE-RAJ -QS I 05 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RAJ-QS/06
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity RAJ : Radiation and Radioactivity
11. (a) (i) Corrected count rate= 520 counts per minute [1] IL (b) OR
The source does not emit a radiation
(ii) Trme t/hour 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 [l]
since the recorded count rat e almost remains tmchanged when a sheet of paper is inserted.
Corrected count rate / counts per minute 520 300 170 99 57 33 18 The count rate drops significantly when aluminium is inserted, this illustrates that it emits ,B radiation.
(b) As the count rates remain unchanged when a sheet of paper is inserted,
the source does not emit a radiation. [l]
Ju the count rates drop significantly'Mlen 1 mm aluminium sheet is inserted,
(ii) The radiation dose received byKen is higher than that ofMary. [I]
16. Place the ct source close to and facing the GM tube. [I]
Increase their separation gradually and observe the count rate reading. [I]
Mark the point for the rapid drop in count rate. [I]
Measure the distance between et source and the GM tube with the metre rule to give the range. [I]
(d) The decay constant is equal to the probability of decay of an atom per unit time. [I]
15. (a) o: radiation cmmotbe detected. [I] OR
(b) To prevent light rays from entering the bag and blackening the film. [I] The decay constant is equal to the probability of decay ofan atom in 1 s. [I]
PE-RAl-QS I 09 Hong Kong Diploma of Secondary Education Examination
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution
RAl : Radiation and Radioactivity Physics - Compulsory part ( ,1.,JHJ! ;;-)
Section A - Heat and Gases (�:fu JilUHI:)
1. Temperature. Heat and Internal energy (ill.£ , M::fo' r"J ils)
19. (a) Insert a piece ofpaper between the sample and the GM tube. 2. Transfer Processes (�#�:i&>U.)
The count rate will reniainapproximately unchanged, showing that n o a radiation is emitted [1] 3. Change of State ('m/$/rott.�)
4. General Gas Law (f,;&Jlllt�#)
Insert a S mm aluminium plate between the sample and the GM tube. [1] 5. IGneticTheory (7/"-f;J!fh'tit-)
The count rate will drop to the background count rate level, showing that p radiation is emitted. [1] Section B - Force and Motion (:h :fl;1�1t;)
1. PositionandMovement (1!!.It.,fr,;f$'f!J)
2 3 1
(b) k = 1n = 5.10 x 10- s- [1] 2. Newton'sLaW'S(4'-'i.li�.f.1t)
136 3. Moment ofForce (h �)
4. Work,EnergyandPower(fh'1, JJsi!:,fr,-')7�)
(c) Initial corrected count rate = 1000- 50 = 950 cpm 5. Momentum(tli:11:)
Final corrected count rate = 250 - 50 = 200 cpm 6. Projectile Motion (4:l!tt�ti;)
[1]
7. drcularMotion ( !lll fti �11,)
By C = Coe-"'
eo(½J''"' 8. Gravitation (�! :h)
By C=
(½f"
OR [1]
Section C -Wave Motion (1£1½)
e-5.lO><!O'"' I I. WavePropagation(i.t�-ffU!!)
{2QQ) = (950) (200) a (950) 2. WavePhenomena(ii.W,,.;Jt.�)
t = 306s t = 306s 3. Reflection and Refraction of Light (-'Ciro &..M .&.-11/"Af)
[1]
4. Lenses (:i!:11:)
5. Wave NatureofLight (:16i¥Jut�!l¼·!i.)
6. Sound C *¾)
(a) The penetrating power of a is so weak that it cannot pass through the thin metallic casing of the RTG. Section D-Electricity and Magnetism ('ili:;:fi,.fl't)
20 . [1]
1. Electrostatics (m-1i:4':)
2. Electric Circuits (1!:4-)
(b) ( i) k = lnZ = InZ = 2.50 X 10-10 S-1 [1] 3. Domestic Electricity ( �.§-J!l 'l!r)
1u2 (87.74x3.16x10 7 ) 4. Magnetic Field (Zii:1§-)
'i
5. Electromagnetic Induction (1t:Zii<l?.4)
Ao = kN = (2.50 X !0-1°) (3.2 X 1025) [1] 6. Alternating Current (�1J!i't)
= 8.00 x 1015 Bq [1] Section E-Radioactivity and Nuclear Energy (�Af"Yl.$.:fu��)
1. Radiation and Radioactivity ($ii#'f!':a:.M a�)
(ii) P = EA 2. AtomicModel (�-1-�zll!.)
3. Nuclear Energy (#;ils)
= (5.5 X 10 5 X 1.6 X 1Q-l9} (8 X 10 15) [ 1]
= 7040W"" 7.04kW [1] Physics - Elective part (ll!1/HI' ;;-)
f. 1 (½)f.u. (½?f7.
1. Rutherford's atomicmodel (1.t£:t&./f.T,nl;�)
74 2. Photoelectric effect (;It. 'QtU)
= = = x100% = 75.2% [2] 3. Bohr's atomicmodelofhydrogen (;,liilifl/J i.�+.fit�)
4. Particlesorwaves($t.-1-�£t)
< accept using the ratio of number of nuclei N> < accept 75% > 5. Probing into nano scale (a��;/Hf·-l'f.)
Elective 3-Energy and Use of Energy (�:i;:fi,J/Gaf.��ffl)
1. Electricity at home ( �� ffl -t)
2. Energy efficiency in building (;it.1/!-fl/Jils�tt.*)
3. Energy efficiencyin transportation (�-�{il)iig!!li.it$)
/ 4. Non-renewable energy sources (;;r:�*1:..@.il-)
5. Renewable energy sources ("tif*1:.�U!t)
Elective4- Medical Physics (-§�Jihl!$')
1. Making sense ofthe eye (Elli(:)/! '5)
2. Makingsenseoftheear(.lfl(:),tl.'g')
3. Medical imaging using non-ionizing radiation (�f- 1!l;Nf.ti.M¥-$-�-/!,$)
I 4. Medicalimagingusingion.izingradiation ('19:,.♦iAf§�i§�.!j.',)
I DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA2 : Atomic Model
000
acting out
/0,,
lilagnetic field and the resulting tracks are as shown in the figure.
ofthepaper
What are the atomic number and the mass number of the
remaining nuclide?
Atomic Number Mass Number
0 0
0r00
A. Z-2 A-4
B. Z+l A-4
radioactive
C. Z+! A nuclide
D. Z-1 A-4
3. <HKCE1981Paperll-31>
Which of the following statements concerning isotopes of an element is/are correct ?
(1) They have the same number of neutrons.
(2) They have the same chemical andphysical properties.
(3) They have the same atomic number but different mass numbers.
A. (1) only
B. (3) only
C. (!) & (2) only
D. (2) & (3) only
I
11.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA2 : Atomic Model
D C. Smoke detectors
D. Thickness gauge
Detector
In a factory producing aluminium sheets of 1 mm thickness, a thickness gauge is used to monitor the thickness of aluminium 20. < HKCE 2001 Paper II- 41 >
sheets. Which of the following states the comet radioactive source to be used in the thickness gauge and the reason behind ?
The below shows part of a radioactive series.
Sour« Reason
A. a The amount of a particles passing through aluminium depends on its thickness.
B. fJ The amount of/3 particles passing through alurcinium depends on its thickness.
Which of the following nuclei are isotopes of the same element?
C. fJ /3 particles are less hannfu1 to human beings.
A. Pand Q
D. r r radiation has the greatest penetrating power.
B. PandR
C. PandS
17. < HK.CE 1998 Paper II - 39 > D. QandS
A nucleus Xemits a beta particle to form a daughter nucleus Y. Which of the following statements is/are correct ?
(1) Xand Yhave the same number of neutrons. 21. < HKCE 2001 Paper II- 39 >
(2) The number ofprotons in Xis greater than that in Yby 1.
Radium (�Ra) decays by emitting an a. particle to form a product nucleus X. Which of the following shows the correct
(3) The total numbers of neutrons and protons inX and Y are equal.
equation for this decay ?
A. (!)only
B. (3) only A. 2;:Ra + a. ---+ 2;� X
C. (!) & (2) o nly
B. 2;!Ra ---+ �X + a.
D. (2) & (3) only
C. �Ra ---+ �X + a.
Mass number A
22. < HKCE 2002 Paper II - 42 >
Np Which of the following is/are application(s) of radioactivity?
237
(1) to estimate the age of ancient remains
236 (2) to kill bacteria in food
p (3) to transmit signals over long distances
235
A. (2) only
Q B. (3) only
234
C. (!) & (2) ooly
233
R s D. (1)&(3)only
Atomic number Z
90 91 92 93 23. < HKCE 2002 Paper II - 40 >
2
The above diagram shows the mass number A and atomic number Z of a few nuclides. The isotope ofneptunium (Np) shown A radioactive isotope 2;� Th undergoes a series of decay processes to fonn a daughter : Pb. How many a-particles and
decays by emitting an a particle and then a ft particle.. �-particles have been emitted in this decay process ?
Which of the following represents the resulting nuclide ? No. of «-particles No. of P-particles
A. p A. 6 7
B. Q B. 7 6
C. R c. 7 8
D. S D. 8 7
I
24,
DSE Physics - Section E : MC.
RAZ : Atomic Model
n - 25 >
PE-RAl-
M/0 1
71
Which of the following are essential criteria in choosing radioactive sources as medical tracers "inhuman bodies ? In the upper atmosphere, neutrons are produced by the action of cosmic rays. These neutrons interact with nitrogen nuclei as
{1) The sources should have a short half.life. shown in the following reaction:
(2) The radiation emitted should have a weak ionizing power. 1iN
(3) The radiation emitted should not be deflected by an electric :field. �n+ ➔ X+ iH
A (1) & (2) only
B. (1)& �) <mly ElementXwill then emit a ftparticle.
c. (2)&mon1y The nuclear reaction is as follows : X ➔ Y + -� 13 .
D. (1), (2) & (3)
What is the final product Y?
n- 42 > A.
1
!c
i:c
25. < HKCE 2004 Paper
In order to detect cracks in an undergrotmd oil pipe, an engineer proposes adding a radioactive source to the oil Which of B.
the following sources is most suitable ?
A. a rsource with a half-life of a few hours
c. i;
N
B. a rsource with a half-life of several years D. �N
C. an a source with ahalf-life of a few hours
D. an a source with a half-life of several years
30. < HKCE 2009 Paper Il- 25 >
26. < HKCE 2005 Paper n- 25 >
c2;i Th) decays by emitting a P particle to form a daughter nucleus X Which of the following equations X --�"----> y z
-
A thorium nucleus
represents this decay ? The above shows part ofa decay series. Which of the following deductions is/are correct?
-
A 2:x+ P (1) X and Z are isotopes ofth e same element
��Th
-
(2) Xhas two more neutrons than Z,
B. ';:Th 2;!x + fJ
-
(3) Zhas one more proton than Y.
c. �Th 2;�x + P A. (I)only
B. (3) <mly
D. 2;� Th ��x+p C. (1) & (2) on ly
D. (2) & (3)only
r
Some fresh foods are exposed to radiations from radioactive isotopes for a short time so that the micro-organisms in the
2
A � U nuclide undergoes a certain number of a and P decays and becomes � Pb. F'md the number of ,8 particles emitted.
foods can be killed Why are the irradiated foods not harmful to people '\W.o eat them'?
A. 2
A. r radiation is an electromagnetic wave.
B. r radiation has a high penetrating power. B. 3
C. r radiation does not have a high ionizing power. c. 4
D. r radiation does not make the foods radioactive. D. S
I DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA2 : Atomic Model
PE-RA2-M/08 II I DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA2 : Atomic Model
PE- RA2- Ml 09 II
Part B : HKAL examination questions 38. < BKAL 2010 Paper IIA- 42 >
A radioactive source having a half-life of 5.3 years has an initial activity of 2500 Bq. A cancer treatment requires 10 seconds
33. < BKAL 1981 Paper I- 33 > of irradiation ofthis source to give a certain number of radiation particles on a cancer site. If the same treatment is required
after 2 years by this radioactive source. what should be the time of irradiation to give the same number of radiation particles?
A stationary radioactive nucleus of mass number N emits an alpha particle, leaving a daughter nucleus of mass number N-4.
The ratio of the kinetic energy of the alpha particle to the kinetic energy of the daughter nucleus is A. 13 s
A. (N-4)/4 B. 15 s
B. N2/(N-4)l c. 18 s
C. (N-4"f!N D. 21 s.
D. (N-4)2/42
34. < HKAL 1994 Paper IIA. - 45 > Part C : BKDSE examination questions
A stationaxy U-238 nucleus undergoes a.-decay. What is the ratio of the kinetic energy of the daughter nucleus to that ofthe
o:-particle? 39. < HKDSE 2012 Paper IA - 36 >
A. 238:4
Isotopes of an element have different mass number A and neutron number N. Which of the following N - A plots correctly
B. 4:238 shows the relationship ofN and A for any given element ?
C. 234:4 A. B.
D. 4:234
HKEAA's Marking Scheme is prepared for the mm::km.' I'Cfetence. It should not be regazded as a set of model answers.
42. <HKDSE 2015 Paper IA -33 > Stttdents and teachers who are not involved in the marking process are advised to intt:ipret the Marlcing Scheme wi1h care.
A piece of ancient wood is dated using caxbon-.14 dating method. It registers a corrected count rate of lLO counts per minute
while a fresh wood sample cut from the same kind of trees gives a corrected count rate of 15.6 counts per minute. What is the M.C. Answers
approximate age of the wood found in the archaeological site? Given: half-life of carbon-14 is 5730 years.
A. 890 years I. A II. B 21. C 31. A 41. D
B. 1300 years
C. 2000 years 2. B 12. D 22. C 32. C 42. D
D. 2900 years 3. B 13, B 23. B 33. A 43. B
4. C 14. C 24. A 34. D 44.B
43. < HKDSE 2018 Paper IA- 32 >
X and Y are two radioactive nuclides. The ratio of the mass of an atom ofX to that of an atom of Yis 1 : 2. The half-lives of 5. B 15. B 25. A 35. A 45. 8
X and Y are T and 2T respectively. If two samples consisting of purely X and Y respectively have the same initial mass, :find
the ratio of the number ofundecayed nuclei ofXto that of Yafter a period of 4T.
A. 1 :4 6. B 16. B 26. D 36. A 46. D
B. 1 :2 D 27. D 47. C
7. 17. B 37. B
C. I: 1
D. 2: 1 8. D 18. D 28. D 38. A
9. B 19. A 29. C 39. D
44. <HKDSE 2019 Paper IA--32>
10. A 20. C 30. B 40. A
M.C. Solution
1. A
The magnetic field is directed out of paper.
The magnetic force is towards the right
By using Left-hand rule, the direction of current is upwards,
that is same as the direction of motion.
Thus the radiation carries (+) charge, it must be a-particle.
:. 1X ➔ 1'=.W + 1He
2. B
45. <HKDSE 2020 Paper IA-31>
p �R
P -�-Q ---;-.._ S �
-----z__ T
X
✓
(1)
(2)
Both have 17 protons.
No. ofneutrons in i�Cl = 35-17 = 18
No. ofneutrons in f;ct =37-17 =20
X
(3) Isotopes have identical chemical pr operties.
NncJide P can d�y ioto .imclide Tthrough ehheT process P- Q- R - Tor process P- Q- 8- T a.s
$hmm. Which deductions below are com:ct?
3. B
(1) P and Tare isotopes.ofthe same clem=it.
QaodSbavctheumcnumbcrofprotoos.
X (1) Isotopes have different number of neutrons but have same number of protons.
(2)
(3) S has one more neutron than R. Different mass number represents different physical properties.
X (2)
A. (l}m,d(2)omy ✓ (3) This is the definition ofisotopes.
B. (l) and (3) Cllly
C. (2) and (3) only There is question in next page
D. rn. fZ1 and m
46. <HKDSE 2020 Paper IA-32>
A. is random.
B. depends on pressure ,nd temperature.
c. is directly proportional to the number ofnucleons. in 1he isotope.
D. is an identifying cbaracterimc ofthat isotope.
Two radioactm: samples P and Qare freshly prepared. It is found that when � ofall the nuclei ofP
16
63 half-life of p ,
I,a-,odecayed, of all the nuclei of Qbave also d..,.yed. Find the ratio
64 half-life of Q
A. I 4
B. 2 3
C. 3 2
D. 4 I
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RA2-MS/02 DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RA2-MS/03
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
4. C 12. D
✓ (!) �U ➔ �0Th +�He
✓ (2) 2i!At ➔ �Bi + 1He
2
Balancing the mass number :
• ( 3) 21:in ➔ l�Pb + fX
238=A+2x4 :. A=230
Balancing the atomic number:
5. B 92 = 2 + 2 X 2 + 2 X (-}) Z = 90
Isotopes have different number of neutrons but have same number ofprotorui, so as the electrons.
13. B
6. B Upper number = Mass number of neutron = 1
20� 10 S700- l 5
Lower number = Charge ofneutron = 0
:. Age ofthe wood = 5700 x 2
14. C
7. D Assume the mass number of Wis 100 and the atomic number of Wis 50. (OR any two arbitrary values)
(1) �X ➔ jHe + 2;:A; since the atomicnumberofYis 90, there must be �-decay in the series.
✓ (2) ✓ (!) Wand Zhave the same atomic number, thus they are isotopes.
✓ (3) BothX and Yhave the same atomic number 90.
✓ (2) The atomic number ofXis 51, which is the greatest among the above 4 nuclides.
(3) The mass number of Yis 96, which is less than that of WandX, not the greatest.
8.
Balancing the equation: ziJu ---1!!4 �1Th � 2!:Pa � �;Ac
15. B
X=a
✓ A_ Carbon-14 dating makes use of the detection of/3-radiation emitted by caibon for archaeological study
B. Examination offetuses makes use ofultrasoimd
✓ C. Killing cancer cells makes use ofy-rays
9. B ✓ D. Sterilb.ation offood makes use ofy-rays
Isotopes have different mass number but same atomic number, ie. 50.
:_ ;!
1 X and T'm have the same atomic number and thus they are the same element. 16. B
p particles are only partly absorbed by thin sheet ofalumi:nimn
10. A amount of 13 particles passing through depends on its thickness
p can be used to check thickness of alumillium sheets
Balancing the mass, 235 = 207+4x •• X =7
Balancing the charge, 92 = 82 + 2(7) + y(-1) y =
4 17. B
(3) numberofneutrons = massnumber-atomicnumber = 214-83 = 131 ✓ (3) Same mass number ⇒ same total numbers ofneutrons and protons
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RA2-MS/04 I DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE -RA2-MS / 05
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
18. 26. D
"•' Np � 233
" X � 233
nS The symbol of/J is -� �-
Thus the mass number ofX is unchanged and the atomic number ofX should be 9I.
19. A
✓ A Age of ancient :findings can be found by C-14 that emit 13 radiation with a constant half-life
B. Use y-rays to kill bacteria and germs 27. D
C. Use cM·a.diation to ionize the air Since P and Y are two isotopes, they must have the same atomic number but different mass number.
D. Use fl-radiation to check thickness of aluminium sheets
Assume the atomic number ofP and Yare both equal to n.
20. C
Assume the atomic number ofP is Z
Atomic number of Q = Z - 2
np � n+IQ � n+2R � ns
Atomic number of R = Z - 2 + 1=Z -1
Atomic number of S = Z - 2 + 1 + l = Z ✓ (1) BothX andR have the same atomic number of n + 2.
Thus, P and Shave the same atomic number, they are isotopes of the same element ✓ (2) Both Y and Shave the same atomic number of n.
✓ (3) Both Zand Q have the same atomic number of n + L
21. C
22�Ra
28. D
After the foods have been exposed to y radiations,
22. C
✓ carbon 14 dating is used to estimate the age of ancient remains the foods will not become radioactive,
(1)
✓ 0) gamma rays are used to kill bacteria in food since there is no radioactive source in the foods.
X
(3) microwaves are used to transmit signals over long distances
29. C
23. B The neutron interacts with nitrogen:
Balancing the equation : 2;6 Th ----
2
�� Pb + x i a. + y -� 13 1
�n + iN ➔ :X+ :H
1
(I) Since the atomic numbers ofXand Z are not equal, they are not isotopes of the same element
25. A
(2) The number of neutrons ofX is 50 and the number of neutrons ofZ is 96 - 49 = 47
r source should be used Thus Xshould have 3 more neutrons than Z.
since it bas great penetrating power to pass through the pipe wall and the ground to be detected. ✓ (3) The number of protons of Y is 48 and that ofZ is 49,
The balflife should be short in order to reduce the harmful effect to the enviromnent thus Z bas one more proton than Y.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution PE-RA2-MS/06 DSE Physics - Section E : MC. Solution PE-RA2-MS/07
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
31. A 37. B
Massnumber ofK is 234 and atomic number ofK i s 84. Consider the mass number : 244 = 208 + a (4) a = 9
�:K � �ix � n�y ---1.._,,. �z There are 9 alpha particles emitted in the series.
Considertheatomicnumber: 94, = 82 + 9x(2) + b(-1) b= 6
The final product isP which has the mass number of230 and atomic number of83.
There are 6 beta particles emitted in the series.
As each emission of beta particl e involves a decay ofneutron, there are6 neutrons having such change.
32. C
238 = 210+4a • • a, = 7
38. A
92=82+2x7-!3 Theinitialactivity:Ao = 2500Bq.
33. A
A:ftertwoyears, theactivityAbecomes: A= (250o,tJ l )"" = 1925Bq
:. KE cc 39. D
LetZbe the atomic number, which is equal to the number ofprotons.
A=Z+N :. N=A-Z
Compared with y = m x + c, thegraph is a straight linewith slope +l and with a negative y•intercept
34. D 40. A
i
KE= .!.mvi = (mv AtomicnumberofX= 92-2+1+1-2 = 90
2 2m
MassnumberofX= 238-4-0-0-4 = 230
since th e daughter nucleus and the o: particle must have thesame magni tude of momentum after the explosion
Since 1he initial mass ofX andY are equal, initial number of undecayed nuclei ec �--,'--- The following list of formulae may be found useful:
Mass of one atom
Since mass ofone atom ofX : mass of one atom ofY = 1 : 2 Law ofradioactive decay
2t =
N0 x ( ½J r i ¼No Part A : HKCE examination questions
/fy =
Radioactive
source
Ainmininm shoot - - - - -
--r:'0,------"5'--?ffi<r-- -
D
Detector
(i) State what type ofsource (ix, f3 ory) should be used. (1 mark)
(u) Explain briefly why the other two types ofsource are not used. (2 marks)
m- -
radioactive
source
(i) Cl-particles,
Figure l 20om -----•A
(ii) 13-particles, and
20cm (b) The parent Cl source is � Ra. Ifthe daughter nucleus of Ra after Cl decay is X, write down the equation ofthe Cl-decay-.
N
(3 nwk,)
(i) If 2:U decays by emitting four ct-particles and two /:I-particles, what will be the atomic number and mass number
(c) If 7;1X decays by emitting one Cl particle and one 13 particle to form a stable product nucleus Y, what will be the atomic
of the resulting nucleus? (6 marks)
number and mass number ofY? (2 marks)
(ii) A GM counter is placed at A as shown in tp.e Figure I about 20 cm from the source. What types of radiation can (d)
144
be received by the counter at A ? (2 marks) / A
B ,/
142
N-o,
of C
(iii') An electric field is applied across the metal pl.ires Mand N as shown in the Figure 2 so that Mis connected to the
Neutrons 140
/
positive tenninal andNis connected to the negative terminal. ofa voltage supply. The GM counter is now moved to
B about 20 cm from the source. DescnOe and explain what h appens to the count-rate. (2 marks) ✓
/ D
138
,/
(c) If an Cl-particle is emitted from an atom of � Ra during the decay process, what will be the mass number and the
atomic number of the daughter atom? (2marks) (ii) What is the mass number of C? (I nwk)
I
4.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
=
Time/hour 0 20 40 60 80 100 120
--�--x Totalcount rate/counts per min. 1100 498 259 161 125 110 104
LeadboxP A
(a) Suggest TWO major sources of background radiation. (2 marks)
E.H.T.
(i) Sketch the electric field pattern betweenX and Y. The direction of the field should be shown.
(b) Plot the graph of the CORRECTED count rate against time on graph paper. Hence find the half-life of the isotope.
(it) If a radioactive source emitting o:; particles is placed in P, the ammeter shows that a current is flowing. ExplaID. (6nwks)
whythereisacurrent. (2marks)
(iii) Explain what happens to the ammeter reading ifthe source in (ii) is replaced by one emitting y rays? (2 m arks)
(iv) Suppose now a radioactive source 2;1Pa is placed inP. 2fiPa decays by emitting a� particle and yrays to form
a daughter nucleus U.
(1) Write down an equation for the decay.
(2) On the below figure, sketch and labelthe paths ofthe radiation emitted by the source.
--'---X
LeadboxPH A
E.H.T.
(b) Leaks in underground oil pipes can be detected by adding a small amount of radioactive source into the oil being
pumped. Oil flows out from the leaks and radioactivity is detected on the ground around the leaks.
(i) Which type of source (a., 13 ory) is suitable? Explam briefly. (2marks)
(c) By considering its half-life, state whether the isotope is suitable to be used for injecting into a patient's vein so as to
investigate his blood circulation. Give your reason. (3 marks)
(ii) Two sources emitting the suitable type of radiation of half-lives 50 years and 10 hours are available. Which one
should be used? Explain briefly. (3 marks)
I DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
(b) State two nuclides in the series which are isotopes of each other. (1 mark)
(b) Suggest one suitable detector for the above system. (lmarlc)
(c) The final stable nuclide of the series isx; whose atomic number is 82 and the number ofneutrons is 126.
(c) Explain how the monitoring system can detect bottles of detergent that have not been filled up to the required level.
(i) Fmd the mass numbers ofA andX
(3 marks)
(d) Some of the nuclides in the figure also emit y-radiation when they decay. However, it is impossible to identify these
nuclides from the figure. Explam briefly. (2 marks)
(d) Two sources emitting the suitable type of radiation of half-lives 10 minutes and 5 years are available.
(i) What type(s) of radiation emitted by the source can reach the counter? Explain briefly. (2 marks) (ii) Which source should be used? Explain briefly.
(e) State two safety precautions that factory workers should take when handling radioactive sources. (2 marks)
(iii) Explain briefly why the three readings differ from each other. (2marks)
I DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
PE - RA2 - QI 8
0
I I DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
PE-RA2
-Q I 0
9 I
8. < HKCE 1997 Paper I - 6 > 8. (d) Xis placed very near the metal plates and the galvanometer reading is recorded every 30 seconds. The results obtained
are shown below :
High voltage
d.c. suPPly
�----� o-----� Time/ s 0 30 60 90 120 150
Current/ 72 48 32 22 15 10
(i) Plot a graph of current against time on graph paper.
Metal plates
I\ t -
" . ' ' ".
• •....+4+�-- i'-
: :t1.#j:
J: 1
-!- 4 1-t
Two metal plates are COllD.eclcd to a high voltage d.c. supply and a galvano.o:ieter as shown in the Figure above. When a
+
radioactive source X emitting a particles is placed very near the metal plates, the galvanometer shows that a current is
flowing. WhenX is moved a small distance away from the two plates, the galvanometer reading quickly drops to zero.
(a) Explain why there is a current and why jtis present onlywhen Xis verynoar the metal plates.
(b) �X decays by emitting an a: particle to fonn a stable nucleus Y. Write down an equation for the decay. What is the
neutron number ofY? (3 marks)
,�
i:
(b) A factory produces alumilrium sheets 1 mm in thickness. The thickness of the sheets is monitored by a gauge as shown
in the figure below. A jJ source is used in the gauge.
(c) The half-life of �Na is 15 hours. A sample of �Na withanactivityof32 x 103 disintegrations per second is injected
into the blood stream of a patient. After 45 hours, 6 cm.3 of blood is taken out from the patient's body and its activity is
found to be 5 disintegrations per second.
Radioactive source
(i) Explain why a and r sources are not used in the gauge. (2nwks)
(ll) Which ofthe nuclides (X or 1') is more suitable to use as the radioactive source? Explain your answer. (2 marks)
(ill.) Suggest two reasons for USUlg �Na in this dilution test (2nwks) (iii) The count rate recorded should be around 90 counts per second when the thickness of the aluminium sheet is 1 mm.
On a certain day when the gauge is operating properly, the following: data are recorded :
Time/s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100
(d) State an application of radioactive isotopes, other than tracers, in each of the following fields ; Describe and explain the variation in the readings in the above table.
i
ytc-�-r-�:1/
11. < HKCE 2002 Paper I- 10 > 12. < HKCE 2004 Paper I- 9 > to an alarm cireuit
r---<'-=:::::J---------1111---�
7£#<r2,ow,
Iodine-131 ( 1�1) is a radioisotope which decays by emitting a !3-particle and y rays. It is used in hospitals to test the kidneys
Lcium
ofpatients. During the test, an iodine-131 solution is injected into the bloodstream of a patient As the blood passes through
the kidney, iodine-131 will be absorbed by the kidney and eventually excreted out of the body with urine. Ifthe kidney is not
functioning properly, both the absorption and excretion rates of iodine-131 will decrease. A y-dctector is placed near the ,Jot
electrode ..,,...,-
kidneys of the patient to detect the activity ofthe :radiation cotnlllg from the kidneys as shown in the above figure. SOlll'CC
(a) UsingXto denote the daughter nucleus, write down an equation for the decay ofan iodine-131 nucleus.
Figure 1 m.,...,
Figure 1 shows a smoke detector. The circuit inside the detector is shown in Figure 2. A small amount of1he radioisotope
americium-241 ( 2:�Am) is placed between two electrodes. The two electrodes are cOJlD.ected to a battery and an alann
(b) Explain why the !3-particles emitted by iodine-131 fail to reach the detector. (1 mark) circuit The detector has slots in it to allow airflow.
(a) An americium-241 nucleus decays by emitting an a-particle to form a daughter nucleus neptunium (Np), with a half-life
of 432 years.
(c) The half-life ofiodine-131 is 8 days. (i) Write down an equation for the decay ofan americium-241 nucleus. (2 =ks)
(i) State the meaning of 'half-life'. (2 rrwks)
(ii} For safety purposes, the activity of iodine-131 solution in the test should not exceed 1.5 x 108 disintegrations per
second. When an iodine-131 solution is prepared, its activity is 6 x 108 disintegrations per second. How many (b) Under normal conditions, a small current flows in the circuit inside the detector. However, when smoke particles enter
days after preparation would the solution be suitable for the test? (2marks) the detector, the current drops significantly. This triggers the alm:m to sound.
(i) Explain why a current flows between the electrodes under normal conditions. (3 marks)
(ii) Suggest one possible reason why the current drops when smoke particles enter the detector. (2 marks)
Left kidney
(c) Explain why it is preferable for the radioactive source used in smoke detectors to have a long half-life. (2marks)
"--------------..Time/min
The above graph shows the variation of the activities of the radiation detected from the right and left kidneys of a
patient wi1h time. Which kidney do you think is not functioning properly ? Explain your answer. (3 marks)
(d) Carbon-14 ( 1!C ) is a radioisotope which decays by emitting fJ particles and has a half-life of 5700 years. Explain
whether this source is suitable for use in smoke detectors or not (2 marks)
(iv) Besides iodine-131, technetium-99m is another radioisotope that can be used in the kidney test. Technetium-99m
emits y radiation only and its half-life is 6 hours. Which of these two sources do you think is more preferable for
use in the kidney test 7 Explain your answer. (4 marks) (e) People are conce.med about the biological hazards of radiation. If you are the manufucturer of the above descnbed
smoke detector, how would you explam to the public that using the detector will not pose any health hazard ? (2 marks)
II
13.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
Iodine-131 therapy consists of two stages. In Stage 1, the patient will take a low dose of Iodine-131 to trace
the remaining thyroid tissue. A detector is placed near the patient to monitor the activity of the radiation
coming from the patient.
In case any remaining thyroid tissue is spotted in Stage 1, the patient will then take a higher dose of Iodine-
131 in Stage 2. The iodine will be absorbed by the thyroid tissue and the radiation emitted can kill the
cancer cells.
Special hospital rooms are designed for patients who receive Stage 2 of the therapy. The rooms have metallic
shielding in the doors and reinforced walls. Inside the rooms, there are plastic covers on the furniture, doors,
handles and switches.
Source: Iodine-131 Therapy, The Ohio State University Medical Center, 2003.
(a) Explain why, in Stage 1, 13 radiation from the patient cannot be detected by the detector. (1 mark)
20
.:/:t.:�-� ·,---, ,- .-,-.- ,--- ,· -.., '
LL.W..U..U..U..U.'-'..U..U..W..U..U..U..U..U..LL.W..U..U..W..U..W..W..W..W..U..W..U.•Atomic number
82 83 84 85 86
(a) Estimate the mass ofundecayed Rn-222 after 15.2 days if its initial mass is I x Io-5 g.
(b) 1n Stage 2, which kind of radiation is more effective in killing cancer cells ? Explain your answer.
(b) State the nuclear radiation emitted in process (I) indicated in the above Figure. (I nmk)
(c) Write down a nuclear equation for process (2) indicated in the above Figure, (2 marks)
(c) State one special feature of the hospital rooms designed for patients receiving Stage 2 of the therapy and explain its
function. (2 marks)
(d) Determine the total number of a particles and the total number ofP particles emitted in the radioactive decay series from
Rn-222toPb-206. (4marks)
1
1S. <HKCE2010Paperl-8>
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
PE-RA2-Q /16
I I16.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
I
Read the following passage about low-level radioactive waste and answer the questions that follow. Carbon-14 dating can be used to identify the age of some objects. Living organisms contain a constant proportion of
carbon-14. After an organism dies, the amount ofcarbon-14 in it decreases due to decays. We can estimate the age of an
object by measuring the activity of carbon it contains.
Low-level Radioactive Waste
(a) Carpon-14 undergoes decay as shown in the following nuclear equation, where D denotes the daughter nucleus.
Industrial, medical and educational institutions in Hong Kong generate small amounts of low-level radioactive waste.
Such waste produces no detectable heat output and is of low radioactive level. Weakened radiation sources from '!C ➔�+�
hospitals and educational institutions are examples oflow-level radioactive waste.
Find the values ofx and y. (2,n,,ks)
For many yean;, most of the waste had been stored in disused tunnels and hospitals. The Government considers that in
the long nm the low-level radioactive waste should be stored in a pmpose-built facility. After about two years of
construction, the Low-level Radioactive Waste Storage Facility (the Fac.ilit:Y) (see the Figure below) at Siu A Chau, an
uninhabited island to the southwest of Lanta.u Island, was successfully commissioned and began its operation in July
2005. It comprises a shielded waste storage vault, a fully equipped laboratory. an automatic control room, an advanced (b) In a piece ofwood found, the activity of 10 g ofcarbon is 35 disintegrations per minute. It is known that the activity due
wastewater treatment plant and specially designed waste reception and processing area. The radiation levels inside and to 10 g of carbon in a living plant is 140 disintegrations per minute. Estimate the age of this piece of wood. Given that
outside the Facility are continuously monitored to ensure safe operation. the half-life ofcarbon-14 is 5700 years. (3 marks)
17. <HKCE2011Paperl-7>
It is known that plutonium-238 ( 2;!Pu} decays by emitting one ci. particle.
(a} Write a nuclear equation for the decay of plutonium-238. Use the symbol Y as the daughter nucleus. (2 marks}
(b) A sample ofplutonium-238 is put in a cloud chamber. Some tracks are seen.
(a) State one characteristic oflow-level radioactive waste. (1 mark) (i) Describe the tracks that are seen.
(b) Explain why Siu A Chau is suitable for the storage oflow-level radioactive waste. (1 mark) (ii) No tracks can be seen when the sample is covered by a piece ofpaper. Explain. (2nmks)
(c) Suggest an instrument to monitor the radiation levels inside and outside the Facility. (c) Plutonium-238 can be used in heater units in spacecrafts for outer space missions. It is known that the power of the
heater unit is directly proportional to the activity of plutonium-238 contained. Each heater unit has a power of 2 W
when it is newly manufuctured. How long can a newly manufuctured heater unit last if the minimum power ou1put
required is 0.25 W?
Given : half-life of plutonium-238 = 87.7 years (3 marks)
(d) In hospitals, rndioactive sources are used as tracers. The radioactive source is injected into a patient's body and the
radiation level is monitored with detectors outside the body. Explain whyy source is suitable for using as tracers.
(2nmks)
I DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
The :figure below shows the decay series for an isotope of uranium: 2;1U.
144
142 (c) Give two factors that determine the activit;y of a radioactive source.
"'
140
N,m,on P,
number
136
Atomic
134
88 89 90 9l 92 number
20. < HKAL 2009 Paper I- 8 >
(a) Name the particles emitted when
Carbon-14 dating is used in archaeological study to detennine the age of an ancient sample.
(i) Uranium (U) decays to Thorium (Th); and (1 nwk)
(Given : mass of one mole of carbon-12 = 12.0 g and half-life of carbon-14 = 5730 years )
(ii) The relative abundance of carbon-14 in living things is only one wbon-14 atom for every 7.2 x 10 11 atoms of
carbon-12. Calculate the activity for 1 g of carbon in living things. (3 marks)
(b) Given that the half-life of �U is 7.1 x 10 8 yeani, what would be the percentage of �U left ina sample after a period
ofl 08 years ? (3 marks)
(b) (i) Explain the origin of carbon-14 in the atmosphere and why the abundance of carbon-14 in living things, such as
plants, remains more or less constant (3 marks)
(a) (i) Find the decay constant ofpotassium-40. (2 marks) (ii) An archaeologist measured anactivity of2 Bq from 60 g of carbon in a piece ofancient bone. Use the result in (a),
estimate the age of the bone. (3 marks)
(ii) Give the physical meaning ofthe decay constant of a radioactive isotope.
I DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
I I22. <HKDSE2016Paper1B-9>
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model
PE -
RA2-
Q /2111
Part of the decay series ofuranium-238 (U-238) is shown below. The end product lead-206 (Pb-206) is stable.
21. <HKDSE2013Paper1B-9>
Carbon-14 dating can be used to identify the age of some objects which have the 14C isotope, as it is radioactive and decays nJu ----"---�
9
➔
by emitting a ft-particle. A piec e of wood sample is exammed using carbon-14 dating and its activity is 0.2 Bq. The half-life 4.5 x 10 years
of 14Cis 5730years. Given: I year = 3.16 x 107 s
(a) When a U-238 nucleus decays to a Pb-206 nucleus, how many a-particle(s) and ,B-particle(s) are emitted? (2 mark s)
(a) Calculate the decay constant of 14C in s·1• Hence find the number of 14C nuclei in this wood sample. (3 marks)
(b) As the first decay in the above chain from U to Th has a half-life much longer than those of subsequent decays, the
decay from U-238 to Pb--206 can be simplified to a single decay with half-life4.5 x 109years :
(b) The carbon content ofthis wood sample is found to contain a total of 1 x 1023 carbon nuclei. Estimate the number of 14 C (1) Estimate the age of the rock. Assume that all Pb-206 atoms come from the decay ofU-238 originally present in the
nuclei in the sample originally when it died. sample and ignore the small number ofU-238 atoms which have decayed but have not yet become Pb-206.
(1 mark)
(2 marlcs)
(ll') State, with a reason, whether the answer in (b} (i) is an overestimate or underestimate of the age ofthe rock if some
Pb-206 atoms have actually been lost (2 marks)
(iil) The graph lll. the Figure below shows how the number ofU-238 atoms in the sample varies with time t subsequently
(c) Estimate the age ofthis wood sample in years using the results found in (a) and (b). while t = 0 denotes the present time. On the same Figure, sketch a graph to show the variation of the number
ofPb-206 atoms in the sample with time. (2 marks)
no. ofatoms
'
' U- 8
0
PE-RA2-Q/22 PE-RA2-Q/23
I
DSE Physics - Section E : Question DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
OJ �� Pb, 2� Pb and 20�Pb are three stable isotopes of lead. State, with a reason, which isotope can be the end
product in this series. (2 marks)
ti$•Blic.e:'Of.:POiom'um;.2J'.0
(ti) In a certain laboratory, aRa-226 source has been used for 50 years. Estimate the percentage ofundecayed Ra-226
left after this period (2 marks)
'��
(a) Write a nuclear equation for the decayofpolonium-210.
(b) Spark counter can show the ionizing power of radiations. The Figure indicated the main features of a type of spark
counter in school laboratories.
(b) Briefly explain how the a particles help clean the charged dust (2 marks)
A spark counter consists of afine metal wire mounted a few mm beneath an earthed metal gauze. The wire is connected
to the positive terminal ofan E.H.T. (Extra High Tension) supply so that a very intense electric field is set up between
the wire and the metal gauze. When a Ra-226 source is brought near the gauze, sparks giving out flashes of light and
crackling sound are produced at irregular intervals.
(c) Briefly explain why the polonium-210 slice must be fixed near to the brush hair. (l mark} (i) Explain why the sparks occur at irregular intervals. (1 """<)
A Ra-226 source used in school laboratories is usually said to emit ct, (:J, as well as y radiations.
(ii) Explain why (:J, radiation is also emitted even though the source is primarily an a-emitter. (1 nwk)
(d) The manufacturer recommends that the brush should be returned to the factory for replacement of the polonium-210
slice every year. Taking the activity of a newly replaced polonium-210 slice as 1 tmit, find its activity after one year
(365 days). Given: half-life ofpolonium-210 is 138 days. (2 marks)
(iii) Why is the sparking mainly caused by a radiation rather than p or r radiation ? Suggest a simple way to verify this.
(2 """1<s)
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2- QS I 01 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2-QS/ 02
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
HKEAA's Matlcing Scheme is prepared for the markers' tefcrence. It should not be regarded as a set of model answers.
Students and teachers who are not involved in the marking process are advised to u,.t:c:n,ret the Madcing Scheme with care. 3. ca) (i) mass number of a: = 4 [!]
(ill a: is not used because it is totally absorbed by the aluminium sheet [l ] (b) �: Ra ----)- � X + i a: [3]
OR
et is not used because its penetrating power is too weak that it cannot pass through alumiruum sheet. [l] (c) atomicnumber = 91-2+1=90 (!]
mass number =234 - 4 = 230 [!]
y is notused because the count rate would not be affected significantly by the aluminium sheet. [!]
OR (d) (i) A � B : a particle [!]
y is not used because its penetrating power i s too strong that almost all y will pass through the sheet. [I]
B � C : !3 particle [!]
(b) Any TWO ofthe following: [2] c� D : a: particle [!]
* radiotherapy D-----+ E : a: particle [!]
* estimate the age of archaeological samples (ii) MassnumberofC = 141 +92 =233 [!]
*
=r=r i==r
r :
medical tracer
* sterilization
* leakage test of underground oil pipes
4. ( a) (i)
* Sllloke detection
[Note : Thickness gauge is NOT acceptable since itis the application in part (a).)
4. (b) (i} Arsourceshouldbeused. [!] 5. (b) Half-life "" 15hours <I4-16hoursisacceptable> [!]
Since the penetrating power ofy is high enough to reach the ground. [!]
(c) Yes, it is suitable [!]
(ii) The source with halflife 10 hours should be used. [!]
The half-life is long enough for the doctor to d iagnose the patient. [1]
Reason: (Any ONE of the following) [2]
* It gives less pollution to the environment as its activity disappears quickly
The half-life is short enough to cause less harmful effect on the patient [1]
* It causes less hannful effect to the environment as its activity disappears quickly OR
The half-life is not too short [1]
and not too long. [!]
s. (,) Any TWO of the following: [2]
* Cosmic radiation from the space
* Radiation from the rocks
* Radiation from air
6. (a) (i) o: particle [!]
Corrected count rate / cpm 1000 398 159 61 25 10 4 (c) {i) MassnumberofA = 142+90 = 232
[1]
Corrected count rate/ cpm Mass number ofX = 126 + 82 = 208
1000
(h') Total number of o: particles emitted = 232-208 [!]
4
• 6 [1]
(d) y emission does not change the atomic number and mass number ofthe nuclide. [2]
. :.+' - ,- {e) (i) /3 and y radiation can reach the counter because their ranges in air are longerthan 20 cm. [2]
' ""'-+ '
_,
; (ii) A corrected count rate is equal to the recorded count rate minus the background count rate. [2]
'.
.-1-1+• :·-i
(fu') The readings differ d ue to therandom nature of radiation. [2 ]
400
Time/hour (b) AGM tube {OR Geiger Muller tube) (OR GM counter) can be used.
0 20 120
< Two axes labelled correctly> [!] (c) If a bottlenot filled up to the required level passes the source,
< Suitable scales chosen> [!] the counter will record a much higher reading than that when an acceptable bottle passes th e source, [2]
< At least 5 points plotted correctly> [!]
since the /3 radiation does not pass through the detergent and hence isnot absorbed. [!]
< Smooth curve drawn > [!]
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2- QS I 05 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2-QS/06
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
7. (d) (i) The half-life is the time taken for half ofthe number ofundecayed nuclei in the source to decay. [2] 8. (d) (i)
Current/ µA
OR
The half-life is the time taken fur the activity ofthe source to fall to halfof its initial value. [2]
OR
The half-life is the time taken for the mass of the undecayed nuclei in the source to decay. [2]
* The source will decay slowly and can be used for a long time.
* The activity ofthe source will be very stable to be used for a long time.
* Handling :radioactive sources using special forceps (OR remote controlled robots)
* Radioactive sources should be stored in lead castles and returned to the storage box after use
[2]
1
10.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution
RA2 : Atomic Model
(b) (i) a: source is not used because the penetrating power ofa particles is too low.
PE-RA2-QS/08
[1]
l1
y source is not used because the penetrating power ofy radiation is too high. [I]
(b) The GM tube is held close from the source and its reading is noted. [l]
Insert a piece ofpaper between the GM tube and the source. [1] (ll) Nuclide Yis more suitable. [I]
The count rate would remain unaffected. This shows that the source does not emit ct particles. [l] As nuclide Yhas a longer half-life, its activity remains stable over a longer period oftime. [I]
Insert the aluminiumsheet between the tube and the source. The count rate would drop significantly. [!]
(ri.i) The reading remains steady from t = 0 to 50 sand from t = 80 to 100 s. [!]
This shows that the source emits 13 particles.
The small variation within this period is due to the random nature of radioactive decay. [I]
(c) (i} Numberofha!f-liveselapsed = � = 3 [1] The reading drops significantly from t= 60 to 70 s.
15 [I]
(ii) Total activity in the blood ofthepatientafter45 hours = 32 x 103 x (½J -" 4000 [!]
The aluminium. sheet in this period is thicker than the normal value. [I]
V 4000
[l]
6 5
OR [2]
V = 4800 cm. 3 [l]
(b) The P particles fail to pass through the human body. [I]
(c) (iii) luiyTWOofthefollowing: [2]
* The half-life is long enough for medical diagnosis. OR
* The half-life is short enough to reduce the hanniiil effect to the human body. The p particles are absorbed by the human body. [1]
* Thedaugh.tetnuclei Mg isstableand has noharmfuleffect
(c) (i) The half-life is the time taken for the activity ofthe source to drop to half of its initial value. [ 2]
(OR Sodium and magnesium have no harmful chemical effects on human body,)
(it) No. ofhalf-life = 2 [I]
(d) {i) Any ONE ofthe followings: [1]
* Radiotherapy
Thesolution is suitable after 2 x 8 = 16 days [!]
*
Since tecbnetium-99m has a shorter half-life [I]
Food preservation (Steriliz.ation ofbeef)
and does not emit P particles, [I]
*Le,bg,-
* Radioactive lightning conductor so it causes less harmful effect to the patient. [I]
* Smoke detector
[2]
10. (a) (i) The atomicnumberincreases byone. [!]
The mass number remains unchanged. [1] (it) Numberofneutrons = 237-93 = 144 [1]
(ii) The activity of spccimenXwill fall to a quarter ofits original value. [1] (b) (i) The ex-particles will ionize the !Ill' to give ions. [2]
The activity of specimen Y will remain approximately unchanged.. [1] The ions then move to the electrodes to give a CUirellt [I]
(iii) As the mass of p particles emitted is very small, [1] (li) The smoke particles block the movement ofthe charged particles. [!]
the mass of the specimen would almost remain unchanged after 12 hours. [!] As a result, fewer ions reach the electrodes, so the current drops. [I]
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2- QS /09 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2- QS / 10
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
I
12. (c) The activity of the source will remain stable for a long period of time. (OR decay very slowly) [!] 15. (a) It produces no detectable heat output [!]
So the detector can be used for a longer timer. (OR The source needs not be replaced frequently.) [!] OR
It has a low radioactive level [!]
(d) As ,8 particles have a weaker ionizing power, [!]
the current flowing between the electrodes will b e extremely small. [!]
(b) It is because it is an uninhabited place. [!]
So Carbon-14 is not suitable.
(c) GM counter ( OR GM tube) [!]
(e) Any ONEofthefollowing: [2]
OR
* The radiation dose from the smoke detector is very small
photographic fihn [!]
* The radiation from the smoke detector is much less than the background radiation. (d) Ithasweakionizingpower [!]
(½J
[!]
Since the ionizing power of!3 is higher than �t ofy radiation. [!] OR
(b) 35 = 140 140➔70➔35 [1]
(c) The rooms have metallic shielding in the doors and walls. [!]
:. n = 2 [1]
They can prevent radiation from leaking out of the rooms. [!]
OR The age of the wood = 2 x 5700 "' 11400 years [1]
Inside the rooms, there are plastic covers on the furniture, doors, handles and switches. [!]
This prevents otherpersons using the room from being contaminated. [!]
(OR ;o:) [2]
[!]
I
20.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution
RA2 : Atomic Model
(b) (i) Carbon-14 is formed when neutrons produced by cosmic rays collide with nitrogen.
1�N+tn➔
PE-RA2-QS / 1211
(ii') /3 particle [!]
'!c+:,P [!]
Carbon-14 forms radioactive carbon dioxide and is taken up by plants for photosynthesis.
(b) k =�
7.lxl08
= 9.76x10-10 year-1 [!] ( OR Carbon-14 is taken up by animals through eating.) [!]
This exchange maintains the same abundance inside a living thing until it dies. [I]
[I]
(li) Activity of the bone per gram: A = ,.3_ = 0.0333 Bq [!]
:. perccntageleft = 90.7% [!] 60
_J{_ a ( 2) [!]
N, OR
o')l{7,WO')
= (½J = 0.907 [I]
By A•A,,
(!)"'
2
• (0.0333) a (0268)[½)
,mao
[!]
.-. percentage left = 90.7% [!]
t = 17200 years [!]
7.2xlOll c,) a 2
N
12
A = kN = (3.84 x 10-12) x (6.97 x 101°) [!]
t = 3.32 x 109 years < accept 3.3 x 109 years> OJ
= 0.268 Bq < accept 0267 Bq> [I]
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA2-QS I 13 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE- RA2 -QS / 141
RA2 : Atomic Model RA2 : Atomic Model
22. (b) (it") Answer in part (i) is underestimate. [!] 24. (a) (i) 226-206 = 20 whichisamulti.pleof4(foro:) [!]
The origilialnmnber ofU-238 should be greater. 2
:. � Pb is the end product [!]
present number of U -235 at oms
The ratio is in fact smaller than � [!]
originalnumberofU-238atoms 5
[!]
thus, longer time should have been elapsed.
(ii) Some of the daughter products ofRa-226 may emit ,8particles [!]
(fuJ Since the ionizing power of f3 and rare weaker than that of a [!]
U-' 8
Any ONE of the following: [!]
0
* Raise the source to a distance greater than the range of a, sparks will cease.
* Insert a paper between the source and the gauze, sparks will cease.
23. (a)
2 2
:Po ➔ :Pb + iHe < accept i o; > [2]
(c) This is because a. has a short range ofa few centimetre in air. [!]
36S/138
j
(d) A = (I) X (-) [!]
2
= 0.160 unit [!]
OR
3. Ch angeofState(*h!Mli;t.l!i!:)
4. General Gas Law (f-:iUi.ilt:$::4:t) Atomic mas s unit U = 1.661 X 1Q·2'7 kg (1 u is equivalent to 931 MeV)
5. Kinetic Theory (�"TiU(rtll,)
Section B- Force and Motion (:/J;fi,;r(�) Speed oflightin vacuum
1. PositionandMovement(,utJ::ft,;f,;t,i)
2. Newton's1aws(4'Mit.f.lt)
Chargeofelectron e= L6xlo·19c
3. Moment ofForce (:h�)
Avogadro constant
4. Work.EnergyandPower(fp/.1, �:li:if�:W.'.fl.)
5. M omentum(l!lii:) Molar gas constant
6. Projec ti le Motion (:<tl�tiJ)
7. CircularMotion(!HJ;llliltlJ)
8. Gt-avitation(�!fl)
The following list of formulae may be found useful:
Section C- Wave Motion (iltt/J)
1. Wave Propagation (iti¥.141Ht) Law of radioa ctive decay
2. Wave Phenomena (it�J.Jl�)
3. Reflectionand RefractionofLlght (76>¥.1.&.Af.&.# Af)
ln2
4. L enses (.i!it) Half.life anddecay constant t1.• = -
5. WaveNatureofLight(,;'c.��:th#-ht) k
6. Sound(�¼)
Activity and the numberofundec ayed nuclei A=kN
Section D - Electricity and Magnetism ( 11!:::fi>.i:i)
1. Electr ostatics C*1!!:4!-) Mass--energy relationsh ip M=!:i.mc2
2. Ele ctricCircuits(1!!:J!S.)
3. Domestic Electricity { *� Jff 'Ii!:)
4. MagneticField(tii::J¼)
5. Electromagn etic Induction (1!!:-filiUU
Part A : HK.CE examination questions
6. Alternating Current (3(.$1,i_ 1!:)
Section E- Radioactivity and Nuclear Energy (�MJJtt.'fl';Jt�I;)
1. < HKCE 1983 Paper II - 37 >
1. Radiation and Radioactivity (�Af'f";!;x.M;,U'l)
2. Atomic Model (,W-T��) In the following nuclear reaction:
3. NuclearEnergy(#int)
�;Al + iHe ➔ ��p + X
Physics - Elective part (i!1ffF 1t) what is the mass nwriberand atomic number ofX?
Elective I -Astronomy and Space Science (1-.�.!¥,,fi,fl/t.1-.#<$-) Mass number Atomic number
1. The universe seen in different scales (:f: !llJ :!!M;!l.i.r 1,1/ � 'iii ilii tie.)
A. 0
2. Astronomythrough history (��*llllff-Jil.Jt)
3. Orbital motions under gravity (�hTllll'-M..it.iltlJ) B. 0 -1
4. Stars and the universe (•/1.!l.'f" q:'jjj) c. 4 2
D. 0 0
Elective 2-Atomic World (4 "'T-tJI:�)
1. Rutherford's atomic model C.tl&#i&.T.ilt�)
2. Photoelectric effect (;It, 1t£t..1.)
2. < HKCE 1986 Paper II- 40 >
3. Bohr's atomic modelofhydrogen(;ti 1,1/ itli T-fiti!)
4. Particlesorwaves(Jl'.tt.T.;lilt) Which of the following equationsrepresent(s) possible nuclear reac tions?
5. Probinginto nanoscale(1it�.tfi;f.'!lt.J})
(1) 1�B + neutron --,,. �Li+ a.particle
Elective 3 - Energy and Use of Energy (.tl;t�fisi'N.�11t.lfl')
1. Electricity at home (��/fl it) 2
�Bi --> �Po + f3 particle
(2)
2. Ener gy efficien cyin building (��tro�i/ii.a!fi)
3. Energy efficiency in transportation (.;t#'.tfrott.ij.a!fi)
4. Non•renewable energy sources (;f:";;J".jlj-:itt,i!f.) i
(3) 1 N + a particle --> '! 0 + proton
5. Renewable energy-sources ('if.j?}.:i:fisi:l!i.)
A. (l)on.J,y
Elective 4 -Medical Physics C -1-!¥:#Jl£ �) B. (2) onl,y
1. Making sense of the eye C !llH{I S; 1") C. (1) &(3) o nly
2. Makingsenseoftheear(�'9"<i\'i) D. (2) & (3)only
3. Medical imaging usingnon•ionizingradiation (.'/f 'lltNE.t&M M*i.HU�)
4. Medical imaging using ionizing radiation (1tN!:.t&Af-U-,f,:J:Hf.4'e)
! l.l=====D
...
3.
RA3 YSlC .;;;:s - S ecllEnergy
;;;:SE;;;::PhNuclear
;;;:
= ;;;: ;;;: = = ;;;: = ;;;:
< HKCE 1991 Paper II - 39 >
E -
·on E : M .c . =====P - RA =3 M /02 11
_ _;;;: - = - :::.1._ I
7. < HKCE 2005 Paper II- 26 >
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
P-
E RA
-3 M/03 l
:Kr+
"Which of the following equations represents(s) possible nuclear reaction(s) ? Which of the following nuclear reactions is a nuclear fusion?
(3) �Pa + Z Which of the following descriptions about the nuclear reaction above is correct ?
��Th
A. It is a nuclear fission.
X y z B. It is a nuclear fusion.
C. It is a chain reaction.
A. an ct particle a proton a !3 particle D. It is a radioactive decay.
B. an ct particle a neutron a !3 particle
C. an a. particle a neutron yrays
D. a !3 particle ,n,utron yray s
Part B : BKAL examination questions
6. < HKCE 2004 Paper n- 40 > 11. < HKAL 1.980 Paper I- 49 >
i
Find the values ofx and y in the above nuclear reaction. 2
(2)
2
��Bi � �Po .+ beta particle
X
A. 2
y
1
(3)
1
i 1
N + He ---?> ; 0 + proton
A. (1) ooly
B. 2 2
B. (3) on ly
C. 3 1
C. (1) & (2 ) only
D. 3 2
D. (2) & (3} ooly
I12.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
1� N + alpha particle ----+ proton + X Which ofthe following nuclear reactions are accompanied with a mass defect?
In the above nuclear reaction, X represents (l) the union oflzydrogen isotopes to form helium
A . i;o
�H + �H --+ �He+ �n
B. 1;F
(2) the natural radioactive decay ofradium-226
C. 1;N
1� 1;:Ra � �Rn+ iHe
D. C
(3) the emission of a ,B-particle from a nucleus
13. < HKAL 1992 Paper I - 44 > �n � iH + -� e
The main reason why a chain reaction can occur in a nuclear reactor using uranium-235 is that A. (1)&(2)only
A. a large quantity of energy is evolved in each fission. B. (i) &(3) on ly
B. the products ofnuclear fission are highly radioactive. C. (2) & (3) only
C. plutonium is produced and it undergoes further fission. D. (1),( 2)&(3)
D. more than l neutron is produced when a nucleus undergoes fission.
14. < HKAL 2003 Paper IIA- 43 > 18. <HKAL2013 Paper IIA -44>
The sun and stars give out their power mainly by The sun radiates energy at a constant rate of4.0 x 1025 Wby a nuclear fusion process. The mass ofthe sun is 2.0 x 1030 kg.
(1) radioactive decay. Estimate the lifetime ofthe sun if0.07% ofits mass is converted into radiation energy during the sun's lifetime.
(2) nuclearfission. Given; 1 year= 3.15 X 101 S
(3) nuclear fusion.
A. (I) only A. 1.0 X 106 years
B. (3) onl y B. 1.0 X 10 10 years
C. (!) & (2) only C. 1.0 X 1012 years
D. (2) & (3) only
D. LO x 10 17 years
22. In a particular chain reaction, a neutron collides with a heavy nucleus. The nucleus then splits to give two lighter nuclei, 27. The main reason why a chain reaction can occur in a nuclear reactor using uranium is that
energy and
A. a large amount of energy is released in each fission.
A. alpha particles.
B. the products ofnuclear fission are bigblyradioactive.
B. - beta particles.
C. uranium splits into two smaller fragments.
C. �protons.
D. fission neutrons are produced
D. ' neutrons.
28. Ifthere were accident in a nearby nuclear power plant, which ofthe following is NOT the way that the radioactive substances
23. Vlhich of the following show(s) nuclear fission?
released in the accident can spread to the neighbouring lands?
23
(1) �U + �n A. Bywind
B. Byrain water
(2) z:!Pu � 23
� U + � He
c. By -
D. Byplants
A. (1) oilly
ii. ·(3) only 29. Which ofthe following is NOT the disadvantage of using nuclear energy?
C. . (1) & (2) only
A. The capital investment of a nuclear power plant is very large.
D. (2) & (3) o nly
B. There must be leakage ofradiation i n a nuclear power plant
C. Once accident occurs, it would be veryserious.
24. A U-235 nucleus 'Will split when it captures
D. The disposal. ofradioactive waste is a difficult problem.
A. an alpha particle.
B. a beta particle.
C. a neutron. 30. Which ofthe following do(es)NOT make use ofnuclear fusion?
D. aproton. (1) A nuclear bomb
(2) A hydrogen bomb
25. The Stm. releases its energy mainly by (3) Emission oflightby a star
A. (1) only
(1) radioactive'decay.
B. (3) only
(2) nuclear fission. C. (1) &(2) only
(3) nuclear fusion. D. (2) & (3) only
A. (!)only
B. (3)only
31. Which ofthe followings are the advantages ofusing nuclear energy?
C. (1) & (2) only
D. (2)&(3)on ly (1) Nuclear energy causes less pollution to our environment
(2) The running cost ofpower plant using nuclear energy is lower.
26. The following equations represent some typical nuclear reactions : (3) Nuclear energy is the only choice other than the use of fossil fuel.
(I) !Be + :H -,), �Li + ;He A. (l) &(2) only
B. (1) &(3) only
(II) ;H + �H ---+ 1He + �n C. (2) &(3) only
D. (!), (2) &(3)
(III) :i;;u + tn ---+
1
i�La + �!Br + 3 �n
,. Which of the following descriptions ofthese reactions is/are correct? 32. Which ofthe following are the advantages ofusing nuclear fusion to generate electricity?
(1) Reaction (I) represents an o:-decay. (1) The fuel for nuclear fusion is hyd rogen which has unlimited supply in oceans.
(2} Reaction (II) represep.ts a nuclear fusion. (2) The waste products in nuclear fusion are not radioactive.
(3) Reaction (Ill) represents a nuclear fission. (3) The nuclear fusion takes place at a very high temperature.
A. (l)only A. (1) &(2} only
B. · (1) & (2) only B. (1) &(3) only
C, (2) & (3)only C. (2) & (3) only
D. (1), (2) &(3) D. (1), (2)&(3)
I
33.
DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
Which of the following are the difficulties to use nuclear fusion for generating electricity?
(1) Nuclear fusion can only take place at a very high temperature.
PE
-RA3-M
/0811
I DSE Physics - Section E : M.C.
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
(2) No physical container can withstand the high temperature that fusion occurs. 38. < HKDSE Sample Paper IA-34 >
(3) It is difficult to dispose the waste products of the fusion. Which ofthese is a nuclear fusion reaction?
A. {1) & (2) only
B, (!) & (3) only
C. (2) & {3) only
D. (!), (2) & (3)
�:Ra -
34. Which of the following nuclear reactions is/are an example of fusion?
(1) 2;!N + �He+ energy
HKEAA's Marking Scheme is prepared for the markets' refexence. n should not be regarded as a set of model answers.
42. < HKDSE 2015 Paper IA - 31 > Studemli; and teachers who are not invoivcd in the marking process are advised to interpret the Marlring scheme with care.
Which ofthe following nuclear reactions is/are spontaneous reaction(s) ?
(1) ft
Na ➔ �Mg+ -� e M.C. Answers
1 B 1. A 11. D 21. C 31. A 41. C
(2) � + �n ➔ ;Li+ !He
I
,. B 13. D
( 1)
2
:Po ➔ m�Pb + iHe x, a. particle Neutrons can trigger the further fissions ofthe remaining u.235 nuclei, thus maintain the chain reaction
6. D
• (}.) Nuclear fission occurs for element ofvery high atomic number.
The sun and stars do not contain these elements.
The symbolofneutronis tn
✓ (3) The sun and stars contain mainly hydrogenand helium for nuclear fusion to take place.
Balance the mass number : 2 +x=4 + 1 :. X =3
Balance the atomic number : 1 + 1 = y +0 :. y = 2
15. B
7. C ✓ (1) i
Small nuclei � H combining to form large nuclei He is a fusion process.
A. This is an example of nuclear fission. • (2) Since energy is released, there must be mass defect Thus the total mass of the product should be smaller.
B. This is an example ofbombardment ofparticle into a nucleus. ✓ (3) 2�H➔ �He+ �x .. X is a neutron.
✓ C. Fusion is the combination oftwo smaller nuclei : H-2 and H-3 to form a larger nucleus : He-4.
D. This is an exam.pie of-alpha decay.
16. C
(D 235 + 1 = 141 + 92+ q
8. A
✓ A. It is a typical fission ofU-235, triggered by a neutron. 92+0=56+:z+0
23. A 31. A
✓ (1) It is a typical fission ofU-235. ✓ (!) Nuclear energy makes use of fission does not produce air pollution.
X (2) It is an a-decay. ✓ (2) Nuclear energy is cheaper once the chain reaction starts.
X
(3) It is fusion. X
(3) Other than the fossil fuels, there are renewable energy resources
such as solar energy, wind energy and hydroelectric energy.
24. C
"When a neutron is captured by a U-235 nucleus, the neutron will trigger the fission ofthe uranium nucleus. 3 2. A
✓ (!) In ocean, there is unlimited supply ofwater that consists of hydrogen.
25. B
✓ (2) The water products in nuclear fusion are helium which are noble gas and not radioactive.
X (1) The Sun does not contain radioactive nuclei to give radioactive decay.
X (3) Fusion takes place at hlgh temperature is a disadvantage, not advantage.
X (2) The Sun does not contain large nuclei to give fission.
✓ (3) The Sun contains mainly hydrogen that undergoes fusion to give out solar energy.
33. A
✓ (!) Nuclear fusion takes place at very lngh temperature; it is not easy to produce such a high temperature.
26. C ✓ (2) Even the high temperature (about IO 000 000°C) is aclneved, all containers will change to gases.
X (!) Reaction (I) is the bombardment of proton on the Be-9 nucleus to give two other nuclei. The waste products of fusion is clean and not radioactive, and thus no disposal problem.
X
(3)
✓ (2) The combination of two smaller nuclei to give a large nucleus is called fusion.
✓ (3) The split up ofa large nucleus to give two smaller nuclei is called fission. 34. B
X (1) lt is an example ofa.-decay.
27. D X (2) It is an example of /3-decay.
The fission neutrons can trigger further fissions of the remaining uranium nuclei to give the chain reaction.
✓ (3) It is an example ofnuclear fusion.
28. D
35. B
✓ A. Wind can carry the radioactive waste from one place to another place.
Fusion is combining two smaller nuclei (hydrogen nuclei) to fozm a large nucleus (the helium).
✓ B. Rain water can carry the radioactive waste :from one place to flow to another place.
✓ C. Alrimals can bring the radioactive waste and move to another place.
X D. Since plants cannot move, they cannot canyradioactive waste from one place to another place. 36. B
As I u is equivalent to 931 MeV,
29. B mass equivalent of the energy released = 5-00216 "" 0.00537 u
✓ A. Building a nuclear power plant is very expensive to ensure every safety measure. 931
X B. A good design ofnuclear power plant e nsures no leakage ofradiation to the environment By conservation of mass and energy,
✓ C. If explosion occurs in a nuclear power plant, it would cause disastrous effect to the environment 23.99096 "" 23.98504 + m� + 0.005373
✓ D. Since the wastes of fission product are radioactive, their disposal causes a series problem. :. m� = 0.00055 u
I DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
PE-RA3 -MS /06 II DSE Physics - Section E : M.C. Solution
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
PE-RA3-MS/07
37. A 44. D
By !::.E = twJ cz (1) Chain reaction only occurs in nuclear fission. This is a nuclear fusion, chafu reaction does not occur.
:. AE = (2x 10 16)x(3 x 108)2 = 1.8 x 10'3J ✓ (2) There are 3 fission neutrons that can trigger the remaining u.235 to give chain reaction.
Assume 365 days in 1 year. ✓ (3) There are 3 fission neutrons that can trigger the remaining Pu•239 to give chain reaction.
39. B
Since the reaction is to combine two hydrogen nuclei into a helium nucleus, it is a fusion reaction.
Mass defect = 2.014 + 3.016 - 4.003 - 1.009 = 0.018 u
Enezgyrcleased = 0018 x 931 = 16.76 MeV
40. B
In l second, energy released is 3.8 x 1026 J.
By /!,,E = twJc Z
(3.8xlOU)=6»1(3x108)1 :. twJ=4.2xI09 kg
41. C
By Einstein's equation:
/::.E=t:.mc1
:. (4.9 X 106 X 1.6 X 10-1� = l::,m X (3 X 108)2 :. t:.m = 8.7 x 10-30kg
Since energy is released, there is mass defect
Thus, the total mass ofthe daughter nucleus Yanda-particle is less than the mother nucleus.
42. A
✓ (1) This is a beta-decay reaction, which is spontaneous.
X (2 ) This is a bombardment reaction, triggered bythe hitting of neutron onto the nucleus B� 1 0.
X (3) This is a fusion reaction, which occurs when the temperature is hlgh enough.
43. B
X (1) The decay is spontaneous, can take place in any temperature.
✓ (2) Mass defect: t:,m = 238.05079 - 234.04363 - 4.00260 = 0.00456 u
Energyreleased: E = 0.00456 x 931 = 4.25 MeV
• (3) The energy released in the decay will become the kinetic energy of both Th and He.
I DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
PE - RA3
-Q /
01 I I
1.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
PE-RA3-Q/02
(d) The development of nuclear energy is a controversial issue. Do you support the development of nuclear energy? State
I
Use the following data wherever necessary :
the reasoning to support your point ofview. (4 marks)
Speed of light in vacuum
The following list of formulae may be found useful: 2. < HKAL 1983 Paper IlB - 7 >
Half-life and decay constant 0.18 unit lost 0.007 unit lost
to atmosphere to atmosphere
Activity and the number ofundecayednuclei
reactor 0.49unit
Part A : HKCE examination questions to coolingwater
In a nuclear reactor using U-235 as fuel, 1 unit of fission energy produced would undergo the changes shown in the above
1. < HKCE 2003 Paper I - 9 > figure, that finally 0.323 unit of electrical energy is obtained.
In 1986, a disastrous nuclear accident happened at the Chernobyl Nuclear Station. A large amount of radioactive substance (a) Suppose the electrical power output ofthisplantis I066MW.
was released and spread to neighbouring countries. The radiation levels recorded in these countries were much higher than
the nonnal background count rate. (i) Calculate the total power generated by the reactor. (! nruk)
(b) State one way by which the radioactive substances released in the accident were spread to neighbouring countries.
(! mruk)
(b) The turbine is cooled by circulating water through it at the rate of 48 m3 s- 1• Calculate the rise in temperature of the
cooling water. (Density of water = 103 kgm-3 , specific heat capacity ofwater= 4200 J :icg-1 K-1) (3 marks)
(c) One of the radioactive isotopes released in the accident was caesium-13 7 (Cs-137). The following equation shows how
Cs-137 is produced:
(c) In the reactor, energy is produced by the fission ofuranium-235 atoms.
mu+ n 141 Ba + 92Kr + 3n
(i) If z = 4, find the values ofx and y and state their physical meanings. (4marks) Given: z.su,,,235.0409 u; 141 Ba= 140.914lu; 92Kr= 91.9250 u; n= l.0086u.
Calculate the number ofuranium atoms which undergo fission in I s.
(ii) The half-life ofCs-137 is 30 years. Suppose that a soil sample contaminated by Cs-137 is 30 years was found to
have an initial activity of 1.2 x 1()6 Bq (disintegrations per second). A physicist comments that the contaminated
sample will affect the envirorunent for more than 300 years. Justify the physicist's claim 'With calculations. You
mayasmime that the activity of a non-contaminated sample of similar nature is 200 Bq. (3 marks) (d) The nuclear plant is designed to produce power continuously for 10 years without refuelling. Estimate the mass of
uranium-235 required. Given that the molar mass ofU�235 is 235 g. (2 marks)
Ii
3.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
i Ii
S.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
�n = l.0087u
(a) According to the above equation, find the mass defec t between the reactants and products when one �; U nucleus (b) Given: mass ofhydro gen = 1.00728 u
undergoes fission. (2 marks) mass ofhelium = 4.00150 u
Calculate the energy r eleased in each fusion by the Sun. Express your answer in joule.
23
(b) If4.00 x 10-5 kgof �U undergoes fission in one second, calculate the rate of energy production. Take the mass of
one moleof ��U as235 g. (3ID"ks) (c) Calculatethe total energy r eleased by the Sun for every kilogram of hydrogen fu sed to form helium nuclei. Take the
mass of one mole ofhydrogen (� H)be I g. (2 marks)
(a) Calculate the massofa neutron, express the answer in atomic mass unit. (3 marks) (a) Write an equation for thedecay and find the energy released, in MeV, in the d ecay. (3 marks)
(b) The fuel in the reactor contain 1.0 x 104 kg ofU-235. calculate the total energy released when all the U-235 nuclei in
the fuel haveundergone fission. Take the mass ofone mole ofU-235 as 235 g. (3 marks) (b) The energy released in the deca y becomes the kinetic energy of the deca y products. Explain quantitatively why the
a-particle takes most of the decay energy. Assume that the parent nucleus is at rest initially. (2 marks)
(c) If the average power output of the react or is 500 MW and the efficiency of conversion of nuclear energy to electrical
energy is 40%, estimate the time for whic h the fuel can be used. (2 marks) (c) Hence cal culate the speed v of the a-particle, assume all the decay energy is transferred to the a-particle. (2 mmi<.s)
I
7. <HKAL2012PaperI-6>
DSE Physics - Section E : Question
I
Iodine-131 ('�I) is a common radioactive nuclide found in radioactive waste from nuclear power plants. It undergoes
P decay and becomes a stable nuclide Xenon-131 (' 31Xe) with a half-life of8.02 days. 8. (a) When an alpha particle strikes a beryllium( :Be) nucleus, one caxbon ( 1� c) nucleus and one particle Q are formed.
Write down the nuclear equation. What is the particle Q? (3 marks)
(a) Write down the decay equation oflodine-131. (1 mark)
(li) Assuming that all the decay energy oflodme-131 becomes heat, find the initial heating power of 1 kg oflodine-131
intheunitW. (4marks) (ii) If electrical energy costs $0.9 for 1 kWh, how much does it cost for the electrical energy generated in one day?
(4nwk,)
Given: mass ofaniodine-131 nucleus = 130.90612 u
(ill) Calculate the electrical energy that can be produced by 1 kg of uranium in the fuel rod. (2marks)
(c) Even after a reactor is shut down and nuclear fission is completely stopped, fission products like Iodine-131 keep on
producing heat. Explain why we cannot stop the Iodin.e-131 from producing heat. (2 marks) (iv) Fmd the mass of uranium fuel used in one day. (2nwk,)
(c) Some people propose that nuclear energy should eventually replace oil and coal as sources of energy supply. Do you
agree with this ? List 3 reasons to support your argument (4 marks)
(d) Iodine-123 is another radioactive isotope ofiodine. It emits y rays and has a half-life of 13 hours. As thyroid in the
human body readily absorbs iodine, Iodine-123 is commonly Ulled as a medical tracer for diagnosis of thyroid diseases.
Give ONE reason why Iodine-123 is more suitable to be used as medical tracer than Iodine-13 I. (1 mark)
DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RA3-Q/07 I DSE Physics - Section E : Question PE-RA3-Q/08
RA3 : Nuclear Energy RA3 : Nuclear Energy
9. In a nuclear reactor for generating electricity, Uranium�235 undergoes :fimion 10 generate energy. Part D : HKDSE examination questions
(b) The waste products from a nuclear reactor contain isotopes which are radioactive and emit 13 radiation. They are stored
in sealed metal cans for 200 years until the activity decreases to 400 Bq that can be disposed of.
(b) One ofthe radioactive isotopes released in the accident was caesium•137 (Cs•137). The following equation shows how
(i) Explain how these isotopes are produced. (2 marks) Cs· 137 is produced
(lll) State the reasons why metal cans are used to store the waste products. (1 mmk)
(ii) Find the energy release in the fission of one U•23S nuclide in MeV. (2 marks)
(iv) It is knovm. that the half life of the radioactive isotope in the metal cans is 25 years. What is the initial activity of
the waste products in the cans? (3 marks)
(iii) The half.life of Cs..137 is 30 years. A soil sample contaminated by Cs•l37 has an activity of 1.2 x 106 Bq. A
physicist comments that the co ntaminated sample will affect the environment for more than 350 years. Justify the
physicist's claim with calculations. It is known that the activity ofan uncontaminated soil sample is 200 Bq.
(2 marks)
(v) Calculate the initial number ofatoms ofthe radioactive isotope in the metal cans. (3 ma rks)
(c) David wonders why nuclear fusion is not used to generate electricity. Suggest two reasons to explam this. (2 marks)
11. < HKDSE 2012 Paper m • 11 >
BKEAA's Marking Scheme is prepal'Cd for the matkers' reference. It should not be regarded as a set of model answers.
Students and teachers who are not involved in the marking process arc advised to iDtcipret the Marking Schc:me with care.
12. < HKDSE 2015 Paper IB - 10 > (c) (i) x = 92-37=55 [!]
Scientists had been experimenting controlled fusion in a nuclear reactor in which deuterium { � H) and tritium (� H) undergo y = 235+1-137-4 = 95 [!]
the following nuclear fusion : x is the atomic number of Cs [!]
y is the mass number of Rb [!]
�H + �H ➔ iHe + �n + energyreleased
(ii) Number ofhalf-life in 300 years = 10 [!]
Given : mass ofa deuterium nucleus 2.014102 u
Activity after 10 half-lives = (12 x 106) x (½ ) 1° = 1172 Bq [!]
mass of a tritium nucleus 3.016049 u
mass of a helium nucleus 4.002602 u After 300 years, the activity is still higher than that ofnon-contaminated sample, thus his claim is correct. [!]
mass of a neutron = 1.00866Su OR
(a) Calculate the energy released, in MeV, in the above nuclear fusion. (2 marks) ByA=Ao- (!)"'"'
.. (200) = (l.2x106)x(.!..)1/3o [!]
2
t = 377 years [!]
{b) In the nuclear reactor, deuterium and tritium exist as plasma, which is a mixture of ions at a very high temperature. A time longer than 300 years is required for the activity to drop to safe level, thus his claim is correct. [!]
To start the fusion reaction, the average kinetic energy of the ions in the plasma has to reach the minimum value
of0.2MeV.
(d) I support the development of nuclear power since
(i) Explain why a very high temperature is needed for nuclear fusion to occur. (2 marks)
it is cheaper as the running cost is lower, and [2]
itis clean since it does not produce air pollution and acid rain. [2]
OR
I do not support the development ofnuclear power since
(ii) Estimate the order ofmagnitude of the :minimum temperature at which fusion of deuterium and tritium nuclei would
be possible if the plasma can be regarded as an ideal gas. (2 marks) itis dangerous as once accident occurs, it would be very serious, and [2]
itis expensive as the capital investment is very high. [2]
< accept other reasonable answers >
There is question in next page
13. <HKDSE 2019 Ppaper-IB-10> 14. <HKDSE 2020 Paper 1B -10>
(a) Toe equation below represents "11Clear fission ofuranium-235 (IJ-235). Given: mass of proton = 1.0073 u
massofapai.1icle =4.0015u
mass of 1jN nucleus = 13.9993 u
235 l u1 · 92 1
92U+ 0n ➔ �6Ba+ 36Kt+x0u+200MeV
mass of 1JO nucleus = 16,9947 u
(f} What is the value ofx? (1 marl<)
When a stationary 1� nucleus is bombarded by an a particle., the following nuclear reaction can be triggered
with products 1JO andXfly off:
(Ji) State anecessaey condition for chain reaction offission to occur� (] JllBik)
Scientists fi>und evidence in Oklo, Amea that� nuclear fission oeeurred two billion (2 x 10� years ago.
The unmiom mineral .ore mined from OJdo at prE.Sent is found to ha� 0,6% concentration by mass of U�23 S *(b)Based on energy consideration,. estimate the minimum kinetic energy� in MeV, of the a particle required
(see the 1able below), m,foh is much lowor 1han usual. for such a nuclear reaction to occur. (2 marks)
(b} Toe table gives the infonnlllion ofU-235 and U-233 in a,amploofuraninm mineral ore follnd in OJdo.
G!ven:lialf-life ofU-235 =7.04,: IO'yeai,; (c) However, when conservation of momentum is also taken into account, the a particle must possess a
kinetic energy greater than that found in {b) to bring about such a reaction. Explain. (2 marks)
2 x 109 years :ago at present
U-235 m,kg 0.060 kg (Le. 0.6¾ conceottation by mass)
U-:2$3 13..S56kg 9.940 kg (i.e. 99.4% conci;ntrati.on by mass)
•(i) Estimll1ethe amoimt mo(m kg) ofU-235 in 11,esample 2 x lo' ye= ogo.
(ii) Hace determine whether natural nuclear fusion of U-235 was posnole 2 x IO' years ,go. For
fission of U·235 to imppon. its ooru;emmion by mass fu the uranium mineral ore has lo be at
least3%. (I mm:k)
� must be underground water in the vicinity of this uraniUm-ricb. mineral deposit for natural nllelear
.fission to Ile pOSSI"ble. Since water can 9low down the fust neutrons from .fission, these neutrons can easily be
captured by U-235.
(c) In fact the chain reaction stopped even befure the coru:entration by mass of U-235 dropped to 3%.
Explain why this occwred. (2 mm)
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA3-QS /02 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA3-QS I 031
RA3 : Nuclear Energy RA3 : Nuclear Energy
2. (a) (i) As 1 unit ofnuclearpower can only give 0.323 unit of electricity, the efficiency is 32.3% 3. (a) Mass defect= (235.0439u) - (90.9234u + 141.9164u + 2x1.0087u) [1]
Power generated by the reactor 1066 +32.3% 0.1867 u [l]
(ii) Power lost to the atmosphere = 3300 x (0.18 + 0.007) !!.. = 4.ooxrn-s x 6.02 x 1023 = 1.025 x 1020 s-1 [1]
t 0.235
= 617MW [1]
p= !!..e = (1.025 X 10� X [0.1867 X 1.661 X }Q-27 X (3 X J08)Z} [1]
(b) Power delivered to cooling water = 3300 x 0.49 t
= 1617MW = 2.86xlOg W [1]
[l]
In 1 s, volume ofwater circu.lating is 48 m1 Method@:
:. mass = volume x density = 48 x 103 kg !!_ = 4.00xlO-s x 6.02 x 1023 = 1.025 x t02°
s-1 [1]
t 0.235
By E = m c f:..T and consider the time of1 s.
p = !!...E = (J.025 X 102°) X (0.1867 X 931 X 106 X 1.6 X 10- 1') [l]
(1617 x W) = (48 x 1000) x (4200) x t::r [l] t
[I]
i 7.
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution
RA3 : Nuclear Energy
[I]
/J.E = l:,m c2 "' (0.02762) (1.661 X 10-27) (3 X 1Q'1')2 = 4.13 X :IO-IZ J [I] E = ($ X 1Q ) X (931 X
-4
106 X 1 .6 X 10- 9)
1
[I]
Number of fusion by 1 kgofhydrogen= _O_)_x (6.02 x HP) x .!. "" 1.505 x 1025 [I] P = EA=(7.45 xI0-14)(4.60x10'8)
3
{lxl0- ) 4
3.43 x 10s w <accept 3.4x 105 W to 3.Sx I05W> (I]
Energy released by 1 kgofhydrogen = I.SOS x 1026 x 4.13 x 10-12
(c) The decayofaradioisotope is determined by the half.life (OR decay constant). [I]
= 6.22 x 10 14 J <accept 6.14 x 1014 J to 6.28 x 10 14 J> [I]
It cannot be changed by human factors or surrounding factors. [I]
(b) (i) Numberofatoms ofH31 in I kg = __I_ x 6.02 x 10 23=4.60 x 10 24 (iii) Electrical energy produced by 1 kg ofunmium = 5.6 x 10 12 x 30% [I]
(I]
131x10-3
=l.68xI0l:zJ [I]
Decay constantofl-131: k= lnZ= ln2 = l.00xl0-6s-1 [I]
ti,2 8.02x24x3600 432xl0 13
(iv) Massofmaniumfuel used inone day [I]
l.68x1012
lnitialactivity:A 0 = kN0 =(l.00 x J0 )(4.60 x 1024) = 4.60 x 10 18 Bq
-6
[I] =25.7kg [I]
DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA3-QS/06 DSE Physics - Section E : Question Solution PE-RA3 -QS I 07
RA3 : Nuclear Energy RA3 : Nuclear Energy
8. (c) Agree [!] 10. (a) Any ONE of the following: [!]
Reasons : (any THREE of the following) < accept other reasonable answers> * cosmic radiation from space
* *
[3]
Reserves of oil and coal are limited. radiation from rocks
* Nuclear energy does not produce greenhouse gases. * radiationfrom human bodies
OR [!]
Disagree [!]
(ii) Mass defect = 235.0439 - (136.9071 + 94.9399 + 3 x1.0087) = 0.1708 u [!]
Reasons : (any THREE of the following ) < accept other reasonable answers> [3 ]
* The capital investment ofa nuclear plant is high. Energy released = 0.1708x 931 MeV = 159 MeV [!]
* The disposal of radioactive waste causes a serious problem.
(iii) Activity ofthe sample after 350 years :
* If there is accident, the damage to public is large.
A = (1.2 x 106) x (..!.) 3so/ao
* Some other resources of energy maybe used, e.g. solar energy. 2
••. A=369Bq [1]
Since the activity is larger than 200 Bq, the claim is cmecf. [!]
OR
9. (,) When a neutron is captured by a Uranium-235 nucleus, the nucleus undergoes fission. [!] (200) = (1.2 x 106) x cly/30 .-. t = 377 years [!]
It then splits into two smaller nuclei and together 'With some fission neutrons. [!] Since the time for the activity to drop to 200 Bq is longer than 250 years, the claim is correct. [!]
1n2 ln2
N = 5xIO x 6.02 x 1023 = 1.332 x 1016
"'"'
(v) Decay constant: k = = = 8.79xl0-l0 5-l [!] [!]
tu, 25x365x24x3600 226
m
Section D - Electricity and Magnetism ( 'il!:;fu-Zl't)
13. (a) r-3 IA 1. Electrostatics (M-11!:.!Jb)
I 2. Electric Circuits C 11!:Jl3.)
3. Domestic Electricity(,f..% }lj :t)
(li) More """"1>m are produced la eoch fissicn lbr trigg<ring IA 4. MagneticField(.tlli)
furtherfissions,.ie-.:r> 1. 5. Electromagnetic Induction (11!;.@llx,M,)
6. Alternating Current (�5/ii.11!:)
....,.[=
k=!!.!.{- 9-.3%xlo- yr-1)
'½
,.,.. ]
3. NuclearEnergy(;!a:�5)
m.
0.()6 • e
7.Gf.,,:10. IM
m Physics - Elective part (;J!if<I' ii-)
Elective 1-Astronomy and Space Science (�5C.�lf"'Alt.�#�)
m, - 0.429J82332 (ig) • 0.430 (l<g} IA
2
*
1. The universe seen in different scales (.:f:.13.1 J!f.:J;/lli.To¥.i 'iii ifigfe,)
2. Astronomy through history (1'.:SC.${8.ft-Al.31:.)
3. Orbital motions widergravity(frhT�.fh:i!.,!.:t'.1)
(ii) 0.430 •0.0307U91 .,3.1 %>3% 4. Starsandtheuniverse(•/j.J.�*'ili)
13556+0.430
Thus ruibnl noclet.r fission was
possible. 1),1/lA Elective 2 -Atomic World (,l,y. Ti!t-Jf-)
I. Rutherford's atomic model (lit£'f,U.'T"�lt-M)
I
2. Photoelectric effect(�'ttt.li)
(<) =···. IA
3. Bohr's atomic modelofhydrogen (�lff,l#.1 A't.&.-'f-;fJt�)
4. Particles or waves ($.'T"illc.iK)
nnc Energ,vreleased pY fissim drys 1JJ) dl.e � Vr'atl,r. IA) 5. Probing into nano scale(nl.�#J;r.i!t.ff,.)
� fission m.igbt stop wilbout .slow ueatrons. IA Elective 3 -Energy and Use of Energy ( � itifr:�ti.l!i.�itffl)
2 1. Electricity at home ( �.§ ffl 11!:)
2. Energy efficiency in building (;t_��.@;l,Mt�)
3. Energy efficiency in transportation(;{#,-1:"#.l �5/lf.!Jt�)
4. Non�renewable energy sources (.:f:. -;i--.jl};t_ /is.if.)
5. Renewable energy sources (�.pj.!£H6�)
Elective 4 -Medical Physics (i}$-Jj6;1.!$-)
1. Making sense ofthe eye (Bll#.1� 1?)
2. Makingsenseoftheear(.IF-#.l�'it)
3. Medical imaging using non�ionizing radiation Ula 'Ill: 14/t.iitM Y$£1t. ,!J!,)
4. Medical imaging using ionizing radiation ( 1lt$� M -U- :!f!, �{t$)